Download INVESTIGATING COMMUNICATION MANAGEMENT BY GOVERNMENT

Survey
yes no Was this document useful for you?
   Thank you for your participation!

* Your assessment is very important for improving the workof artificial intelligence, which forms the content of this project

Document related concepts

History of public relations wikipedia , lookup

Internal communications wikipedia , lookup

Distributed workforce wikipedia , lookup

Transcript
INVESTIGATING COMMUNICATION MANAGEMENT BY GOVERNMENT
DEPARTMENTS IN THE KWAZULU NATAL PROVINCE IN SOUTH
AFRICA
by
Ms. R.F. Mukhudwana
11168049
0767534844
[email protected]
Home department:
Marketing and Communication Management
Supervisor:
Professor Ronel Rensburg
Supervisor’s e-mail address:
[email protected].
Strategy of inquiry:
Explorative research
Submitted in partial fulfilment of the requirements for the degree
(PhD in Communication Management)
in the
FACULTY OF ECONOMIC AND MANAGEMENT SCIENCES
at the
UNIVERSITY OF PRETORIA
Date of submission:
2014-05-21
.
Open Rubric
FACULTY OF ECONOMIC AND
MANAGEMENT SCIENCES
Declaration Regarding Plagiarism
The Faculty of Economic and Management Sciences emphasises integrity and ethical behaviour
with regard to the preparation of all written assignments.
Although the lecturer will provide you with information regarding reference techniques, as well as
ways to avoid plagiarism (see the “Guidelines on Referencing” document, you also have a responsibility to
fulfil in this regard. Should you at any time feel unsure about the requirements, you must consult the lecturer
concerned before submitting an assignment.
You are guilty of plagiarism when you extract information from a book, article, web page or any other
information source without acknowledging the source and pretend that it is your own work. This does not
only apply to cases where you quote the source directly, but also when you present someone else’s work in
a somewhat amended (paraphrased) format or when you use someone else’s arguments or ideas without
the necessary acknowledgement. You are also guilty of plagiarism if you copy and paste information directly
from an electronic source (e.g., a web site, e-mail message, electronic journal article, or CD-ROM) without
paraphrasing it or placing it in quotation marks, even if you acknowledge the source.
You are not allowed to submit another student’s previous work as your own. You are furthermore not
allowed to let anyone copy or use your work with the intention of presenting it as his/her own.
Students who are guilty of plagiarism will forfeit all credits for the work concerned. In addition, the
matter will be referred to the Committee for Discipline (Students) for a ruling. Plagiarism is considered a
serious violation of the University’s regulations and may lead to your suspension from the University. The
University’s
policy
regarding
plagiarism
is
available
on
the
Internet
at
http://www.library.up.ac.za/plagiarism/index.htm. Also see the notes for Theme 2.
For the period that you are a student in the Faculty of Economic and Management Sciences, the
following declaration must accompany all written work that is submitted for evaluation. No written work will
be accepted unless the declaration has been completed and is included in the particular assignment.
I (full names & surname):
Rofhiwa Felicia Mukhudwana
Student number:
11168049
Declare the following:
1.
I understand what plagiarism entails and am aware of the University’s policy in this regard.
2.
I declare that this assignment is my own, original work. Where someone else’s work was used
(whether from a printed source, the Internet or any other source) due acknowledgement was
given and reference was made according to departmental requirements.
3.
I did not copy and paste any information directly from an electronic source (e.g., a web page,
electronic journal article or CD ROM) into this document.
4.
I did not make use of another student’s previous work and submitted it as my own.
5.
I did not allow and will not allow anyone to copy my work with the intention of presenting it as
his/her own work.
R.F Mukhudwana
Signature
21.05.2014
Date
ACKNOWLEDGEMENTS
First, is due acknowledgement to God almighty for giving me the strength, belief and perseverance
to see this study through. Very important is my sole supervisor, Professor Ronel Rensburg for her
assistance, guidance and encouragement throughout the study. Her vibrant personality, academic
success and professional demeanour are a lifetime source of inspiration. It is a great honour to
have been under her supervision and mentorship.
This research could not have been possible if it was not for the KZN GCIS (Ms Ndala Mgadi), Head
of KZN Government Communication (Mr Cyril Madlala), KZN Office of the Premier and the seven
Government Departments that took part in the present study. Thank you for opening the doors to
academic scrutiny and for mutual intellectual engagement.
My appreciation goes to the entire staff of the Department of Communication Management, Faculty
of Economics and Management Sciences at the University of Pretoria where this study was
conducted. Thank you to Ms Samantha Dathibool for always squeezing me in.
To the entire staff of the Department of Communication Science at the University of South Africa
(Unisa), I cannot thank you enough for a warm hospitality. Thank you to Prof Beschara Karam &
Siyasanga Tyali (if it was not for your support, I might have dropped the ball at work), Prof Viola
Milton, and Prof Blessing Mbatha for all assistance and motivation. To Dr Takalani Mudzanani,
thank you for a critical review. A big acknowledgement to the Department of Communication
Science at the University of Johannesburg (UJ) where the academic art was learnt and the Media
Studies Department at the University of the Witwatersrand (Wits), my foundation.
To the Department of Media and Cultural Studies at the University of KwaZulu Natal, UKZN
(Howard), I am forever grateful and appreciative of the motivation and support. Dr Zoe Molver, you
rock! Professor JP Wade, and to my friends: Mrs Anusharani Govender, Mrs Guiditta Toniolo, Mrs
Pam De Beers (UKZN), thank you.
To a gentleman who witnessed the beginning to the end of this research project, thank you for the
unwavering support.
For having faith and contenting with a ‘ghost friend’ Mr Muthu Ramabulana, Funanani Muremi,
Nwabisa Malotana, Luthando Ngema, Lerato Modisadife, Takalani Rambao, and everyone else (I
see you lol).
- -
i
DEDICATIONS
This thesis is dedicated to my lovely family: Mr Ronal Mukhudwana, Mrs Margret (Meki)
Bugana-Mukhudwana, Mrs Shathi Mukhudwana, Mushe Mukhudwana, Tshilidzi Valentia
Mukhudwana, My niece Unarine (Una) and the rest of the Mukhudwana and Bugana
family.
Mma vhari:
“Rilala risongolala, vhatshivuwa vhari rotalifha”
- -
ii
FINANCIAL ASSISTANCE
Financial assistance provided by the National Research Foundation (NRF) in respect of
the cost of this study is hereby acknowledged. Opinions or conclusions that have been
expressed in this study are those of the writer and must not be seen to represent the
views, opinions or conclusions of the NRF.
- -
iii
ABSTRACT
Communication practice in relation to government communication reveals a lacuna in
research and literature. Heise (1985:199) lamented the lack of academic interest in
government communication. Because of such scant literature, government communication
as a practice is poorly understood (Pandey & Garnett, 2006:37). Given its significance,
government communication is too important a challenge to ignore (Canel & Sanders,
2013). A question of how government communication should be organised and practiced
in order to contribute to effectiveness is rarely addressed. For that matter, Vos (2006:257)
prescribes future academic research in communication management to focus on exploring
government communication practices and factors that influence them. The present study
responds to such a call.
The theoretical framework of this study is based on the thesis that communication
management is vital for democracy. For government communication to be professional
and strategic, it must be organised excellently and effectively while taking into account the
advocacy nature inherent in external organisational rhetoric that could threaten the ethics
and legitimacy of (government) communication management. It is equally essential for the
distinctive communication environment of
the public sector (the public sector
distinctiveness theory) to be considered in both the theorising and the practice of
government communication.
The purpose of this study is to explore the extent to which the distinctive communication
environment of the public sector affects the practice of communication management in
provincial government departments within the KwaZulu Natal province. In addition, the
study examines the extent to which government communication can be strategic, ethical,
and distinctive.
This study arrives at the following conclusions: The data confirms the distinctiveness of the
public sector communication environment as measured by the 13 features identified from
literature. It is conclusive that these features significantly affect the practice of government
communication as they influence the organisational structures, communication practices,
roles and functions, and evaluation measures of communication management in provincial
- -
iv
government departments. However, it was found that the negative impacts of the public
sector communication environment can be considerably reduced by the extent to which
communication management in the public sector is professional, strategic (excellence and
effectiveness) and ethical.
The results demonstrate that government communication in KZN is relatively strategic
having fulfilling the excellence requirement of strategic communication. However, KZN still
falls short of achieving the effectiveness requirement of strategic communication. Hence,
improvements are recommended towards the fulfilment of the ‘effectiveness’ principle.
In conclusion, the study presented a model for strategic government communication that
takes into account the distinctive, strategic, and ethical elements. This framework
demonstrates that the structure (the distinct internal environment of the public sector)
influences the practice (of government communication) which in turn determines the
outcome (ethical & strategic). This is not withstanding to the fact that all four nodes
consisting of (1) the external environment, (2) the internal environment, (3) the desired
outcomes and (4) the organisational culture, equally influence the practice of government
communication. For this reason, it is advisable for the study of government communication
to take a multi-faceted theoretical approach.
Keywords:
Government
communication,
political
communication,
communication
management, strategic government communication, political public relations, public sector
distinctiveness, external organisational rhetoric, excellence theory,
organisational
effectiveness, ethics and rhetorical theory.
- -
v
TABLE OF CONTENTS
CHAPTER 1: INTRODUCTION AND BACKGROUND ..................................1
1.1 INTRODUCTION ......................................................................................................... 1
1.2 BACKGROUND........................................................................................................... 1
1.2.1
GOVERNMENT COMMUNICATION AS PRACTICE ......................................... 3
1.2.2
GOVERNMENT COMMUNICATION AS A DISTINCTIVE PRACTICE ............... 6
1.3 THEORETICAL FRAMEWORK AND CONCEPTUAL FRAMEWORK ........................ 9
1.4 PROBLEM STATEMENT .......................................................................................... 11
1.5 PURPOSE STATEMENT .......................................................................................... 12
1.6 RESEARCH QUESTIONS ........................................................................................ 12
1.7 SPECIFIC RESEARCH OBJECTIVES ...................................................................... 12
1.8 RESEARCH DESIGN ................................................................................................ 13
1.9 CONTEXT AND UNITS OF ANALYSIS..................................................................... 14
1.10 ACADEMIC VALUE AND INTENDED CONTRIBUTION OF THE PROPOSED
STUDY ...................................................................................................................... 15
1.11 DELIMITATIONS ....................................................................................................... 16
1.12 ASSUMPTIONS ........................................................................................................ 17
1.13 STUDY EXPOSITION ............................................................................................... 18
1.14 DEFINITION OF KEY TERMS .................................................................................. 18
CHAPTER 2: THE DISTINCTIVENESS OF GOVERNMENT
COMMUNICATION ......................................................................................24
2.1 INTRODUCTION ....................................................................................................... 24
2.2 INTRODUCTION TO PUBLIC ADMINISTRATION ................................................... 25
2.3 THE PUBLIC SECTOR REFORM AGENDA ............................................................. 26
2.3.1
Government as business: The New Public Management Movement ................ 28
2.3.2
Critique of the New Public Management Movement ......................................... 30
2.4 THE PUBLIC SECTOR DISTINCTIVENESS THEORY............................................. 32
2.4.1
Distinctive features of public organisations ....................................................... 35
2.4.2
Critique of public sector distinctiveness theory ................................................. 40
2.5 THE DISTINCTIVENESS OF GOVERNMENT COMMUNICATION.......................... 41
2.5.1
Politics .............................................................................................................. 43
2.5.2
Public good ....................................................................................................... 44
- -
vi
2.5.3
Media scrutiny ................................................................................................... 44
2.5.4
Legal constraints ............................................................................................... 45
2.5.5
Devaluation of communication .......................................................................... 45
2.5.6
Poor public perception ...................................................................................... 46
2.5.7
Poor professional development......................................................................... 47
2.5.8
Limited leadership opportunities ....................................................................... 47
2.5.9
Centralisation .................................................................................................... 47
2.5.10 Internal vs external communication................................................................... 48
2.5.11 Budgeting: Limited financial resources ............................................................. 48
2.5.12 Communication evaluations .............................................................................. 49
2.5.13 Multiple communication responsibilities ............................................................ 49
2.6 EMPIRICAL
RESEARCH
ON
GOVERNMENT
COMMUNICATION
DISTINCTIVENESS .................................................................................................. 51
2.7 CONCLUSIONS ........................................................................................................ 53
CHAPTER 3: GOVERNMENT COMMUNICATION THEORY AND
CONCEPTUAL FRAMEWORK ....................................................................55
3.1 INTRODUCTION ....................................................................................................... 55
3.2 THE NATURE OF THEORIES .................................................................................. 58
3.3 COMMUNICATION THEORIES ................................................................................ 59
3.4 PART ONE: GOVERNMENT COMMUNICATION IN A POLITICAL
COMMUNICATION & PARTICIPATORY DEMOCRATIC APPROACH .................... 61
3.4.1
Government communication from a participatory democratic perspective ........ 62
3.4.2
Political communication .................................................................................... 65
3.4.3
Government communication ............................................................................. 68
3.4.4
Government communication research .............................................................. 69
3.5 GOVERNMENT COMMUNICATION IN A MULTIFACETED THEORETICAL
APPROACH .............................................................................................................. 71
3.6 PART TWO: GOVERNMENT COMMUNICATION IN AN ORGANISATIONAL
COMMUNICATION MANAGEMENT APPROACH .................................................... 73
3.6.1
Public relations and communication management ............................................ 74
3.6.2
Communication management in the public sector ............................................ 76
3.6.3
Stakeholder management ................................................................................. 77
3.6.4
Citizens as external stakeholders ..................................................................... 78
3.6.5
Levels of communication management ............................................................. 79
3.6.5.1
The micro (programme) level ................................................................... 80
- -
vii
3.6.5.2
3.6.5.3
The meso (departmental) level ................................................................. 80
The macro (organisational) level .............................................................. 81
3.7 THE EXCELLENCE AND EFFECTIVENESS THEORY IN COMMUNICATION
MANAGEMENT......................................................................................................... 82
3.7.1
Excellence in strategic government communication ......................................... 86
3.8 PART THREE: GOVERNMENT COMMUNICATION IN AN ORGANISATIONAL
RHETORICAL APPROACH ...................................................................................... 91
3.8.1
Ethics in government communication ............................................................... 92
3.8.2
Definitions and history ....................................................................................... 94
3.8.3
Contemporary rhetoric ...................................................................................... 95
3.8.4
External organisational rhetoric......................................................................... 96
3.8.5
Credibility, reputation, and legitimacy ............................................................... 97
3.8.5.1
Reputation management as organisational advocacy .............................. 98
3.8.6 Identification ...................................................................................................... 99
3.8.7
Relationship management .............................................................................. 100
3.8.8
Symmetry and dialogue .................................................................................. 101
3.8.9
Discourse enactment and enlightened choice................................................. 102
3.8.10 Rhetoric as advocacy...................................................................................... 103
3.8.11 Self-interest (advocacy) .................................................................................. 105
3.8.12 Negative connotations of rhetoric advocacy.................................................... 106
3.8.13 Sophistic rhetoric ............................................................................................ 107
3.8.14 Is advocacy inherently bad?............................................................................ 107
3.8.15 Advocacy as competition ................................................................................ 108
3.9 RHETORIC, DEMOCRACY AND PUBLIC RELATIONS IN GOVERNMENT
COMMUNICATION ................................................................................................. 109
3.10 PART FOUR: EXTANT MODELS OF GOVERNMENT COMMUNICATION ........... 112
3.11 CONCLUSIONS ...................................................................................................... 113
CHAPTER 4: STRATEGIC GOVERNMENT COMMUNICATION .............. 115
4.1 INTRODUCTION ..................................................................................................... 115
4.2 STRATEGIC MANAGEMENT ................................................................................. 115
4.2.1
Strategy in strategic communication management ......................................... 116
4.2.2
Strategic communication as a theoretical foundation ...................................... 116
4.3 THE
PRETORIA
SCHOOL
OF
THOUGHT
ON
STRATEGIC
COMMUNICATION ................................................................................................. 117
4.4 THE ENVIRONMENT IN STRATEGIC COMMUNICATION .................................... 119
- -
viii
4.4.1
Boundary spanning ......................................................................................... 120
4.5 STRATEGY COMMUNICATION AND COMMUNICATION STRATEGY ................ 122
4.5.1
Strategy communication ................................................................................. 122
4.5.2
Communication strategy ................................................................................. 122
4.6 THE ROLE OF COMMUNICATION IN THE STRATEGY-MAKING PROCESS ...... 125
4.7 STRATEGIC GOVERNMENT COMMUNICATION ................................................. 126
4.8 MODELS FOR DEVELOPING COMMUNICATION STRATEGIES ......................... 131
4.9 ORGANISING THE COMMUNICATION DEPARTMENT ........................................ 135
4.9.1
Position of the communication unit within an organisation .............................. 135
4.9.2
Access to management .................................................................................. 136
4.10 COMMUNICATION EVALUATION IN GOVERNMENT........................................... 136
4.11 CONCLUSIONS ...................................................................................................... 141
CHAPTER 5: THE PRACTICE OF GOVERNMENT COMMUNICATION ... 143
5.1 INTRODUCTION ..................................................................................................... 143
5.2 COMMUNICATION AS PRACTICE ........................................................................ 143
5.3 ROLES OF GOVERNMENT COMMUNICATORS .................................................. 144
5.3.1
Types of communication practitioner roles ...................................................... 145
5.3.2
Communication role differentiation.................................................................. 150
5.3.3
Involvement in organisational decision-making ............................................... 152
5.3.4
Job satisfaction ............................................................................................... 153
5.3.5
Role specialisation .......................................................................................... 153
5.4 FUNCTIONS OF GOVERNMENT COMMUNICATORS.......................................... 154
5.5 CHALLENGES CONFRONTING GOVERNMENT COMMUNICATION .................. 158
5.6 PROFESSIONALIZING GOVERNMENT COMMUNICATION ................................ 160
5.7 COMMUNICATING GOVERNMENT SERVICES .................................................... 163
5.8 COMMUNICATING THE CORPORATE IDENTITY ................................................ 164
5.9 GOVERNMENT COMMUNICATION AND THE MEDIA .......................................... 167
5.10 DIRECT COMMUNICATION (DIRECT REPORTING) ............................................ 169
5.11 SOCIAL MEDIA AND WEBSITES AS DIRECT COMMUNICATION ....................... 170
5.12 CONCLUSIONS ...................................................................................................... 173
5.12.1 Conclusion to the literature ............................................................................. 173
CHAPTER 6: GOVERNMENT COMMUNICATION HISTORY AND
DEVELOPMENTS IN SOUTH AFRICA ...................................................... 175
- -
ix
6.1 INTRODUCTION ..................................................................................................... 175
6.2 THE STATUS OF GOVERNMENT COMMUNICATION RESEARCH IN SOUTH
AFRICA ................................................................................................................... 175
6.3 THE HISTORICAL DEVELOPMENT OF GOVERNMENT COMMUNICATION
IN SOUTH AFRICA ................................................................................................. 177
6.4 GOVERNMENT MEDIA RELATIONS IN SOUTH AFRICA ..................................... 180
6.5 GOVERNMENT COMMUNICATION AND INFORMATION SYSTEM (GCIS) ........ 182
6.6 THE STRUCTURE AND POSITION OF THE COMMUNICATION UNIT WITHIN
GOVERNMENT DEPARTMENTS IN SOUTH AFRICA .......................................... 184
6.7 POLICY GUIDELINES FOR GOVERNMENT COMMUNICATION IN SOUTH
AFRICA ................................................................................................................... 185
6.8 CONCLUSIONS ...................................................................................................... 188
CHAPTER 7: RESEARCH DESIGN AND METHODS ............................... 189
7.1 INTRODUCTION ..................................................................................................... 189
7.2 RESEARCH PARADIGM / PHILOSOPHY .............................................................. 189
7.3 INQUIRY STRATEGY: DESCRIPTIVE STUDY ...................................................... 191
7.4 RESEARCH DESIGN: TRIANGULATION (MIXED-METHODOLOGIES) ............... 193
7.5 POPULATION ......................................................................................................... 195
7.6 SAMPLING .............................................................................................................. 196
7.6.1
Probability purposive (non-random) sampling ................................................. 200
7.7 DATA COLLECTION ............................................................................................... 203
7.8 QUALITATIVE RESEARCH .................................................................................... 203
7.8.1
Multiple- case study ........................................................................................ 204
7.8.2
In-depth interviews .......................................................................................... 206
7.8.2.1
Structured interviews .............................................................................. 206
7.8.2.2
Unstructured interviews .......................................................................... 206
7.8.3 Document analysis research methodology ..................................................... 210
7.9 QUANTITATIVE METHODOLOGY: SURVEY QUESTIONNAIRES ....................... 212
7.10 DATA ANALYSIS .................................................................................................... 213
7.10.1 Data coding ..................................................................................................... 214
7.10.2 Thematic analysis ........................................................................................... 215
7.10.3 Analysis of questionnaires of limited scale ...................................................... 215
7.10.4 Analysis of interview data................................................................................ 216
7.10.5 Analysing of communication strategy documents ........................................... 218
- -
x
7.11 ASSESSING AND DEMONSTRATING THE QUALITY AND RIGOUR OF THE
PROPOSED RESEARCH DESIGN ........................................................................ 220
7.12 RESEARCH ETHICS .............................................................................................. 220
7.12.1 Confidentiality and anonymity ......................................................................... 222
CHAPTER 8: REVIEWING GOVERNMENT COMMUNICATION
STRATEGY DOCUMENTS ........................................................................ 224
8.1 INTRODUCTION ..................................................................................................... 224
8.2 THE ALIGNMENT OF DEPARTMENT COMMUNICATION STRATEGIES WITH
THE GCIS PROVINCIAL STRATEGY .................................................................... 225
8.3 THE VALUE OF THE ENVIRONMENT OR CONTEXT IN STRATEGIZING........... 226
8.3.1
The national environment ............................................................................... 226
8.3.2
The provincial environment ............................................................................. 227
8.3.3
The departmental environment ....................................................................... 227
8.3.4
Synergy of the three levels of environment ..................................................... 228
8.3.5
The value of government communication strategies ....................................... 228
8.3.6
The process of developing and approving government communication
strategies ........................................................................................................ 229
8.4 DOCUMENT ANALYSIS OF GOVERNMENT COMMUNICATION STRATEGY
DOCUMENTS ......................................................................................................... 231
8.4.1
Strategic objectives ......................................................................................... 232
8.4.2
Provincial government communication (office of the KZN Premier) ................ 232
8.4.3
Department of KZN Education ........................................................................ 232
8.4.4
Department of Public Works KZN ................................................................... 233
8.4.5
Department of Health KZN .............................................................................. 234
8.4.6
Department of Sport and Recreation .............................................................. 235
8.4.7
The department of KZN COGTA ..................................................................... 235
8.4.8
Department of KZN Economic Development and Tourism ............................. 236
8.4.9
Synthesis and discussion of government communication strategy
objectives ........................................................................................................ 236
8.5 POLICY DOCUMENTS GUIDING GOVERNMENT COMMUNICATION
STRATEGIES.......................................................................................................... 237
8.5.1
Synthesis and discussion of guiding policy documents in the formulation of
government communication strategies ........................................................... 239
8.6 POLITICS ................................................................................................................ 240
8.7 LEGAL CONSTRAINTS .......................................................................................... 240
8.8 BUDGETING ........................................................................................................... 241
- -
xi
8.9 STRATEGY GOVERNMENT COMMUNICATION .................................................. 243
8.10 THE COMMUNICATION ENVIRONMENT .............................................................. 244
8.10.1 Synthesis and discussion of the communication environment in the
formulation of government communication strategies ..................................... 248
8.11 COMMUNICATION EVALUATIONS ....................................................................... 249
8.11.1 Synthesis and discussion of government communication evaluations ............ 250
8.12 GOVERNMENT MEDIA RELATIONS ..................................................................... 251
8.13 IMAGE-BUILDING AND CORPORATE IDENTITY ................................................. 252
8.14 OUTREACH PROGRAMMES ................................................................................. 254
8.15 INTERNAL COMMUNICATION............................................................................... 255
8.16 TWO WAY COMMUNICATIONS ............................................................................ 257
8.17 KEY SPEAKERS /MESSENGERS.......................................................................... 257
8.18 INTEGRATED COMMUNICATION ......................................................................... 258
8.19 GOVERNMENT COMMUNICATION’S TEN COMMANDMENTS ........................... 259
8.20 CONCLUSIONS ...................................................................................................... 261
CHAPTER 9: RESULTS AND DATA FINDINGS ....................................... 262
9.1 INTRODUCTION ..................................................................................................... 262
9.2 DEMOGRAPHICS ................................................................................................... 263
9.3 PERCEIVED PRIVATE/PUBLIC DISTINCTION...................................................... 264
9.4 POLITICS ................................................................................................................ 266
9.4.1
The effects of politics on the practice of government communication ............. 268
9.4.2
Is politics intrinsic to government communication? ......................................... 272
9.5 THE EFFECTS OF LEGAL CONSTRAINTS ON THE PRACTICE OF
GOVERNMENT COMMUNICATION ....................................................................... 274
9.5.1
The protocol of consulting and information gathering ..................................... 274
9.5.2
The protocol of consulting and approval ......................................................... 276
9.5.3
Bureaucracy and red tape ............................................................................... 276
9.5.4
Confidentiality and information classification................................................... 277
9.6 MANAGEMENT SUPPORT FOR GOVERNMENT COMMUNICATION ................. 278
9.6.1
Government communication seen as technical or supporting instrument ....... 281
9.6.2
Poor understanding of media relations ........................................................... 281
9.6.3
Budget constraints .......................................................................................... 282
9.6.4
Additional challenges caused by the devaluation of government
communication ................................................................................................ 284
- -
xii
9.6.5
The value political and administrative managers attached to government
communication ................................................................................................ 285
9.6.6
Reasons political managers value communication ......................................... 286
9.7 STRATEGIC GOVERNMENT COMMUNICATION ................................................. 287
9.7.1
Government communication as a management function ................................ 287
9.7.2
Communication manager to manage government communication
strategically ..................................................................................................... 289
9.7.3
Involvement in organisational decision-making ............................................... 289
9.7.4
Influence on strategic management of the department ................................... 290
9.7.5
Strategic government communication as a verifying tool ................................ 293
9.8 COMMUNICATION EVALUATIONS ....................................................................... 293
9.9 COMMUNICATION STRUCTURES ........................................................................ 296
9.9.1
Communication unit as aligned to the HOD .................................................... 297
9.9.2
Communication unit as aligned to the MEC .................................................... 298
9.10 GOVERNMENT COMMUNICATION ROLES.......................................................... 299
9.10.1 Roles, functions and responsibilities of government Communicators in the
department ...................................................................................................... 299
9.10.1.1
9.10.1.2
9.10.1.3
9.10.1.4
9.10.1.5
9.10.1.6
9.10.1.7
9.10.1.8
9.10.1.9
Government communicators employment titles ...................................... 299
Perception of role differentiation ............................................................. 300
Expert prescriber (Level D) ..................................................................... 300
Problem solving process facilitator (Level C) .......................................... 301
Communication facilitator (Level B)/ acceptance legitimizer/ the town
crier ........................................................................................................ 302
The steward conductor (level C) ............................................................. 303
Media relations (Level B) ........................................................................ 304
Media relations (Level C) ........................................................................ 305
Communication liaison / the traffic manager........................................... 305
9.11 THE OVERALL PURPOSE OF GOVERNMENT COMMUNICATION ..................... 305
9.11.1 Government communication (definition) ......................................................... 305
9.11.2 Promoting government services through branding, identity management
and events management: ............................................................................... 307
9.11.3 Information diffusion........................................................................................ 308
9.11.4 Media relations................................................................................................ 308
9.11.5 Two-way communication and feedback .......................................................... 309
9.11.6 Educating the public about government and its services ................................ 309
9.11.7 Integrated communication ............................................................................... 309
9.11.8 Managing internal communication .................................................................. 310
- -
xiii
9.11.9 Stakeholder management ............................................................................... 310
9.11.10 Advising management of communication issues ............................................ 311
9.11.11 Strategic government communication as a verifying tool ................................ 311
9.12 EFFECTS OF CENTRALISATION .......................................................................... 311
9.13 OUTREACH PROGRAMMES AND EVENTS MANAGEMENT............................... 313
9.13.1 Project sukuma sakhe ..................................................................................... 314
9.13.2 Integrated communication for outreach programmes...................................... 315
9.13.3 Criteria for deciding areas for outreach programmes ...................................... 315
9.13.4 Procedures and research prior imbizos .......................................................... 316
9.13.5 Role of communicators in outreach programmes............................................ 317
9.13.6 Challenges of outreach programmes .............................................................. 318
9.14 GOVERNMENT
COMMUNICATION:
ADVOCACY,
INFORMATION
DIFFUSION OR BOUNDARY SPANNING? ............................................................ 319
9.15 GOVERNMENT COMMUNICATION AND MEDIA RELATIONS............................. 320
9.15.1 High media scrutiny ........................................................................................ 321
9.15.2 Negative coverage .......................................................................................... 321
9.15.3 Media understanding of the intricacies of government communication ........... 324
9.15.4 Training media about government issues, structures and procedures ............ 327
9.15.5 Media – government relationship .................................................................... 328
9.15.6 Dominant coalition’s understanding of the media............................................ 329
9.15.7 Media channels ............................................................................................... 330
9.15.8 Ex-journalist government communicators (experiences from the other side) .. 331
9.16 DIRECT COMMUNICATION ................................................................................... 332
9.16.1 Direct communication in the KZN provincial government ................................ 332
9.16.2 Simama ........................................................................................................... 333
9.16.3 Departmental publications............................................................................... 333
9.16.4 Other forms of direct communication .............................................................. 334
9.17 SOCIAL MEDIA AS FORM OF DIRECT COMMUNICATION ................................. 335
9.17.1 Social Media in government communication ................................................... 335
9.17.2 Integrated communication ............................................................................... 335
9.17.3 Introducing social media in government communication ................................. 336
9.17.4 Advantages and uses of social media in government communication ............ 337
9.17.5 Disadvantages and fears of social media ....................................................... 338
9.17.6 Responding to social media queries ............................................................... 339
9.17.7 Evaluating social media .................................................................................. 340
- xiv
9.18 PROFESSIONAL DEVELOPMENT ........................................................................ 341
9.18.1 Limited specialisation of communication professional roles ............................ 343
9.18.2 Education and professional membership affiliation ......................................... 344
9.19 THE ROLE OF THE PROVINCIAL GCIS IN STANDARDISING AND
PROFESSIONALISING GOVERNMENT COMMUNICATION ................................ 346
9.19.1 Rating the usefulness of the provincial GCIS in KZN ...................................... 346
9.19.2 Interaction between the GCIS and government communicators in KZN ......... 348
9.19.3 Government communicators’ compliance to GCIS initiatives .......................... 349
9.19.4 The role of the GCIS in standardising government communication ................ 350
9.19.5 The role of the GCIS in providing practical communication support................ 351
9.19.6 The role of the GCIS in professionalising government communication ........... 351
9.19.7 Additional roles of the GCIS ............................................................................ 352
9.19.8 Uses of the GCIS government communicators handbook .............................. 353
9.19.9 Conversations with the GCIS .......................................................................... 354
9.19.10 Challenges of government communication in KZN the province ..................... 355
CHAPTER 10: DISCUSSIONS AND CONCLUSIONS ............................... 357
10.1 INTRODUCTION ..................................................................................................... 357
10.2 THE DISTINCTIVENESS OF GOVERNMENT COMMUNICATION........................ 358
10.2.1 Effects of high media scrutiny on the practice of government
communication ................................................................................................ 361
10.2.2 The effects of politics to the practice of government communication .............. 364
10.2.3 Effects of legal constraints to the practice of government communication ...... 365
10.2.4 Effects of centralisation on the practice of government communication.......... 367
10.2.5 Effects of the devaluation of communication to the practice of government
communication ................................................................................................ 368
10.3 STRATEGIC GOVERNMENT COMMUNICATION ................................................. 371
10.3.1 Effectiveness in strategic government communication ................................... 371
10.3.1.1
10.3.1.2
10.3.1.3
Effectiveness feature 1: Communication as a management function ..... 372
Effectiveness feature 2: Contribution to enterprise strategy ................... 373
Effectiveness feature 3: Environmental scanning and communication
evaluations ............................................................................................. 375
10.3.2 Organisational structure of the communication unit ........................................ 377
10.3.3 Government communication roles .................................................................. 378
10.3.4 The allignment between government communication strategy documents
and the practice of government communication ............................................. 380
10.3.5 Excellence in strategic government communication ....................................... 381
- -
xv
10.4 PROFESSIONAL DEVELOPMENT AND THE ROLE OF THE GCIS ..................... 385
10.4.1 Effect of (poor) professional development on the practice of government
communication ................................................................................................ 385
10.4.2 The role of the GCIS in standardising government communication ................ 386
10.5 THE QUESTION OF ETHICS IN GOVERNMENT COMMUNICATION
MANAGEMENT....................................................................................................... 388
10.5.1 The purpose of government communication ................................................... 388
10.5.2 Advocacy and identity management in government communication............... 389
10.5.3 Effects of internal vs external communication on the practice of
government communication ............................................................................ 391
10.5.4 Government communication as a public good ................................................ 392
10.5.5 External rhetorical theory in ethical government communication .................... 393
10.6 CONCLUSIONS ABOUT RESEARCH PROPOSITIONS (OBJECTIVES) .............. 396
10.7 THE DISTINCTIVE, STRATEGIC AND ETHICAL FRAMEWORK FOR
GOVERNMENT COMMUNICATION ....................................................................... 399
10.7.1 Introduction ..................................................................................................... 400
10.7.2 Structure of government communication ........................................................ 401
10.7.3 Processes of government communication ...................................................... 403
10.7.3.1 Excellence in government communication ............................................. 403
10.7.3.2 Effectiveness in government communication ......................................... 404
10.7.3.3 Professionalism and standardisation of government communication ..... 406
10.7.4 Degree of democracy in the specific country .................................................. 407
10.7.5 Management style of the government department .......................................... 408
10.7.6 Outcome: Ethical government communication ................................................ 409
10.7.7 Conclusions of model...................................................................................... 410
10.8 CONTRIBUTIONS AND IMPLICATION FOR THEORY .......................................... 411
10.9 IMPLICATION FOR POLICY AND PRACTICE ....................................................... 416
10.10
IMPLICATIONS FOR METHODOLOGY ......................................................... 418
10.10.1 Methodological successes .............................................................................. 418
10.10.2 Methodological challenges .............................................................................. 419
10.11
LIMITATIONS OF THE STUDY ...................................................................... 420
10.12
FUTURE RESEARCH RECOMMENDATIONS .............................................. 420
10.13
CONCLUSION ABOUT THE RESEARCH PROBLEM ................................... 422
LIST OF REFERENCES............................................................................. 424
- -
xvi
LIST OF FIGURES
Figure 1: Position of the communication units in government departments ................... 185
Figure 2: Demographics (gender) .................................................................................. 263
Figure 3: Demographics (race) ...................................................................................... 263
Figure 4: Survey data –impact of politics on government communication...................... 267
Figure 5: Interview data - impact of politics on government communication .................. 267
Figure 6: Survey data – value of transparency in government communication .............. 277
Figure 7: Survey data- management support for government communication ............... 279
Figure 8: Management understanding of government communication ............................ 280
Figure 9: Survey data: centralisation .............................................................................. 311
Figure 10: survey data – relations with the public ............................................................ 313
Figure 11: Survey data- media relation activities (roles) .................................................. 320
Figure 12: Survey data- perceptions on tone of media coverage..................................... 321
Figure 13: Survey data- perceptions on professional development ................................. 341
Figure 14: Survey data- survey data- interaction with the GCIS ...................................... 346
Figure 15: The distinctive, strategic, and ethical framework for government communication
........................................................................................................................ 399
- -
xvii
LIST OF TABLES
Table 1:
Definitions used in this document ..................................................................... 18
Table 2:
Abbreviations used in this document ................................................................ 22
Table 3:
Public sector attributes and their impacts ......................................................... 49
Table 4:
Traditions of government communication ......................................................... 57
Table 5:
Principles of the excellence theory.................................................................... 83
Table 6:
Sanders framework for the analysis of government communication ............... 139
Table 7:
Van Ruler’s typology of communication roles ................................................. 149
Table 8:
List of all KZN provincial government departments (Ministries) ...................... 196
Table 9:
List of sampled government departments ....................................................... 197
Table 10: Units of analysis: Interviewees ........................................................................ 199
Table 11: Phases of thematic analysis............................................................................ 215
Table 12: Availability of communication strategy documents .......................................... 224
- -
xviii
CHAPTER 1:INTRODUCTION AND BACKGROUND
1.1
INTRODUCTION
Communication practice in relation to government communication reveals a lacuna in
research and literature. Because of such scant literature, government communication as a
practice is poorly understood (Pandey & Garnett, 2006:37). Given its significance, it is too
important a challenge to ignore (Canel & Sanders, 2013). Government communication
presents an inviting field for current and future research. Vos (2006:257) recommends
future scholars to explore government communication practices and factors that influence
them. The present study responds to such a call. The purpose of this study is to explore
the extent to which the distinctive communication environment of the public sector affects
the practice of communication management by government departments within the
KwaZulu Natal province. In addition, the study investigates the extent to which government
communication can be strategic, ethical, and distinctive.
1.2
BACKGROUND
Communication is in theory a fundamental prerequisite for democracy and it is in practice
inseparable from how government operates (Young, 2008). The act of governance
involves constant exchange of information and communication between the governors and
the governed (Heinze, Schneider & Ferie, 2013:370). Accordingly, the scholarship on
democracy and governance finds value in communication studies. However, a crisis in
democracy is often cited in reference to declining public interest in politics, heightened
cynicism about politics, politicians, and government. Young (2008) postulates that the poor
quality of government communication is the main catalyst behind a dwindling interest in
public participation, marginal legitimacy, and a poor reputation in many governments.
Political communication theorists as grand ancestors to the field predominantly influence
the study of government communication. Political communication can be defined as the
study of the role of communication in political processes (Kaid, 1996:443). According to
this definition, government communication is a subset discipline in the field of political
communication. The roots of government communication can be chronologically traced to
its pedigree in political communication science. Government communication functions for
the benefit of the citizen. It is supposed to remain balanced, concise, and non-partisan
(Glenny, 2008:153). Political communication scholars have explored government
communication issues from a variety of perspectives such as “rhetorical analysis of
political discourse, propaganda studies, voting studies, mass media effect” and the
interactions between government, press and public opinion (Canel & Sanders, 2013).
Scholars such as Kaid (1996:443) and Young (2008) lament the preoccupation of political
communication as a field predominated by voter persuasion paradigms. Until recently,
political communication has largely been studied and theorised from a persuasive, political
campaigns and public opinion influence perspective. As a solution, a broader perspective
has been advocated (Kaid 1996; Young 2008). Aligned with this recommendation, the
present study proposes a multifaceted theoretical approach in the theorising of
government communication.
The field of government communication is at the juncture of various methodological and
disciplinary approaches (Canel & Sanders, 2012:93). The study of government
communication could benefit largely from multiple theoretical perspectives and a wider
assortment of research strategies. This is because the study of government
communication can be traced within a variety of research traditions in political
communication, public opinion, propaganda studies, media studies, and public
administration. Quite recently, it has been linked to other cognate fields such as public
relations, corporate communication, political marketing and strategic communication.
Canel
and
Sanders
(2012:93)
suggest
various
concepts
from
organisational
communications, communication management, and corporate communication that are
potentially useful approaches to the study of government communication. The following
concepts are identified: symmetrical communication, mutuality, reputation, issue
management, evaluations, organisational stakeholders, and publics. These concepts were
foreign to the traditional political communication perspective of the study of government
communication. The crucial contribution of organisational communication to the study of
2
government communication is essentially the portrayal of government communication as a
practice configured by strategic communication and professionalism. The section that
follows introduces the practice of government communication.
1.2.1
GOVERNMENT COMMUNICATION AS PRACTICE
A question of how government communication should be organised and practiced in order
to contribute to excellence and effectiveness is rarely addressed (Heise, 1985:199;
Killingsworth, 2009:71). Such a structural and performance dimension is indispensable in
understanding the nature of government communication. A practice perspective provides
the inductive lenses through which to understand and describe how government
communication is actually practised within an organisational context. However, quality
control, performance, and communication practices are neglected in the government
communication research agenda (Vos & Westerhoudt, 2008:18).
Organisational communication literature tends to portray government communication as a
simplistic, asymmetrical (one-way) flow of information, mostly within the confines of mass
media (Glenny, 2008:155). Media studies portray it as pure propaganda. Regrettably,
much research on strategic communication is reserved for corporate communication within
the private sector. What is lacking is an acknowledgement that government
communication is likewise complex, strategic, multidimensional, and professional. As a
result, the complexity of government communication is under-studied and under-theorised.
For instance, Graber (2003:13-14) suggests that much like the study of organisational
communication, government communication studies lack a comprehensive theory with
regard to the area of focus, purpose of analysis and ideological lenses. Furthermore, a
broader strategic review of communication management in government is lacking, yet
sorely needed. This study attempts to contribute to the first gap in literature by proposing a
three-dimensional (strategic, distinctive, & ethical) theoretical framework in which
government communication can be practiced and theorised. In addition, this study aims to
contribute to the second gap in literature by approaching government communication as a
strategic function.
3
The year 2000(s) brought into light the paucity of research activities in and about
government communication management (for example: Glenny, 2008; Liu & Horsley,
2007, Liu, Hosley & Levenshus, 2010, 2011, 2012; Lee 2007, 2012; Fairbanks, Plowman
& Rawlins, 2007; Young 2008). However, much of these studies concentrated on the roles
and functions of government communicators (For example, Edes, 2000; Gregory, 2006). A
few other studies focused on information dissemination (Gelders & Ihlen, 2009), while a
few others concentrated on performance and quality of government communication (Vos,
2006; Vos & Westerhoudt, 2008). Later, additional studies introduced the question of
professionalism (Sanders, Canel & Holz-Bacha, 2011) while others introduced the
concepts of strategic communication and excellence in government communication
(Grunig & Jaatinen, 1999; Killingsworth 2009; Likely 2013). Furthermore, a significant
scholarship grew among scholars who aspired to observe the distinctiveness of
government communication (Gelders, Bouckaert & Van Ruler, 2007; Liu, Hosley &
Levenshus, 2010, 2011, 2012; Waymer, 2013). However, none of these studies has
evaluated the practice of government communication holistically. This study attempts to do
so.
Upon reviewing literature about government communication in South Africa, it was found
that government communication research in South Africa centres predominantly on
mediated political communication (Johnston, 2005) and political rhetoric (Audenhovem,
2003), primarily employing discourse analysis methodologies. Another interest focus is on
political rhetoric during election periods, particularly political campaigns such as political
posters (Fourie, 2008), print advertisement (Teer Tomaselli, 2005) and the role of political
blogs (Goldfain & Van der Merwe, 2006). Much of government communication research
conducted in South Africa is predisposed to a notion of government communication as a
participatory development tool (for example Msibi & Penzhorn, 2010; Netshitomboni,
2007). To this end, the public administration field in South Africa has contributed robustly
and immensely to this scholarship.
Notwithstanding vibrant government communication research in South Africa, there
remains a dire need to understand government communication from an organisational
perspective. This is because the individual government department remains responsible
4
for the actual transmission of government communication to the public. As such, the
practice dimension is necessary to understand the nature of government communication in
South Africa. A few noble studies in this area are discussed throughout this document.
The Task Group on Government communication, also known as the Comtask was
convened in 1996, to examine the nature of communication within government, “the
structure of the media and the relations of government with the media, international
communications and other aspects of governmental communications” (Lor & van As,
2002:106). The produced report was entitled Communications 2000: a vision for
government communication in South Africa. To date, this is the only comprehensive study
of the practice of government communication in South Africa.
Rasila and Mudau
(2012:1398) put forth an argument that many of the findings of the Comtask report are still
applicable in today’s government communication system in South Africa. This is not an
ideal finding as it insinuates there have been insufficient developments in government
communication in South Africa over the past 20 years. In a limited way, this study aims to
gauge developments in the field of government communication from the Comtask era in
South Africa.
A suggested approach in conducting a communication practice research is to evaluate
three central features of an organisation, namely, structure, processes, and outcomes
(Sanders et al., 2011:5). Structure concerns the conditions in which an activity takes place
(i.e. the distinctive communication environment of the public sector), processes are a set
of ordered actions such as roles, functions and communication practices, and outcomes
are the results or consequences of processes (such as government reputation as an
outcome). This framework of analysis is adopted for this particular study.
In government communication practice research, it is essential to ask: “where and by
whom work is actually done and the tools and techniques that are being used (i.e. practice
and activities), the roles and skills required by practitioners and how these are acquired
(i.e. practitioners and their professional development) and the ways in which practitioners
and the work involved are organised (i.e. the organisation of communication unit)” (Van
Bekkum et al., 2008:85). Added here are the political and cultural elements that
5
contextualise the practise (i.e. the distinctive communication environment of the public
sector). It is noteworthy that the key focus of this study is on government communication
practices and the distinctiveness of such practice. Nevertheless, it is worth questioning if
government communication is truly a distinctive practice. The next section briefly explores
this question whilst chapter 2 further expounds on the topic.
1.2.2
GOVERNMENT COMMUNICATION AS A DISTINCTIVE PRACTICE
Academic debates concerning the management of the public sector as a business are
being revitalised in recent years. Aligned with this, discussions about the treatment of
citizens as external stakeholders have become prevalent. This sentiment is predominantly
expressed by terminologies such as ‘customer service governance’, ‘customer-responsive
governance’ and ‘customer-focused governance’ amongst others. Projected prospects
from this customer-focused governance is that “it offers an antidote to popular stereotypes
of bureaucracy, red tape, officious administrators, long queues, and drab uniformity of
services” (Alford, 2002:337). For instance, the Batho Pele Gazette (1997:12) reads:
“The public service is currently perceived as being characterised by, for example,
inequitable distributions of public services, especially in rural areas, lack of access to
services, lack of transparency and openness and consultation on the required service
standards, lack of accurate and simple information on services and standards at which
they are rendered, lack of responsiveness and insensitiveness towards citizens’
complaints and discourteous staff”.
Gelders, Bouckart and Van Ruler (2003:327) query the extent to which management
models from the private sector, such as those mentioned by Canel and Sanders (2012:93)
in section 1.2, are actually transferable to the public sector (government) and the arising
consequences for public communication management. Heise (1985:200) is one of the first
few scholars to evaluate the impact of corporate communication models within the
government sector. He questioned “whether public relations, as developed and practiced
in the private sector, ought to be the model for the public sector and, if not, what the model
for the public sector should look like”.
6
Boyne (2002:97) and Rose (1999:66) depict two contending schools of thought in
answering Heise’s (1985) question. Government reformers propose the implementation of
a “customer focused” style of communication from the private sector. This school of
thought postulates that public organisations including government can and must import
and emulate the managerial processes (communication management) from the private
sector to gain from the “supposedly successful techniques” of private institutions (Boyne,
2002:97). In contrast, the critics contend and dismiss the idea as inadequate for the public
sector because it devalues the notion of citizenship (Alford, 2002:337). There seems to be
cynicism to the immediate adoption of such business-like-management. At the extreme of
such scepticism is an emphasis that “if public and private organisations are fundamentally
different, there is little point in seeking to draw lessons from management of the private
sector” (Boyne, 2002:97).
Although government communication is expected to reside amidst both the public
administration and the communication field, it is surprising that only scant research activity
would exist within the communication sector, which is arguably predominated by corporate
communication research focusing on the private sector (Glenny, 2008:154; Waymer,
2013:321).
Scholars from public administration have long begun documenting differences between the
environment of the public and the private sector (for example Graham, 1994:361-375;
Kaplan, 2009:197-212; Nzimakwe, 2010; Rose & Lawton, 1999:63-77). Renowned public
administration theorists have delivered resounding arguments about the distinctive
characteristic of public organisations (Pandey & Garnett, 2006:38). There is substantial
literature pertaining to the distinctive characteristics of the public sector. At an extreme,
such literature may be synthesised into a ‘public sector distinctiveness theory’.
The argument of the ‘public sector distinctiveness theory’ is that distinctions between the
public and private sectors entail important differences in organisational environments,
constraints, incentives, and culture, which should be incorporated to management theory,
including communication management theory (Perry & Rainey, 1988:182). For that reason,
the espousal of private sector models is met with scepticism in public administration and
7
public management literatures. The most compelling work on public and private sector
distinctiveness is that of Allison, 1979; Boyne, 2002; Bozeman 1987; Rainey, 2003;
Ranson, 1998, Sayre, 1958 and Andersen, 2010.
The field and extant theories of communication management do not sufficiently distinguish
between the public and the private sector (Liu & Levenshus, 2010:1). Communication
research examining the public sector rarely indicates differential communication practices
as due to the distinctive environment in which government communication takes place
(Liu, Horsley & Levenshus. 2010:190). A distinction of practice, theories, and models are
essential considering that the environment of the public sector contains opportunities and
constraints that are dissimilar from those of the private or corporate sector (Liu & Horsley,
2007:391). Leading scholars on the distinctiveness (uniqueness) of the communication
environment of the public sector are Lee (2000); Liu, Horsley and Levenshus (2007/2010);
Gelders, Bouckart and Van Ruler (2003), among others.
Rose (1999:4) attests to the distinctiveness of public service administration. The
increasing complexity of government policies, rules, and practices makes government
communication difficult and therefore different (Killingsworth, 2009:62). For example,
Theaker (2004:218) claims that working in the public sector is challenging for
communication management. There are several reasons for this. One of which is that
government often deals with various, never-ending stakeholders (Aertsen & Gelders,
2011:2). Liu and Horsley (2007:384) are of the opinion that unique and distinctive
communication models are crucial for the communication management practised in the
public sector, particularly in government.
Gelders et al. (2003:327) posit that the application of dominant private sector
communication models and techniques is only possible if the distinctiveness (specific
characteristics) of the public sector is acknowledged and accounted for. They emphasise
that if communication theories developed in the private sector are to be applied in
government, it is essential to consider their repercussions for public communication
management (Gelders et al., 2003:327).
8
There is a plethora of literature concerning the applicability of private sector models of
communication management to the public sector in general and to government in
particular (Boyne, 2002; Gelders, Bouckart & Van Ruler, 2007; Liu & Horsley, 2007; Liu &
Levenshus 2010; Liu et al., 2010; Rainey, 2003; Pandey & Garnett, 2006). Such literature
provides an overview of factors, attributes, and properties that authenticate the
distinctiveness of government communication. For instance, Liu, Horsley, and Levenshus
(2007, 2008, 2010) synthesised 13 features from literature and research which account for
the distinctiveness of the public sector. However, most of this literature simply concerns
itself with mapping out features and characteristics that distinguish the communication
environment of the public sector from that of the private sector. Very seldom do these
studies evaluate the effects of such ‘distinctiveness’ to the practice of government
communication. This study sought to fill this gap. To start with, the theoretical framework is
introduced next.
1.3
THEORETICAL FRAMEWORK AND CONCEPTUAL FRAMEWORK
This section introduces the theoretical framework underlying the study. The full review of
the theoretical framework is advanced in chapter two (2) and chapter three (3). The thesis
statement proposed in the study is that communication management is vital for
democracy. For government communication to be professional and strategic, it must be
organised excellently and effectively while taking into account the advocacy nature
inherent in external organisational rhetoric that could threaten the ethics and legitimacy of
(government) communication management. It is equally essential for the distinctive
communication environment of the public sector (the public sector distinctiveness theory)
to be considered in both the theorising and the practice of government communication.
The theoretical framework below introduces features/elements that make government
communication strategic, distinctive, and ethical. The detailed operationalization of these
features is described in chapter 2, 3 and 4, while a visual representation is presented.
The study of government communication requires a multifaceted theoretical approach. The
political communication approach counsels that in modern democracy, every organisation
survives ultimately only by public consent. It is mainly by excellent, effective, and ethical
9
communication management that governments are able to secure this approval
(reputation/legitimacy). Literature demonstrates that excellence and effectiveness are
foundations to strategic (government) communication.
The excellence theory identifies fourteen (14) key assumptions regarding the features of
an excellent communication management department (Grunig, 2007). The principle of
excellence is discussed in chapter 3 and tabulated in table 5. The present study evaluates
all fourteen 14 principles of the excellence theory in order to appraise excellence in the
practice of government communication by the KZN province. Regarding the effectiveness
question, the Pretoria School of Thought (PST) is chosen as a paradigm best able to
explain the functions and the contributions of strategic communication management to
organisational effectiveness. For this purpose, five (5) elements of effectiveness in
communication management have been identified from literature. The principle of
effectiveness is explored further in chapter four (4), focusing on strategic government
communication.
Contrary to the strategic communication approach (excellence and effectiveness), the
rhetorical approach describes an alternative view of communication management. The
rhetorical approach calls into question the ethics of communication management. As it
is, the rhetorical approach contributes two key ideas (points) considered relevant to the
study of contemporary government communication. The first point is in effecting the high
end of symmetrical communication proposed by the excellence theory. Rhetoric argues
that effective symmetrical communication is only achievable by the dialogic form.
However, the rhetoric approach does not assume that communication between the public
and the government will naturally be impartial as projected by the excellence theory. The
excellence theory takes for granted that by being structured in a certain way (the 14
principles); the resulting communication management will naturally be effective and
ethical. Rhetoric argues instead that communication management must be dialogic in
order to be ethical, but being ethical is not innate for organisations so they must
consciously make an effort. Five (5) elements of ethical communication management are
identified from literature. This study argues that the two principles of strategic
10
(effectiveness + excellence) and ethics (rhetoric) are equally essential in understanding
the practice of government communication.
The public sector distinctiveness theory contends that the public and the private
sectors are distinct and thus the practice and the management of such organisations will
differ. It is advisable that organisation and management theories take cognisance of such
distinctions. Literature identifies thirteen (13) features of distinctiveness that are outlined in
chapter two (2). This study attempts to determine the extent to which these features are
applicable to the South African public sector (KZN) and evaluate their impacts upon the
practice of government communication.
1.4
PROBLEM STATEMENT
Historically, Heise (1985:199) lamented the lack of academic interest in government
communication. However, since then, public administration scholars have risen to the
challenge of providing some knowledge in government communication even though such
literature often fails to explore communication in its full capacity. A question of how
government communication should be organised and practiced in order to contribute to
effectiveness is still poorly address. The question of why and how governments at various
levels communicate or fail to do so remains academically unattended (Sanders et al.,
2011:2). This offers an opportunity for communication management scholars to contribute
towards closing this literature and theoretical gap. Marketing scholars have taken
significant steps in researching the applicability of their trade to government and the public
sector, often addressing the difficulty of marketing a non-tangible product (for example
Nzimakwe, 2010). Communication management is yet to join this imperative academic
debate.
Whilst a variety of features contributing to a distinctive communication environment of the
public sector are identified in extant literature, very few of these studies are grounded by
extensive empirical research (Gelders et al., 2003:327). Moreover, these studies rarely
evaluate
the
impact of
such
‘distinctiveness’ on
the
practice
of
government
communication. These attributes must be empirically tested to determine the extent to
11
which they influence the function, structure, and practices of communication management
in the government sector (Liu & Horsley, 2007:392). No such study has been conducted
within in the South African perspective. In overall, the extent to which government
communication can be distinctive, strategic, and ethical has never been evaluated.
Moreover, the intersections between these three concepts have never been academically
considered.
1.5
PURPOSE STATEMENT
The purpose of this study is to explore the extent to which the distinctive communication
environment of the public sector affect the practice of communication management in
selected government departments within the KwaZulu Natal provincial government. In
addition, the study examines the extent to which government communication can be
strategic, ethical, and distinctive, as well as the interrelations between these concepts.
1.6
RESEARCH QUESTIONS
The above problem statement yields the following research questions:

To what extent does the distinctive communication environment of the public sector
influence the practice of government communication in the KZN provincial
government?

Which conditions of the internal communication environment of the public sector
renders government communication strategic and ethical?

What themes, perspectives, constructs, and issues are essential in laying the
groundwork towards the theorising of government communication?
1.7
SPECIFIC RESEARCH OBJECTIVES
As guided by the above research questions and as emanating from the theoretical
framework and the literature, specific research objectives guiding this study are as follows:
12
Distinctive communication management
•
Objective 1: To identify distinctive features of the public sector communication
environment and to explore their impacts on government communication in provincial
government departments.
•
Objective 2: To design a framework for government communication that takes into
account the strategic, ethical and distinctive elements.
Strategic communication management
•
Objective 3: To investigate the organisational structures, communication practices,
roles and functions, and evaluation measures of communication management in provincial
government departments.
•
Objective 4: To examine the link between government communication policies,
strategies and government communication practices.
•
Objective 5: To explore the role of the GCIS in standardising and professionalising the
practice of government communication at a provisional level.
•
Ethical communication management
•
Objective 6: To investigate whether the practice of government communication in the
KZN provincial government is moving towards the dialogic or the self-advocacy rhetoric
(reputation)?
1.8
RESEARCH DESIGN
At this point in South Africa, the topic of study (government communication) is not yet fully
explored, yet an emergent research activity exists internationally that provides some
exploratory grounding upon which this study can be based (see Gelders, Bouckart & Van
Ruler 2003: Pandey & Garnett 2006: Liu et al., 2007, 2008 & 2010). Hence, an exploratory
study is academically insufficient, yet necessary for the context of study. A pure
exploratory study runs the risk of reinventing the wheel. For that reason, an exploratory—
descriptive study is proposed for the present study. Whilst this study is explorative, it takes
the notch up towards the descriptive.
A sample of eight (8) government departments in the KZN province has been drawn from
a population. The population for this study are government communicators and
13
government communication units within the KwaZulu Natal provincial government. There
are in overall 16 provincial ministry government departments in the KwaZulu Natal
province (see table 9).Triangulation informed the data collection of the study as comprised
of interviews, policy document analysis, and surveys. In-depth interviews were conducted
with 30 government communicators working across eight KZN provincial government
departments. A purposive snowball sampling was used to identify respondents. In addition
to the interview, respondents were required to fill in the questionnaires (essential to
quantify variables and to tackle sensitive matters). Furthermore, to achieve a rich data
and for additional validity, eight communication strategic documents were analysed.
1.9
CONTEXT AND UNITS OF ANALYSIS
The
study
was
conducted
in
South
Africa
at
the
KwaZulu
Natal
province
(Pietermaritzburg). The units of analysis are provincial ministerial government departments
whose primary external stakeholders are the general public. The identified government
departments are usually at the forefront of service delivery protests because they are
considered the custodians of basic social needs. For this reason, communication with the
general public is not only essential but mandatory.
Selected government departments are:
•
Office of the KZN Premier (Department of Provincial Communication),
•
KZN Department of Health,
•
KZN Department of Sports and Recreation,
•
KZN Department of COGTA,
•
KZN Department of Education,
•
KZN Department of Public Works,
•
KZN Department of Social Development, and
•
KZN Economic and Tourism Development.
14
1.10 ACADEMIC VALUE AND INTENDED CONTRIBUTION OF THE
PROPOSED STUDY
Communication management, according to Vos (2006:256), “means paying attention to
quality and increasing the added value of communication within an organisation”.
However, quality control and communication practices are neglected in the government
communication research agenda (Vos & Westerhoudt, 2008:18). Such a performance
dimension is indispensable in understanding the nature of government communication.
Much of government communication research conducted in South Africa is dominated by a
notion of government communication as a tool of participatory development. Another
research focus in South Africa is an analysis of the general role of the Government
Communication and Information Systems (GCIS). Both themes are not near exhaustion.
Nevertheless, there is a dire need to understand government communication from an
organisational perspective. This is because the individual government department remains
responsible for the actual transmission of government communication to the public. As
such, the practice dimension is necessary to understand the nature of government
communication in South Africa.
From an academic point of view, no studies on the practice and the distinctiveness of
government communication have been conducted within the African context. This study
attempts to fill this gap. The present study intends to determine if the kind of
communication practiced in the government sector is as distinctive as predicted by
scholars. An exploratory-descriptive study of government communication practices and
factors influencing the nature of the practice (such as the distinctive communication
environment of the public sector and the GCIS) should provide the much needed bases
from which government communication theories and models may be developed. The
nature of government communication should be described in some details by taking into
account different aspects at the same time rather than specialising on just one or two
elements. Once there is sufficient descriptive research (still lacking), theories can be
developed.
15
The extent to which government communication can be distinctive, strategic, and ethical
and the intersections between these three concepts have never been academically and
empirically considered. This study attempts to contribute towards such an endeavour.
Government practitioners may find value in understanding various quality measures
developed in the study. Another valuable contribution will be the identified context in which
strategic and ethical government communication is possible within a distinctive
communication environment. In addition, government practitioners may find value in
understanding the distinctive communication environment of the public sector and how it
affects their practice. Furthermore, the influential role of the GCIS in standardising and
professionalising
the
practice
of
government
communication
may
better
be
comprehended. Delimitations and assumptions are discussed next.
1.11 DELIMITATIONS
The aim of this study is to investigate the nature of government communication practiced
in South African government departments especially those in the KwaZulu Natal province.
The proposed study excludes the politics of government, unless if such politics is directly
related to communication. The study examines the distinctive communication environment
of the public sector, not the distinctiveness of the public sector in general. An analysis of
the general distinctiveness of the public sector may be found in Allison (1979), Boyne
(2002:97), Rainey (1988), Rainey (2003) and Rose (1996:63-77).
The proposed study only considers ministry provincial government departments, not
NGOs, local municipalities, parliament, political organisations, or parastatal organisations.
A purposive sampling method is used to select only government departments whose
primary external stakeholders are the general public (see section 1.7).
The general public (citizens) is the only stakeholder considered for this study.
Consequently, only external communication is considered primarily relevant to this study.
Internal communication
is
indeed
germane to achieving an
effective
external
communication, and for that matter, it was not entirely excluded in the study. Moreover,
16
there are sufficient studies aptly focused on internal (government) communication that are
extensive in depth, this study does not attempt to do that.
This study is not particularly focused on the Government Communication and Information
System (GCIS) as a ‘government communication institution in South Africa’. The focal
points of the study are the communication unit within government departments. Thus, the
parameter of analysis is confined to the aspects of the GCIS that concern the
standardisation and professionalization of government communication at a provincial level.
As such, all other politics, management, and responsibilities of the GCIS are overlooked.
1.12 ASSUMPTIONS
Assumptions are basic to all research. Leedy and Ormrod (2010:59) posit that
assumptions have a bearing on the research problem, direction, and conclusions. Thus,
assumptions should be “openly and unreservedly set forth” (Leedy & Ormrod, 2010:59).
There are several basic assumptions underlying this research project. It is assumed that:
•
All government departments embody a communication unit at best or someone
responsible for communication management at the very least.
•
All government departments make efforts to communicate with the public (citizens) as
external stakeholders without whose support they would flounder.
The proposed research is based on the public sector distinctiveness theory. Scholars who
are concerned with understanding the specific nature of public organisations usually begin
with an assumption of the public-private distinction thesis (Rainey, 1988:185). This
research is based on the proposition and the mild acceptance that specific characteristics
exist in the public sector, which make the communication environment of the public sector
(government) distinctive and therefore different from the private sector’s communication
environment (Gelders et al., 2003:327); (Liu et al., 2010). This position is further explored
in chapter 2. The study exposition is outlined next.
17
1.13 STUDY EXPOSITION
It is crucial at this juncture to provide an overview of the structure to the rest of the thesis.
The remaining section of chapter 1 defines concepts and constructs adopted for this
study. Chapter 2 presents the context and the theoretical background to the study. The
chapter reviews literature concerning the distinctive communication environment of the
public sector. Chapter 3 further adds to the theoretical framework on which the study is
engrained by discerning the field of government communication as a semblance of
organisational and communication management. Chapter 4 describes the ideals of
strategic government communication along with its requisite principles. Chapter 5
describes the practice of government communication from an organisational perspective.
In that chapter, the organisational structures, communication practices, roles and
functions, and evaluation measures of government communication and the challenges
towards the standardisation and professionalization of the practice are delineated.
Chapter 6 outlines the history of government communication and its development in South
Africa. The aim behind the methodology chapter 7 is to designate the methodology plan
selected for the study. A triangulation of data collection methods and instruments from
both qualitative and quantitative approaches are described. Both Chapter 8 and Chapter
9 present the research findings (results), while Chapter 10 contains the discussion,
conclusions, and recommendations. The conceptual model depicts the study exposition in
brief and outlines the conceptual framework of the study. The following is the
conceptualisation of key terms discussed in this study:
1.14 DEFINITION OF KEY TERMS
Table 1: Definitions used in this document
Communication
Management
 Within the African discourse, the term public relations
is
more
dominantly
used
and
accepted
than
‘communication management’ (Rensburg, 2007). In
this study, the term, ‘public relations’ is used
synonymously with ‘communication management’.
18
Communication management is more of an inclusive
term encompassing a variety of communication
modalities such as public relations, organisational
communication, business communication, corporate
communication, and to a lesser extent, marketing
communication.
 Adopting such a definition allows for flexibility of the
study to investigate additional paramount aspects of
government communication that perhaps fall outside
the parameters of public relations (Shelby, 1993:254)
Communication
Practices
Communication
 The sum of all the ways in which an organisation
communicates with stakeholders.
 According to Liu and Horsley (2007:384), the public
environment of the
sector creates a distinctive (unique) communication
public sector
environment with constraints and opportunities that
are different from the private sector.
Corporate identity
 What the organisation chooses to communicate
about itself (Wood, 2002:93).
Customer-Focused
Government
 A customer-focused government is one that centres
communication and services on the user. It is
dependent on the satisfaction of the user and is thus
responsive to his/her demands as a customer.
Customers
 Citizens are customers because they too receive
services from their government.
Dominant
Coalitions:
 The dominant coalition is a term used to define a
group of senior managers entrusted with controlling
an organisation (Grunig, 1992).
19
Government
Communication
 According
to
Glenny
(2008:153),
government
communication, by definition, relate to “the apolitical
or non-partisan communication activities of the
executive arm of government concerning policy and
operatives”. This is a balanced, concise, and nonpartisan communication (Gelders & Ihlen, 2009:2).
Government communication and government public
relations are used synonymously within the text.
Government
Communicators
 This term refers to government public relation
practitioners who handle communication on the
behalf of government departments. The term is
inclusive of all various positions and names given to
different
speciality
functions
of
government
communication.
Excellence:
 The 14 generic principles characterising strategic,
symmetrical,
and
effective
communication
management.
External
Stakeholders
 External stakeholders are not directly connected with
the operation of the organisation, but may affect and
be affected by the operations of the organisation.
Identity
Management
Media Relations
 Identifying the right image for the organisation and
communicating it effectively (Wood, 2002:93).
 The establishment and management of relationships
with the mass media that facilitate favourable and
timely media coverage. This part of public relations
deals with publicity and information diffusion.
20
Organisational
communications
 Refers to all “communications managed by an
organisation, especially as communication managed
for the organisation by communication specialists”
(Grunig, 1992:5).
Political
communication
 Refers to persuasive communication designed to
uphold the objectives of a political party or a politician
(Gelders & Ihlen, 2009:2).
Private Sector
 Refers to the corporate sector, which is profit oriented
and owned by anyone but the state.
Public Sector
 For the purpose of this study, the public sector means
government.
Public relations
 Refer
to
“the
management
of
communication
between an organisation and its publics” (Grunig,
1992:4).
Here
used
synonymously
with
communication management.
Public sector
distinctiveness
 This study follows Gelders et al. (2007:327) loose
definition of ‘uniqueness/distinctiveness’ as “special
characteristics of the public sector”.
The public
 Refers to a group of people with whom the
organisation communicates.
Stakeholder
 The concept of stakeholder refers to “those groups of
individuals without whose support the organisation
would ceases to exist as well as those who aim to
influence or are influenced by the organisation”
(Luama-aho, 2008:447). Stakeholders can be internal
or external. The term public and stakeholder will be
used interchangeably
21
The following is a table of abbreviations used in this document.
Table 2: Abbreviations used in this document
Abbreviation
Meaning
ANC
African National Congress
COGTA
COMTASK
GCIS
Cooperative Governance Traditional Affairs
Task Group on Government Communication
Government Communication and Information Systems
Exco
Executive Council
HOD
IABC
Head of Department
The international association of Business
Communication
LMS
Living Standard Measure
MEC
Member of the Executive Council
Manco
Management Committee
NPM
The New Public Management
NPG
The New Public Governance
PCF
Premier’s Coordinating Forum
PR
PST
PRISA
Public Relations
Pretoria School of Thought
Public Relations Institute of South Africa
22
23
CHAPTER 2: THE
COMMUNICATION
2.1
DISTINCTIVENESS
OF
GOVERNMENT
INTRODUCTION
This chapter demarcates the context upon which the theoretical framework of the study is
based. One of the central purposes of this study is to explore the extent to which the
distinctive communication environment of the public sector influences the nature of
communication management practiced in the South African government sector (KZN) and
the degree to which such distinctiveness is perceived and experienced by government
communicators. Naturally, the starting point towards this deliberation is in investigating
whether government communication is indeed a ‘distinctive’ practice. In so doing, the
scholarship surrounding the public sector distinctiveness theory is examined. The
discussion will take into account both public administration and communication
management literature.
The chapter describes debates concerning the contrast and/or distinctions between the
public and the private sector and the impacts of such distinctiveness on communication
management. Intrinsically, this chapter outlines a review of literature pertaining to the
distinctiveness of the public sector communication environment. To this end, features
contributing to the distinctiveness of the public sector communication environment are
delineated. Subsequently, extant empirical research concerning the distinctiveness of
government communication is outlined as an attempt to trace which features of
government communication’s ‘distinctiveness’ have been studies thus far.
This thesis argues that government communication is theoretically haunted by debates
between scholars of Traditional Public Administration (public policy) and scholars of the
New Public Management (government as business). Each side pulls government
communication into differing perspectives, objectives, and purposes. Such competing
movements in public administration seem to have a significant impact on both the practice
and the theorising of government communication.
24
This study serves no purpose of providing a comprehensive opportunity for these two
schools of thought to engage each other. Such can be found in Kaboolian (1998), who
among others, offer debates between the traditional scholars of public administration
(government as distinctive to business) and those of the New Public Management
(government as business). This section serves merely as an introduction to the debates in
each standpoint and their potential impacts on the study of government communication.
The first section discusses the genesis of the field of public administration and the reform
agenda inclusive of the New Public Management Movement. The second section explores
the distinctiveness philosophy and its relevance to communication management within the
public sector. In addition, research conducted in government communication informed by
this premise of distinctiveness is described. The impact of the New Public Management
Movement on Government Communication is catalysed by the espousal of strategic
communication models of excellence and effectiveness in public organisations as
expounded in chapter 3 and 4.
2.2 INTRODUCTION TO PUBLIC ADMINISTRATION
The concept of governance has come to be acquainted with the study of public
administration or public management. Khan (2008:1) describes ‘public administration’ as
“the management of government affairs”. However, the meaning of the term is seldom
clearly articulated (Peters & Pierre, 1998:223). Osborne and Gaebler (1992) defined
governance as the business of government. Governance is thus concerned with the nature
of state-society relations in the pursuit of collective interests (Pierre & Peters, 2005:6).
Public administration is a highly diverse and evolving field of scientific inquiry
characterised by competing paradigmatic perspectives (Van der Walt, 2014:169). The
writings of Woodrow (1887) are often cited as the founding seminal works in public
administration. Since then, a lively discourse ensued on the scope, objectives, and theory
of the field (Van der Walt, 2014:178). Khan (2008:10-16) provides a detailed history of
public administration scholarship and its progressive scope. Such chronicle is not
presented here.
25
The study of public administration is interdisciplinary by nature. It is interdependent and
intertwined with theories and conceptions about many elements of public policy, public
management, democratic values, service delivery, ethical behaviour, governmental
responsibility, communication, and other social, political, and economic matters (Van der
Walt, 2014:178).
Mathiasen (1999:94) describes three dominant disciplines in which public administration
can be categorised. First, microeconomics offers mainly normative management
techniques. The second is Law and Regulations that is guided by constitutional law,
egalitarianism, public policy, public service and the public good, all working in the public
interest. Third is organisational theory with the premise that organisations including public
ones consist of customs, rules, norms, incentives, and rewards. “Organisational theorists
are interested in how the culture of bureaucracy shapes and steers the behaviour of
individuals and how individuals or groups of them can influence the way the organisation
functions” (Mathiasen, 1999:94).
This study assumes an organisational theory outlook. It should be noted that the focus of
the study is not on public administration, but on communication management with a
special focus on public organisations (government). It is imperative to describe the nature
and the environment of government organisations in which communication management
occurs. For this reason, specific literature on public administration is summoned to set the
scene for the context of study. Public administration literature is therefore delimited only to
this chapter. To begin with, the public sector reform agenda is introduced next.
2.3 THE PUBLIC SECTOR REFORM AGENDA
Pierre and Peters (2005:49) put forth the notion that “governance is not a constant, but
rather tends to change as needs and values change”. The traditional conceptualisation of
the public sector has come under continuous strain. Over the past three decades, a
strenuous struggle was advanced to reform the model of public administration from a rulebased system of accountability to one in which government runs more like a business
(Peters & Pierre, 1998:223; Morgan & Cook, 2014:4). The argument is that the traditional
26
conception of government as a controlling agent for society is out-dated (Peters & Pierre,
1998:224). The reform debate argues for a different pattern, structure, and role of
government and a different practice of governance. Such reform would alter the
conceptualisation of democracy and governance in modern political systems (Peters &
Pierre, 1998:225).
Some scholars such as Hood (1995:94) view the reform agenda as a paradigm shift
haunting the traditional public administration mode of governance into extinction.
Numerous claims of a paradigm shift are insinuated, for example, from bureaucratic to
entrepreneurship, from progressive public administration to the New Public Management
(NPM) movement and from NPM to the New Public Governance (Gray & Jenkins,
1995:76; Morgan & Cook, 2014:3). Whether the reform debate represents a ‘paradigm
shift’ is an empirical question largely unanswered (Kaboolian, 1998:189). Kaboolian
(1998:192) sees this reform movement as providing an extraordinary opportunity “to
engage in theoretically grounded empirical work and theory building that crosses the
boundaries of the disciplines that have studied the public sector”. One such discipline is
communication management.
The New Public Administration, New Public Management, and Reinventing Government
Movement became popular catchphrases of the 1990s. Scholars are still continuously
calling for the broadening of the field (Van der Walt, 2014:179). Forces for change have
resulted in movements that question the capacity of government to remain the primary
agent in solving society’s problems (Morgan & Cook, 2014:3). First, the New Public
Management (NPM) procures business models as the standard for measuring government
success (Morgan & Cook, 2014:3). The second movement, the New Public Governance
(NPG), highlights the importance of a collaborated approach in the provision of public
services, involving a network alignment across the public, non-profit, and private sectors
(Morgan & Cook, 2014:3). This study will draw from the NPM to be descried next.
27
2.3.1 GOVERNMENT AS BUSINESS: THE NEW PUBLIC MANAGEMENT
MOVEMENT
Since the 1980s, a recurrent theme in public administration scholarship has been upon the
notion that ‘government can and should be run like a business’. Hartle (1985:341) once
proclaimed such perspective, as he emphasised that “despite widespread and
longstanding recognition that public and private management are different phenomenon,
we remain fascinated with the idea that the efficiency and effectiveness of government can
be improved by adopting private sector management techniques”.
The public sector faces increasing demands to run government like a business (Box,
1999:19). “Today, even elusive public-private differences are fading as the public sector is
increasingly penetrated by the metaphor of the market and of running government like a
business” (Box, 1999:19). Beckett (2000) reviews the common phrase, ‘government
should run like a business’, which she claims has become a mantra. This mantra is
associated with market economics and the new public management (NPM) reform
discourse in public administration theory and practice (Beckett, 2000:186). As a result,
“public administration has borrowed from business in many important areas: organisation
theory, management techniques, budgeting and fiscal administration, and personnel
administration” (Khan, 2008:6). Many practices from the private sector such as strategic
management and total quality management are gaining popularity in public administration
(Khan, 2008:9).
Scholars of organisational studies within the public sector have been playing catch-up with
their private sector counterparts in their strife to integrate economic theories and concepts
in the analysis of public organisations (Vasu, Stewart &Garson, 1990:365). The conviction
that private administration is far more effective than public administration, resulted in the
popularity of incorporating business techniques in public management (Khan, 2008:9).
The term New Public Management was coined in the late 1980s to signify the importance
of ‘management’ and ‘production engineering’ in public service delivery (Page, 2005).
These were practices often associated with economic doctrines. As a result, the new
public management draws extensively from both organisational and management theories.
28
NPM strives to make service delivery more responsive and accountable to citizens by
applying business management techniques focused on competition, customer satisfaction,
and performance measurement (Morgan & Cook, 2014:4), in addition to business
concepts such as customer service and total quality management (Lyons, Duxbury &
Higgs, 2006:605).
The term NPM was coined as a generic label in order to collate similar, but certainly not
universal paradigms in public management styles (Hood, 1995:94). The NPM cannot be
seen as a set of concepts growing out of a formal body of theory but rather as evolving
constructs from an inductive process of observing new public management practices
(Mathiasen, 1999:91).
The NPM offers a new perspective about the nature of government, and the management
of that government. The New Public Management generally contradicts traditional public
administration (Gray & Jenkins, 1995:76). The NPM is led principally by economists,
management scientists, and human resource managers and by all those who contend that
the management science of private organisations should be transported to public ones in
the name of improving efficiency (Gray & Jenkins, 1995:80). “Through these reforms, the
public sector is gradually introducing new management tools that were initially developed
for the private sector” (Desmairais & Chatillon, 2010:128).
The New Public Management is essentially a philosophy of generic management because
it argues that both public and private sector management experience comparable
challenges and should henceforth resolve them in similar ways. Therefore, NPM considers
the public-private dichotomy as obsolete (Peters & Pierre, 1998:227). The NPM is a reform
in which the public sector brings its management system closer to business, thus
rendering the public sector less distinctive as a unit (Dunleavy & Hood, 1994:9). The new
public management suggest best practice, abandoning the concept of federalism, and
rejecting the distinctiveness agenda (Mathiasen, 1999:91). The ambition of NPM is to
accommodate not only political scientists, but also organisational theories and other
management specialists to the field (Gray & Jenkins, 1995:79).
29
Mathiasen (1999:109) summarises some of the key indicators of NPM practices in
governance as follows:
1. Decentralisation of authority with governmental units and devaluation of
responsibilities to lower levels of government (for example municipalities);
2. Re-examination of what government should both do and pay for, what it should pay
for but do not do, and what it should neither do not pay for;
3. Downsizing the public service and the privatisation or corporatisation of activities;
4. Consideration of more cost-effective ways of service delivery, such as outsourcing,
market mechanism, and user charges;
5. Customer orientation, including explicit quality standards for public services;
6. Benchmarking and measuring performance; and
7. Reform designed to simplify regulation and reduce its cost.
2.3.2
CRITIQUE OF THE NEW PUBLIC MANAGEMENT MOVEMENT
Khan (200815) insists that government should run like a democracy, not a business. This
is a fundamental critique of the NPM. Models of organisational conduct in private sectors
are founded on the value of profit augmentation (Vasu et al., 1990:365). Such market-like
techniques may be problematic if they override traditional values associated with the public
sector and public service (Box, 1999:36). Naturally, individuals concerned with the quality
of public service, social justice, and fairness in governance, transparency and equality,
would find contempt in the concept of running government like a business (Box, 1999:19).
Despite the public sector habitually reinforcing ethical discourse, they are still dependent
on directors who exude corporate values that hence debilitate ethical contemplations
(Vasu et al., 1990:365).
Morgan and Cook (2014:4) highlight two major weaknesses in extrapolating private sector
business principles in improving the performance of government. First, they lament a lack
of a common denominator, such as profit, market share, or return on investment, which
would serve as a benchmark for comparison on criteria that build legitimacy among
citizens (Morgan & Cook, 2014:4). In addition, corporate concepts such as efficiency,
effectiveness, and customer-focus are insufficient in the public sector. Instead, values
30
such as fairness, equality, protection of rights, and transparency should equally be
measured since they play important roles in determining the legitimacy of public
institutions. The same argument is later presented in this study that because government
is a public good, concepts reinforced by corporate strategic communication (excellence
and effectiveness) are insufficient without incorporating ethical egalitarian principles in
communication management of the public sector.
On the adoption of market-type mechanisms, privatisation, corporatisation, competition
and other economic terminologies, adversaries of New Public Management condemn such
methodologies as an infringement of the moral foundation of government and as an
appalling dismissal of the general welfare of the public in favour of pure profit (Mathiasen,
1999:97).
Accountability remains an unresolved issue in NPM literature. Government theories (and
NPM) contend that customary democratic channels of accountability are being supplanted
by several market methods of constituent control, for example ‘stakeholdersim’ and
consumer choice (Peters & Pierre, 1998:226). The other criticism is that the proposed
model of government may instead necessitate additional rather than fewer bureaucracy
ensuing amplified oversight, evaluations and regulation (Page, 2005).
A literal interpretation of the 'government ought to run like a business" mantra is found on
the premise that business is worthy and government is feeble (Beckett, 2000:191). In this
case, business (the private sector) is considered a benchmark, a standard and an epitome
of excellence, efficiency, productivity and profitability. However, there is little bound proof
that business is indeed infallible (Beckett, 2000:191).
A detailed account of various critiques of the new public management movement can be
found in Dunleavy & Hood (1994:10-14). They describe four categories of criticism of
NPM, ranging from the fatalist critique (1) pointing out that no system of management,
whether it be NPM can eliminate basic problems of public sector management—notably
human error, poor communication, system failures, misdirected programmes, fraud or
corruption, and bad intentions— these remain omnipresent. The Individualist critique (2)
31
pursues complete corporatisation of the public sector and therefore criticises any reform
halting halfway through the process, as the case stands for the NPM. Hierarchists critique
(3), on the other hand, worry about the risk of eroding traditional public service ethics as a
result of NPM. Finally, egalitarian critique (4) is concerned with the danger of inappropriate
(welfare-reducing) corporatisation that could devalue the notion of citizenship (Dunleavy &
Hood, 1994:14). Perhaps the principal critique of the NPM is that the public sector
environment is different to the private sector and such business-like strategies fail to
correspond to such a distinct environment. This argument is explored further next.
2.4
THE PUBLIC SECTOR DISTINCTIVENESS THEORY
Most theorists emphasise the commonalities among organisations in order to develop
knowledge that is applicable to all organisations. In consequence, much scholarship
avoids popular distinctions such as public versus private and profit versus non-profit.
Rainey (2003) illustrates how virtually all major contributions to the field of public
management are conceived to apply broadly across all types of organisations. Perry and
Rainey (1988) concur, “The public-private distinction has held no particular salience for
scholars interested in developing a general theory of organisations”. Generally, the
distinction between public and private organisations receives short shrift.
Wallace Sayre’s widely quoted aphorism: ‘public and private management are
fundamentally alike in all unimportant respects’ signalled an invitation towards researching
such a laden assertion. The increasing number of comparative studies published in public
administration and management literature attest to the vibrant debates regarding the
contrast and/or distinctions between the public and the private sector. The practical
relevance of such literature and studies refer to their potential significance in
understanding the proper roles of the public and private sectors, the implications of
imposing public purposes on private corporations, and the transferability of management
techniques and theories between the two sectors (Perry & Rainey, 1988:182).
There is an on-going academic debate concerning the distinctiveness of public and private
management. “Government and business have been compared and contrasted throughout
32
public administration literature” (Beckett, 2000:187). Outlining such literature would involve
tracing the history of public administration. Government administrations and business
practices were compared early on in the works of Wilson, Goodnow, and White during the
primordial orthodox era of public administration (1880-1920). Later, Hartle (1985:341)
postulated that “the similarities and differences between public and private administration
will never be completely defined; the issues change too frequently to permit it”. Decades
later, Desmairais and Chatillon (2010:129) still inquire if the distinctiveness of public and
private sectors is indeed significant.
Organisational and management theorist have contributed to the topic of public-private
differences. Perry and Rainey (2001) discuss the usefulness of the public-private
distinction in organisational theory. Two competing perspectives are found when studying
public and private organisations. The generic perspective contains the claim that no such
differences exist (Andersen, 2010). For instance, the New Public Management (NPM)
movement has downplayed sectorial distinctions through its implicit suggestions that
“management is management’ regardless of sector (Lyons, Duxbury & Higgs, 2006:605).
The contending claim is that government is distinct because it is a public good.
According to Rainey (2003:55), distinctions between the public and the private sector are
sufficient to warrant special analysis. Rainey (2003:55-56) questions, “If public
organisations are not distinct from other organisations, such as businesses in any
important way, why do public organisations exist”? An answer to this question points to the
inevitable need for public organisations and to their distinctive attributes. Since the
establishment of the public administration scholarship, there has been a substantial debate
on whether public management is different from private management. However, existing
literature to date has come to no definitive conclusion (see Boyne 1992) (Meier & O’Toole,
2011:283). Therefore, empirical studies are still necessary to examine the degree of
convergence, if any, between management in the public and private sectors (Desmairais &
Chatillon, 2010:127). Recent studies in this area have focused on leadership,
management roles, employee behaviour, and communication management amongst
others.
33
Traditional public administration of a historic era was founded on the premise of a vastly
distinct public sector (Dunleavy & Hood, 1994:9).The traditional public administration
attempts to ensure accountability of government by imposing two basic management
doctrines. One of which is to keep the public sector “sharply distinct from the private sector
in terms of accountability, ethos, methods of doing business, organisational design,
people, rewards and career structure” (Hood, 1995:94). The second management doctrine
was to maintain buffers (separation) between the political (MEC) and the administrative
management (HOD) (Hood, 1995:94).
The public-private sector distinction is used for many purposes, including developing
distinct theories of public organisations. It has also been used as a moderator variable in
organisational studies and as a predictor variable in evaluation studies. Perry and Rainey
(1988:185) found that scholars of governance involved in constructing a theory of public
institutions typically start with presumptions about the general environment of this subset
of organisations.
The point of departure in this study pertains to literature on the distinctive characteristics of
the public sector. The synthesis of such literature may be called the public sector-isdifferent perspective, thesis, or viewpoint, primarily rooted in traditional public
administration. At an extreme, such literature may eventually coalesce into a public sector
distinctiveness philosophy.
The public –private distinction perspective reinforces the argument that there are
significant differences between public and private organisations (Andersen, 2010:137).
When expounding the public-private distinction perspective, Rainey, Backaff and Levine
(1976) are often cited as having presented a number of propositions describing differences
in public and private organisations. They observed signs of vital contrasts between private
and public organisations that should not be overlooked in administration research
(Andersen, 2010:138). Differences were proposed in (1) purpose, objectives, and planning
as well as in (2) selection, management, and motivation; (3) and in controlling and
measuring results between the public and private sectors (Andersen, 2010:138).
34
The public and private sectors were often presented as two completely different worlds.
For instance, the public sector is for the most part seen as stagnant having been
weakened by bureaucratic constraints (Desmairais & Chatillon, 2010:128). Traditional
public administration scholarship accentuates the distinctiveness of public organisations as
consequences of obligated service provided to society (Andersen, 2010:138). Similarly,
Cook (1998) in Andersen (2010:138) concedes that the character of public administration
as a political institution should be at the centre for the conception of its distinctiveness.
Ring and Perry (1985:281) are of the opinion that if the performance of the public sector is
judged against a normative model of strategic management developed in the private
sector, it is likely to be found inadequate. However, judged against standards grounded in
the public sector, different conclusions might be drawn. “The criteria of performance and
actual assessments of accomplishments are all likely to change if alternative normative
models are used” (Ring & Perry, 1985:281). Therefore, more research on strategic
management processes must be undertaken within a framework that recognises the
existence of separate sets of rules governing organisational conduct within the public and
the private sector.
Strategic management in the public and private sector functions differently and thus
generates distinctive opportunities and constraints on various practices within the two
organisational sectors. According to Ring and Perry (1985:276), the context of strategic
management can be defined as the societal role of the organisation. The context
influences both the strategic management and the practices of an organisation. The key
argument is that “basic distinctions do exist between the public and private sectors, and
they are critical to understanding differences in strategic management processes” (Ring &
Perry, 1985:276).
2.4.1
DISTINCTIVE FEATURES OF PUBLIC ORGANISATIONS
Leading public administration theorists have mounted persuasive arguments about the
distinctive characteristic of public organisations (Pandey & Garnett, 2006:38). For that
reason, the adoption of private sector models is viewed with scepticism in the public
35
administration and public management literatures (Allison, 1979; Boyne, 2002; Bozeman
1987; Rainey, 1989). The dominant view in the public administration and public
management scholarship is that public and private organisations are very different.
Distinctions between the two sectors involve important differences in organisational
environments, constraints, incentives, and culture that seek incorporation in management
theory (Perry & Rainey, 1988:182). The most compelling work on public and private sector
distinctiveness is that of Allison, Bozeman, Rainey, and Sayre.
The most comprehensive and current list of assertions about distinctive features of public
organisations are presented by Rainey (2009, 75-76). Allison (1983), Ring and Perry
(1985), Boyne (2002:100), and Rainey (2003 - 2009) identify several features of the
external circumstances and the internal characteristics of public organisations that
proponents of the public sector distinctiveness theory propose. Such studies present
taxonomies and typologies listing features, which are distinct or unique to the public
sector. Some of the most widely cited external features of distinctiveness are present
below:
Complexity: government operates through a network of interdependent organisations
rather than through independent organisations. Moreover, public agencies face a variety of
stakeholders, each of whom demands the attention of the public organisation.
Permeability: public organisations are considered ‘open systems’ that are easily influenced
by external events. This feature is somewhat debatable.
Instability: political constraints result in frequent changes in policy, and in addition, the
political cycle means that government organisations are often constantly pressured to
achieve quick results. Allison (1983) adds two features associated to the instability of the
public sector. The first feature is termed time perspective, which adheres to the fact that
government managers tend to have relatively short time horizon dictated by political
necessities and political calendar. The second feature called duration attest to the
assumption that the length of service of politically appointed government managers is
relatively short while private sector managers have a longer tenure (Allison, 1983). In
36
reference to the tenure of public officials, Ring and Perry (1985:279) also noted time
constraints as point of distinction. In that regard, strategic management in the public sector
entails the management of discontinuity. Coalitions are unstable, political executive tenure
is brief; agendas change constantly (Ring & Perry, 1985:284).
Absence of competitive pressures: it is mentioned that public agencies typically have few
rivals for the provision of their service. They often enjoy the dominant position in the
market. Private sectors do not enjoy the monopoly enjoyed by public sectors (Khan,
2008:7).
Effectiveness: public sector has fewer incentives to cost cutting and efficiency because it
lacks the direct link between the sale of output and the revenue received (Khan, 2008:9).
Public managers have less available clear market indicators such as prices, profits, market
share (Khan, 2008:9). “Public administrators must conduct their activities in a much more
stable environment than business administrators. They are affected by politics, changing
power relationships, economic swings, and volatile social issues” (Khan, 2008:9).
Bottom line: government managers rarely have a clear a bottom line, whereas the bottom
line of private business managers is profit, market performance, and survival. The primary
purpose of a private sector is to make profit while the public sector’s goal is to implement
the policy in an efficient and effective manner (Khan, 2008:7)
Publicness: the publicness of the public sector stems from the common ownership of
public organisations. The term ‘public’ in public affairs is used to denote affairs that affect
everyone (Yeomans, 2009:578). The public sector is both legally and morally obliged to
inform the population and the media about policy decisions and issues affecting the
society in its entirety (Khan, 2008:8; Yeomans, 2009:578). For this reason, strategic
management in the public sector must take into account the interests of a wide range of
stakeholders (Ring & Perry, 1985:280).
37
Public processes: Government management and its processes tend to be exposed to
public scrutiny and to be more open whilst private business management is often private
and its processes internal and less exposed to public review (Allison, 1983:19).
Role of press and media: the role that the media plays is cited frequently as one of the
major differences in the working environment of the public sector. The indication is that the
media impede through the strategies and policies of government as it appears that policy
makers are not only concerned with how the policy will work, but they are equally
considerate of how it will appear in the public sphere (Ring & Perry, 1985:279). Allison
(1983:19) claims that government management must contend regularly with the press and
the media. The press often anticipates government decisions. Decisions of the private
sector are less often reported in the media, and the press has a limited impact upon the
substance and timing of such decisions.
A number of empirical studies have compared structural characteristics of public and
private organisations (Rainey & Bozeman, 2000:453). The internal characteristics/features
of public organisations that are viewed as distinctive refer to the following:
More bureaucratic: organisations in the public sector have more formal procedures for
decision making, and are less flexible and more risk-averse that their private sector
counterparts (Boyne, 2002:101). Many of the pathologies commonly associated with public
bureaucracies are impersonal work rules, centralised decision making, isolation of workers
and management, struggles for power, and rigidity in the face of change (Hartle,
1985:439).
More red tape: One of the central issues examined in public organisation internal
structures often refer to formalisation, that is, the extensiveness of rules and formal
procedures, their enforcement and the exertion of red tape (Rainey & Bozeman,
2000:453). Red tape is regarded as the side effect of bureaucracy in the public sector.
“The existence of red tape implies an unnecessary and counter-productive obsession with
rules rather than results and with processes instead of outcome” (Boyne, 2002:101). Rules
and procedures result in unnecessary delays.
38
Multiple accountability structures: “public organisations and managers who operate within
them have a more complex set of expectations from numerous public sector stakeholders”
(Hodges, 2005: 6).
Lower managerial autonomy: Managers of public organisations have less freedom to react
as they see fit to the circumstances that they face (Boyne, 2002:101; Allison, 1979:462).
Public managers have the cost of hierarchy (rules and red tape) without the benefit of
autonomy. “One outcome of the many rules and regulations is controlling personnel
management in the public sector is a decrease in the authority and discretion of line
managers and executives” (Hodges, 2005:9). However, it is believed that public sectors
managers enjoy more solid job security in the rigidity of employment policies in
government.
Personnel constraints: Allison (1983:19) shows that in the government sector, there are
two layers or groups of managers that are at times hostile to one another: the civil servant
(executive, administrators, HOD in South Africa) and the political appointees (MEC in
South Africa).
Policy and goal ambiguity: as noted by Allison (1983), the management structure of
government is often segregated and diffused across national, provincial and local levels.
This separation of functional responsibility, according to Ring and Perry (1985:277),
contributes to vagueness. In the contrary, “a direct link between strategy formulation and
implementation and the active involvement of all relevant parties throughout the process is
deemed to be essential to effective private sector policymaking”. This is not always the
case within the public sector (Ring & Perry, 1985:277).
Product: The political product is often complicated and intangible. “An important difference
with the private sector is that the quality of public performance and the quality of public
communication are not only measured by effectiveness and efficiency but also by
requirements such as democracy and lawfulness” (Gelders et al., 2007:332). Products and
services of private sectors are developed internally with the expected target market in
mind. The same is less true for the public sectors whose products and services are
39
realised externally following the democratic process and public consultations (Gelders et
al., 2007:332). It is hard to imagine that private company leaders would publicly discuss
their product until they are shelved as often occurs in the public sector (Gelders et al.,
2007:330). For this reason, strategic two-way communication is essential for the public
sector to develop and amend products (services) in ways that resonate with the needs of
the citizens as customers or as external stakeholders.
Hartle (1985:350) suggests that the sheer size and complexity of the federal government
create managerial and leadership problems that dwarf those of every other type of
organisation.
Thus far, the public sector distinctiveness thesis has been described. The theory contends
that the public and the private sectors are inherently dissimilar and thus should be
practiced, managed, examined, and theorised differently from each other. However, this
philosophy of the public sector distinctiveness and its proponents has not been without
critique. The nature of the criticism is discussed next.
2.4.2
CRITIQUE OF PUBLIC SECTOR DISTINCTIVENESS THEORY
In contrast to the public sector distinctiveness theory, is the critique that distinct
characteristics of public organisations are merely myths that need to be clarifies or
discarded through sound research (Perry & Rainey, 2001: 180; Andersen, 2010:138). For
example, some people point to the common sense observation that an organisation
becomes bureaucratic, not because of it being a government, or a business, but because
of it being large. “Research advocating the generic perspective claim that public and
private organisations face similar constraints and challenges (Andersen, 2010:138). For
them, management processes are the same in all sectors.
Because of poor organisation, structure, and consistency of studies dealing with the
public-private distinction, confusion sometimes arises due to multiple definitions and uses
of the terms. Perry and Rainey (1988:183) attest to numerous empirical studies that have
been undertaken which suffer from lack of comparability because of diverse designs,
40
samples, and focal variables. Perry and Rainey (1988:185) maintain that such divergence
of purposes has impeded accumulation of research findings. Another point of critique is
that many of these public-private distinctions have been exploratory and therefore only
loosely refer to theory or theory building. A challenge for future research is to design
approaches that are conducive to integrating these traditions into a coherent theory.
With regard to future public-private distinction research, Perry and Rainey (1988:192)
advise researchers to be more attentive to key subdimensions within the public-private
dichotomy. It is essential for researchers to move beyond the general to the specific and
focus more on the nauseas of distinction in specific elements of organisation management.
In response to the specialisation call detailed above, some communication scholars have
joined in on the debate regarding the public-private distinction by comparing and
evaluating the communication environment of the public and the private sector as a
subcategory in the public sector distinctiveness theory. The following section presents
such literature concerning the distinctiveness of the communication environment of the
public sector.
2.5
THE DISTINCTIVENESS OF GOVERNMENT COMMUNICATION
Liu and Horsley (2007) argue that existing public relations and communication models are
not adequately befitting to the unique environment of the public sector in general and
government in particular. The government’s level of responsibility far exceeds that of the
private sector. Because of the inherent differences between the public and the private
sectors’ operating environment, the prevailing communication models and theories do not
account adequately for the public sector environment and its influences on communication
practices (Liu, Horsley & Levenshus, 2010b).
Canel and Sanders (2012) summarise the special character of government communication
based on the public sector distinctiveness theory discussed above. They argue that
government communication should ideally denote the principle of publicness in that
governance should be constituted on the basis of the people’s direct or indirect consent. In
41
that way, government communication is especially directed at external audiences. The
environment of the public sector is typically less open to market competition, less
concerned with consumer preferences and more subject to legal and formal constraints
than the private sector. Public organisations are subject to sanctions and control and
significant public scrutiny. Public organisations are required to have a high degree of
accountability to political and public constituents. With relations to internal structures and
processes, public sector organisations tend to be more complex than their private sector
counterparts. They tend to have less decision-making autonomy and flexibility (Canel &
Sanders, 2012).
Gelders, Bouckaert and Van Ruler’s (2007:327) research compared and analysed public
relations in the private and the public sectors in an attempt to map out the differences and
similarities between the two. Their findings identified four differences. First, it was found
that the environment of the public sector was more turbulent and unstable consisting of
complicated networks of societal actors. Government communicates about an extensive
range of issues to a wide diversity of targeted publics (Gelders et al., 2007:327). A study
by Liu et al. (2010:207) confirms that government communicators serve a more
information hungry and heterogeneous public. Secondly, citizens often expect to have a
say in government processes much more than they do for the private corporate sectors
(Gelders et al., 2007:327; Killingsworth, 2009:60). The third finding was that government
organisations are more bureaucratic than private ones (Gelders et al., 2007:327). Adding
to the above, legal and formal constraints render the freedom of information in the public
sector virtually impossible (Pandey & Garnett, 2006:46).
Another equally important difference is that government public relations practitioners not
only strive for efficiency, but also for democratic values (Liu & Levenshus, 2010:3). The
two concepts may be conflicting if not properly balanced. Also considered by Gelders et al.
(2007:333-334), are the roles of PR practitioners within the two sectors to which they
found an unsurprising difference that:
42
Business communication professionals evaluate improving an adequate image of the organisation
and of its leaders as more important than government communication professionals. Business
communication professionals consider debating problems and their solutions less important than
their colleagues from the public sector.
Liu and Horsley (2007) illustrate eights factors contributing to the distinctiveness of the
public sector. The identified features are as follows: politics, public good, media scrutiny,
lack of managerial support for communication, poor perception of government
communication, lagging professional development and federalism. Other researchers
support most of Liu and Horsley’s (2007) attributes. With subsequent research, Liu and
Levenshus (2008) identified additional features that emerged as outliners. The following
features were added: limited leadership opportunities, internal vs external communication,
limited financial resources, poor communication evaluations and multiple communication
responsibilities (Liu & Levenshus, 2008; Liu, Horsley & Levenshus, 2010b). All thirteen
(13) attributes are discussed next.
2.5.1
POLITICS
The first character is ‘politics’ which forms the essence of the public sector. Whilst other
institutions are not ultimately free from politics, government is fully encompassed by politic
that may stifle the freedom of public relations practitioners (Liu & Horsley, 2007:379).
Government communicators are often forbidden from communicating certain issues until
such issues are voted on (Killingsworth, 2009:70). Politics create a potential for conflict,
miscommunication and misunderstandings (Liu et al., 2010:192). Government cannot
detach completely from party politics. For instance, in reference to Imbizos, Mabelebele
(2006:109) argued that “the ANC as a political party took advantage of this existing cultural
communication and governance infrastructure transmitted through word of mouth to
advance its own political and governance strategies” (Mabelebele, 2006:109).
According to Canel and Sanders (2012:86), public organisational communication and in
particular government communication operates in a political environment, which denotes
the following:
43
-
Political realities often lead to short-termism in strategic planning.
-
Politics influences political considerations, events, and cultural structures,
resources, personnel and goals.
-
Heads of communication in government ministries, agencies, and departments may
be appointed based on partisanship rather than professional criteria.
-
Government communication often has to endorse what appear to be conflicting
objectives set by political masters.
2.5.2
PUBLIC GOOD
The second characteristic pertains to the government as a ‘public good’. Governments and
the public sector are established to serve citizens (Gelders & Ihlen, 2010:34; Liu &
Horsley, 2007:379). While corporate organisations work for profit, the public sector works
for the social good, which is dependent on the public perception of doing well (reputation).
“You cannot just do your work, no one will know, you must be seen to be doing your work”
(Jackson & Lilleker, 2004).
2.5.3
MEDIA SCRUTINY
Media scrutiny presents the third element. According to Liu and Horsley (2007:379), the
public sector and their officials face a higher level of media scrutiny than their counterparts
in the corporate sector. Most often, government decision-making processes are reported
on by the media, making government susceptible to public and media criticism. This is not
the case for the private sector. In addition, Liu et al. (2010:192) found that public
organisations are covered more negatively than private ones.
Although both private and public institutions are held to the same standard of transparency
and accountability, Gelders et al. (2007:331) attest to the manner in which accountability
and transparency are institutionalised and enforced differently. For instance, the private
sector is seldom legally coerced into disclosure of any kind, while the public sectors may
be forced by law and the proverbial public interest to disclose every process of
policymaking or service delivery (Gelders et al., 2007:331).
44
2.5.4
LEGAL CONSTRAINTS
Legal constraints often limit the ability of government to communicate openly. This is the
fourth character of the public sector environment. There are laws that may reduce the
capacity of government communicators to function freely (Liu & Horsley, 2007:379; Liu et
al., 2010:191). Public organisations tend to be more bureaucratic than corporate private
sectors. The budgeting, timing and planning of government communication tends to be
tentative following rigid political procedures (Gelders et al., 2007:331).
Pandey and Garnett (2006) conducted one of the few studies that directly measured
government communication performance. They tested the effects of two distinctive
attributes of the public sector (lack of goal clarity and red tape) on government
communication performance. They found that red tape negatively affected the
performance of internal communication (Pandey & Garnett, 2006:45).
Government communication contends with considerable complexities in terms of goals,
needs, audiences, definition, and resources. “The multi-layered and organisationally
diverse nature of government communication is a key factor in the complexity of
understanding its needs, goals, and resources” (Canel & Sanders, 2012:86). For this
reason, it is essential for government communication to operate on a multi-layered level,
taking into account a very diverse group of stakeholders.
2.5.5
DEVALUATION OF COMMUNICATION
The fifth on the list is the devaluation of communication in government. Unlike the private
corporate sector where the value of PR is demonstrated by financial returns, public
relations in the public sector do not produce significant financial gains for the government.
It is thus difficult to motivate budget spending in this regard (Lattimore et al., 2009:308).
Killingsworth (2009:70) notes that some in the highest echelons of government
management perceive communication as a waste of taxpayers’ money. Other professional
difficulties emanating from a devaluation of communication in government may include,
“internal bureaucratic situations that hinder professional efforts, weak job standards,
45
political pressure, and little career development or recognition” (Lattimore et al., 2009:311).
Consequently, many qualified communicators leave government services for private
organisations that offer better salaries and esteem (Liu & Horsley, 2007:380).
Comtask (1996) found the status of communicators to be an inhabiting factor. There is
poor recognition for the need of professional government communication and information
service in South Africa. Even where arrangements were made to create a post for a
communications professional, this had been filled by people with other skills (Comtask
report, 1996:23). In reviewing the work of GCIS over the past 10 years, the findings reflect
a critical capacity shortage in content development and analytical skills. Where such
capacity has been recruited, it has been a challenge to retain them, as GCIS is unable to
compete with the private sector or similar organisations within the communication industry
in attracting and retaining relevant skilled employees (Annual year report 2010/2011
GCIS).
2.5.6
POOR PUBLIC PERCEPTION
Poor public perception adds sixth to the list. The intention of government communication is
sometimes met with cynicism as it is often infiltrated by negative connotations such as
propaganda or spin (Liu & Horsley, 2007:380). Government is often criticised for a lack of
transparency, falsification of information, secrecy, and spin (Gelders & Ihlen, 2010:34).
Government communicators report that one of the biggest challenges of their jobs is
overcoming public cynicism (Liu & Levenshus, 2008:2). However, this is not a new
phenomenon, Cutlip’s (1976:6) earlier work noted the extent to which the hostility to
government communication keeps it in the shadows of legitimacy, which thus weakens the
efficiency of its function. This is a formidable impetus to government communication. Vos
(2006:252) concurs that poor public perception discredits government communication and
weakens public trust.
Gelders and Ihlen’s (2009:2) study of government communication of potential policies
found that the citizenry perceives all government public relations as forms of propaganda
and fundamentally distrust all the communication effort. Gaber (2009:84) also lamented
46
the waning trust of government communication. The reason may be ascribed to the
inclination of governments to put communication of policies and service delivery as a
priority superior to the actual delivery of those services (Gaber, 2009:84).
2.5.7
POOR PROFESSIONAL DEVELOPMENT
The seventh element is the lagging professional development of public relations in the
public sector. Professionalism is necessary to elevate the public image of any field to grant
public respect and autonomy to the profession (Grunig, 2000:25; Liu & Horsley, 2007:380).
Professional development relates to the training, education, and experience of
practitioners (Liu et al., 2010:192). It refers to anything that renders practitioners more
insightful and more effective in their jobs (Liu & Levenshus, 2010:4). One common metric
of professionalism is through a fraternity membership to a professional organisation such
as the Public Relations Institute of Southern Africa (PRISA) (Meintjes & Niemann-Struweg,
2009:2). However, no distinct institutions exist specifically for government communicators
in South Africa.
2.5.8
LIMITED LEADERSHIP OPPORTUNITIES
An additional feature added by Liu and Levenshus (2010) refers to limited leadership
opportunities in government. In their findings, the majority of government communicators
negatively evaluated leadership opportunities in their various departments. Without
prospects of leadership, government communicators are simply relegated to technical
roles (Killingsworth, 2009:71; Liu & Levenshus, 2010:4). For instance, Steyn and Green’s
(2001) research proved that communication managers in the Department of Housing in
South Africa merely served technical roles and thus contributed very little to the
management of the department.
2.5.9
CENTRALISATION
The ninth characteristic adding to the distinctiveness of the public sector is federalism. It is
defined as “a system of authority constitutionally apportioned between central and regional
47
governments” (Liu & Horsley, 2007:380). Centralisation refers to a complex system of
organisation in which the national government oversees and creates policy for
programmes that are actually implemented by provincial and local governments (Liu &
Levenshus, 2010:3). The concept of centralism is relevant to South Africa where
ministerial government departments traditionally have one central department in Pretoria,
provincial departments and many regional departments (of the same nature, e.g., Home
Affairs) in various districts. Communication between provincial departments and the
central department must be integrated to avoid contradictions. However, at the extreme,
centralisation may paralyse the power of individual departments to communicate in a way
that is befitting to a particular community.
2.5.10 INTERNAL VS EXTERNAL COMMUNICATION
Liu and Levenshus (2008:9) found that most public organisations, particularly in
government valued external communication that internal communication. The majority of
government communicators felt that “internal communication may be important to help the
organisation, but external communication gets on the front page of the newspaper or on
the TV station...so external communication really gets the top shelf”.
2.5.11 BUDGETING: LIMITED FINANCIAL RESOURCES
It was found from Liu and Levenshus’ (2008) qualitative interview research that
government communicators consider limited financial recourses as a hindrance to the
effectiveness of government communication practices. Some communicators declared
that they could not go out and drive the communication objectives of the government
department amidst their financial constraints. “These government communicators said they
were not able to be as creative and effective as their corporate counterparts because of
their meagre budgets” (Liu et al., 2010c:206). Although, the survey results of 2010
highlighting dissatisfaction with communication budgets is not unique to the government
sector, government communicators seem to be more dissatisfied than corporate sector
communicators. Budget constraints seem significant to the practice of government
communication.
48
2.5.12 COMMUNICATION EVALUATIONS
Liu and Levenshus (2008:9) research reported that government communicators claim that
their budgets do not support formal evaluation of their communication practices. Some
mentioned that they are not trained to conduct communication evaluations.
2.5.13
MULTIPLE COMMUNICATION RESPONSIBILITIES
Liu and Levenshus (2008) found that government communicators frequently wear multiple
hats and are responsible for a variety of non-communication activities. “These
responsibilities included employee communication, media relations, event planning,
graphic design, crisis management, customer service, community relations, mail service,
cable television management, speech writing, lobbying, records management, marketing,
and evaluation as well as non-communication responsibilities”. Because of a variety and
instability of communication roles and responsibilities, “government employees have fewer
opportunities to practice communication as a strategic management function than their
corporate counterparts” (Liu et al., 2010c:209). Table 3 below summarises key distinctive
features of the communication environment of the public sector and their likely impacts on
government communication practices.
Table 3:
Public sector attributes and their impacts
Environmental
Explanation
Public Sector Impact
Attribute
Influences on Communicators' Daily Activities
Centralization
Overlapping, yet independent, system of
Decentralized communication approach may
constitutional authority.
cause
government
bodies
to
speak
with
multiple, contradictory voices.
Media Scrutiny
Media
act
as
government
watchdogs,
Makes
government
scrutinize government activities, and push for
conservative
transparency
negative
(Fitch,
2004;
Lee,
2008).
Government media coverage declining and
in
communicators
communication
coverage.
Some
to
more
avoid
government
communicators see media scrutiny as positive.
increasingly negative.
Relationships
with
Even
though
most
government
May limit acceptance and effectiveness of
49
Primary Publics
Legal Frameworks
Politics
communication is truthful, the public and
government communication. Public cynicism
media tend to have negative perceptions
seen
about government communication.
communication.
Federal laws ban propaganda and restrict
Misinterpretation of laws may unnecessarily limit
government use of public funds for publicity
communication activities at all government
(Lee, 2008). Federal, state, and local access-
levels and hurt ability to share information with
to-information
the public and media. May expand or hamper
laws
vary
(e.g.,
federal
as
greatest
obstacle
to
effective
Freedom of Information Act).
communicators' efforts.
While all organisation s experience the
Influences
influence of politics, external politics define
message distribution and creativity, increase
government bodies.
outside interest groups' influence. Determines
strategy
selection.
May
hinder
the level and means of information sharing.
Devaluation
of
Historic avoidance of public communication
Obstacles created by management who do not
Communication
by
strategies may be changing.
value strategic communication may reduce the
Management
effectiveness of communication strategies and
tactics.
Public Good
Unlike the private sector, the government's
Government bodies are not typically influenced
goal is public service rather than profits.
by market pressures when making strategic
decisions.
Influences on Communicators' Professional Advancement
Few
Leadership
Opportunities
Government communicators are historically
A weaker voice in management decision making
relegated to a technical role, but data are
may impede strategic communication planning
mixed on their inclusion in management
and execution.
decision making and promotions.
Lacking Professional
Government communicators lag behind their
The lack of skill and management development
Development
corporate
may affect the effectiveness of communication
Opportunities
professional associations and standards.
counterparts
in
terms
of
efforts and partnerships.
The following section reviews extant literature and studies concerning the distinctiveness
of government communication. This review may not be a comprehensive list but it
identifies the most recent studies in the area and the most relevant to the present study.
Most government communication literature primarily starts by point out the distinctiveness
of the public sector. Such studies are discussed throughout this document. However, they
are excluded in this section, as they are not specifically concerned with testing or
evaluating the distinctiveness of public sector even though they have referred to it as a
foundational theory, a premise, or a hypothesis.
50
2.6 EMPIRICAL RESEARCH ON GOVERNMENT COMMUNICATION
DISTINCTIVENESS
Liu and Horsley 2007’s study began by identifying seven features that are distinctive about
the communication environment of the public sector. The aim of Liu and Levenshus’
(2008) study was to determine whether and how Liu and Horsley 2007 unique attributes
directly influenced the daily activities of government communication. The subsequent
(2010b) study comparatively tested the propositions of whether the proposed distinctive
attributes are indeed specific only to the public sector (government) (Liu, Horsley &
Levenshus, 2010:195). The study in question confirmed notable differences between the
public and the private sector’s communication environment. The surprising finding of the
study was that some of the identified unique characteristics were in fact opportunities
simplifying the task of government public relations practitioners.
Gelders and Ihlen’s (2010) study on government communication of potential policies
applied the gap analysis model, a framework primarily used for business service marketing
to improve service quality. The above stated study identified some of the challenges likely
to
arise
from
using
a
business
formula
in
the
public
sector
(government).
Recommendations were provided on how to apply business models to government
communication. The gap model according to Gelders and Ihlen (2010) seems to provide a
sufficient assessment of government communication. According to their conclusions, the
distinctiveness of government and the public sector does not automatically limit the
applicability of business models if the specific environment of the public sector is
acknowledged and accurately accounted for.
Responding to Gelders et al., 2007; Liu & Horsley, 2007 and Liu et al., 2010 call for
evidence based research on the distinction between the public sector and the private
sector communication environment, Aerksen and Gelders (2011) conducted a pilot study
in Belgium which confirmed the discrepancy of the manner in which communication
practitioners of both sectors experience and respond to organisational rumours.
Government communicators were found to be more frequently confronted with harmful
rumours than their business counterparts (Aerksen & Gelders, 2011:8). One of the major
51
reasons behind this occurrence is the ‘capricious political climate’ of the public sector
(Aerksen & Gelders, 2011:8). This finding confirms previous research predictions (Liu &
Horsley, 2007; Gelders et al., 2007; Liu et al., 2010). Government communicators
generally exist within a complicated environment made up of a complex web of
stakeholders (Liu et al., 2007:377; Aerksen & Gelders, 2011:8). The identified complex
environment possibly not only brings about more rumours, but also makes it harder to
combat these rumours (Aerksen & Gelders, 2011:9).
Rumours in public organisations were found to be mainly about job security (Aerksen &
Gelders, 2011:8-9). This finding corroborates Liu and Horsley’s (2007:380) distinctive
feature of the public sector environment in which communication is devalued in
government. The latter may explain the restlessness and job insecurity felt by government
communicators.
Liu, Levenshus and Horsley (2012) evaluated the differences between the communication
practices of US public sector communicators working for non-elected officials (HOD office)
versus those employed by elected officials (MEC Office). Their findings indicated more
similarities than differences on how government communicators in elected and nonelected offices disseminate messages and evaluate influences on their professional
development. However, the pressure of information diffusion seemed to be perceived
differently between the two groups. This is because the two groups perceive their functions
differently. The primary goal of communicators working for non-elected officials is public
information whereas government communicators working for elected officials have divided
priorities between the promotion of their employer and public information (Liu et al.,
2012:235). Another key difference found was that “elected officials’ communicators are
more likely than non-elected officials’ communicators to be part of the management team,
indicating those non-elected officials’ communicators may have a higher need to convince
public administrators that communication is a management function” (Liu et al., 2012:235).
Waymer (2013) demonstrated how the distinctiveness of government communication
posed challenges to dominant conceptual frameworks in which the concept of ‘relationship’
is operationalised. The research illustrated the challenges accrued by relationship
52
management theories that emphasise ‘closeness” as an optimal relations measure.
Closeness is not always democratic, particularly when imposed to the public by a
patriarchy government. Waymer (2013) proposes that relationship management research
should take into account public’ (non) desire for a close relationship as well as recognise
the existence of different types of government - public relationships that are left
unexplored. As a result, Waymer (2013) introduced the concept of ‘distance’ to
communication management as a way of broadening the relationship management
framework.
Despite indicators of the unique communication environment of the public sector, a
number of scholars still challenge the distinctiveness agenda. For instance, Grunig and
Jaatinen (1998:219) “theorise that the principles of public relations for government are the
same as for other types of organisations, but the specific conditions to which the principles
must be applied are different”. They see communication management as being more or
less the same whether practised in the public or the private sector. In contrast to the public
sector distinctiveness theory, Grunig (2007:33) insists, “A theory of strategic management
used in government agencies should not differ from theory developed for corporations.
However, the specific application of that theory will differ”. Perhaps it can be extended that
the ‘specific application’ will differ in accordance to the context of the organisation, i.e. the
internal communication environment of the public sector.
2.7
CONCLUSIONS
It suffices to conclude this chapter by encapsulating the point of discussion thus far. The
public sector distinctiveness theory has been described. This theory postulates that the
public and the private sectors are distinct and thus the practice and the management of
such organisations will vary. It is recommended for organisational theories and
management theories to take cognisance of such distinctions. Similarly, communication
management must also consider such distinctions. For that purpose, this chapter identified
several features relating to the distinctiveness of the communication environment of the
public sector (government).
53
Following Perry and Rainey’s (1988:192) advice for researchers to become more attentive
to key sub-dimensions in the public sector distinctiveness thesis, communication scholars
have joined in on the debate to investigate the point of differentiation and the impacts of
such distinction on communication management within the public and the private sector. In
summary, the fundamental postulation of proponents of the public sector distinctiveness
theory, within the communication field, is that communication management in the public
sector is distinctive. Hence, the distinctions must be considered, acknowledged, and
accounted for, in practice and in theory. To this end, Liu, Horsley and Levenshus
(2010a:210) advise, “More research is needed to develop a theory that explains and
predicts communication practices and decision-making in government and their ultimate
impact on publics”.
Indeed, the distinctive communication environment of the public sector begs for more
attention to be paid toward this field of study regrettably neglected by both practitioners
and scholars. Clearly, there is a dire need to understand the communication environment
of the public sector in order to develop communication theories and models that are
specific to it. Once the distinctive context of communication is understood, it is then
opportune to discuss the nature of communication management therein. The following
chapter outlines the conceptual framework and literature on communication management
in government organisations. This field is now called government communication.
54
CHAPTER 3: GOVERNMENT COMMUNICATION THEORY AND
CONCEPTUAL FRAMEWORK
3.1
INTRODUCTION
This chapter outlines the theoretical framework grounded in this study. The thesis
statement presented is that communication management is vital for democracy. For
government communication to be professional and strategic, it must be organised
excellently and effectively (excellence theory) while taking into account the advocacy
nature inherent in external organisational rhetoric which may threaten the ethics and
legitimacy of (government) communication management. It is also essential that the
distinctive communication environment of
the public sector (the public sector
distinctiveness theory) be considered in both the theorising and the practice of government
communication. This thesis statement conveys the essence of the theoretical framework
that is proposed for the study.
The theoretical framework is presented in a series of two chapters. This chapter carries
the second part of the theoretical framework while chapter two (2) contained the first part
of the theoretical framework. This second part (chapter 3) reviews government
communication from a variety of perspectives – without taking into account the
public/private sector distinctiveness debate that is already discussed in the previous
chapter. The first part (chapter 2) offered literature on public – private sector
distinctiveness and the effects of this on communication management. The reason behind
such separation is that these two parts of the theoretical framework (chapter 2 & 3) are
equally imperative to the study, yet each presents government communication from a
differing perspective. The two chapters are not mutually distinct. If anything, they are
collaborative and this alliance is the subject of this study.
This chapter is divided into three sections that together form a coherent whole
demarcating the first part of theoretical framework. Part one (1) of this chapter discussed
the essence of communication towards the enactment of the ideals of democracy. The
field of political communication is presented as the theoretical and practical foundation of
55
government communication. Part two (2) carries with it a theoretically grounded
discussion about the relevance of the organisational communication management
approach in the theorising of government communication along with its practices. Part
three (3) of this theoretical chapter provides the critique of the excellence theory outlined
by a group of theorists who advocate an alternative view of communication management
called a rhetorical approach. The rhetorical approach calls into question the ethics of
communication management. An attempt is made to apply the rhetorical approach towards
the understanding of government communication. Part four (4) provides a review of the
existing models of government communication developed thus far. Table 4 depicts four
dominant traditions of government communication scholarship.
56
Table 4:
1.
Traditions of government communication
Government Communication
in a political communication
perspective
2.
Government
Communication in a
participatory
democratic perspective
3.
Government communication in
an organisational
communication perspective
4.
Government
communication in
organisational
rhetorical perspective
Influenced by mass communication
Influenced by traditional
Influenced by organisational
Influenced by persuasion,
and information diffusion theories
public administration and
communication and NPM movement
propaganda and public
democratic theories
Not organisation specific
opinion theories
Government communication
Communication management is the
is a distinct practice in
same regardless of organisation. Any
demand of its own theories
model or theory of corporate
and models.
communication such as strategic
Not organisation specific
management, excellence, and
effectiveness are applicable to
government communication.
Citizens as electorates
Citizens as constituents
Citizens as stakeholders
Citizens as dialogic
partners
Political communication traditions
It is fundamental citizens’
Concentrate on relationship
Rhetoric postulates that
are predominately information-
rights to know the functions
management for mutual
effective symmetrical
diffusion process based models such
of their governments.
understanding through two-way
communication is only
as
Citizens need to understand
communication. Extending the scope
achieved by the dialogic
Effect tradition – effects of
the policies, laws, and
of government communication
form. Organisation’s ethical
government communication on
regulations pursued.
beyond media relations to include
practices can be improved
voting. Uses and gratification –
The purpose of government
other activities such as reputation,
by paying attention to the
active consumers of government
communication in a
stakeholder, and issue management,
external environments
messages. Agenda setting – media
democracy is to
internal communication. Introducing
(public opinion).
communicate service
communication effectiveness –
Rhetoric approach provides
a call for a broader interpretation of
delivery and developmental
making government communication
the base necessary to
political communication moving
communication.
to contribute to better governance.
understand the self-
beyond voter persuasion paradigms.
The assumption is that
presentation motives and
government is a public good.
tactics through which
Corporate communication
governments attract
concepts (excellence and
legitimacy and reputation.
effectiveness) are insufficient
The rhetorical approach is
without incorporating ethical
best able to explain the
egalitarian principles in the
technical function of
communication management
communication
of the public sector.
management such as
and government relations. There is
messaging, publicity, and
media relations.
Press agentry model
Public information model
Two-way asymmetrical
Two way symmetrical
Micro level (program/operations)
Macro level ( societal/
Meso level (departmental/
Micro program level
enterprise)
functional)
(operations)
57
3.2 THE NATURE OF THEORIES
In order to understand the purpose of this theoretical framework chapter, we turn first to a
summarised and brief discussion of social theories. Neuman (2000:40) defines a social
theory as “a system of interconnected ideas that condenses and organises knowledge
about the social world”. Theories are often appropriated without explicitly labelling them as
such. They clarify why things are the way they are and how to alter those conditions.
Theories are flexible and progressive. However, they contain incomplete knowledge and
offer tentative answers. Theories frame how we look and think about a topic. They set the
concepts, provide basic assumptions, direct researchers to the important questions, and
suggest ways to make sense of the data (Neuman, 2000:60).
Most theories do not claim to be omniscient of all things. All social theories contain
assumptions about social life. “Assumptions are statements about the nature of things”
(Neuman, 2000:44). Theories must be tested to determine their accuracy level regarding
the assumptions they make. For that reason, theories must be tested against the hard,
empirical facts of ‘real’ material reality. As such, the aim of this study is to test if the
organisational communications approach, the rhetoric approach, and the public sector
distinctiveness approach are compatible and useful in the practice, the study, and the
theorising of government communication.
Macro-level theories focus on the operation of big systems such as social institutions or
societies. Theories at the micro level, observe smaller details, fixed in time and space.
Micro level theories review the day-to-day of life practices. Meso level theories attempt to
link the micro level and the macro level. They are often used in the description of
organisational theories. This study is demarcated at a meso-level as it seeks to describe
the distinctive communication environment of the public sector (organisation) and explore
the nature of communication management in governments as organisations.
With regard to meta-theory, this study takes a practical theory approach to theorising.
Practical theories propose a functional value in the purpose of theorising. Theories must
aid in improving the world, organisation, or practice. As reflected by Littlejohn and Foss
58
(2009:660), “Practical theory assumes that theories should address practical problems
(praxedogy) and that an essential purpose of theory is to open new possibilities of
communication practices in society” (axiology). The field of communication science
contains with it a wealth of theories, to these we turn next.
3.3
COMMUNICATION THEORIES
The meaning of the term communication is simple; to communicate is to impart or to
convey meaning. According to Rodfielf (1965), “communication is, in the first instance, by
its very nature the process of transferring a selected bit of information from an information
source to a destination”. Hundreds of unrelated theories that differ in starting point,
methodology and conclusions inundate the field of communication theory (Craig,
1999;135; Griffin, 2012:37). Craig expressed the difficulties of attempting to congest all
communication theories into one grand theoretical overview. However, he identified seven
dominant traditions or approaches into which most communication theories are grounded.
Namely: (1) the socio-psychological tradition, (2) the socio-cultural tradition, (3) the
semiotic tradition, (4) the rhetorical tradition, (5) the critical tradition, (6) the cybernetic
tradition, and (7) the phenomenological tradition. These seven traditions may be called the
ancestries of various communication theories. The socio-psychological tradition may be
rated the most objective of the seven approaches (Griffin, 2012). The cybernetic tradition
is also relatively objective. The phenomenological tradition on the other hand is rated the
least objective of the seven traditions (Griffin, 2012). Each tradition is briefly described
next.
The socio-psychological tradition sees communication as an interpersonal interaction. The
socio-psychological tradition epitomises the scientific, empirical, and objective perspective
in communication studies (Griffin, 2012:38). Advocates of this approach postulate that
communication truth can be discovered through a systematic observation. Through cause
and effects research, communication relationships and patterns may be established,
controlled and predicted (Griffin, 2012:38). For such purpose, longitudinal empirical studies
are best suited for the socio-psychological tradition.
59
The semiotic tradition is concerned with signs, symbols and meaning. Griffin (2012:38)
defines semiotics as “the study of verbal and nonverbal signs that can stand for something
else, and how their interpretation impacts society”. As such, the semiotic tradition discerns
communication as the process of sharing meaning through signs. “Problems of
communication in the semiotic tradition are primarily problems of (re)presentation and
transmission of meaning, of gaps between subjectivities that can be bridged, if only
imperfectly, by the use of shared systems of sings” (Craig, 1999:136-137).
Close to semiotics is the socio-cultural tradition based on the premise that society produce
and
reproduces
culture
by
communication.
The
socio-cultural
tradition
sees
communication as the creation and enactment of social reality. In contrast, the
phenomenological tradition observes communication as the experience of self and others
through dialogue. According to Griffin (2012:45), phenomenology “refers to the intentional
analysis of everyday life from the standpoint of the person who is living it”. Therefore, “the
phenomenological tradition places great emphasis on people’s perception and their
interpretation of their own experience. For the phenomenologist, an individual’s story is
more important, and more authoritative, than any research hypothesis or communication
axiom” (Griffin, 2012:45).
The cybernetic tradition regards communication as the link connecting the separate parts
of any system. Cybernetics is “the study of information processing, feedback, and control
in communication systems” (Griffin, 2012:39). Norbert Wiener referred to cybernetics to
describe the field of artificial intelligence. Theorists in the cybernetic tradition seek to
answer such question as how does the system work and how could it be changed.
Cybernetic explains “how all kinds of complex systems, whether living or non-living, macro
or micro, are able to function, and why they often malfunction” (Craig, 1999:142).
Therefore, cybernetics encourages communication theorists to look at communication
process from a broader, systematic viewpoint (Craig, 1999:142).
From the “Frankfurt School”, stems the critical tradition. For critical theorists,
communication is a reflective challenge of unjust discourse. The essence or end goal of
critical approaches is to emancipate society from conditions that perpetuates unjust power
60
relations (Littlejohn & Foss, 2009:659). Communication conceived in a critical approach
explains how social justice is perpetuated by ideology distortion and how justice can
potentially be restored through communication practices that enable critical reflection or
consciousness (Craig, 1999:147). The critical approach is often condemned for politicising
science and coercing normative standard for communication based on a predetermined
(priori) ideology (Craig, 1999:149).
The rhetorical tradition emerged from writings of Plato, Aristotle, and Cicero just to mention
a few. Rhetoric “is the art of using all available means of persuasion, focusing upon lines
of argument, organisation of ideas, language use, and delivery in public speaking” (Griffin,
2012:40-41). Rhetoric is the discovery of all available means of persuasion. According to
Craig (1999:135), rhetoric is useful for “explaining why our participation in discourse,
especially public discourse is important, how it occurs, and hold forth the possibility that
the practice of communication can be cultivated and improved through critical study and
education”. Thus, rhetoric best thinks of communication as a practice. The present study
adopts both the rhetorical and the cybernetic tradition to form a cybernetic-rhetorical
approach to government communication theory and research. As mentioned, this chapter
is divided into three parts, each presenting government communication from a particular
perspective; the first part (part 1) discusses government communication from a political
communication approach. This discussion follows next.
3.4 PART ONE: GOVERNMENT COMMUNICATION IN A POLITICAL
COMMUNICATION & PARTICIPATORY DEMOCRATIC APPROACH
Part one (1) explores government communication from a political communication
approach. Political communication is recognised as the foundation of most studies in
government communication. The field of political communication investigates the role of
communication in the facilitation of democracy. In this section, government communication
is defined and an argument is presented that a multifaceted theoretical approach is best
able to unravel the nuances of government communication as a field of study.
61
3.4.1 GOVERNMENT COMMUNICATION FROM A PARTICIPATORY
DEMOCRATIC PERSPECTIVE
Communication is in theory a fundamental prerequisite for democracy and it is in practice
inseparable from how government operates. According to Young (2008), communication is
a dimension of every action or decision a government takes, from the way in which policies
are made, promoted and enacted, to how government is organised and relationships are
built with citizens. The democratic theory emphasises the value of communication between
the governors and the governed. In practice, governing involves constant exchange of
information and communication about policies, ideas, and decisions between the
governors and the governed (Heinze, Schneider & Ferie, 2013:370). Accordingly, the
democratic theory recognises the prominence of studies in government communication.
Theoretical accounts that prescribe or suggest what ought to be (ideals) are called
normative
models.
For
an
adequate
comprehension
of
contemporary
political
communication, one must begin first with ideals. In classical direct democracy, citizens
ruled. “In the 5th century BC., an assembly with a quorum of 6,000 Athenians met over 40
times each year, discussing, debating, and making policy on taxes, foreign alliances, and
declaration of war” (Perloff, 2014:11). Citizens were expected to participate in politics
(largely to the exclusion of women and slaves). Thus, rhetoric was essential in the
deliberative and dialogic process within the classical democracy model.
Liberal democratic theories later came to the fore. Liberal democratic approaches
emphasised that an individual should be allowed freedom of speech, press, religion, and
economics (Perloff, 2014:12). It was later noted that society had become too large and
impractical for all citizens to participate. This was a recognition that Athenian notion of
direct democracy was cumbersome in mass society. Representative democracy was
advocated, in which through an election process, all citizens would elect others to
represent them in determining government policy and related matters of public affairs. In
this, communication was deemed fundamental to the enactment of liberal democracy.
Liberal democracy theorists advocate for a “free, competitive press, in which a thousand
flowers, roses and daisies, but also weeds and underbrush – bloom” in the marketplace of
ideas (Perloff, 2014:12).
62
In Perfloff’s words, deliberative democracy is now the newest intellectual kid in the
democracy block (2014:13). Deliberative democracy calls for the reinvigoration of the
public sphere wherein all citizens could participate for the greater social good. Deliberative
democrats take issue with liberal democratic theories, particularly against the notion of a
free marketplace of ideas. To this, deliberative democrats note that “voters are not mere
consumers choosing among different political brands, but citizens whose thoughtful
participation in politics serves as the foundation for democratic government” (Perloff,
2014:13).
Perloff (2014:15) identifies five primary characteristics of a vibrant democracy: (1) the right
of all adult citizens to vote and run for office; (2) free, fair elections that involve competition
between more than one political party; (3) individual liberty and freedom of expression,
including for those who oppose the party in power; (4) a civil society characterised by the
right to form associations, such as parties and interest groups, that attempts to shape the
agenda and influence public policy; and (5) opportunities for reasoned deliberation on
major national issues.
Berelson (1952:314-329) on the other hand, compiled a composite list outlining political
requirements expected of electorates (citizens) in enacting democratic principles.
Constituencies should excise moral responsibility in their public choices. Political
democracy requires interest and participation in public policy. The possession of
information and knowledge is a requirement for public interest and participation because it
arguably contributes to the wisdom of decisions making (Berelson, 1952:318). In addition,
citizens are recommended to engage in public discussions, and that they judge rationally
and consider the common good in the community interest.
It is fundamental citizens’ rights to know the functions and performances of their
governments. Citizens need to understand the policies, laws and regulations pursued and
enforced by their government. In addition, they seek knowledge of programmes
implemented, an awareness of international agreements, and details on government
budgets (Edes, 2000:456). Transparency increases the accountability of government and
63
assists citizens in evaluating and forming opinions about issues pertaining to public
policies that affect their lives (Fairbanks, et al., 2007:24).
McNair (2011:20) maintains, “Democracy presumes an open state in which people are
allowed to participate in decision-making, and are given access to the media, and other
information networks through which advocacy occurs”. In democracy, citizens are
supposed to be provided sufficient information and education enabling them to make
rational
decisions
regarding
their
public
opinion
and
other
political
activities.
Representative democracy depends on voting which in turn depends on an informed
electorate. “Democracy was real, in other words, only when it involved the participation of
an informed, rational electorate” (McNair, 2011:16). However, this democratic ideal is not
always attained.
The declining public interest in politics, heightened cynicism about politics, politicians, and
government suggest that there is a crisis in democracy and its legitimacy. Consequently,
citizens are retreating from political affairs. Young (2008) postulates that “the poor quality
of government communication has been identified as one of many possible causes of this
‘crisis’ amid concerns that government ‘spin’ or communication that is evasive, glib or false
is undermining trust between citizens and their representative”. The failure in education,
that is, the failure of the media to produce rational electorate is also a contributing factor to
an apathetical electorate who neither understands nor see any value in public
participation. When those who have the right to vote decline to do so, democracy is clearly
less than perfect (McNair, 2011:21).
The field of communication has always been cognisant of the relationship between public
opinion research (communication) and democratic theory. Bereleson (1952:314) made a
call for a corroborated theoretical framework between the two disciplines advancing that
the connection would strengthen and eliminate the deficit of each side. Such a “closer
collaboration of political theorists and opinion researchers (communication theorists)
should contribute new problems, new categories, and greater refinement and elaboration
to both sides” (Berelson, 1952:314). An alliance between communication theorists and
public administration theorists can be considered beneficial to democracy.
64
In summary, “there can be no doubt that communication, in all its forms and channels
plays a major role in how democratic systems are formed, in how they govern, and how
their public respond”. For this reason, political communication theory and research must
therefore retain a preeminent place in communication studies (Kaid, 1996:453). Political
communication theories provide the foundational theoretical grounding and tools for
understanding government communication. For that matter, they predominantly influence
the study of government communication, as they are the grand ancestors of the field.
3.4.2
POLITICAL COMMUNICATION
Political communication traces its pedigree to the earliest formal studies of communication,
taking into account scholars such as Plato and Aristotle who were interested in
communication as it affected the political and legal institutions of the day (Kaid, 1996:443).
Although no universal definition of the field has been advanced to date, political
communication can be defined as “the study of the role of communication in political
processes and institutions associated with electoral campaigning and governing”
(Swanson, 2000:190 in Canel and Sanders, 2012:87). Chaffe (1975) perhaps offers the
simplest definition that “political communication is the role of communication in the political
process” (Kaid, 1996:443).
The question of power and its exertion is vital for political communication scholarship
(Littlejohn & Foss, 2009:757). Littlejohn and Foss (2009) refer to the power of political
actors in their ability to obtain, preserve, and exercise authority in public policy. The power
of the citizens on the other hand stems from knowledge and willingness to engage in
political processes. Positioned amidst the power of political actors and voters, lays the
power of the media to transfer political messages. Further recognised is the power of
political communicators in their attempts to persuade the public by selecting persuasive
messages in their interaction with both voters and the media (Littlejohn & Foss, 2009:757).
Kaid (1996:443) identifies four basic perspectives guiding most political communication
research. Those are (a) rhetorical, critical, and interpretative approaches, (b) effects
research, (c) agenda- setting theory, and (d) the uses and gratifications approach. Political
65
communication researchers within the rhetorical, critical, and interpretative approach focus
primarily on the source and message aspect of the political communication process.
Herein, researchers seek common themes in political messages, analyse political
speeches, analyse the underlying motives of speakers, and ferret out strategies and
techniques of communication devices (Kaid, 1996:443). Many various types of rhetorical
studies share an interpretive philosophy. This present study is demarcated within the
rhetorical interpretive approach as it seeks to analyse the organisational structures,
communication practices, roles, and purposes of communication management in provincial
government departments.
Political communication researchers within the effect approach are naturally preoccupied
with the effects of political messages. As the political communication field became more
concerned with modern communication techniques and messages carried through the
mass media, issues of effects rose to the fore in seeking answers to political
communication outcomes. The traditional theories mass media effect such as the limited
effect model, the hypodermic needle, the bullet theory, the two-step theory, and the spiral
of silence theory became useful in analysing voters’ behaviour and effects on political
advertising.
Agenda setting research tradition espouses the notion, based on Cohen’s (1963) assertion
that “the media do not tell us what to think but what to think about”. To prove this theory,
McCombs and Shaw (1972) presented confirmation that the agenda of issues
communicated by the media became equally salient to voters (Kaid, 1996:447; McCombs,
Shaw & Weaver, 1997). Likewise, Hiebert (2003) confirmed the use of public relations and
propaganda in framing the Iraq war. Agenda setting, framing, and priming rejuvenated the
media effect tradition and are now essential elements of political communication research
(Littlejohn & Foss, 2009:757).
The uses and gratifications perspective focuses on active audiences or active voters.
“Unlike the passive audience myth of early direct-effects research, uses and gratification
research posits that audience members have expectations about communication they
receive, resulting in gratifications that are sought and received- or avoided” (Kaid,
66
1996:447). For political communications, this means that different types of political
messages perform different types of functions for voters. This insinuates that political
communication audiences (citizens) have the capacity to engage with, and utilise political
messages as they see fit.
All four political communication traditions discussed above are predominately informationdiffusion process based models. Scholars such as Kaid (1996:443), Swanson and Nimmo
(1990:9) and Young (2008) lament the preoccupation of political communication as studied
and theorised from a political campaign or public opinion influence perspective. According
to Swanson and Nimmo (1990:9), “the field’s centre or mainstream continues to be
devoted to studying the strategic uses of communication to influence public knowledge,
beliefs, and action on political matters and to regard the political campaign as the
paradigmatic instance of the subject”. Young (2008) adds that such a predominant focus
on elections distorts the purpose of political communication scholarship and the nature of
its day-to-day practice. In confirmation, Heinze et al. (2013:371) similarly acknowledge that
most of political communication literature is predominantly media-centric. In resolution,
scholars call for a broader interpretation of political communication moving beyond voter
persuasion paradigms.
On the brighter side, the field of political communication has grown dramatically in the past
few decades. Great strides are discernible as theoretical perspectives, major areas of
inquiry; research methods and techniques are maturing and diversifying (Kaid, 1996:4512). The field of political communication has contributed immensely to the study of
government communication. Political communication scholars have explored government
communication issues from a variety of perspectives such as “rhetorical analysis of
political discourse, propaganda studies, voting studies, mass media effect and the
interplay of influence between government, press and public opinion” (Canel & Sanders,
2013). Government communication as a subset of the political communication field is
discussed further below.
67
3.4.3
GOVERNMENT COMMUNICATION
As government modes shift towards consultative, transparent, and collaborative
governance, government communication is becoming a large industry in many countries.
With that said, what exactly is government communication?
According to Canel and Sanders (2010), government communication refers to the aims,
roles and practices of communication implemented by public relations officers in the
service of a political rationale. Canel and Sanders (2013) later amended their definition to
read: “Government communication is the role, practice, aim and achievements of
communication as it takes place in and on behalf of public institution(s) whose primary end
is executive in the service of a political rationale, and that are constituted on the basis of
the people’s indirect and direct consent and charged to enact their will”. This second
definition will take effect in this study because it takes into account both conceptual (what it
is) and functional (what it does) elements of government communication.
A definition of government communication varies from author to author (Howlett, Craft &
Zibrik, 2010:13). According to Howlett (2009:24), there may be no sufficient definition to
the term because government communication can be thought of as a generic name for a
wide variety of specific types or categories of communication in and about government
(Howlett, 2009:24). Cutlip, et al. (1985:579) concur, “the practice of public relations in
government varies widely”. Consequently, these different foci make comparative crossassessment and generalisation about trends, patterns, and structures of government
communication virtually impossible (Howlett et al., 2010:14).
A clear distinction between government communication and political communication is not
absolute. Gelders and Ihlen (2009) demonstrate the fluidity and the complexity of the two
concepts. Government communication functions for the benefit of the citizen. It is meant to
remain balanced, concise, and non-partisan (Glenny, 2008:153). According to Cutlip,
Center and Broom (1985:567), the justification for government communication
management is ingrained in two premises. The first premise is that a democratic
government is obligated to report to its citizens, and the second premise is that effective
68
administration requires citizen participation and voters’ support. The intertwined
relationship between political and government communication is worthy of further
discussion, next.
3.4.4
GOVERNMENT COMMUNICATION RESEARCH
Contrary to government communication, political communication refers to persuasive
communication designed to uphold the objectives of a political party or a politician
(Gelders & Ihlen, 2009:2). This definition seems conflicting to the one presented earlier
which views political communication as the study of all communication that is political.
According to this current definition, political communication is inherently persuasive and
partisan. Therefore, the separation of government communication from political
communication is ideal. However, in reality, it is impracticable for government
communication to be completely apolitical (Glenny, 2008:153). Nonetheless, efforts must
be made to formalise, professionalise, and depoliticise government communication
(Sanders et al., 2011:15).
Canel and Sanders (2012) chronologically traced the roots of government communication
from its pedigree in political communication science. They argue that “despite its key
importance for 21st century politics, the study of government communication is an underresearched area of political communication studies, finding itself in a kind of theoretical noman’s land between political communication, public relations and organisational
communication research” (Canel & Sanders, 2012:86). Political communication contributed
immensely to government communication scholarship. For this purpose, political
communication research identifies five key standpoints and methodological perspectives
through which government communication can be approached. Those are briefly outlined
below:
The chief executive communication and rhetorical studies perspective received the most
significant attention from US political communication scholars. The focus here is on
presidential political rhetoric, how political rhetoric shapes political reality, and its influence
on audiences - as studied through methodologies from the humanities and social sciences.
69
The permanent campaign, political advertising, public diplomacy, and propaganda studies
perspective marked the development of strategic government communication often called
the permanent campaign. The techniques of election campaigns, gathering of intelligence
(marketing), audience segmentation, message promotion, and rapid rebuttals became part
of the relentless campaign machinery of government (Canel & Sanders, 2012:87; Young,
2008). Communication specialists are hired to facilitate campaigning communication
functions.
The propaganda studies perspective is the dominant tradition used to analyse the
manufacturing of consent by governments through the mass media. Hiebert’s (2003) paper
about public relations and propaganda in framing the Iraq war is a good example of
propaganda studies in government communication research. Propaganda studies
essentially evaluate the relationship between government, press, and public opinion. In
this wave of political communication, government campaigns “seek to win, not engage”.
Hence, public relations, political advertising, and social marketing become essential during
times of crisis, war, and terrorism in order to win warning public support.
New media relations and effects research are popular in government communication
research. Because government communication takes place in a mediated environment, it
is unsurprising that government-media relations preoccupy a significant area of
scholarship in political communication. Research in this area focuses on the relationship
between politicians and journalists and on the conflict that arise when politicians seek
control of the newsroom, while journalists seek novelty and revelations from political
realities (McNair, 2011). Related to this area are studies in e-government, e-democracy,
and social media democracy. Such studies reflect the development of new media
technologies and their contribution to government-citizen relations and to the permanent
campaign (Canel & Sanders, 2012:88).
The structure and organisation of government communication is a new addition to
government communication scholarship. This perspective predominately explores how
government organise their communication. Research within this perspective evaluates the
relationship between government and its citizens. This subfield of research often concerns
70
itself with organisational charts, roles, functions, and decision-making processes of
government
communication.
The
examinations
of
government
communication
management, practices, and structures fall under this section of research. Hence, this
study demarcates itself within this perspective of government communication research.
Much is written about government communication from a practical application standpoint.
However, literature is still lacking on the theorising of government communication. For
instance, Canel and Sanders (2012:89) lament the actuality that “critical analysis of
baseline issues for the field or for modelling government communication to lay the
foundation for comparative study going beyond the mainly descriptive has yet to be carried
out”. This present study proposes a multifaceted theoretical approach in the theorising of
government communication. This proposal is substantiated in the following section.
3.5 GOVERNMENT
COMMUNICATION
THEORETICAL APPROACH
IN
A
MULTIFACETED
The study of government communication requires a multifaceted theoretical approach
because it is positioned at the crossroads of research traditions in political communication,
public opinion and other cognate fields such as public relations, corporate communication,
political marketing, and strategic communication (Canel and Sanders, 2013).
Political communication literature provides two indispensable theoretical standpoints from
which government communication research can be approached. First, is an “emphasis on
the exploration of and sensitivity to institutional and social contexts” (communication
context) and second is the normative concern of how communication can better serve
democratic processes. These contributions are essential to the theorising of government
communication. The limitation with the political communication framework, however, is
with regard to its failure to challenge the intellectual pessimism that “government
communication is seen simply as a way to gain votes” (Canel & Sanders, 2013).
Rensburg (2007) along with Canel and Sanders (2012:89) suggest that political
communication scholarship could establish a vintage point for academic innovation by
71
exploring work carried out by cognate fields of organisational communication and public
relations. Communication management and organisational communication scholars can
offer a fresh conceptual approach to issues concerning government communication
(Rensburg, 2007). However, there is very little research examining government
communication or communication management in the public sector from an organisational
communication perspective (Canel & Sanders, 2012; Canel & Sandars, 2013; Likely 2013;
Liu, et al., 2012).
Canel and Sanders, (2012) identify three themes where public relations and organisational
communication management may contribute invaluably to the understanding and the
improvement of government communication research and practices: The first area
identified is symmetrical relationships and mutuality which is seen as essential for
understanding government inter-relationships with a complex network of stakeholders. The
second area is on appraising the principle of professionalisation in government
communication. Scholarship in communication management entails many benchmarks in
which effectiveness, professionalisation and communication practices are measured and
evaluated (Canel & Sanders, 2012). The third area of contribution is with reference to the
concept of reputation in government. Concepts such as corporate identity, branding, and
reputation have emerged as essential to government communication and have proved
invaluable to the perceived success of government as a whole. To encapsulate, the
organisational communication management theoretical perspective therefore introduces
into political communication the notion of relationship management, professionalisation
and reputation management (Canel & Sanders, 2013).
The application of the organisational communication management theoretical framework
into the study of government communication implies that: first, the scope of government
communication should go beyond media relations to include other activities such as
reputation, stakeholder, and issue management. Secondly, relationship management
requires a strategic communication approach. Thirdly, the effectiveness question becomes
relevant in appraising the contributions of government communication to the achievement
of organisational goals - how does government communication make government
effective? An analysis of government communication from a strategic approach implies
72
effectiveness on the exploration of the extent to which government communication
contributes to shared decision-making process with the public or citizens thereby
upholding the principle of representative democracy (Canel & Sanders, 2013). The
concept of effectiveness in communication management is dealt with in chapter 4.
In summary, part one of this chapter discussed the essence of communication in the
enactment of the ideals of democracy. For this purpose, the field of political
communication was explored as a theoretical foundation of government communication. In
this, the rhetorical, critical, and interpretative approach was elected the foundation of the
present study. This approach is primarily concerned with the source and message aspect
of political communication. Hence, the approach is considered relevant and appropriate to
the analyses of organisational structures, communication practices, roles, and purposes of
government communication in provincial government departments.
This study presents the argument that a multifaceted theoretical approach is best able to
holistically evaluate and explain the nature of government communication. Within this
holistic approach, the study is further delimited to the (organisational) communication
management approach. Part two (2) presents a theoretically grounded discussion
concerning the relevance of the (organisational) communication management approach
towards the study and the theorising of government communication. This approach is
henceforth referred to as communication management.
3.6 PART
TWO:
GOVERNMENT
COMMUNICATION
IN
AN
ORGANISATIONAL COMMUNICATION MANAGEMENT APPROACH
Part 2 of the chapter explores government communication from a management
communication approach. This is within the organisational communication framework.
Organisational communication is “the study of the flow and impact of messages with a
network of interactional relationships” (Vasu et al., 1990:145).
In any organisation,
communication is critical to effective management ((Vasu et al., 1990:144). “Of all the
problems that beset organisations and bedevil administrators, few are more pervasive and
continuous than those which involve communication” (Highsaw & Bowen, 1965:5). Within
73
organisations, communication is the foundation of control and coordination (Vasu et al.,
1990:156). It determines the structure, scope, and extensiveness of organisations.
Therefore, effective communication is a prime factor in achieving organisational
effectiveness (Vasu et al., 1990:145). However, in public administration and public
management, communication as a phenomenon is not well-understood (Vasu, Stewart &
Garson, 1990:145).
The premise is that government departments are in fact organisations that must
orchestrate and manage communication with their stakeholders. This section defines the
concept of communication management, identifies levels of communication management,
and introduces the function of communication management in the public sector. Within the
stakeholder management concept, citizens are identified as external stakeholders. In
addition, Part 2 discusses the excellence theory and its contribution to the study of
government communication.
3.6.1
PUBLIC RELATIONS AND COMMUNICATION MANAGEMENT
Edward Bernays (1955:3) defines public relations as an “attempt, by information,
persuasion, and adjustment, to engineer public support for an activity, cause, movement,
or institution”. Bernays connotes public relations as a practice predominated by persuasion
and the manufacturing of consent. Grunig (1992:23) on the other hand defines public
relations as “the management of communication between an organisation and its publics”.
This definition reconceptualises public relations as a strategic management function.
Accordingly, Hutton (1999:208) defines public relations as the process of “managing
strategic relationships” which also denotes public relations as a management function
(Hutton 1999:208).
Another definition provided by Lattimore, Baskin, Heiman and Toth (2009:4) is that public
relations is a management function that maintains an organisation’s relationships with
society in a way that most effectively achieves organisational goals. One comprehensive
definition offered by the Public Relations Institute of South Africa (PRISA) inscribes that
“public relations is the deliberate, planned and sustained effort to establish and maintain
74
mutual understanding between the organisation and its various publics, both internal and
external” (Rensburg & Cant, 2003:36).
Within the African discourse, the term public relations is more used and accepted than
‘communication management’ (Rensburg, 2007). Seitel (1984:4) once said, “The field (of
public relations) is still plagued by misrepresentations of what it’s all about. More often
than not, the public’s perception is that public relations is aimed at and not for them; that
they are the object of public relations, not the beneficiaries” (Seitel, 1984:4). The term
public relations has been under siege, it’s been challenged from both inside and outside
the profession - with many preferring a change of terminology in order to avert negative
connotations. Public relations is now reincarnated into various euphemism terminologies
such as: corporate communication, public information, public affairs, communication
management and many more (Gregory, 2009:20). As public relations has evolved from
‘the public be fooled’, to ‘the public be damned’, to ‘the public be manipulated’, to ‘the
public be informed’ (Seitel, 1984), and now, to the ‘public be accommodated’; the term
communication management has come to be preferred in order to reflect the maturity of
the profession, both theoretically and practically.
Communication management is more of an inclusive term encompassing a variety of
communication modalities such as public relations, organisational communication,
business communication, corporate communication, and to a lesser extent, marketing
communication (Shelby, 1993:254). Adopting such a definition allows the flexibility of the
study to investigate additional aspects of government communication that are paramount
but perhaps fall outside the parameters of public relations. However, in this study, the
term, ‘public relations’ is used synonymously with ‘communication management’ because
some scholars still refer to public relations as to reflect the heritage from which
communication management was founded. Hence, although the term public relations,
communication management, and government communication are used interchangeably
in this document, an understanding of the nuances among these definitions and their uses
is still recommended. The following section introduces the function of communication
management in the context of the public sector (in government).
75
3.6.2
COMMUNICATION MANAGEMENT IN THE PUBLIC SECTOR
Public relations is based on the proposition that in modern democracy, every organisation
survives ultimately only by public consent (Lattimore et al., 2009:308). Heightened media
scrutiny, increasing citizen’s intolerance to unethical conduct and rising power of advocacy
movements have increased the pressure for governments to respond to the relentless cry
for transparency (Edes, 2000:456; Fairbanks, Plowman & Rawlins, 2007:24). Furthermore,
as citizens become more accustomed to accessing unlimited and uncensored information
from the internet, they come to expect the same kind of transparency from their
government (Edes, 2000:456).
Stromback and Kiousis (2011:8) offered a definition of political public relations which they
conceptualise as “the management process by which an organisation or individual actor
for political purposes, through purposeful communication and action, seeks to influence
and to establish, build, and maintain beneficial relationships and reputations with its key
publics to help support its mission and achieve its goals” (Canel & Sanders, 2013).
As in any organisation, government public relations, here referred to as government
communication, is viewed as a management function that defines objectives and
philosophies whilst assisting organisations to adapt to their environment and its
constituencies (Theaker, 2004:218). Still like corporate public relations, government
communication must be rendered to all relevant internal and external stakeholders
(Gelders & Ihlen, 2010:36). It is through public relations that government explains the
services rendered and how to access and utilise them (Theaker, 2004:219).
Communication management (public relations) is fundamental to government, especially
since the success and stability of democratic governments are ultimately determined by
continuous public approval (Fairbanks, et al., 2007:24). Through public relations,
governments are able to secure this approval. Government communicators must develop,
execute, and evaluate programmes that promote mutual understanding between the
government and its publics (Lattimore et al., 2009:308). Hence, citizens are critical
stakeholders for government.
76
3.6.3
STAKEHOLDER MANAGEMENT
Stakeholders consist of any group that affects and is affected by the operations, policies
and proceedings of the organisation, and whose support is needed by the organisation
(Luoma-aho, 2008:447). Through stakeholder management, organisations can recognise,
analyse, and examine the interests and concerns of groups who may influence and are
relatively influenced by the organisation (Mainardes, Alves & Raposo, 2011:230).
Stakeholders can be internal or external. External stakeholders are not directly associated
with the internal operation of the organisation, but may affect and be affected by the
functions of the organisation. The present study centres on citizens as external
stakeholders of government departments. This position is not withstanding of the
acknowledgement that government has many other equally important external
stakeholders.
According to Grunig (1992:22), “Organisations, like people must communicate with others
because they do not exist alone in the world”. Organisations need communication
management and public relations because they have relationships with publics.
Communication management is about reinforcing mutual understanding. Organisations
that communicate well with their publics know what to expect from those publics (Grunig,
1992:22). Mass communication implies that communication professionals assist
organisations to communicate well with a larger heterogeneous and unidentified mass,
often referred to as the general public. The concept of the general public however is a
misnomer because according to Grunig, “a general public actually is contradictory because
publics only arise around shared problems or concerns. Therefore, a public always is
specific and cannot be general”.
Steyn (2004) also makes the distinction between ‘stakeholders and ‘publics’. Following
Grunig’s ‘theory of the public’, Steyn (2004) points out that individuals and groups only
become organisational stakeholders when they are affected and could affect the
organisation. At the stakeholders’ level, they are largely passive. They become aware
publics as they recognise how affected they are by the organisation’s activities. They only
become active publics when they seek out resolutions to potential issues affecting them.
77
Although the theoretical distinctions have been noted between the concept of stakeholders
and publics, for simplicity reasons, the two concepts will be used interchangeably. For
government communication, citizens as external stakeholders are the key recipients of
public relations’ messages. The notion of citizens as external stakeholders is discussed
next.
3.6.4
CITIZENS AS EXTERNAL STAKEHOLDERS
At the heart of government communication debates and theories is usually an interest in
citizens, that is “the extent to which citizens are included or excluded, listened to or
ignored, informed or misinformed” (Young, 2008). It is noteworthy that “citizens are a
cacophonous combination of the politically engaged and opinionated, along with the
indifferent and woefully ignorant” (Perloff, 2014:34). The concept of stakeholder
management is rather new in public sector dialogue (Luoma-aho, 2008:447). The concept
of the public is relevant for government communication because citizens in a democracy
are expected, and most increasingly do participate and communicate back to government.
According to Grunig (2007), the concept of the public captures the application of
symmetric communication between the government department and its various publics.
Communication management is concerned with the construction of relationships between
organisations and their publics. Within the stakeholder management parameter, the public
is not seen as an impartial and passive spectator of an organisation’s communication.
Although, this approach is not yet evidently present in political communication scholarship,
communication management is gradually contributing to the understanding of symmetrical
relationships and mutuality between the government and its many stakeholders, especially
the citizens (Canel & Sanders, 2012:90).
The symmetrical perspective places an implicit value on relationship management going
beyond the achievement of organisational goals. The goal here is mutual understanding,
mutual
benefit,
win-win,
and
mixed
motivated
communication.
Grunig’s
symmetrical/excellent model of communication management and ethical public relations
may prove useful in improving government communication. Within this new perspective,
78
the understanding of the public is fundamentally altered and “government communication
is conceived as the cultivation of long-term relationships oriented to mutual understanding”
(Canel & Sanders, 2012:90).
Government communication practitioners have begun borrowing segmentation techniques
from marketing research, such as demographics, psychographics, geo-graphics, and
VALS (value and life-styles) in order to segment citizens into specific groups of publics. It
is essential for government communicators to note that organisations may “create their
own markets by covering up a population into the segments most likely to consume their
products and services. Publics in contrast, organise around problems and seek out
organisations that create these problems” (Grunig, 2007:28). Thus, government
communication should be aiming at communicating with citizens as both markets and
publics. For this to be possible, government communication must be proactive in seeking
out ‘markets’ and reactive in attending to the initiatives of the ‘publics’. Communication
management in itself is categorised into various areas of organisational activities. Such
demarcations are discussed next.
3.6.5
LEVELS OF COMMUNICATION MANAGEMENT
Grunig (2007:23) marks a distinction between three layers of public relations abstraction,
namely, the micro, meso and macro levels of abstraction.
In order to contribute to
organisational effectiveness, communication management has to be practiced at the
macro
(strategic/societal/environment)
level
(the
strategist
role);
the
meso
(functional/divisional) level (the manager role); and the micro (implementation/operation)
level (the technician role) (de Beer, Steyn and Rensburg, 2013:208).
The micro level refers to the planning and evaluation of individual public relations
programmes. The meso level refers to how public relations departments are organised and
managed. The macro level refers to explanations regarding the connection between
communication management and organisational effectiveness. Included in the macro level
of analysis is the critical evaluation of the role of public relations in society. This particular
research investigating communication management practices of government departments
79
in KwaZulu Natal therefore evaluates government communication at a meso level of
abstraction. The research analyses how communication units within government
departments are organised, managed and how they operate. For that reason, this
research does not investigate the operations of individual communication programmes of
each communication unit (micro) and most certainly falls short of evaluating the impacts of
government communication into the overall democratic culture of the South African society
(macro). However, the study is also concerned with the impacts of government
communication on the effectiveness of the government department (macro). Each level of
abstraction is explored further in the section that follows.
3.6.5.1
The micro (programme) level
The micro level of analysis is much more popular in public relations research and in
government communication scholarship because it deals with the greatest concern of
public relations and government communication. Primarily, practitioners and theorists alike
are more concerned with evaluating the success of communication programmes and
campaigns (impact and effectiveness research). For that reason, the two areas of effect
research that have attracted public relations theorists concern “the effects of the media
and the effects of persuasive messages on attitudes and behaviours” (Grunig, 2007:25).
Grunig (2007:25) claims that “most of the research studying the effects of individual
messages, campaigns, or the mass media still cling on the idea that communication must
persuade (change attitudes and behaviours) in order to be effective”. Research on the
micro level of government communication helps conceptualise the planning and evaluation
of government communication programmes, messages and campaigns.
3.6.5.2
The meso (departmental) level
It is impossible to study public relations at a meso level and yet neglect the models of
public relations and a thorough discussion of public relations’ roles. With regard to models
of public relations, the two-way symmetrical model is considered the most effective of all
four models. The two-way symmetrical can be used alone or in conjunction with the twoway asymmetrical model. The press agentry model and the public information model
conceptualise of public relations as a monologue (Grunig, 2007:40). The press agentry
80
model describes public relations as solely engaged in attracting favourable publicity for an
organisation or a government department in this case.
Like the press agentry, the public information model too is a one-way flow of
communication. The public information model values public relations purely for the
purpose of information diffusion. Herein, the practitioners (government communicators)
work as ‘journalists-in- residence’. These are “public relations practitioners who act as
journalists to disseminate relatively truthful information through the mass media and
controlled media such as newsletters, brochures, and direct mail” (Grunig, 2007:41). Both
the press-agentry and the public information models are not based on research and
strategic planning. Public information practitioners are generally technicians than
managers as they seldom provide strategic counsel to top management (Grunig &
Jaatinen, 1998:219). The press agentry and the public information model are asymmetrical
models, meaning they attempt to change the perceptions and behaviours of the external
environment and key stakeholders without changing those of the organisation itself.
Grunig, (2007:41) is of the opinion that asymmetrical communication make(s) the
organisation look good either through promotional type (press agentry) or by disseminating
only favourable information (public information).
3.6.5.3
The macro (organisational) level
The organisational level is concerned with “understanding of and respect given to,
communications processes and audience feedback by the organisation and its staff”
(Tench & Yeomans, 2009:150). On the macro level, some scholars have adopted the
power-control perspective to explain that communication departments without power do
not and cannot practice strategic communication management. Lack of power therefore
seems to explain why few public relations programmes are excellent (Grunig, 2007:46).
This brings into question the issue of excellence and effectiveness in communication
management. How is government communication to be structured, managed, and
practiced for it to contribute to excellence and effectiveness? The principle of excellence is
discussed in the next section while the principle of effectiveness is explored in chapter 4.
81
3.7 THE
EXCELLENCE
AND
EFFECTIVENESS
COMMUNICATION MANAGEMENT
THEORY
IN
Strategic communication is strongly linked to the issue of effectiveness and excellence in
public relations and communication management. No discussion or research concerning
communication practices is complete without a review of standards or benchmarks
regarding excellence and effectiveness in the practice therein. The International
Association of Business Communication (IABC) commissioned a study to discern the
essence of communication management. The IABC study was originally concerned with
what is called the ‘effectiveness question’ regarding “how, why and to what extent does
communication contribute to the achievement of organisational objectives”?
It was realised during the research project that most organisations do not manage
communication strategically and that most communication departments were not
contributing to organisational effectiveness. Therefore, the excellence question was added
into the equation. The excellence question was concerned with investigating: how must
public relations be practiced and how must the communication function be organised for it
to contribute the most to organisational effectiveness? The IABC study resulted in a theory
of excellence and effectiveness in public relations. The theory has been called by different
names such as the excellence theory, the symmetrical/asymmetrical theory, or the public
relations effectiveness theory among others.
Grunig (1992:16) defines excellent public relations departments as those that are
managed strategically in order to maximise the contribution of communication
management to organisational effectiveness. The excellence theory contends that
excellence and effectiveness in communication management are achieved only by
organisations that are symmetrical rather than those that are asymmetrical in their
relations with the public. A symmetrical worldview conceive “public relations as a non-zerosum game in which competing organisations or groups can both gain if they play the game
right”, perhaps even fairly (Grunig, 2002:9). The symmetrical approach recommends that
public relations should be practiced to serve the public interest, to develop mutual
understanding between organisations and their publics, and to contribute to informed
debate about issues in society. Consequently, symmetrical public relations is considered
82
more ethical and more socially responsible than the asymmetrical one which presupposes
that organisations can achieve powerful self-interest effects with communication.
The public relations excellence theory attempts to describe, explain, and predict the nature
of
effective
organisational communication,
types
of
excellence
public
relations
departments, and the contribution that excellent communication makes towards the
success of the organisation.
With regard to the IABC excellence project, a set of independent variables (characteristics
of public relations) including a set of dependent variables (indicative of organisational
effectiveness) are logically identified and empirically related to each other. These
independent and dependent variables are described in table 5 (Grunig, 2007:37). Table 5
describes all the characteristics of the public relations excellence theory. Within the table,
the meso-level is identified inclusive of the micro-level characteristics regarding individual
communication programmes within the department. Incorporated in the table is the
relationship between communication management and strategic management, and the
conditions of excellent communication that contributes to organisational effectiveness
(macro). Each of these variables is discussed next. However, for ease of narration and
depiction of relations between variables, the numbering of the discussion will not
necessarily correlate with the numbering in the table
Table 5:
Principles of the excellence theory
Characteristics of Excellent Public Relations Programs
i.
1.
ii.
Program level
Managed strategically
Departmental Level
2.
A single or integrated public relations department
3.
Separate function from marketing
4.
Direct reporting relationship to senior management
5.
Two-way symmetrical model
6.
Senior public relations person in the managerial role
7.
Potential for excellent public relations, as indicated by:
-
Knowledge of symmetrical model
-
Knowledge of managerial role
83
-
Academic training in public relations
-
Professionalism
8.
Equal opportunity for men and women in public relations
iii.
9.
Organisational Level
Worldview for public relations in the organisation reflects the two-way symmetrical model
10. Public relations director has power in or with the dominant coalition
11. Participative rather than authoritarian organisational culture
12. Symmetrical system of internal communication
13. Organic rather than mechanical organisational structure
14. Turbulent, complex environment with pressure from activist groups
Source: Grunig, 1992:28
The excellence theory typology identifies fourteen (14) key assumptions regarding the
features of an excellent communication management department: Strategic management
is the interlink that integrates excellence and effectiveness in communication management
(1). “Excellent public relations departments contribute to decisions made by the dominant
coalition of senior management by providing information to that coalition about the
environment of the organisation, about the organisation itself, and about the relationship
between the organisation and the environment. Empowerment or access to the dominant
coalition can be measured by (a) being part of the dominant coalition or (b) having a direct
reporting line to senior management (Likely, 2013) (2). That means, excellent
communication departments engage in environmental scanning (3). The assumption is
that organisations with high environmental turbulences are more likely to engage more in
environmental scanning which often leads to excellent communication management
practices (4).
Public relations must be a management function if it is to contribute excellently to
organisational effectiveness (5). For this to be possible, excellent communication
department must have access to the dominant coalition (6). Excellent public relations
departments should therefore be structured in an open-system located in an organisational
structure with ease access to the managerial subsystem and must integrate all public
relations functions in a single department (7). However, excellent public relations
departments will be separate from other functions such as marketing departments
whereas less excellent ones will be subliminal to marketing. When such sublimation
happens, public relations is usually relegated to technical roles (8).
Excellent public
84
relations departments model more of their communication programmes to reflect the twoway symmetrical than the other three (two-way asymmetrical, public information and
press-agentry) (9).
Excellent communication departments strategically manage public relations at the
programme level by developing programmes to communicate with internal and external
publics in a manner that averts threats and maximise opportunities (10). For this purpose,
excellent public relations departments choose and plan communication systems that
minimise conflict and maximise cooperation between an organisation and its strategic
public (11).
Excellent communication departments will employ professionals who have specialised
body of knowledge in the field (12). This assumes the role of education in the
professionalization of communication management. The excellence theory purports that
knowledge to enact the management function role is a strong determinant of excellence in
communication management (Clemons, 2009). In addition, diversity is essential for
excellent communication management. Likely (2013) defines diversity as “the inclusion of
both men and women in all roles, as well as practitioners of different racial, ethnic, and
cultural backgrounds”. Such excellent departments will have women in communication
management roles and also implement mechanisms to assist more women in assuming
management roles (13). Most importantly, excellent public relations does not exist in
isolation, it is a characteristic of an excellent organisation (14). For this reason, “the
characteristics of excellence in the organisation as a whole provide the condition that
make excellent public relation possible” (Grunig, 1992:19).
On the macro level of public relations and communication management research, some
scholars have adopted the power-control perspective where they argue that “organisations
behave as they do because the people with the most power- the dominant coalition
choose to do so” (Grunig, 2007:46). The power-control issue is essential in understanding
communication management within organisations in general, particularly bureaucratic
ones like government departments (Grunig, 2007:46). According to this perspective,
85
communication management cannot be effective unless the most senior communication
manager retains power to affect organisational decisions either formally or informally.
Communication departments without power do not and cannot practice strategic
communication management. “Lack of power therefore seems to explain why few public
relations programmes are excellent” (Grunig, 2007:46). The power-control theory clarifies
why organisations practice public relations in the way that they do. The power-control
theory is concerned with how the dominant coalitions choose to enact the communication
management function based upon their understanding, ideology, and worldview
concerning the proper function of communication within an organisation (Grunig, 1992:23).
Proponents of the excellence and effectiveness theory generally uphold the idealistic
social role towards communication management, which sees public relations a mechanism
by which organisations and publics interact in a pluralistic system to manage their
interdependence and conflict (Grunig, 1992:9). The excellence theory also reinforces a
critical social role based on the premise that public relations scholars and practitioners can
and should criticise public relations for poor ethics, negative social consequences,
ineffectiveness, and they should suggest changes to resolve those shortcomings (Grunig,
2002:10). The following section reviews the incorporation of the excellence theory in
government communication practice and research.
3.7.1
EXCELLENCE IN STRATEGIC GOVERNMENT COMMUNICATION
The excellence theory has been replicated and applied to many studies of corporate
communication in the private sector. There are a small number of studies that have
applied the excellence theory in the government communication sector (for example
Grunig & Jaatine, 1999; Killingsworth, 2009; Likely 2013). However, in overall, research in
this area has been lacking. When examining the difference in excellence by types of
organisations, Grunig, Grunig & Dozier, (2002:86) in Clemons (2009:7) and in Likely
(2013:70) found that:
86
The senior public relations person in government agencies is more likely to report being in a
technician or media relations role than in other types of organisations – especially in comparison to
corporations. However, he or she is about average for the managerial role, participation in strategic
management, and being in the dominant coalition. Such a combination or roles suggests that the
historical public information or public affairs definition lives on in government – of disseminating
information to the general population directly or through the media. At the same time, the data
suggest that the government agencies are moving towards a more managerial and strategic
role…government agencies seem to be moving towards a strategic, managerial and symmetrical
role, but they are not quite there yet.
Likely (2013:70) evaluated if the excellence theory is applicable to contemporary practices
of government communication. In this, five generic principles were tested in order to
determine whether government communication in the Canadian Federal Government has
moved positively ‘towards a strategic, managerial and symmetrical tone (Likely, 2013:70).
The study focused on five of Grunig’s principles evaluating whether the communication
department has/is: (1) access to the dominant coalition, (2) separation from other
functions, (3) integration into one function, (4) considered a management function, (5)
diversity is embodies in all roles. Likely’s (2013) study demonstrated the applicability of the
excellence theory as a measure of strategic communication management. In all five
counts, the sampled Canadian government departments portrayed a move towards
strategic communication management in obligation to the identified excellence principles.
Killingsworth’s (2009) research was from the communicators perspective conducted
through small-scale interviews of a single local government department in Western
Canada. This study also explored the values and practice of excellent communication
management based on the principles of excellent theory. The research evaluates three
elements: starting with how and to what extent do the executive managers and politicians
value communication. Killingsworth (2009:62) found that the perception and value of
communication varies according on the individual and his experiences and expertise in
communications as a profession. Communication managers were not part of the dominate
coalition and lacked representation in the day-to-day management of the department
(Killingsworth, 2009:71). Killingsworth (2009:71) argues, “Communications is respected at
a technical level, but many of the executive and managers do not see communication as
having any possible influence on the decision making or strategy level of the organisation”.
87
The second question related to how must public relations be practiced and organised for it
to contribute to effectiveness. In this, Killingsworth (2009) noted a significant shift towards
a two-way form of communication with the adoption of call centres and social media. The
third question was on how and to what extent government uses evaluation research to
demonstrate the benefit of effective performance? To this question, Killingsworth (2009)
found that the department used a number of methods to measure satisfaction around
communication tools and tactics and nothing on evaluating the contribution of
communication to the effectiveness of the government and governance (organisational
effectiveness).
Valentini’s (2013) study of excellence in government communication aimed to examine
whether public communication officers in Italy are involved in the strategic management of
the public sector, and whether they manage their information and communication
programmes strategically based on the excellence theory. Through a survey research,
Valentini (2013) tested three elements of the excellence theory: (1) the empowerment of
the communication management unit as measured by having a direct reporting line to the
dominant coalition, (2) the existence of a two-way symmetrical model and (3) knowledge
potential for managerial role. Valentini’s (2013) findings revealed that most public
communication officers in the Italy do not contribute to the strategic management of public
sector and only limitedly managed communication strategically. A direct relationship
between communication unit and the dominant coalition was acknowledged but most
respondents still identified with technical roles and therefore contributed operationally
rather than strategically. The finding confirmed that not only one public relation model is
document in the Italian public sector, rather indicating that government communicators
employed only certain aspects of each model where required (Valentini, 2013:109).
In terms of public relations models, Grunig and Jaatinen (1998:219) concluded that
government departments were more likely to practice the public information model than
other types of organisations. It was found that government organisations are more likely to
practice one-way, information based communication because of a pluralistic view of
government (Grunig & Jaatinen, 1998; Valentini, 2013:97). This means that within the
government sector, government communication is seen as a technical function essential
88
only to disseminate information and to handle media (Clemons, 2009:1). In consequence,
the relegation of government communication into a technical function hinders
government’s ability to pursue mutually beneficial relationships with its citizens based on
openness, trust and transparency (Clemons, 2009:1).
As governments improve along to proceeding levels of communication management, they
are likely to advance to the two-way symmetrical model that serves the interests of both
the department and its key stakeholders (Grunig & Jaatinen, 1998:219).The two-way
symmetrical is based on research. This makes the model less self-serving than the other
three models since it is based on negotiation, compromise and mutual understanding.
Moreover, in countries where government is based on a societal corporatist view,
governments are most likely to practice strategic, two-way communication. This resonates
with the principles of strategic government communication deliberated upon in chapter
four.
The excellence theory has not been without criticism. For example, Roper (2005) criticised
the symmetrical tradition contending that it was nothing more than a strategy to maintain
hegemonic power relations. Roper (2005) alerted to the surreptitious self-interest inherent
in the symmetrical approach wherein Grunig and White (1992:39) acknowledged that “the
symmetrical model actually serves the self-interest of the organisation better than an
asymmetrical model because organisations get more of what they want when they give up
some of what they want”. Against this background, the symmetrical model and it’s
“compromises in the long term favour the corporations much more than their critical
stakeholders in civil society and can serve to dilute the negotiating power of those
stakeholders. Negotiations of this nature are rarely, if ever, truly collaborative. Nor are they
based on democratic principles of open debate regarding the public good… Can we
legitimately call this ‘ethical’ public relations”?
Heath (1992) joined Crable and Vibbert (1998) Person (1989), Vasques (1996), and
Coombs (1999) in the critique of the excellence theory.
Instead, they proposed a
rhetorically based approach to communication management. The centre of the critique is
that the excellence theory is not a complete theory, it is preoccupied by processes, and it
89
is one amongst many equally worthy perspectives of communication management (Likely,
2013:74). Critics have argued that the excellence theory is “an idealistic model which
misrepresents the reality of communication process in reality, where vested interest dictate
the nature of PR practice and rarely encourage truly balanced communication process”
(Tench & Yeomans, 2009:150). One need not look deeply to reveal a public relation model
that features organisations as seeking to control the conditions of their future via symbolic
action (Heath, 2011). The weakness of many contending theorists is that they did not
provide systematic research to substantiate their premise.
In summary, part two (2) carries with it a theoretically grounded discussion on the
relevance of the organisational communication management approach to better
understanding and theorising on and about the nature of government communication
along with its practices. Currently, the term ‘communication management’ is more used
and accepted than the historic ‘public relations’. This term is preferred because it is able to
reflect the holistic maturity of the profession, both theoretically and practically. In this
study, the term, ‘public relations’ is used synonymously with ‘communication management’
for reasons already discussed. However, the nuances between these two terminologies
are noted and recommended.
At the heart of government communication debates and theories is usually an interest in
citizens with reference to the extent in which citizens are included or excluded, listened to
or ignored, informed or misinformed. The citizens are critical stakeholders for government.
For this reason, the present study centres on citizens as external stakeholders of
government departments. This position is not withstanding the acknowledgement that
government does have many other equally important external stakeholders.
Grunig (2007:23) marks a distinction between three layers of
communication
management: the micro (programme level), meso (departmental level) and macro
(organisational) levels of abstraction. As this study investigates communication
management practices of government departments in the KZN province, it therefore
evaluates government communication at a meso (departmental) level.
90
In modern democracy, every organisation survives ultimately only by public consent. It is
mainly thorough excellent and effective communication management that governments are
able to secure this approval. With that said, what makes government communication
excellent and effective? The excellence theory identifies 14 key assumptions regarding the
features of an excellent and effective communication management department. These
elements were discussed and tabulated in table 5. With criticism of the excellence theory
acknowledged; the present study applies and evaluates all fourteen features presented as
elements of the excellence theory.
Part three (3) of this theoretical chapter describes the critique of the excellence theory by a
group of theorists who present an alternative view to communication management called a
rhetorical approach. An attempt is made to apply the rhetorical approach towards the
understanding of government communication.
3.8 PART THREE: GOVERNMENT COMMUNICATION
ORGANISATIONAL RHETORICAL APPROACH
IN
AN
This section describes an alternative view in communication management called the
rhetorical approach. The rhetorical approach contributes three key ideas (points)
considered relevant to the study of contemporary government communication. The first
point relates to the ethics of government communication in effecting the high end of
symmetrical communication proposed by the excellence theory. Rhetoric postulates that
effective symmetrical communication is only achieved by the dialogic form. However,
unlike, rhetoric does not assume that such communication between the public and the
government will naturally be equitable as projected in the excellence theory. The
excellence theory takes for granted that by being structured in a certain way (the 14
principles); the resulting communication management will naturally be effective and
ethical. Rhetoric argues instead that communication management has to be dialogic in
order to be ethical, but being ethical is not innate for organisations so they must
consciously make the effort.
91
The second point of contribution is that the rhetoric approach provides the base necessary
to understand the self-presentation motives and tactics through which organisations and
governments attract legitimacy and reputation. Corporate reputation is dependent on an
appropriate communication system and on how an organisation identifies itself (rhetoric).
As such, corporate reputation is a construct that is particularly appropriate for measuring
the effectiveness of an organisation’s communication system (Van Riel & Fombrun,
2007:38). Although this study does not measure reputation, it does evaluate the
communication efforts employed by government in an attempt to manage reputation. The
desire for reputation and advocacy often brings into question the issue of ethics in
government communication.
The third point of contribution is on dissecting the practice of government communication.
Because the excellence theory is entrenched in organisational theory, it is best able to
dissect and explain government communication as a strategic management function. The
rhetorical approach on the other hand, is best able to explain the technical function of
communication management such as messaging, publicity, and media relations. Rhetoric
thus contributes to the practice of government communication. The next section discusses
ethics in communication management and the stance of the rhetorical theory in the
emancipation of ethics in government communication.
3.8.1
ETHICS IN GOVERNMENT COMMUNICATION
Ethical considerations are divided into two schools of thought: the cognitivism and the noncognitivism. Cognitivism holds that actions can be good or bad, moral and amoral, right
and wrong. In contrast, the non-cognitivism states that ethics are subjective, context based
or situational. Bowen (2012) describes three ethical approaches relevant to government
communication. Namely: materialism, utilitarianism (consequentialism) and deontology
(non-consequentialist). Materialism is non-cognitivist while the other two take cognitivist
standpoints on the ethical debate.
Consequentialism or utilitarianism assumes that organisations evaluate the potential
consequences for decisions in order to determine what is ethical. In utilitarianism,
92
decisions are predicted by their consequences in which the best decisions will maximise
good outcomes and minimise bad outcomes (Bowen, 2012:165). Bowen (2012) considers
utilitarianism best for government communication since the framework of ‘the greatest
good for the greatest number of people’ resonates with the ideals of the public interest,
which is the responsibility of government communication. Government communication
should after all be conducted in accordance with the public interest (Bowen, 2012:165).
For utilitarianism to be possible, sophisticated research is essential to determine and
accurately predict intended and unintended consequences of organisational decisions and
strategies on concerned publics.
Deontology is un-consequentialist because it is based on a duty to uphold moral principle.
Deontology is a duty-based ethic that focuses on obligation, principles, and rights
(Gregory, 2009:278). Rationality and objectivity are essential to deontological ethics
because decisions should not be infiltrated by selfishness, bias, or fear of retribution.
Objectivity allows government communicators to consider the meritorious viewpoints of
various stakeholders or publics involved. In addition, autonomy and authority are equally
vital for deontological ethics. Autonomy refers to independence of decision-making
whereas authority refers to a voice and the ability to be heard within an organisation.
Intension is also a key principle in deontology. Deontological theory holds that “only
decisions made from a basis of goodwill or pure moral intention are ethical” (Bowen,
2012:170-173).
Materialism ethics presume that organisations seek to satisfy their needs first in a
competitive arena. It is common for organisations, either government or corporate to make
self-interested decisions (Bowen, 2012:164). Materialism is based on competitive
positioning. Although there are many moral flows to materialism, it is an approach most
dominant in practice. “Materialism turns out to be more descriptive of what happens in
actual practice than a normative paradigm that is helpful in determining the ethical”
(Bowen, 2012:165).
In public relations, the non-cognitivist school of though is expounded by rhetorical theorists
such as Burke (1969), Heath (2004), Pearson (1989) and others. Rhetorical theorists
93
assert that “truth emerge from a process of dialogue, negotiation and debate where
individuals eventually agree on a particular moral truth”. In this case, the process by which
the debate is conducted determines whether it is ethical or not (Gregory, 2009:276). For
this reason, great emphasis is placed on ethical dialogue in order to maintain integrity and
validity. The following sections describe materialism ethics in communication management
through the rhetorical approach lenses.
3.8.2
DEFINITIONS AND HISTORY
“The rhetor (communicator) creates persuasion by building personal
credibility (ethos), appealing to the emotions of the audience (pathos), or by
making and supporting reasonable arguments (logos)” (Hoffman & Ford,
2010:26).
The conventional notion of rhetoric is argumentation and persuasion stemming from the
ancient Greek sophist, such as Aristotle, then Romany with Cicero (Mackey, 2005:2). The
study of rhetoric can be traced to fifth century BC Athenian sophists who were well
travelled, charismatic teachers offering intensive training in persuasive public speaking.
“The writing and speaking skills of the sophists were in demand because of the emergence
of democracy which required enfranchised men to participate in government and legal
affairs” (Mackey, 2005:5). Nevertheless, rhetoric declined as an academic subject around
the mid nineteenth century and only resuscitating in the mid-20th century.
Aristotle, a student of Plato, penned the greatest single work on rhetoric called the
Rhetoric consisting of three books. Book I dealt with the speaker, while book II considered
the audience and book III focused on the message (De Wet, 2010:29). Following this
analogy, this study only focus on book 1 (speaker) as it seeks to analyse the
communication efforts of government departments. Aristotle was especially concerned
with political rhetoric. He believed that the essential element in any rhetorical discourse is
proof while all else is accessory. For Aristotle, ethos was an artistic proof consisting of the
credibility derived from the communicator’s expectedness, trustworthiness, and goodwill
(reputation). The other form of proof is pathos, which entails psychological appeals to the
emotions, needs, and values of audiences. Contemporary examples of pathos are political
94
advertising, corporate social responsibility, and propaganda (De Wet, 2010:32). The last is
logos, which are meant to appeal to the intellect or rationality of the recipients. In short,
logos are concern with the message, ethos with the organisation and pathos with the
audience (De Wet, 2010:32; Griffin, 2012:293; Hoffman & Ford, 2010:26).
Given its historic heritage, rhetoric is considered the queen of communication studies. It is
also known as the study of what is persuasive (De Wet, 2010:27). Over the years, Heath
and others have been advocating for drawing judiciously on the rhetorical heritage as
guiding foundation for communication management (Palenchar, 2011:570). Heath
(2011:419) alluded to the rich heritage that rhetoric offers, both as a positive guide and as
a critical adjudicator of strategic options. One of the reasons for advocating a rhetorical
approach to organisational communication management says Edward (2011:536) is to
open an avenue through which communication between the organisation and its publics
can be articulated in ethical terms and rationalised in terms of organisational interests.
3.8.3
CONTEMPORARY RHETORIC
In contemporary times, the rhetor is likely the spokesperson along with other
communication professionals within an organisation. The rationale of rhetoric is still the
same as that of Aristotle’s era. Spicer (2007:192) spoke of Sproule’s (1998) concept of the
new management rhetoric in which the public sphere of rhetoric has been captured by
institutions. This defines a shift from traditional rhetoric that focused on individual speakers
to new persuasions and propagandas employed by big institutionalised organisations and
big governments that rely on the media to reach their strategic public and the mass
audience.
Mackey (2005:3) spoke of a ‘rhetorical turn’ in the field of communication management,
citing Robert Heath as the pioneer and driver of a ‘rhetorical turn’ in communication
management. Heath (2001:31) claims that the rhetorical theory can meet epistemological,
axiological, and ontological requirements for the advancement of public relations. Mackey
(2005:4) concurs that “contemporary academic theories of rhetoric offer the possible
attainment of a clearer picture of what public relations is and what its effect on society and
95
individuals are”, adding that a rhetorical turn offers the possibility of a powerful critique of
the ethics in communication management.
Mackey (2005:3) argues that the application of a rhetorical approach in communication
management should be a progressive move, which aligns communication management
with contemporary studies of rhetoric. Classical rhetoric is the intellectual starting point for
much of what goes on in the communication management field today. Mackey (2005:11)
posits that communication management processes in its entirety, from research to
planning, resource allocation, execution among its publics and evaluation can be viewed
as part of a rhetorical process (Mackey, 2005:11). For this reason, organisational rhetoric
has become an independent area of study. The study organisational rhetoric is both the
oldest and the newest area of communication (Hoffman & Ford, 2010:8).
3.8.4
EXTERNAL ORGANISATIONAL RHETORIC
A distinction can be made between internal and external organisational rhetoric. Internal
rhetoric is concerned with how organisational rhetoric can help make each organisation a
good place to work (Heath, 2011). Organisational rhetoric has now captured the interest of
many scholars. For example, two (2) publications emerged in the Management
Communication Quarterly journal, the 2008 eight issue focused on internal organisational
rhetoric and the 2011 issue focused on external organisational rhetoric. In application, the
Public Relation Review (2013) explored the intersection between, rhetoric, public relations,
and democracy.
According to Hoffman and Ford (2010:7), “organisational rhetoric is the strategic use of
symbols by organisations to influence the thoughts, feelings, and behaviours of audiences
important to the operation of the organisation”. Therefore, external rhetoric is essential to
understanding, evaluating, and improving organisations’ participation in the socio-political
discourse in the communities where they operate. Studies in rhetoric explore how
organisations engage constructively and destructively in the discourse, that defines their
legitimacy (Heath, 2011:415). The end goal of external rhetoric is reputation and
legitimacy. Rhetoric is a “new way of understanding organisations”.
96
Heath (2011) suggests that communication management and its attendant organisational
rhetoric is meant to serve two purposes: first, to improve an organisation’s ethical practices
by paying attention to external perception (public opinion), and secondly, to improve an
organisation’s self-interest communication by responding appropriately to that public
opinion (Boyd & Waymer, 2011). This means that first and foremost, external
organisational rhetoric serves its own interest, “but did so in ways sensitive to a changing
and complex environment where the organisation’s interests could only be achieved by
advancing those of others” (Palenchar, 2011:571).The next sections provide the principles
or purposes of external organisational rhetoric, starting with the notion of rhetoric as a tool
for establishing and maintaining organisational credibility, reputation and legitimacy. This
discussion is next.
3.8.5
CREDIBILITY, REPUTATION, AND LEGITIMACY
The first purpose or principle of external organisational rhetoric is the establishment and
maintenance of credibility, reputation, and legitimacy. Organisations’ characters (ethos)
count in rhetoric (Griffin, 2012:293). Therefore, organisations are encouraged to adopt
integrity in their practice and policies. On the notion of ‘the good organisation
communicates well’, Heath (2001) counsels that each organisation should strive to be
moral and to communicate to satisfy the interests of key publics. It was Aristotle’s belief
that persuasion is espoused by the speaker’s personal character that depicts his
credibility. Aristotle believed, like many rhetoricians, that bad character is dissuasive
(Heath, 2001:39). Therefore, we must investigate what it means and what it takes to be a
‘good organisation communicating well’ (Heath, 2007:42).
Public relations can assist organisations’ “narrative enactment” (Heath, 2011:247).
Explicating on his rhetorical enactment theory, Heath (2007:58) postulates that all of what
an organisation does and says can be meaningful and therefore helpful or harmful to the
relationships that the organisation needs to accomplish in its mission and vision. The ‘good
organisation communicating well’ analogy emphasises the character of the organisation as
the basis for and the result of its communication management (Heath, 2007:58). Heath’s
97
(2007:49) definition hold that advocacy is characterised by “the content and process of the
discourse used by the good person (reputation) speaking well”.
The concept of legitimacy is directly linked to that of reputation. Organisational legitimacy
is an organisation’s right to exist and function. It is based on compliance with the minimum
standards of typical organisations in its class (Highhouse et al., 2009:1487). Legitimacy is
based on the actions of the organisation and responsible communication about them. As
such, legitimacy is clearly the focus of communication management. It is established,
maintained, challenged, and defended through dialogues between the organisation and its
various publics (Metzler, 2001: 322). Scholarship has shown a connection between
communication and legitimacy in the boundary-spanning role of public relations, in crisis
management and in image creation (Metzler, 2001:322). Legitimacy requires that
organisations remain responsive to the public.
3.8.5.1
Reputation management as organisational advocacy
“Reputation refers to a holistic and vivid impression held by a particular group towards a
corporation, partly as a result of information processing carried out by the group’s members and
partly by the aggregated communication of the corporation in question concerning its nature, i.e.
the fabricated and projected picture of itself” (Alvesson, 1990 in Van Riel & Fombrun, 2007:44).
External organisational communication is fundamentally concerned about reputation. The
concept of reputation is therefore essential to understanding how government and publics
evaluate performance. Concepts such as corporate identity and corporate reputation have
emerged as essential to government communication (Canel & Sanders, 2012:90).
Organisational success depends on how they are viewed by key stakeholders. According
to Canel and Sanders (2012:90), two concepts are vital to defining reputation. The first
concept is identity, which is defined “as consisting in what an organisation present of itself
in terms of behaviour, communication, and symbolism as well as visual, non-material
aspects of the institution”. The second concept is image, which is understood as “the
mental structure of the organisation that publics form as the result of the processing of
information related to the organisation” (Canel & Sanders, 2012:90).
98
Highhouse, Brooks & Gregarus (2009:35) view organisational reputation as a temporally
stable evaluative judgment about an organisation that is shared by multiple constituencies.
But the question arises if reputation can be managed and how much control organisations
and governments exert over their reputation. Some researchers see reputation as
something that cannot and should not be managed, mainly because reputation is a direct
consequence of behaviour. This sentiment espouses a notion that corporate reputation is
a social construct. It is construed that the dynamics of governing reputation are not in the
prerogative of the organisation, but that of the publics (Van Riel and Fombrun, 2007:46).
On the contrary, others see value in the management of reputation as something
controllable (Hutton, Goodman, Alexander & Genest, 2001). This school of thought
espouses the notion of reputation as a management construct. From this perspective,
reputation is a product of an organisation’s attentiveness towards environmental, social
justice, and ethical concerns (Highhouse, Brooks & Gregarus, 2009:1482). Highhouse et
al. (2009:1483) posit that corporations and governments, like people, are concerned with
self-presentation and organisational impression (rhetoric advocacy). For example, Da Silva
and Batista (2007) demonstrated the potentialities of customer relationship management
(CRM) in building government reputations. What was found was that governments are
attempting at reversing the negative reputation of bureaucracy and insensitivity by
investing more resources on customer relationship management (CRM). However,
research on organisational impression management conducted at the organisational level
is currently very limited – more so where government is concerned. The statistics are even
worse for reputation studies in government. Identification is one concept closely linked to
identity management, reputation management, and legitimacy. To this concept, we turn
next.
3.8.6
IDENTIFICATION
Identification is the second principle of external organisational rhetoric following ‘credibility,
reputation, and legitimacy’ discussed above. Scholars such as Burke (1937/1984) and
Cheney (1983) emphasised the value of identification as a persuasion power (Hoffman &
Ford, 2010:35). They posit that when the public identify with the organisation, they are
99
likely to behave in ways beneficial to it. As for Burke (1969), rhetoric is a form of courtship
– or perhaps courtship is a form of rhetoric. Thus, publicity and promotion can easily be
seen as organisational forms of courtship based on appeals to identification (Heath,
2011:420).
Organisations facilitate identification by communicating its values, goals, and information
(identity management). In that way, identification arises as a communicative and
cooperative response. Therefore, identification is compensatory to division (Cheney,
1983:145). Cheney (1983:143-158) discerns three types of identification strategies.
Starting with the common ground technique where the rhetor overtly equates himself with
the publics. The second strategy of identification through antithesis is a call to unifying
against a common enemy. In the third identification strategy, the assumed “we”, surmises
the pronoun “we” as signalling unity. Following this study, Cheney added a fourth strategy
in reference to the use of unifying symbols such as branding (Hoffman & Ford, 2010:35).
As such, brand loyalty can be a sign of identification among external stakeholders.
Identification is a form of coalition formation, an attempt by rhetors to forge conceptual
association with the persuadees (Cheney, 1983:144). Thus, identification can be used as a
strategy of resuscitating legitimacy and strengthening a week reputation through
communication of shared values (Metzler, 2001:342). Identification is influenced by both
internal and external communication management (Van Riel & Fombrun, 2007:76).
Rhetoric emphasise the role of dialectic, many voices engaged in dialogue (Heath,
2001:39). Such type of dialectical discourse inherently calls for identification. Therefore,
identification is also a foundation of relationship management that is explored next.
3.8.7
RELATIONSHIP MANAGEMENT
Relationship management is the third principle of external organisational rhetoric. As
communication management theory and research move towards a two-way relational
communication model, many scholars and practitioners are increasingly adopting the
terms dialogue or dialogic in reference to ethical and effective communication
management philosophies. The end goal of relationship management is ethics, morality,
100
and social capital (credibility, reputation, and legitimacy). According to Kent and Taylor
(2002:22), “dialogue involves an effort to recognise the value of the other – to see him/her
as an end and not merely as a means to achieving a desire goal”.
This dialogic perspective is very similar to Grunig’s (2006:156) appropriation of the term
coorientation. “The symmetrical model and its parent, the coorientational model, proposed
that individuals, organisations, and publics should use communication to adjust their ideas
and behaviour to those of others than try to control how others think” (Grunig, 2006:156).
Kent and Taylor (2002) proposed five principles in the enactment of a dialogic
communication management theory: (1) mutuality, which is the recognition of organisationpublic relationships. (2) Propinquity involves the temporality and spontaneity of interactions
with publics. (3) Empathy entails the supportiveness and confirmation of public interest
goals. (4) Risk involves the willingness to interact with individuals and publics on their own
terms. (5) Finally but not least, commitment reflects the extent to which an organisation
gives itself over to dialogue, interpretation, and understanding in its interactions with
publics (Kent & Taylor, 2002:23-25).
There are now proposals for two-way or dialogic approaches to be incorporated to external
organisational rhetoric that prioritises discourse based on principle of: openness,
spontaneity, inquiry, advocacy, reflection, and the potential for involvement by more than
two parties or publics (a multiplicity of voices) (Boyd & Waymer, 2011:480). This ideal of a
high-end enactment of symmetrical communication is explored next.
3.8.8
SYMMETRY AND DIALOGUE
On the relationship between advocacy and symmetry, Heath (2007:42) argues that
advocacy is not inherently contradictory to symmetry. Rhetorical symmetry assumes that
advocates are equal until their ideas are tested in the public sphere. It is only through
dialogue that superior ideas defeat bad ones (Heath, 2001:35). Rhetoric presumes that all
parties are symmetrical in terms of the right to speak. This however does not suggest that
all points are equal in rhetoric potency. “Through dialogue, participants co-create or co-
101
define meaning by the rhetorical process of statement and counterstatements. One side
wins because its arguments are more compelling” (Heath, 2001:35).
3.8.9
DISCOURSE ENACTMENT AND ENLIGHTENED CHOICE
The underlying normative paradigm of external rhetoric is dialogue. This is the fourth
principle of external organisational rhetoric, while the facilitation of enlightened choice if
the fifth principle. Dialogue begins by acknowledging the merit of other’s ideas rather than
presuming others have no worthy ideas. It is assumed that discourse foster enlightened
choice, and that relationships result from and lead to social capital (Heath, 2011:416).
Complex organisations have become modern rhetors engaged in discourse with their
publics. For this to be possible, organisations engage in discourse to co-create reality with
external publics needed to align interest rather than suffer disabling friction. “Such
relationships are forged strategically through communication structures and in discourse
arenas: public policy issue debates, integrated marketing communication, corporate
communication, crisis response, issues management, and risk management” (Heath,
2011:417).
Heath (2011:20) argues that “rhetoric is relevant to any context in which humans are
compelled to make enlightened choice”- such as citizens are expected in democratic
societies. However, can rhetorical discourse advance as well as frustrate choice? Heath
(2011:421) offers Nichols’ (1963) response that the combination of persuasive and
dialectic discourse can and should lead to enlightened choices. Such understanding sets a
firm, ethical and socially responsible view of rhetoric and organisational communication.
The underlying paradigm of external organisation rhetoric is about multiple voices engaged
in battles within the public sphere. The public sphere is conceived of a marketplace of
ideas, preferences, choices, and influence (Heath, 2011:420). The landscape is one of
battle for advantage, whether it is that of one organisation, government, an industry, a
group, an interest, or even society. Rhetoric is thus made from fragments of dialectic,
rhetoric is not independent of others but gains its meaning, relevance, and resolution by
how it agrees, disagrees, or otherwise responds to other rhetoric (Burkey, 1969:207). The
premise is that, “as competitive and collaborative rhetors interact – and in an ideal
102
rhetorical world, balance each other out – the process allows for the pursuit of common
goals”. Burkey, (1951:203) puts the concept of dialectic (the cooperative use of
competition) more bluntly:
“A rhetorician, I take it, is like one voice in a dialogue. Put several such voices together, with each
voicing its own special assertion, let them act upon one another in cooperative competition, and you
get a dialectic that, properly developed, can lead to views transcending the limitation of each”.
The great concern is whether each dialogue of many persuasive voices proactively and
constructively worked for some collective good or merely for the advancement of one
interest, perhaps even at the loss of another’s interest? This worry is epitomising of Plato’s
anxiety on the likelihood of which the cleverer rather than the more reflective and wellgrounded voice can win the rhetorical battle (Heath, 2011:422). The concept of dialectic is
dependent on enlighten choices being made by the public as guided by dialectical tensions
of multiple contending voices counter-correcting each other.
It should be noted however that not everyone agrees whether a dialogic communication
model is possible let alone practical (Kent & Taylor, 2002:24). Dialogue is not a panacea.
Dialogue cannot make an organisation behave morally or force organisations to respond to
publics. Organisations themselves must first be willing to make dialogic commitments to
publics. Dialogue can also be appropriated for both moral and immoral ends particularly
where self-interest sublimes the dialogic process into propaganda, manipulation, or
exclusions.
3.8.10 RHETORIC AS ADVOCACY
“It is widely understood that any individual, organisation, or institution that seek
public support must hire, professional communicators to advocate in the court of public
opinion as it hires lawyers to advocate in the court of law” (Saitel, 1984:6).
Should public relations professionals assume the role of advocates, consensus builders, or
both? This question contributes to the ongoing debate about the appropriate role of
communication management in government. Spicer (1997:182) contends that “the
103
distinction between advocacy and consensus building, like the distinction between the
asymmetrical and symmetrical models, are indicative of competing ways in which an
organisation communicates”. In the exception of Grunig (1992), many scholars rarely
distinguish between communication management as advocacy (persuasion) and
communication management as straight communication (Heath, 2007:45). Advocacy and
consensus building are seen as dichotomous or polarised. The argument being that
communication in an advocacy frame is inherently monogamous whereas communications
from a collaborative frame is one of dialogue and participation. According to Spicer
(1997:186), these distinctions are useful in that they allow us to evaluate the foundation of
different types of communication management in different organisations.
The rhetorical tradition has always recognised advocacy as a tool or tactic of
communication management. Advocacy public relations is a way of responding to
corporate or government critics who challenge management policies and actions.
Advocacy in communication management occurs when public relations practitioners
attempt to meet the needs or desires of their organisation to the exclusion of the needs or
desires of the other side (asymmetrical communication) (Reber, 2005:1 in Heath,
2007:45). Conversely, in consensus building frame, communication effectiveness is judged
by the degree to which participants or citizens are able, wiling to and encouraged to
participate in the communication process (Spicer, 1997:220). Consensus building
(boundary spanning/symmetrical communication) is naturally counter the self-centred
external communication that characterise many organisations and governments.
Heath (2001:32) cautions, “Organisations that attempt to use rhetoric to control and
manipulate the opinions of key stakeholders and stake-seekers suffer public exposure of
their tactics as well as the flaws in the content they espouse”. Advocacy public relations
can proclaim ideas an organisation believes to be best about itself. However, the claims
demand authentication and proof in order to increase the probability to which those claims
are accepted. Advocacy is bound to fail in the end if it merely advances the cause and
interest of one side (Heath, 2007:59). The concept and the impacts of self-interest
advocacy in communication management are discussed in depth over the next sections.
104
3.8.11 SELF-INTEREST (ADVOCACY)
Edwards (2011:531) acknowledges that rhetorical theory is in itself a reminder that all
communication, and particularly organisational communication, is partisan – and naturally,
government communication will be partisan. External organisational rhetoric is reflective of
organisational advocacy. Barney and Black (1994) opine that organisations should not
worry about presenting anything but their own side. This proposition is based on the
assumption that public discourse takes place in an adversarial system where every actor
pursue only self-interest, and the ‘other side’ can take a rhetorical stand if so choses (Boyd
& Waymer, 2011:479).
Boyd and Waymer (2011) proposed a one-sided ethical approach to external
organisational rhetoric. They add, “that the traditional corrective saying, ‘organisations
should pay more attention to ethics has not worked” (Boyd & Waymer, 2011:482). They
hence suggest that “professional communicators use their powers of persuasion to argue
that; in fact, an ethical standard – not just legal standard or an adversarial perspective – is
consistent with organisational self-interest” (Boyd & Waymer, 2011:483). Until professional
organisational speakers assert themselves more as organisational consciences, the
continued domination of organisational self-interest will continue and the privileging of selfinterest in the management of external communication may persist to the detriment of the
other interests involved.
The challenge arises when bias and self-interest distort communication. It should be
accepted that communication is distorted from a rhetorical ideal. Rhetorical scholars would
argue that if organisations control their instinct to serve their own self-interest their
communication moves closer to efficiency and rhetorical success because audiences are
interested in truth and will therefore judge such rhetoric more favourably (Edwards,
2011:532). Paradoxically, a rhetorical view also reminds scholars that communication is
inherently about meaning-generation. This perspective casts a different light on selfinterest because cocreation of meaning requires recognition of both one’s own and others
self-interest (Edwards, 2011:532).
105
Scholars of organisational rhetoric claim that communication fortified by self-interest is
bound for failure wherein its persuasive power is lost. Rhetorical approaches to external
communication assume that self-interest is optional and generally negative, and reducing
or eliminating it leads to better and more persuasive communication (Edwards, 2011:533).
Edwards contends that “simultaneous recognition that rhetoric is partisan creates an
analytical conundrum”. If rhetoric is partisan, then organisational communication must be
driven by self-interest rather than the public good. Without bias, rhetorical enactment
would not exist. The process of co-creation of meaning (dialectics) requires recognition of
self-interest and the interests of others to take place. Edwards (2011:534) reasons:
“understanding self-interest as a contextual factor that influences rhetoric, rather than an
immutable barrier to effective rhetoric, opens the door to a more balanced role for selfinterest in the co-creation of meaning”.
3.8.12 NEGATIVE CONNOTATIONS OF RHETORIC ADVOCACY
Reflections on the good or evils of rhetoric are not new (Heath, 2007:42). Rhetoric can be
used unethically, thus, it is judged by the quality of the process and its outcomes (Heath,
2001:38). Rhetoric is a two-edge sword fraught with peril as well as good prospect.
Rhetorical theories neglect to theorise their use of rhetorical concepts. As a result,
management theorists often see rhetoric as manipulation and control. “The term rhetoric
arouses pejorative connotations such as viciousness, manipulativeness, pandering, and
mere” (Heath, 2001:31). This assessment of rhetoric as manipulative spin doctoring
remains today. However, Heath maintains that such prejudice remain with those ignorant
of the theory of rhetoric. In essence, Heath (2001:32) counsels…
“Rhetoric can manipulate until other voices uncover this manipulation and turn minds against it.
Rhetoric can pander by telling people what they want to hear. On the other hand, it can challenge
pandering and forewarn persons to watch for that manipulative technique. For this reason, rhetoric
never is mere”.
106
3.8.13 SOPHISTIC RHETORIC
Aristotle was critical of sophists, hence infused the term sophist with negative connotations
(Mackey, 2005:4). Sophistic concentrated on the role of the communicator rather than the
message or recipients. Plato was highly critical of sophistic rhetoric that was only
concerned with how, when and what is the best form of expression (De Wet, 2010:27).
Sophistic rhetoric is by nature monolithic as recipients are not dynamically involved with
the communication. What is of concern is the technical skill through which the
communicator manipulates passive recipients. “A rhetoric that is designed to enhance
reputation, and to mislead in order to win assent at the expense of truth, is rejected as
sophistic” (De Wet, 2010:34).
3.8.14 IS ADVOCACY INHERENTLY BAD?
“Advocacy can achieve understanding, agreement, reinforcement, and motivation. The
opposite is also true: advocacy can bring about misunderstanding, failure to understand,
disagreement, diminished belief and demotivation” (Heath, 2007:53).
In his research of the Australian public sector, Glenny (2008:116) brought into question the
morality of persuasion and advocacy in government communication. Varying and
contentious responses from practitioners evidenced the political density of this question.
Others see advocacy as a political stance and an essential element of their responsibility
as cheerleaders of government while others see government communication as neutral
information diffusion or dialogue at best. Hutton (1999) demonstrated how such
orientations strongly influence communication practices. This sparks concerns about the
professionalization of government communication. The argument heralded is that the
professionalization of government communicators is dangerous in the hands of a
manipulative-government that masters the art of advocacy persuasion in the form of
propaganda (spin) (Sanders et al., 2011:20).
The question arises if advocacy is essentially partisanship, which begs a follow-up
question of whose party it represents. Advocacy as a concept is characterised by negative
connotations implying propaganda, manipulation, win-lose conflict. To others, advocacy
107
signifies one-way asymmetrical communication. In its worst form, advocacy can be limited
to bellicose monologue (Heath, 2007:42). This kind of advocacy communication
management is used to defend against and deflect criticism rather than to respond
proactively and positively to differing opinions (Heath, 2007:43). If advocacy listens, the
aim is only to counter-argue and refute rather than to appreciate debate. This is the
foundation of a media versus government feud because the aim of advocacy
communication is to protect, not engage.
Not all advocacy communication is appalling, argues Heath (2007:43), advocacy can be a
virtuous management and communication philosophy in good organisations. This sort of
advocacy is comfortable with counterarguments and debates in the public sphere. At best,
advocacy can produce informed decision-making because only the best idea and
argument survives in the open public sphere. In concluding the advocacy versus
collaboration debate, Spicer (1997:186) advises that it should not be implied, however,
that one frame is necessarily better than the other is. Both frames exist and are useful to
public relations practitioners in governments and other organisations. “We should be
thinking of advocacy and collaboration, rather than advocacy versus collaboration” (Spicer,
1997:186).
3.8.15 ADVOCACY AS COMPETITION
The rhetorical tradition makes the point that advocacy do not exist in a vacuum, it emerges
amongst the contradiction of various ideas and arguments in the public sphere. Advocacy
then grows from an examination of arguments and counterarguments. So, advocacy
occurs in public where citizens can, “by hearing the sides of an issue, learn and weigh
facts, consider evaluations, judge character (credibility), and weigh the expediency of
policy” (Heath, 2007:49).
Rhetoric is only as good as there abounds competition on opinions, ideas, and arguments.
Heise (1985:203) assumes rhetoric is only ethical in the competitive environment of the
private sector where a multitude of companies advocate for their products through their PR
departments. “Competition exists between organisations in the private sector, a factor
108
which serves to countervail some of the less than objective, less than balanced information
put out by the advocacy- oriented PR practitioners” (Heise,1983:204). The same cannot be
said of government.
In summary, part three (3) of the theoretical framework provided various strategies used
to communicate positively with the public. External organisational rhetoric in the form of
advocacy, identity management, identification, relationship management, and dialectic
discourse are valuable strategies for government to communicate with the publics for
constructing a favourable reputation. These strategies also provide the bases to which
ethical debates about communication management are deliberated. In addition, these
concepts are the most contention in government communication literature as few expect
government communication to be rhetorical and persuasive while others see it as
inherently rhetorical and persuasive (Glenny, 2008:116).
The present study is concerned with the concept of impression management/identity
management (through external organisational communication). The exclusive focus on
identity management rather than reputation is because identity management is within the
controls of the organisation, while reputation is within the prerogative of stakeholders.
Stakeholders themselves have to be consulted in order to gauge the reputation of
government departments or any other organisation for that matter. The self-presentation of
governments identities is carefully constructed which sanctions the concepts of rhetoric
and advocacy relevant to the study of government communication.
3.9 RHETORIC, DEMOCRACY AND
GOVERNMENT COMMUNICATION
PUBLIC
RELATIONS
IN
This section serves as a summary to part three (3) of the theoretical framework. Heath,
Waymer and Palenchar (2013) explored the nexus between public relations, rhetoric and
democracy. “They posed the question, “what role, if any should rhetorical public relations
play in democracy and the democratic process. In answering this question, conflicting
dimensions of public relations were illustrated. For example, iconic practitioners such as
Ivy Ledbetter Lee sought the value of public relations as contributing to the public interest
109
and thus to democracy by upholding journalistic principles of information provision,
objectivity and transparency. In contrast, equally iconic practitioners such as Edward
Bernays (1955) celebrated the manufacturing of public opinion through the engineering of
consent. Bernays conceived public relations experts as being able to shape (crystallise or
engineer) public opinion in the interest of the client organisation (government). Hence, a
discrepancy exist between scholars who view public relations as manipulation, and those
who view it as the dissemination of information, resolution of conflict, or promotion of
understanding (Grunig, 1992).
Heath et al. (2013:272) advanced a rhetorical approach to communication management in
which they view public relations as capable of participating in constructive dialogue by
which the public is compelled to make enlightened choices. Rhetoric has been the
rationale for reasoned discourse and therefore inherent to democracy. “Because rhetorical
theory arises out of disputes and differences of opinion, it offers guidelines on how people
can negotiate those differences through collaborative decision-making. It informs, creates
divisions, and bridges divisions. It advocates, convinces, and motivates” (Heath et al.,
2013:273).
For democracy requires an informed public, public relations fulfils that need by providing
information to the media and directly to the public from which rational and informed
judgements can be based. Waymer (2013) sees a strong link between democracy and
public relations. This is because, public relations, as an instrument of various stakeholders
and community agents, conceivably can voice and shed light on difficult even dark issues,
help make democracy possible, strengthen an already established democracy, or help
sustain (or defend) a current democracy (Waymer, 2013:323). According to Heath et al.
(2013) public relations must be understood as a steward of democracy. “In this vein, a
steward of democracy cares for democracy as well as those “publics” entrusted to her
care. A steward of democracy would use her power and influence to allow and even
facilitate collective decision-making” (Heath et al., 2013:278).
Government communication is however oxymoronic because whilst public relations
“should play the literal and metaphorical role of referee in democratic societies, it is also a
110
participant in the dialogue or the rhetorical game (Waymer, 2013:323). In his research,
Mabelebele (2006) exemplifies this argument. On the brighter side, Mabelebele’s research
proposes an interesting model of government communication based the collaboration
between the rhetorical approach and participatory democracy.
Mabelebele (2006) introduced imbizos (gatherings) as a (rhetorical) model of
communication and governance. The concept of imbizo and Ubuntu are true to the African
continent. Imbizos can be described as a rhetorical platform used by indigenous
communities to resolve community issues and build community cohesion. For example, “it
is common practice for a chief, headman, or any other community leader to convene a
community meeting with a view to discussing issues of common concern and interest
(Mabelebele, 2006:104).
The ANC government appropriated imbizos as a model of communication and governance
- bringing government closer to the people. The concept of imbizo is premised on another
indigenous African concept of Ubuntu – invoking the spirit of compassion and empathy.
“As members of a particular community interact with government on policy implementation
and how best to improve their lives, government begins to feel for the suffering
communities trapped in conditions of abject poverty”. As such, imbizos portray government
as caring and concerned about the views and the development of the layman. Mabelebele
saw imbizos as a manifestation of participatory democracy. The concept of imbizo is to
improve service delivery in communities affected by poverty and underdevelopment by
truly listening to the issues of the community and discussing possible solutions. Imbizos
also provide a platform for identity management, corporate branding, and reputation. An
advantage of a strong corporate identity is that it enhances tolerance, support and goodwill
for a government department (Bezuidenhout & Van Heerden, 2003:5).
On the negative side, Mabelebele (2006:111) argued that “imbizos was appropriated by
government to achieve party political objectives beyond service delivery and government
imperatives”. In terms of participatory democracy, the enactment of imbizo by the ANC
government failed because “in the realm of decision-making, genuine participation by the
masses has been stunted, as power is still more concentrated in the centre… whereby the
111
participation of ordinary citizens is narrowed down purely to matters of implementation. No
sufficient space has been created for ordinary citizens to participate in the formulation of
policy and programmes of government” (Mabelebele, 2006:121-122). In this case, the selfinterest of the organisation (the ANC government), compounded with advocacy rhetoric,
infiltrated and debilitated the possible social good to be achieved by the practice of
imbizo’s as a rhetorical model of government communication. The following section
outlines additional relevant extant models of government communication.
3.10 PART
FOUR:
COMMUNICATION
EXTANT
MODELS
OF
GOVERNMENT
Likely (2013:72) argues, “A distinct model for government communication, particularly one
that is comparative across countries at various political levels (national, region, province;
and or municipal/local) has not been developed and tested”. Models of government
communication
tend
to
thread
between
those
emphasising
distinctiveness
of
communication management in the public sector (for example Heise, 1985; Gelders,
Bouckaert & Van Ruler, 2007; Liu, Hosley & Levenshus, 2010, 2011, 2012) against those
who perceive government communication management as equivalent to any other sector
(Grunig & Jaatinen, 1999).
Hiebert (1981) provided one of the few government communication models called the
government communication process model. This model identifies four basic information
strategies that governments use to enhance their image: withholding information, releasing
information, staging special events, and persuading the public. The model incorporates
both internal and external communication. However, Liu and Horsley (2007) have criticised
the model for insufficiently incorporating the distinctiveness of the public sector such as the
effect of politics and centralization on government communication. Moreover, the model
only allows for one-way asymmetrical communication and it is more of a typology than a
theoretical framework.
After Hiebert, Heise (1985:200) was one of the first few scholars to evaluate the impact of
the corporate public relations models within the government sector. He questioned
112
“whether public relations, as developed and practiced in the private sector, ought to be the
model for the public sector and, if not, what the model for the public sector should look
like”. To this effect, Heise (1985:209) proposed an alternative communication model – the
public communication model whose tenets assumes the following:
•
Government communicators will make public all legally releasable information both
positive and negative.
•
Government communicators would investigate alternative form of communication to
reach specialised publics far from the domain of the mass media.
•
Government communicators would strive to facilitate accurate, systematic, and timely
feedback.
•
Legitimacy and credibility of government comes following the depoliticization of
government communication.
•
Public relations will be recognised as a management function.
The synthesis model of public sector crisis communication developed by Horsley and
Barker (2002) focuses specifically on crisis communication. For that reason, its relevance
is minimal to the holistic approach of communication management advocated here. The
government communication decision wheel incorporates the distinctive communication
environment of the public sector upon which this study is focused. However, a noted
limitation of the model is that it can only be applied to democratic countries based on
federalism principle such as the United States (Liu & Horsley, 2007:391). In addition,
government decision wheel model is unreasonably complicated as it describes the
intersections between four coexisting microenvironments. Moreover, such identified
environments are inapplicable to this specific study focusing on the practice of
communication management in provincial government departments.
3.11 CONCLUSIONS
This chapter outlined the theoretical framework grounded in this study. The thesis
entrenched in this study is that communication management is vital for democracy. For
government communication to be professional and strategic, it must be organised
113
excellently and efficiently while taking into account the advocacy nature inherent in
external organisational rhetoric, which may threaten the ethics and legitimacy of
communication management. It is also essential that the distinctive communication
environment of the public sector (the public sector distinctiveness theory) be considered in
both the theorising and the practice of government communication. Chapter 2 presented
the premise of the New Public Management (NPM) movement advancing that government
should adopt private sector management techniques such as strategic management,
evaluations, customer responsiveness, excellence indicators, and management by
objective amongst others. The implication of this argument to government communication
is explored in chapter 4 (strategic government communication) next.
114
CHAPTER 4: STRATEGIC GOVERNMENT COMMUNICATION
4.1
INTRODUCTION
Following the New Public Management (NPM) movement, this chapter discusses the
philosophy of strategic communication as reflected in the ‘corporate’ communication
management literature and the applicability of its principles to strategic government
communication. The chapter begins by describing the field of strategic management and
its contribution to strategic communication. The Pretoria School of Thought (PST) is
chosen as a paradigm best able to explain the functions and contributions of strategic
communication to organisational effectiveness. The remainder of the chapter discusses
the strategic communication management principle along with key features and
requirements necessary for its enactment: understanding the environment, boundaryspanning, distinction between strategy communication and communication strategy,
organising the communication department and strategy formulation. The chapter
concludes by describing the nature of communication evaluations in government
organisations.
4.2
STRATEGIC MANAGEMENT
Grunig (2007:29) claims that as an academic field, strategic management is as young as
public relations. Nonetheless, both practices have been oblivious to each other until
recently when they merged to contribute understanding to ‘strategic public relations’ also
known as ‘strategic communication management’. Higgins (1979:563) in Grunig and
Repper (1992:119) defines strategic management as “the process of managing the pursuit
of the accomplishment of organisational mission coincident with managing the relationship
of the organisation to its environment”. Strategic management can also be described as “a
continuous process of thinking through the current mission of the organisation, thinking
through the current environment conditions, and then combining these elements by setting
forth a guide for tomorrow’s decisions and results” (Greene et al., in Steyn 2004).
115
4.2.1
STRATEGY IN STRATEGIC COMMUNICATION MANAGEMENT
Strategy is a word once unheard of in government. The term ‘strategy’, like the term
‘manage’, is ridden by negative connotations insinuating control and manipulation. For
Grunig and Repper (1992:123), the term ‘manage’ connotes logic of thinking ahead or
planning rather than inferring manipulation and control. Few practitioners understand the
meaning of ‘strategy’. When the word ‘strategy’ is used, it is often “bandied around like a
mantra’. Steyn (2004) described a few elements of strategy: strategy is about thinking, it is
the logic behind the actions. Strategy requires choices because ‘strategy’ must indicate an
organisations position regarding its future and decisions to be taken in the future. Grunig
and Repper (1998:123) define strategy as an approach, design, scheme, or system.
4.2.2
STRATEGIC COMMUNICATION AS A THEORETICAL FOUNDATION
The concept of strategic communication is a hotly contested issue in both management
and communication literature (Paul, 2012). “Strategic public relations is a loosely defined
concept that recently has become popular among public relations practitioners” (Grunig,
2007:29). As a result, scholars have started developing theories for strategic public
relations or strategic communication management.
The discourse of strategic communication management according to Grunig (2007:29)
consists of loose references to the idea that “public relations should be planned, managed
by objectives, evaluated, and connected in some way to organisational objectives”.
Following this definition, it becomes deducible that strategic government communication
refers
to
‘managed’
government
communication
as
opposed
to
government
communication that is reactive and tactical. Strategic government communication is
directed by communication managers, not communication technicians largely subservient
to politicians who dictate how government communication should be practiced.
Grunig and Repper (1992:121) claim that communication management is customarily
relegated “to the functional level, where it has been assigned responsibilities for
implementing organisational objectives but not for helping develop them”. Grunig
116
(2007:32) adds that in most cases, communication is relegated to implementation tasks
and not given the responsibility for helping scan the environment and subsequently
formulating organisational objectives. Similarly, in reviewing strategic literature, Moss and
Warnaby (1998:352) confirmed that communication was seldom featured in strategic
literature, and where communication was mentioned at all, the discussion was primarily
tactically oriented. The role of communication was described predominately as of assisting
with the implementation and control stages of the strategic processes. In that regard, Moss
and Warnaby (1998) set out to explore why communication had been relegated to tactical
roles within the strategy and management literature.
Steyn (2004) noted that whilst the concept of strategy is not foreign to management
theory, it is less established in communication management theory and the public relations
body of knowledge. Steyn (2004) points out that “there is mention of a strategic role for the
corporate communication practitioner, but few explanations or descriptions of what
corporate communication strategy means in a strategic organisational context”. Ideally,
communication management should be an integral part of strategic management,
providing input to the planning department and senior managers about stakeholders in the
environment (Grunig & Repper, 1992:121).
4.3 THE PRETORIA
COMMUNICATION
SCHOOL
OF
THOUGHT
ON
STRATEGIC
When it comes to strategic communication, this study adopts the proposition offered by the
Pretoria School of Thought. The Pretoria School of Thought (PST) is a paradigm that
conceptualises communication management in the strategic context of the organisation.
The PST paradigm differentiates between communication management and strategic
communication management. The premise is that communication management functions
in the meso level within the prerogative of a communication ‘manager’ role, while strategic
communication management functions within the macro (societal/enterprise) level within
the prerogative of a communication ‘strategist’ role. This leads to “the redefinition of the
historic ‘manager’ as a role played at the middle management (meso/functional) level,
117
focusing on development of corporate communication strategy linked to enterprise strategy
(de Beer, Steyn & Rensburg, 2013:304).
An important pillar of the Pretoria School of Thought is the emphasis on the contribution of
strategic communication to the organisational strategy and overall management. “This
contribution can be summarised as making inputs to the enterprise strategy at top
management level (the role of the strategist); developing corporate communication
strategy at the middle management level (the role of the manager) and developing
operational strategy at the implementation level (the role of the technician). For strategic
communication to contribute to organisational effectiveness, it has to function in the macro
societal level, that is, within the enterprise strategic management level. The enterprise
strategy answers the question relating to what the organisation should be doing.
Therefore, the enterprise strategy acts as a framework within which other, more specific
strategies operate. According to the Pretoria School of Thought, the contribution of
strategic communication to organisational effectiveness is possible when the strategic
communication management function accomplishes the following tasks (de Beer, Steyn &
Rensburg, 2013:310):
-
Advice top management of societal values so that organisational strategies may be
adjusted accordingly;
-
Make top managers aware of the importance of accommodating public opinion;
-
Act as an early warning system in issue management; ensure dialogue with key
stakeholders; act as advocates for stakeholders by explaining their position to top
management;
-
In addition, influence top management decisions; and explain such decisions to key
stakeholders.
Literature in strategic management until recently had been preoccupied with discussions
pertaining to the ‘formulation and implementation of strategy’. It is only recently that the
two related concepts of ‘mission’ and ‘environment’ have been added to both strategic
management and strategic communication (Grunig, 2007:30).
118
4.4
THE ENVIRONMENT IN STRATEGIC COMMUNICATION
The environment is a key concept in both strategic management and strategic
communication. Steyn (2004) argues that there is lack of agreement in defining the
concept of the ‘environment’ and that various authors conceptualise it differently. The
concept of the environment was defined by Pearce and Robinson (1982:62) “as the sum
total of all conditions and forces that affect the strategic options of a business but that are
typically beyond its ability to control” (Grunig, 2007:32).
More than any other factor, the external environment affects the organisational strategy.
“Organisations create their own environment by paying attention to some information from
out there while ignoring other information” (Steyn & Puth, 2000:59). Thus, when
developing a communication strategy, there are different categories of the external
environment that must be taken into account. First is the remote environment (macro,
societal environment). The macro environment affects the organisation indirectly by
influencing its long-term decisions and strategies. “Organisations are presented with
opportunities, threats and constraints, but rarely does a single organisation exert any
meaningful reciprocal influence in the macro environment”. The remote environment
consists of social factors, economic factors, political factors, technological factors and
ecological factors. Second is the industry environment, which shapes competition in the
industry. The industry environment comprises of issues affecting the particular industry.
Third is the operating environment, also called the task environment. In accomplishing its
mission, an organisation works in its task environment (Steyn & Puth, 2000:58). The task
environment comprises of sectors and stakeholders with direct transactional relationships
with the organisation and influences the day-to-day running of the company such as
customers, suppliers, creditors, competitors, and etcetera. Fourth, the functional
environment (internal environment) – refers to areas of specialisation within the
organisation such as human resource, finance etcetera.
To better distinguish between the task environment and the societal environment, one
must understand that in accomplishing its missions, an organisation functions within its
task environment and that the societal environment may divert its attention from the task
119
environment. Grunig (2007:22) reiterates this point to which he argues that organisations
and government departments have missions and goals. However, they want to choose
their own mission and goals. Because various publics have stakes in organisations, they
also attempt to influence organisational missions and goals.
Scholars of strategic management remain silent about two issues regarding the
environment. There is little discussion about who in the organisation should observe the
environment. In addition, the process to be used in environmental scanning remains
unexplored. Grunig and Repper (1992:123) believe that in the application of the excellent
theory, communication management is able to fill in this gap, both in theory and in
practice. In return, “theories of strategic management will help fill the void in public
relations theories regarding how public relations can contribute to organisational
effectiveness” (Grunig & Repper, 1992:123).
Strategic management literature often conceptualised the environment as a constraint to
organisational missions. Conversely, communication management scholars attempt to
rebut this misconception in order to reconceptualise the organisational environment as a
source of competitive advantage. Strategic communication scholars argue instead that the
environment is not static but open to negotiations, persuasion, accommodation, and
alterations. For that matter, “it is in the strategic interest of the organisation to change their
behaviour when they provoke oppositions from the environment as well as to try and
change the behaviour of the environmental stakeholders” (Grunig & Repper, 1992:123).
The function of the communication unit is boundary spanning between an organisation and
its environment.
4.4.1
BOUNDARY SPANNING
Boundary spanning is one of the most important mechanisms by which information is
imported into organisations. The concept of boundary spanning is an important
understanding the role of communication in interpreting the environment. Boundary
spanning is an ‘outside-in’ approach. Boundary spanners are people within the
organisation who interact with the organisation’s external environment. They are important
120
in strategic decision making because of their ability to recognise and deal with trends or
changes in the external environment (Steyn & Puth, 2000:60). Departments or divisions
that engage in boundary-spanning roles will gain influence over strategic decisions making
within the organisation. As environmental scanners, they make important decisions when
they select which information to present to decision-makers and which to withhold.
However, “it seems that messengers are still blamed (although not killed) for unwelcome
messages, regardless of their value to the decision-making process” (Steyn & Puth,
2000:61).
There are two classes of boundary-spanning functions: the first concerns information
processing. This is called the mirror function. The mirror function (reflective task) is in
effect when boundary spanning is appropriated as a medium for acquiring and interpreting
timely, current, and soft information (Steyn & Puth, 2000:61). The reflective communication
strategist acts as an advocate for key stakeholders by explaining their views to the
dominant coalition and making management aware of the impacts the organisation has on
the environment and its stakeholders. Therefore, strategic communication functions as a
warning system before issues culminate into crises (de Beer, Steyn & Rensburg,
2013:313).
The second class of boundary spanning is called the window function (expressive task).
This entails “communication messages that portray all facets of the organisation in a
transparent way” (de Beer, Steyn & Rensburg, 2013:307). In this, boundary spanning
performs representational roles such as in marketing, advertising, and advocacy external
rhetoric. The Pretoria School of Thought considers the reciprocal (strategic) reflection role
as optimal because it takes into account both the mirror/reflective and window/expressive
functions (de Beer, Steyn & Rensburg, 2013:313). In this, “management is made to
understand that public trust is not earned by simply changing outward communication to
signify responsibility – an organisation actually has to behave accordingly” (de Beer, Steyn
& Rensburg, 2013:313).
121
4.5
Moss
STRATEGY COMMUNICATION AND COMMUNICATION STRATEGY
and
Warnaby
(1998)
distinguish
between
strategy
communication
and
communication strategy. They argue that these two concepts are not the same although
they are equally important. The first concept of strategy communication entails the role of
communication in facilitating the strategy-making process. The latter concept of
communication strategy comprises of the nature and focus of communication strategy
itself. The two concepts are discussed next:
4.5.1
STRATEGY COMMUNICATION
Strategy communication is found mostly within the strategy process literature. Here, the
role of communication in the organisation strategy-making processes is analysed (Moss &
Warnaby, 1998:315). The role of communication in this regard is to communicate the
organisational leaders’ strategic vision to both internal and external stakeholders. Related
to this role, is the function of communication in ensuring consensus in the strategy making
process. The third role is to motivate internal stakeholders to align themselves with the
organisational strategy (Moss & Warnaby, 1998:315). In most strategic management
literature, the role of internal communication is recognised in facilitating the abovementioned roles. In the contrary, little emphasis has been placed on the role of external
communication in seeking out issues and in building relationships with strategic
stakeholders. Within this dispensation of strategy communication, Moss and Warnaby
(1998:315) is of the opinion that “communication has been treated primarily as an enabling
function, facilitating the successful implementation of strategic decisions, but it is not in
itself seen as a key element in the strategic decision making process”.
4.5.2
COMMUNICATION STRATEGY
The tactically oriented perspective of communication as merely supporting or enabling the
strategy-making processes is found mainly in management literature. In contrast, scholars
in communication management have begun recommending for communication to play a
broader role in the strategic management processes. Grunig and Repper (2001) argue that
122
the role of communication in strategic management is in defining and understanding the
organisation’s environment. Following Grunig and Repper (1992), Moss and Warnaby
(1998) also emphasise that communication is able to play a more significant role in
diagnosing the environment as a first step in the strategy making processes.
Most accentuated in communication management literature are the ‘boundary-spanning’
role and the environmental scanning capabilities of public relations. For example, the key
element to Grunig and Repper’s strategic communication model is environmental scanning
and issue management. The key argument is that the communication unit must participate
in the organisation’s strategic processes from begging to end. Steyn (2004:179) adds that
strategic communication is maximally optimised when a practitioner functions at the top
management or macro level of the organisation and assists in the formulation of enterprise
strategy.
Grunig and Repper (1992) advise that communication must be managed strategically. In
that regard, Moss and Warnaby (1998:375) ask the question, how can communication be
managed strategically? In response, the excellence theory offers 14 principles of
excellence and effectiveness as foundations of strategic communication management.
Grunig and Repper (1992:117) describe the strategic role of communication management
as that of building long-term relationships with organisational stakeholders (symmetrical
communication). Moss and Warnaby (1998:136), emphasise the fact that strategic
communication entails diagnoses of the environment (environmental scanning) in order
to make the organisation aware of stakeholders, public and issues as they evolve and the
development of programmes that can help resolve such issues (contributing to
organisational effectiveness). Steyn (2004) adds that strategic communication is based
on a premise of communication management as a management function (Steyn, 2004).
In this way, the five principles of effectiveness in communication management are
delineated.
Communication has been treated primarily as an enabling function. Its role is only
recognised in facilitating the successful implementation of strategic decisions but not seen
as a key element in the strategic decision-making process (Moss & Warnaby, 2003:135).
123
Strategic communication can be regarded as a three-step process as follows: Step 1 is
about gathering information in order to inform strategy. Step 2 is about enabling
communication strategy formation and step 3 is about communicating strategy to internal
and external stakeholders.
According to Hartman and Lenk (2001:147), “Strategic communication within an
organisation is a proactive means of integrating communication with business planning”.
Strategic communication must be integrated with organisational planning. The concept is
based on the belief that strategic communication must contribute to an overall
organisational competitiveness (efficiency) in business processes, employees’ attraction
and retention, reputation, legitimacy and to the bottom line (profit). Strategic
communication channels the organisation to achieve a competitive advantage through
early detection and management of emerging issues and by ensuring mutual
understanding between the organisation and its stakeholders. This means that
communication must assist the company archive both financial and non-financial capital.
To contribute to competitiveness (effectiveness), communication must be aligned with
organisational goals and objectives. Organisational goals must be a prelude to
communication goals. To do that, communicators must fully understand the organisation’s
goals and objectives. It is thus necessary for communication managers to be part of the
dominate coalition, or at the very list, be present at the decision-making table. Through
environmental scanning, communication managers should be able to influence decision
making of the dominant coalition by providing intelligence regarding the socio-political and
economic environment of the organisation. This information should be used to develop
optimal organisational policies, goals, and objectives. “The question that puzzles most
organisations, however, is what does strategic communication look like and where do we
start?” (Hartman & Lenk, 2001:147). There is rarely any discussion regarding where the
communications function may fit into the overall strategic management process (Moss &
Warnaby, 2003:135).
124
4.6 THE ROLE OF COMMUNICATION IN THE STRATEGY-MAKING
PROCESS
There are limited recognitions of the role that the communication function should play in
the strategy-making process. This means that communication is largely relegated to a
technical role within the strategy literature (Moss & Warnaby, 2003:132). There is a lack of
attention paid to communication issues throughout the strategy literature. Moss and
Warnaby (2003:132) argue that “it is necessary to distinguish between two separate yet
related perspectives – the role of communication in facilitating the strategy-making process
(strategy communication) and the nature and focus of communications strategy itself
(communications strategy)”.
For internal communication, one of the roles of strategy communication is in building
consensus to organisational strategy and negotiating resolutions to disagreements. This
relates to the role of communication in articulating a clear strategic vision, involving
organisational members in the strategy-making process, and motivating stakeholders to
adopt the strategy. There is a need to communicate the organisational leader’s strategic
vision to both internal and external stakeholders. Effective communication systems are
necessary to ensure that strategic tasks and tactics are carried out precisely. The other
function of communication is in facilitating understanding and coordination between the
separate hierarchical functions of the organisation such as between directories and
various business units within an organisation. Another recognised role is in implementing a
major cultural change (change communication). Equally important is a role of strategic
communication in building a climate of mutual trust and understanding between managers,
employers and key stakeholders.
In contrast to the tactical orientation of communication in strategy-making process is the
function that communication should play in “a broader, more strategically significant role
within organisations”. Communication management should be treated as a strategically
important function, which can play a key part in helping organisations to diagnose the
environment and manage exchange between stakeholders (Moss and Warnaby,
2003:136). The principle guiding the argument is that of the ‘boundary-spanning’ capability
of the communication function in environmental scanning and stakeholder management.
125
Grunig and Repper (1992:117) define the strategic role of communication management as
that of ‘building long-term relationships with an organisation’s strategic constituencies”.
However, to fulfil this role, communication managers must participate in organisational
strategic planning, and communication programmes must be managed strategically.
Grunig and Repper (1992) see diagnosing the environment as a foundation to strategic
corporate communication. Grunig and Repper’s (1992) multistage model represent
perhaps the most sophisticated attempt to conceptualise strategic communication
management. This model focus on the evaluation of organisational stakeholders, publics
and issues resulting in the formulation of specific communications programmes as a
response. The next section describes the incorporation of strategic communication to
government communication.
4.7
STRATEGIC GOVERNMENT COMMUNICATION
Strangely, the concept of strategic communication is seldom defined. Steyn (2004)
postulates that most definitions of strategic communication are either aligned to, or
involved in communicating ‘corporate strategy’. She referred to two definitions to illustrate
this postulation. One such definition refers to “strategic communication management as
having a communication strategy that is fully aligned and integrated with business
strategy” (Steyn, 2004:176). The second definition mentions that the role of
communication strategy is to interpret an organisation’s vision, values, goals and intention
to its audiences. Both definitions display the tactical and linear view of strategic
communication.
South African government departments are abounded by job titles such as chief director,
deputy director and director of communication. These positions connote the existence of
strategic government communication where the communication manager is involved in
strategic decision-making and performs strategic planning (Steyn & Green, 2001:2).
However, this seems not to be the case in practice. Following Steyn (2000), Steyn and
Green (2001) also found many instances in which communication managers were
performing technical communication roles and mundane daily communicative routines
than they were performing strategic managerial communication roles.
126
Ring and Perry (1985:281) claim that strategic management in the public sector may be
extremely difficult. The argument is that the environmental context and the organisational
structure of government may impede against the functional strategic management. “The
constraints imposed by openness and multiple publics, coupled with contingencies of time,
when compounded by policy vagueness and/or ambiguity, can frequently do create
significant problems in the implementation of policy” (Ring & Perry, 1985:281).
Martinelli (2012:143) posits that when government communicators are so busy reacting to
what they must do on their daily ritual practices, they often do not take time to proactively
think
through
and
plan
their
government
communication
practices.
Strategic
communication planning propels the communication unit forward beyond the ‘reactive’
orientation of government communication. Strategic communication can help the
communication unit to become more visible and appear more valuable to top-management
(Martinelli, 2012:143). However, it seems that government communicators are more
comfortable working primarily within the familiar landscape of media relations and public
meetings and less with more visible, strategic objectives to move units forward. Grunig
(2007:22) illustrates this point:
“Most public relations practitioners are the masters of a number of techniques. They know how to
secure media coverage, prepare press releases, write speeches, write, and design brochures,
produce video news releases, negotiate with activists, interview community leaders, lobby
representatives in congress, stage a special event, or prepare an annual report”.
Mertinelli (2012:144) lamented the limited agency given to strategic government
communication in that “concentrated strategic efforts seem relatively rare” in government
communication. The foundation to this problem according to Grunig (2007:23) is that “most
managers and administrators, and especially the general public – have little understanding
of public relations – equating it with publicity, image-making, or outright deception”. It is
only recently that some government units began developing annual communication
strategic documents.
Grunig and Jaatinen (1998:220) previously postulated that government departments are
moving towards a strategic, managerial, and symmetrical form of communication even
127
though they were not quite there yet. Grunig (2007:32) recently observed that government
are more likely to implement strategic management than corporations do. For instance, it
was found that public affairs departments were more likely to be managed strategically
when they were integrated into the organisational level of strategic management (Grunig
and Jaatinen, 1998:220).
Mertinelli (2012) outlines three preconditions that must be in place for government
communication to be strategic. First, symmetrical communication must be realised. This
means that “dialogue is fostered between the unit and its constituents, both internal and
external, to help the unit understand these publics concerns, wants and needs” (Mertinelli,
2012: 145). The concept of symmetrical communication is relatively foreign to traditional
notions of government communication, which was classified as one-way communication
concerned only with information diffusion.
The second precondition of strategic government communication is that issue
management must be instigated. “Issue management by its nature is a strategic planning
process” (Mertinelli, 2012:145). Issue management demands active environmental
scanning that goes beyond simple media monitoring and content analysis. The process of
issue management forces the communication unit to align the government department’s
activities to stakeholder’s expectations. Mertinelli (2012:145) recommends for active
environmental scanning to be systematically planned, implemented, and included in the
strategic communication plan.
As a third precondition, Mertinelli (2012:145) makes a case for the role of modern
marketing in strategic government communication. He postulates that “government
communicators may want to apply marketing principles in their communications efforts to
engage more citizens in new or exciting government services” (Mertinelli, 2012:146).
Modern marketing goes beyond the traditional four P’s of product, pricing, placement, and
promotion to incorporate broader customers’ needs. This renders modern marketing more
relationship-centred than the traditional one-way publicity oriented traditional concept of
marketing. There has been a growing recognition in government communication of the
value of modern marketing and public relations. This refers to the advancement of external
128
organisational advocacy in government communication. However, despite this growing
recognition of the value of marketing and public relations techniques in government
communication, there appears to be few strategic models that are publicly available for
widespread emulation. There is surprisingly little scholarly research conducted on the
areas of strategic government communication.
The Pretoria School of Thought (PST) expands on the European societal approach to
communication management that views strategic communication from an ‘outside’
perspective, reflecting concern for broader societal issues to enhance legitimacy and
public trust towards the organisation (de Beer, Steyn and Rensburg, 2013:309).
Furthermore, according to The Pretoria School of Thought, for strategic communication to
contribute to organisational effectiveness it must function within the macro societal level.
For government communication to contribute to democracy, it should be incorporated
within the macro/enterprise level of management and decision-making. Therefore, it is
essential for government communication to be practiced and theorised from a societal
approach.
Paul (2012) enumerates challenges and difficulties faced by government departments in
their efforts at strategic communication designed to inform, influence, and persuade
citizens. Writing about the department of defence in the United States, Paul (2012)
mentions that the biggest challenge in government communication is that “strategic
communication is often an afterthought”. When that happens, the result is what can be
called ‘sprinkles approach’ to government communication whereby the contribution of the
communication section is added only at the last minute, usually with little effect. For
example, Paul (2012:191) illustrates that “commanders or operation will direct information
officers to sprinkle some of that information officers stuff on an already completed military
plan”.
The issue that most often deter against sophisticated strategic government communication
initiatives are “lower levels of trust and budget and staff constraints”. For strategic
government communication to work, it should “it must be first and foremost practical and
realistic in terms of resources and expectations” (Mertinelli, 2012:146). Additionally, for
129
strategic government communication to be truly effective there must be a buy in from top
management or the dominant coalition. If not, it is most likely to fail both in planning and in
operation.
Another significant challenge worth acknowledging is that “the leaders who provide
strategic direction for a government agency are not only the managers of that agency but
also legislators and the chief executives”. For this reason, the challenge for strategic
management as defined by Bingman and Kee in Grunig (2007:33) are as follows:
“Strategic
management
in
the
federal
government
involves
constant
accommodation between politicians/policymakers and the administrators/managers.
Very often the manager must follows a vision set by others, with limited ability to
influence its design. Even where the manager helps to establish the vision, it is
subject to annual change and validity in the legislature budget processes”.
The other challenge to strategic government communication as noted by Grunig and
Jaatinen (1998: 229-230) is on the implementation of communication strategies.
Communication strategy documents interpret the reality as well as the ideal in actual
practice. However, in spite of excellent communication strategy documents, the
implementation of the policy is impeded by two factors. First, concerns “the lack of skills by
government
practitioners
to
implement
the
policy”.
The
second
challenge
in
implementation can be ascribed to “a widespread incomprehension of the policy by
programme or line managers” (Grunig & Jaatinen, 1998:229). However, there is a sense
that the application of communication strategies across government departments is
uneven. In some departments, the communication strategy is adopted wholeheartedly
because it received strong support from the dominant coalition. Therefore, the
implementation of communication strategy documents depend on the knowledge base of
practitioners and support found from management (Grunig & Jaatinen, 1998:230).
In offering some suggestions in alleviating the challenges of practicing strategic
government communication, Paul (2012) recommends the following. “To be really good at
strategic communication, everyone, including commanders/ decision-makers and their
130
subordinates, need to have a communication mind-set”. By communication mind-set, Paul
(2012:192) refers to an inclination to consider what executing a given plan will
communicate or signal to others and a willingness to include such considerations in
planning. This supports Grunig and Jaatinen (1998:222) sentiments that “the key terms in
the excellence theory can be found in the statement that organisations are likely to be
more effective when their public relations function helps to build strategic, symmetrical
relationships with key public”.
4.8
MODELS FOR DEVELOPING COMMUNICATION STRATEGIES
The area of academic research and discourse in strategy scholarship is dominated by a
focus on the process in which strategy is formulated and implemented (Moss & Warnaby,
1998). The strategy management process refers to the methods by which strategies are
derived, incorporating various steps or phases through which strategies are formulated
and implemented (Steyn, 2004:173).
Phase 1: Environmental scanning
Steyn considers environmental scanning as the first step in the strategy management
process. The environmental scanning phase provides a link between the stakeholder
environment and the organisation. Steyn (2004:174) describes this process as follows:
“The organisation collects information into the strategic formulation process, and
anticipates issues /trends that will help to buffer threats and take advantage of
opportunities”. This should incorporate step 1-2.
Step 1.
Analyse the internal environment – corporate profile, visions, mission,
culture, values & policies.
Step 2.
Identify strategic stakeholders and publics – identify strategic stakeholders in
the external and internal environment by drawing up stakeholder map (public
relation audit), identifying stakeholders’ perceptions, attitudes and concerns (issuemanagement), and identifying stakeholders familiarity with the organisation
(corporate image studies). “The overall strategic management of organisation is
131
inseparable from the strategic management of relationships” (Steyn & Puth,
2000:64).
Phase 2: Strategic thinking and strategic formulation
Steyn (2004) reminds scholars of the distinction between strategic thinking and strategic
planning. “Strategic thinking is the process that the organisation’s management uses to set
direction and articulate their vision”. This process is both introspective and externally
oriented to produce a framework for the strategic and operational plans to determine the
organisations strategy. This involves step 3- 5:
Step 3.
Identify and prioritise key strategic issues. Part of the strategic role of the
communication manager is being a member of the team that identifies the key
strategic issues facing the organisation (Steyn & Puth, 2000:69). “When
organisations create consequences for others, they must manage diffuse linkages.
When
diffuse
stakeholders
organise,
they
create
consequences
for
the
organisation. The more turbulent an organisation’s environment, the more linkages
the organisation must manage with its environment and manage more rapidly those
linkages change” (Steyn & Puth, 2000:65).
Step 4.
Identify implications of strategic issues for stakeholders. Identify the
implications of each strategic issue for each (strategic) stakeholder.
Step 5.
Decide on the communication strategy – deciding what must be
communicated to each stakeholder to solve the problem or capitalise on the
opportunity presented by the strategic issue.
Phase 3: Strategic planning, implementation and control
Strategic planning is the means to operationalize strategy already generated through the
strategic thinking process. Strategic planning merely formalise the strategic process as
began in the strategic thinking phase (Steyn 2004:174). A master plan is detailed in a
strategy document. The implementation phase operationalizes the process by turning
strategy into a reality by means of detailing shorter-term plans and deciding on tactics to
132
operationalize the master plan. The control phase consists of management ensuring that
the strategy stays on course and achieves set goals. This involves step 6-10.
Step 6.
Set communication goals. A communication goal is therefore the destination
to be reached by means of the organisation’s communication.
Step 7.
Develop a communication policy
Step 8.
Submit the draft of the corporate communication strategy to top
management. “The more they understand the important contribution that the
communication unit is making towards the achievement of organisational goals, the
easier it will be to obtain funds for implementing the strategy” (Steyn & Puth,
2000:73).
Step 9.
Conduct a media analysis. Identify specific media and channels to be used
and how they will be used.
Step 10. Develop a communication plan. That is the master plan of how to do it.
Communication plans implement the strategy, the provide action points by
developing either a communication campaign around the strategy or a
communication programme (continuous) or both.
Grunig and Repper (1992) advanced “ a multi-stage model for the strategic management
of public relations which focuses initially around the analysis of organisational
stakeholders, publics and issues which in turn leads to the formulation of specific
communication programmes to address the stakeholders, publics and key issues affecting
the organisation”.
Martinellie (2012) process model for strategic government communication is as follows:
First, communicators should discuss the benefits of strategic planning to help the larger
unit (department) achieve its goals and get administrative buy-in to begin the process.
When management understands that the communication unit will help contribute to the
goals and visions of the larger department, the value of communication is realised and
support is granted. More research to define the unit’s current situation should be
conducted in order to understand the specific problems, opportunities, or goals of which
the department wishes to attain. In this case, situational analysis of the unit’s strength,
weaknesses, opportunities and threats (swot analysis) should be conducted.
133
Secondly, take into account targeted constituents. Each citizen affected or targeted by the
government department must be defined in terms of who they are demographically,
regarding their ages, income, education level, income level et cetera. The geographical
and psychographic details are also relevant in profiling certain government services. This
can be used for promotional purposes. It is also essential to discover what targeted public
know about the department in order to determine the attitude they already hold. Such
information can be found in media content analysis, surveys polling and focus groups for
example.
Thirdly, key messages should be devised. After determining preliminary information
regarding the target audiences, goals, and objectives of the department, strategic key
messages must be identified. The message should appeal to the audiences’ self-interest,
what is called the unique selling proposition (usp) in marketing terminology. “Each
communication tool or tactic developed should include a specific call for action, which tells
people what they can do to act on the message”. Fourthly, Communication tactics should
be delineated. The communication plan must be formalised and specific tasks or tactics
outlined in order to support the identified strategies, objectives, and goals (Mertinellie,
2012:151).
Fifth, the timetable must be set. The timetable should include a yearlong communication
plan scheduled task /tactics and their respective personnel assignment. Strategic planning
should be an inclusive process entailing all communicators. Sixth, on-going evaluations
are essential. “Communication plans should be dynamic documents that are evaluated on
an on-going basis and adopted accordingly to meet objectives and goals” (Mertinellie,
2012:151). Although the steps in the process of developing a communication strategy
were indicated in a linear fashion in the chapter, it does not necessarily always happen in
this sequence in practice. Essential to the enactment of strategic communication are topics
relating to the structuring of the communication department and communication
evaluations. These issues are discussed next.
134
4.9
ORGANISING THE COMMUNICATION DEPARTMENT
Strategic communication is deeply affected by the position of the communication unit
within an organisation. There is no one best way to organise the public relations
department. To Gregory (2009:20), the way each organisation manages, structures, and
undertakes its public relations (PR) activities is unique. Some departments may consist of
one communication individual while others may house a number of communication
professionals with specialised units responsible for distinct communication activities
(Seitel, 1984:55). Some departments may have decentralised organisational structures
with different communication professionals reporting to different structures of management
whereas other departments prefer a more centralised structure in which all communication
professionals report to one communication executive who then reports to the dominant
coalition. The specific objectives determine the structure. In this case “structure must
always follow strategy – not vice versa” (Van Riel & Fombrun, 2007:260).
4.9.1 POSITION OF THE COMMUNICATION UNIT WITHIN AN
ORGANISATION
The location of the communication unit within an organisation depends on a variety of
factors. Gregory (2009) outlines these factors as follows: the position of the most senior
communication manager in the organisation, the tasks allocated to the communication
unit, and how the communication unit is situated in relation to the other functions in the
organisation.
Gregory (2009:27) argues that the position of the most senior communication manager
within the organisation provides a good indication of how the communication function is
valued within the organisation. Grunig and Repper (1992) have already argued that
communication is valued in an organisation if it is a part of the dominant coalition to
determine the goals and priorities of the organisation rather than merely to communicate
those goals once decided. A compromising role where communication managers are not
part of the dominant coalition is within the ‘senior adviser’ role. Within this role, the senior
135
communication manager is not part of the dominant coalition per se but reports directly to
the CEO and holds a special position of power and influence as a reputable advisor.
4.9.2
ACCESS TO MANAGEMENT
Research on the managerial role of communication represents a major strand in the
communication management literature. Much of the research on the managerial role of
communication centres on “arguments about practitioners involvement or exclusion from
participating in management decision-making and strategic planning” (Moss, Newman &
DeSanto, 2005:873).
There must always be direct access to the top of the organisation, and that this access
should be used to exert influence to strategic planning. Communication units may be
influential, advisory, or merely a support service. Communication departments may not
have direct access to ‘top management’ if they are situated low in the organisational
hierarchy. Van Ruler (2000:409) warns, “Communication managers who do have access
to the top do not always translate this into influence”. On a research of communication
management in the Netherlands, Van Ruler (2000:409) found that “the majority of
respondents in that survey regarded access as important because they had to know what
was going on and so they could alert senior management to threats to the corporate
image. Only a small minority considered that influence over strategic planning was part of
their role”. The next section discusses the importance of communication evaluation to
strategic communication management.
4.10 COMMUNICATION EVALUATION IN GOVERNMENT
The enactment of strategic communication is heavily dependent on continuous
communication evaluations. It has become apparent that “in an organisational environment
characterised by downsizing and zero-based budgeting, public relations no longer can
convincingly argue that the function is justified without evidence of measurable results”
(Hon, 1997:1). The demand for research comes from outside communication
management. It comes from managers schooled in the management by objective
136
philosophy, seeking accountability from communications. However, Dozier (1992:336)
maintains that practitioners are slow to adopt evaluation research into their daily practice.
Research on the effectiveness of communication management often fails to identify the
contribution of communication management to an organisation itself. “Some effect that
were posed and critiqued included increased inquiries, sales, votes, attendance, and
donations, more volunteers, improved employee morale and job satisfaction, and cost
saved by avoiding litigation and negative issues campaigns to fend off external pressure”.
None of these demonstrates the effectiveness of communication management to the
organisation itself.
Communication management attains value only by helping an organisation achieve its
goals. Increasingly, communication managers are preoccupied with demonstrating the
positive financial return on investment (ROI). On the other hand, KwaZulu Natald, “other
professionals are focused on showing that public relations messages have effects on
cognitive concepts such as reputation, brand, image, or identity, which they believe
increase the value of an organisation beyond its tangible asserts” (Grunig, 2006:159).
Rhetorical theorists fall under this group. Though difficult to place momentary value, the
excellence theory posit that good strategic communication management, which is based
on scanning the environment and symmetrical relationships saves an organisation money
by reducing costs of litigation, regulation, legislation, and negative publicity caused by poor
aimless policies, strategies and poor relations.
Although it is old data, Hiebert and Devine (1985:46) research found that government
information officers almost universally proclaim the importance of research and evaluation
to their work, however, there was a huge gap between the admission of importance and
the actual conducting of communication evaluation. “Public information officers in the
federal government conducted almost no research and evaluation” (Hiebert & Devine,
1985:47). Hiebert and Devine (1985:46) identified the following barriers preventing the
uptake of communication evaluations in government: lack of budget, lack of time, lack of
knowledge and qualification to conduct communication evaluations. The public information
directors did not use the techniques because they were oblivious to them and because
they felt such techniques where at the exclusive use of the private sector. Some would say
137
“we are not selling soup… these techniques don’t apply to government” (Hiebert & Devine,
1985:56)
Developing a framework for the evaluation of government communication is also a key
task for researchers (Canel & Sanders, 2012:92). Public relations evaluation concern all
research designed to determine the effectiveness or value of public relations’ efforts such
as the success or failure of specific PR programmes, strategies, activities, or tactics.
These are measured against a predetermined set of objectives (Lindenmann, 2003:5).
Most professions have recognised measuring tools, but public relations’ efforts have
always been gauged in a variety of ways - each using a different kind of measuring stick
and units. Sanders et al. (2011:5) lamented the lack of sufficient published descriptive
data of government communication, which makes it impossible to profile structures,
processes and outcomes suggestive of professionalization and thus serving as an index of
professionalism in government communication.
This study draws on Sanders’ et al. (2011:5) framework for the analysis of government
communication. The proposed approach in quality management is to survey three central
aspects of any organisation, namely, structure, processes, and outcomes. Structure
concerns the conditions in which an activity takes place (i.e. the unique communication
environment of the public sector) and the rules governing an activity (e.g. communication
policies and professional guidance). Processes are a set of ordered actions such as roles,
functions and communication practices, and outcomes are the results or consequences of
communication processes (e.g. government reputation). Please see table 6.
The framework analyses structure, processes, and outcomes. Structure encompasses
two sets of clusters, namely administration and human resource. Administration covers
formal
rules,
legislation
and
communication
policies
relevant
to
government
communication. Guidance and organisational charts detailing communication roles and
functions are included as part of structural administration of government communication in
the department. Another structural dimension is human resources inclusive of the skills,
knowledge, and values of the entire communication workforce (Sanders et al., 2005:6).
138
Financial resources such as budget and other rewards may fall under the human resource
rubric.
The communication processes dimension incorporates information gathering, analysis,
and dissemination (Sanders et al., 2011:6). This cluster is malleable enough to include
analysis of all government communication activities. However insinuated, a lesser
highlighted dimension in Sanders’ et al. (2011:5) framework is the outcome dimension.
This cluster encompasses information evaluation in its entirety. All research on
communication effectiveness and media analysis may fall here.
Table 6:
Structure
Sanders framework for the analysis of government communication
Administration/
Formal rules
Organisational charts
professionalization
Legislation
Policies and guidance
Human resources
Financial resources
Budgets
Skills knowledge values
Reward systems
Professional profiles
Training
Process
*Outcome
Communication
Information
gathering
Research work(commissioned or internally undertaken)
and analysis
Coordination and planning mechanisms and routines
Information
Briefings, meetings, press conferences. Digital media
dissemination
Campaigns advertising
Information evaluation
Feedback mechanism. Media analysis. Communication
metrics (return-on-investment measures)
* Added by current researcher for clarification purposes.
On evaluating government communication outcomes, Grunig and Grunig (1999) discern
four levels of evaluative research in government communication. First, the programme
level evaluates individual communication programmes such as media relations or
corporate reputation. The functional level evaluates the effectiveness of public relations in
the overall management of the organisation. The third level, the organisational level is
done by comparing the structure and process of the departments to the structures and
processes of similar departments and to theoretical principles and scholarly research
(benchmarking). The fourth level concerns the societal level because public organisations
have an impact beyond their own boundaries. As such, organisations cannot be said to be
139
effective unless they are socially responsible (reputation analysis can be a basis for
research in the societal level).
When most government communicators think of research, they think of research directly
related to specific communication programmes. They are evaluation-only studies, which
generally have not been preceded by formative research to help plan the programme.
These studies do not measure objectives based on formative research, so they have no
benchmark. The measures cannot be used directly to conclude whether public affairs
programmes contributed to the effectiveness of the organisation or society. Performance
measurement can clarify the benefit that government communication has contributed to
government operations and successes (Vos, 2009:363).
Formative research precedes the communication effort to identify strategies, publics, to
determine how the organisation can communicate best to develop quality programmes and
communication strategies. Evaluative research is one conducted after the communication
process to determine the success or failure or progress of the communication effort.
“Public relations is not a start/stop communication process where an organisation stops
interaction with publics while the results of a media relations programme are measured”
(Watson & noble, 2007: 88). Evaluation is a continuous process so any model must reflect
the “dynamic, progressive and continuous nature of this process” (Watson & noble,
2007:89).
Lindenmann (2003), and, Watson and Noble (2007) highlighted major PR measurements
and evaluation components. The in-put inclusive of environmental audit and objectives
works as a benchmark. The audit will tell us what the problem is while the objectives will
tell us the solution of the problem (Watson & Noble, 2007:91). Outputs are usually the
immediate results of a PR strategy such as the amount of exposure that the organisation
receives. Media content analysis is one of the principal methodologies used to measure
media outputs. Both quality and quantity of outputs can be measured and evaluated. PR
outtakes are more specific such as determining if key audiences actually received the
message, paid attention, understood (apprehended and retained), and recalled the
message (Watson & Noble, 2007:87). PR outcomes measure effects such as opinion
140
change, and behavioural change. It is more difficult and more expensive to measure PR
outcomes, data-gathering research tools and technique are required (Lindenmmann,
2003:10). A mixture of qualitative and quantitative research techniques are often used to
measure PR outtakes and PR outcomes. Surveys, attitude surveys, focused groups,
interviews and ethnographic research may be used for this purpose.
The purpose of Vos’s (2009) study was to understand communication quality and to find a
way in which government communication performance could be measured at a municipal
level. Vos (2009:368) outlined seven quality criteria for government communication. The
first element is transparency and the value of accountability. Vos argues that performance
measurements lead to transparency, which in turn stimulates innovation in practice.
Accessibility of information and organisation is a second quality measure. This indicator
means that citizens and other stakeholders are able to find what and who they are looking
for. The third indicator of quality in government communication is the level of publicity
through the media. Active media relations and responsiveness to the media signals
symmetrical engagement. Fourth, responsiveness is also an essential indicator meaning
that communicators observe feedback and applies it in making improvements. This
requires a monitoring system and the willingness to use feedback honourably. Interactive
polity forms the fifth indicator. Interactive policy refers to “the active involvement of target
groups in policy projects” (Vos, 2009:368). A culture of collaboration in policymaking is
needed for this indicator to be enacted. Sixth is communication policy, which requires wellconsidered embedded communication as a policy tool in addition to other instruments.
This requires strategic considerations and planning. The last indicator of quality
government communication is the degree of effective and efficiency of communication.
The indicator is only possible when a result-focussed and efficient deployment of
communication is apparently added with well-considered forms of research and costconscious implementation of communication tactics (Vos, 2009:368).
4.11 CONCLUSIONS
Strategic government communication should be planned, managed by objectives,
evaluated, and connected in some way to organisational objectives. Although challenges
141
and hindrances to the practice of strategic communication in government have been
identified in this chapter, literature profiled offer solutions and preconditions for strategic
government communication to be possible. Those requirements are encapsulated as
follows: strategic government communication is only enacted within a symmetrical two-way
communication model. This means that dialogue is fostered between the unit and its
constituents. Issue management, preceded by active environmental scanning and
complemented by precise communication evaluations should become consistent activities
of government communication. Moreover, communication must be planned and such
planning should be reflected in government communication strategy documents. The
strategic management literature insists that strategic communication is sustained by a
conspicuous buy in of top management in the department. Strategic communication
requires the presence of communication managers who practice public relations as a
management function. Another recommendation is for the adoption of modern marketing
and identity management as functions towards a visible and available organisation or
government. Such issues of government visibility, rhetoric, identity management, and
media relations may be considered strategies towards communicating with the public as
external stakeholders. The next chapter explores the practice of
government
communication.
142
CHAPTER 5: THE
COMMUNICATION
5.1
PRACTICE
OF
GOVERNMENT
INTRODUCTION
Important in this chapter is an exploration of how government communication is actually
practiced. A suggested approach in conducting a communication practice research is to
survey three central aspects of an organisation, namely, structure, processes, and
outcomes (Sanders et al., 2011:5). Structure concerns the conditions in which an activity
takes place, that is, the distinctive communication environment of the public sector,
already discussed in chapter 3. Processes are a set of ordered actions such as roles,
functions and communication practices. Outcomes are the results or consequences of
processes such as government reputation as an outcome as discussed in chapter 2.
Particularly vital to this chapter is a discussion of processes as defined by Sanders et al.
(2011:5).
This chapter begins by defining communication as a practice, essentially reviewing what a
practice is and what qualifies government communication to be a practice. A practice is
related but different from a profession. The definition adopted here is that a practice
concerns the day-to-day operation of a profession, whereas a profession refers to the
standardisation and the management of the practice. In this chapter, roles and functions of
government communicators are outlined. This is followed by an assessment of challenges
confronting
government
communication.
Moreover,
issues
concerning
the
professionalising of government communication are described.
5.2
COMMUNICATION AS PRACTICE
According to Craig’s (2006) definition, “a practice is a coherent set of activities that are
commonly engaged in and meaningful in particular ways, among people familiar with
certain cultures”. A practice is a method, procedure, process, or rule, used in a particular
field or profession (www.businessdictionary.com). A practice involves not only engaging in
143
certain activities but also thinking about those activities in particular ways. Practices can
be done well or poorly, that is way it is essential to evaluate the effectiveness of a practice.
As a practice develops, a normative discourse about the practice develops along with it.
The normative discourse is a constitutive part of the practice. Such is the on-going
communication about the practice as standards of excellence, ethical norms, techniques,
styles and so forth are continually conceptualised and disseminated through a culture that
makes the practice meaningful and regulates the conduct through professionalism (Craig,
2006).
Theory provides ways of interpreting practical knowledge. However, no theory can explain
everything necessary to participate in a practical activity. Practical knowledge comes only
with the accumulation of direct experience. Nonetheless, theory contributes to discursive
consciousness. A theory of practice provides a particular way of interpreting practical
knowledge. It should be noted that every theory considered as an interpretation of practical
knowledge presents an idealised normative standard for practice. Roles and functions are
best able to demarcate the parameters of a practice and best able to delineate the nature
of a practice through explanations of lived experiences.
5.3
ROLES OF GOVERNMENT COMMUNICATORS
According to Dozier (1992:328), roles define the everyday activities of public relations.
Roles guide the actions of individuals. Practitioners’ roles are imperative towards
understanding the function of public relations and organisational communication. Roles
and professional status are tightly intertwined (Dozier, 1992:328). In an organisational
setting, argue Steyn and Green (2001:2), the concept of ‘role’ refers to the standardisation
patterns of behaviour required of individuals in specific functional relationships. For Van
Ruler, (2004:124), a role can be considered an expected behaviour associated with a
social position.
Communication roles have been studied from a variety of perspectives. Public relations
roles have been studies in relation to the power of the communication department within
the organisation. In addition, they have been studied in relation to environmental scanning,
144
issue management, models of public relations practices, job satisfaction, role
specialisation, professionalization, and gender empowerment/discrimination (Clemons,
2009:11).
5.3.1
TYPES OF COMMUNICATION PRACTITIONER ROLES
Broom and Smith (1979) operationally conceptualised five conceptual role models: the
expert prescriber, technical service provider, communication process facilitator, problemsolving process facilitator, and the acceptant legitimizer. Dozier (1984) found two major
roles, the manager and the technical roles. In addition, he identified two minor roles: the
media relations specialist and the communication liaison. The Pretoria School of Thought
(PST) identifies three South African communication management roles: strategist,
manager and technician. These are similar to those identified by the European Body of
Knowledge (EBOK), which are reflective, managerial and operational (de Beer, Steyn and
Rensburg, 2013:309).
In communication practices, two central roles always emerge. The communication
technician and the communication manager are two dominant roles that consolidated the
consensus of many scholars (Broom & Smith, 1979; Broom, 1982; Dozier, 1992, Van
Ruler, 2004; Grunig 2007). “The management – technician role dichotomy has been the
most widely used framework in role research over the past two decades” (Moss, Newman
& DeSanto, 2005:873). Grunig (2007:44) distinguishes between these two roles as he
explains, “communication managers’ plan and direct public relations programmes,
communication technicians
provide
technical services
such as
writing,
editing,
photography, media contacts, or production of publications”. However, Grunig (2007)
argues that the majority of public relations people are technicians.
The Pretoria School of Thought (PST) identifies the communication strategist role as
one senior to the traditional manager’s role. Only the strategic manager’s role is capable of
instilling strategic communication management by enacting a reflective role. The reflective
role has to do with analysing changing standards, values and norms in society and
pointing these out to organisational decision-makers (the dominant coalition) so that they
145
can adjust the standards and values of the organisation regarding social responsibility and
legitimacy (de Beer, Steyn and Rensburg, 2013:309). This role has been described more
closely in chapter 4 in the strategic government communication chapter. Below Steyn and
Green (2001) distinguish between the communication manager and the communication
technician:
Practitioners in the manager role make communication policy decisions and are involved in
corporate communication decision making - they frequently use research to plan or evaluate their
work and to counsel management. Communication technicians, on the other hand, do not participate
in management decision making, but provide the communication and journalistic skills - writing,
editing, audiovisual production, graphics and the production of messages - needed to implement
communication programmes.
For Dozier (1984:333), the communication manager “facilitates communication between
management and publics and guide management through what practitioners describe as a
rational problem-solving process”. The role of the manager originated from Broom and
Smith’s (1979) conceptualisation of this role into three different categories: the expert
prescriber, communication facilitator, and problem-solving process facilitator (Steyn &
Green, 2001:3).
An expert prescriber is an informed practitioner, one who becomes the best-informed
person in the organisation (Broom & Smith, 1979:48). Such practitioners are regarded as
expects on public relations, best informed about public relations issues, and best qualified
to answer public relations questions (Dozier, 1992:327). In explaining this role, Broom and
Smith (1979:48) refer to the ‘doctor-patient’ relationship where the doctor (expert
prescriber) diagnose the problem and offer prescriptions (solutions) to a passive
(agreeable) patient (organisation). The expert prescriber “operates as an authority on both
the public relations problem and the solutions that should be implemented” (Broom &
Smith, 1979:48; Broom, 1982:18).
Communication (process) facilitator is the go-between, facilitating communication. This
role is also called the interpreter or the communication link. It is an information mediating
role where the “primary function is to facilitate the exchange of information so the parties
involved have adequate information for dealing with each other and for making decisions
146
of mutual interests” (Broom & Smith, 1979:53). The role concern process, the quality and
quantity of information flow between management and publics (Dozier, 1992:330). This
role involves the maintenance of a two-way communication between the organisation and
its various publics.
Problem-solving process facilitator is a practitioner helping management systematically
think through organisational communication and public relations problems and in
collaboration with clients (management), designs and implements solutions (Dozier,
1992:330). This communication practitioner works closely with management to solve
issues whereas the expert prescriber works independently to solve issues, which
consequently renders management passive and dependent. It is a collaborative
relationship entailing joint efforts of diagnosis, planning, and implementation (Broom &
Smith, 1971:51).
Communication technician role is one of a technical service provider. These
practitioners are also called the journalist in resident because they are hired for their
journalistic skills in writing and dealing with the media. Here, the client (management)
themselves define the problem and select the solution. This means that the dominant
coalition makes strategic decisions, specifying organisational actions and designating the
communications directed at the public about such actions. The communication technician
then is retained to provide those mandated communication service (Dozier, 1992:327).
Hence, the communication technician operates in ways consistent with the clients
(management) expectations and prescriptions (Broom & Smith, 1979:49).
The acceptance Legitimizer involves a nondirective role emergent from psychology
where the practitioner’s role is in helping the client “through sympathetic listening and
empathy support” (Broom & Smith, 1979:53). Here, the practitioner works as a
spokesperson in presenting the ideas of the client organisation. This role is the least active
of all other roles. Broom and Smith (1979:53) explain further, “while this role is the least
active of our experimental role models, we included it because public relations’
practitioners are often subordinated to this position in highly structured organisations”. For
some reason, this role fell out of literature in subsequent years. For example, Broom
147
(1982), Dozier (1992) and Van Ruler (2004) do not mention this role in their renditions of
Broom and Smith’s (1979) communication roles.
Two additional communication technician roles are found. Those are the media relations
specialist and the communication liaison. The media relations specialist specialises in
external media relations rather than internal communication production activities. Similar to
technicians, media specialists make no policy decisions, nor are they held accountable for
outcomes (Broom & Dozier, 1986:41). The communication liaison officer specialises in
linking communication between management and key publics. They too are isolated from
decision-making and accountability (Broom & Dozier, 1986:41; Dozier, 1992:333).
In their article, Moss, Newman, and DeSanto (2005:873) review the methodological
paradigm in which managers’ roles are conceptualised and measured. What were found
worrisome are the limitations of the measures used to identify managers’ role enactment.
The foremost criticism of role research regards the tendency of scholars to treat roles as
static categories into which communicators are ‘pigeon-holed’ (Moss, Newman & DeSanto,
2005:874). It is therefore essential to remember that these roles are highly inter-correlated
and usually performed inter-changeably by the same practitioner meaning that they are
conceptual components to the same empirical role (Steyn & Green, 2001:3).
Although most communication literature indicates a two-role typology of the manager and
the technician roles, a third role had emerged since 1995. The conceptualisation of the
third role is however conflicting. An agency profile is one of the roles noted to fit the
description of the third role. The agency profile is same as a managerial role but also
include counselling management of communication issues. Van Ruler (1997) identified
two additional roles one named the sales manager and the other named the intermediary
role. The sales manager is concerned with synchronising the behaviour of a public with
that of the organisation, largely enacting the two-way asymmetrical role while the
intermediary enacts a two-way symmetrical role building bridges to ensure mutual
understanding and harmony between the public and the organisation. Steyn (2000)
concurred with academics on the existence of a third role. This was termed the strategist
role. According to Steyn and Green (2001:4), the role of the strategist is regarded as a role
148
at top management level of an organisation. A corporate communication practitioner in this
role gathers strategic information on stakeholders and issues from the external
environment by means of environmental scanning, and feeds this strategic intelligence into
the organisation's strategy formulation processes. This represents a corporate
communication's contribution to strategic decision making. Van Ruler (2004) presented a
Typology of communication role by means of metaphors. They are summarised in a
tabulated form in table 7 below.
Table 7:
Van Ruler’s typology of communication roles
Role/ metaphor
Description of communication management role
1. The town crier: PR
In broadcasting their master’s voice, their jobs entail is nothing more than making
is
their master’s communication factual, clear, correct, and reliable. In this, effects
broadcasting
his
master’s voice.
and research is unnecessary.
2. The Steward: PR is
They are tasked with putting the public at ease and making them receptive to
pampering.
positive notions about the organisation. Success and failure is judged by close
informal observations.
3. The traffic
Communication is viewed as a controlled one-way process. The focus therefore is
manager: PR is
on the means of communication, targeting, timing, reach, planning, and control of
transfer of information.
distribution process. Success in such media relations is judged by delivering the
right message, to the right public and the right time.
4. The conductor: PR
Communication is seen as persuasion. Herein, the conductor’s task is to develop
is harmonic
a prominent brand position. For this to be effective, research is essential. This role
performance.
resonates with the asymmetrical model.
5. The creator: PR is
“Creators are the types of public relations professionals who aim to create
about creating a bond.
agreement between the organisation, its members, and its constituencies”. The
symmetrical model is enacted wherein communication is guided by active
research about the environment, audiences, and their issues.
6. The facilitator: PR
Communication is viewed as an interactive two-way process. For the facilitator,
is
communication is about mediation. Communication is as management of
about
hosting
dialogue.
relations.
seat-of-the-
Communication is seen as a talent, there is no value in education and
pants: PR is an art,
professionalization because the sheer complexity of public relations cannot be
not a profession.
analysed and categorised. They draw on gut feelings rather than on research
7.
The
Source: Van Ruler (2004:130-137) typology of communication roles.
149
Moss, Newman and DeSanto (2005:873) conducted a survey of 9000 communicators
based in the United Kingdom. In terms of public relations roles research, the majority of
studies take a quantitative approach, primarily utilising survey-based research. The
research sought to map, explicate, and compare the main elements of the managerial role
performed by communication or public relations practitioners. The findings of this study
outlined a five-factor dimensions interpreting contemporary communication managers role.
The first dimension is labelled the monitor and evaluator dimension. This type of
management role is responsible for organising, controlling, and monitoring the day-to-day
work of communication. The second management role is termed the key policy and
strategy advisor. This role focuses on the relationship public elation practitioners have with
senior management function (the dominant coalition).
Moss, Newman and DeSanto’s
(2005:873) results demonstrated that this dimension was the exception rather than the rule
in most organisations. The third communication management role is issues management
expert. This role relates to the public relations practitioners role in diagnosing and
responding to external threats from major to minor issues that may affect the organisation.
Fourthly, the trouble shooting/ problem –solver dimension – focus on the practitioners’ role
in responding to and dealing with a range of internal and external challenges, threats, or
crises confronting the organisation. The last role of the technician relates to handling and
overseeing of technical work.
The major findings of Moss, Newman and DeSanto’s (2005:886) research were a
confirmation of the interdependence and intertwinement of communication roles. “The
findings point or conceded with the tendency for practitioners to enact elements of both the
manager and the technician role” (ibid). This finding reaffirms the findings of other roleresearchers who argued that, in practice, all practitioners enact activities of both the
manager and technician roles.
5.3.2
COMMUNICATION ROLE DIFFERENTIATION
Van Ruler examined whether role differentiation exist in the government communication
profession, and if so, what tasks’ are carried at certain levels of responsibility. Van Ruler
150
(2000) identified four levels of communication management roles. The highest level is level
D, the strategic communication policy manager. In level D is, “a communication specialist
with general responsibility for communication policy and general communication
management with overall duties, who gives advice at a strategic level”. Level C is
assumed by senior communication officers in middle range. Herein, a communication
expert specialises in strategic policy areas, such as communication advice, project
management, media relations, outreach programme et cetera. The communication officer
is placed in level B, the lower level of communication management. Here, a
communication expert at an executive and practical level, coordinates production and is
able to advise on implementation of already decided communication strategies and goals.
The last and lowest level of them all is the level A of the general communication officer or
the communication assistance (e.g. interns) who provide assistance to others and carry
out general implementation and communication administrative duties (Van Ruler, 2000:
410-412).
However, Van Ruler (2000:412) acknowledges that the four levels are not always present
in all organisations. For instance, a small organisation with fewer communication
practitioners may compel the few communicators to fulfil all four roles by themselves.
Likewise, a communication department situated at a low position within the organisational
hierarchy may be confined to performing the lowest level roles because of isolation to
strategic decision-making and inaccessibility of management.
Although it was expected that there would be a difference between the profiles of those at
each level of responsibility, the data collected from a study of communication management
in the Netherlands, showed no role differentiation within the various levels. Van Ruler
(2000:417) found no differentiation in the sense that the nature of the task performed
varied at each level. In other words, the profiles at the various levels are, to a large
degree, extensions of one another.
151
5.3.3
INVOLVEMENT IN ORGANISATIONAL DECISION-MAKING
In order for the communication unit to contribute meaningfully to the enterprise strategy, it
must be involved in the organisational decision-making process. Research has linked
roles, decision-making, and the nature of the organisation’s environment. A closed –
system approach to communication management is consistent with the technician role.
Technicians are said to be dominant in organisations with nonthreatening and static
environments. For instance, Dozier (1992:343) postulates that when the environment is
both threatening and dynamic, the role enacted is the public relations manager role,
emphasising expert prescription.
Involvement in organisational decision-making is the single construct that is perhaps more
important to the profession of communication management than any other measure of
professional growth. Broom and Dozier (1986:42) point out that isolation of communication
from decision-making limits the practice of communication management to a low-level
support function. Participation in strategic decision-making is extremely important for
practitioners. Dozier (1992:342) advices that “if practitioners are to help organisations
adapt to changes in the environment, they must participate in the management decisionmaking process, not simply implement decision made by others”. Dozier (1992:342)
maintains that “practitioners’ roles are conceptually and empirically related to participation
in management decision-making”.
Grunig (2007:44) argues, “The theory of excellence in public relations states that a public
relations programme cannot be effective unless it has a manager to manage it
strategically”. It seems there is a strong correlation between the public relations
managerial role and the two-way symmetrical model. Practitioners who only know the
technical roles may not be able to manifest a two-way symmetrical form of government
communication, which is an ideal form of communication management. Dozier (1984)
identifies a public relations manager’s role “that included attributes of problem-solving
process, facilitation as interchangeable conceptual components of the same empirical
role”.
152
Van Rule (2000:423) worries that “although staff may well have jobs at management level
within the organisation this certainly does not always mean that they perform in a
‘managerial’ way in the sense that they base their work on data acquired through research
and goal oriented planning”.
Practitioners in management functions that are involved in decision-making are able to
change management knowledge, predispositions, and behaviour than those in the
technician roles. Information about priority publics gets factors into organisational
decisions, policies, and actions (Broom & Dozier, 1986:42). Grunig and Hunt argue that
practitioners should be part of the dominant coalition. This approach is called functional
public relations because it increases organisational sensitivity to the environment and
adopts organisational behaviour that accommodates publics and their dynamic issues.
5.3.4
JOB SATISFACTION
Job satisfaction is imperative to the individual practitioner “Job satisfaction measures both
external and intrinsic components of practitioners’ feelings about their jobs” (Broom &
Dozier, 1986:43). Extrinsic components include attributes of satisfaction such as the
perception that ‘others’ recognise the value of the work, its perceived status, and its
external reward. Intrinsic components are those attributes of satisfaction that describe jobs
as personally gratifying and enjoyable activities as an end in itself (Broom & Dozier,
1986:43). Annual income, participation in decision-making, and job satisfaction represent
thee indicators of professional growth.
5.3.5
ROLE SPECIALISATION
Role specialisation is one of the most essential requirements of professionalisation as it is
likely to enhance expertise in every profession or practice. This implies extraordinary indepth knowledge and specialisation. According to Van Ruler (2000:413), “As a rule, when
a profession is in its pioneering phase everybody involved turns his or her hand to
everything. During the professionalisation phase, though, in-depth knowledge and
specialisation are able to deliver further only if differentiation is introduced”.
153
5.4
FUNCTIONS OF GOVERNMENT COMMUNICATORS
The functions of government public relations and communication management are ill
defined and thus misunderstood (Glenny, 2008:153). Glenny’s (2008) research revealed
confusions and contradictions concerning the roles and functions of government
communicators. The discord is due to divergent opinions regarding the ideal role of public
relations in general (Meintjes & Niemann-Struweg, 2009:5). Poor understanding of
government communication and public relations’ roles stem from disagreements in both
practice and literature about the roles and scope of public relations in general. Hutton
(1999) provides a more illuminating discussion of this phenomenon.
In analysing the nature and functions of government communication, Glenny (2008)
evaluated Huttons’ (1999:199-214) situational roles of public relations as persuader,
advocate, educator, crusader, information provider and reputation manager. The
situational roles mentioned are deemed appropriate guidelines for the ideals of diversity to
government communication functions (Glenny, 2008:155). Government communicators
must inform and educate citizens about policies and services. In addition, persuasion is
essential for the promotion of policies and social marketing. Through a constant supply of
information, government communicators are expected to advocate on the behalf of both
government and its subjects, which is the foundation of relationship management
necessary for a positive reputation management. However, which among these various
roles is the most important or most noble?
It is true that the responsibility for communication is delegated to the public relations or
communication department. Nonetheless, Grunig (1992:23) recommends, “in addition to
communicating on the behalf of management, public relations practitioners also should be
responsible
for
training
and
coaching
other
managers
to
be
more
effective
communicators”.
Killingsworth’s (2009) research explored the values and practice of excellent public
relations based on the principles of Grunig’s excellent theory in local government
department of Western Canada. Killingsworth (2009:62) found that government
154
communication is used to build relationships with key stakeholders such as the public
whilst other external stakeholders are relegated into secondary constituents to whom
communication is limited (Killingsworth, 2009:70). Moreover, communication is used as a
publicity mechanism and not sufficiently utilised for ‘issue management’ (Glenny,
2008:155). For that reason, the communication function of government is effective at
raising awareness of issues rather than managing them.
Killingsworth (2009:70) found that the role of communication is under-appreciated and
undervalued as per Liu and Horsley’s (2007) finding. In this regard, communication
managers are not part of the dominate coalition and lack representation in the daily
management of the department (Killingsworth, 2009:71). Communications is respected
only at a technical level and unrecognised at the management level (Killingsworth,
2009:71).
In a study to explore the roles of senior corporate communication practitioners in the
Department of Housing, South Africa, Steyn & Green (2001) questioned whether senior
practitioners heading communication directorates in government departments are indeed
playing strategic managerial roles in facilitating the achievement of organisational goals
leading to institutional effectiveness. It was found that communication directors merely
exude Dozier’s (1984) media relation specialist role of publicity. The role of communication
practitioners as managers and strategists were unobservable (Steyn & Green, 2001:1-5).
Clemons (2009) argued that very little research exists in investigating the reasons why
government communication has the propensity to be technical in practice. Clemons sought
to
determine
the perceptions
held
by government
communicators
and
public
administrators regarding the role communication management ought to play in the public
sector. The result indicated that public administrators viewed and valued communication
purely as a technical function, whereas government communicators viewed it as serving a
management role. The role of communication management in the public sector is to serve
as a link between public administrators and the publics they serve (Clemons, 2009:1).
155
Glenny (2008:155) opposes this technical dispensation arguing instead for a more holistic
communication approach inclusive of strategic functions of communication in policymaking
and decision-making. This would embrace strategic communication planning and
implementing, communication research and advice, counselling of senior management
and relationship building (Glenny, 2008:156).
According to Edes (2000:458), the typical functions of government communication
comprise of: “monitoring media coverage of public affairs; briefing and advising political
officials; managing media relations; informing the public directly; sharing information
across the administration; formulating communication strategies and campaigns; and
researching and assessing public opinion”. Some of these functions are summarised next
(Edes, 2000:458-461); (Theaker, 2004:219-224); (Lattimore et al., 2009:307).
•
Media relations- to establish and maintain effective channels of public communication
for the department (Lattimore et al., 2009:308).
•
Monitoring media coverage is one of the most important functions of government
communicators because it forms the basis to which communication strategies are
built (Edes, 2000:458).
•
Internal communication- sharing information across the administration and facilitating
internal communication with the department (Edes, 2000:460).
•
Campaigning- designing social marketing campaigns and general campaigns to
educate and encourage public’s support of major government initiatives and policies
(Edes, 2000:461).
•
Create and maintain an informed opinion about subjects with which the department
deals. Interpreting public opinion (about policy) back to the department (Theaker,
2004:219).
•
Government must maintain open communication channels with the public and
provide sufficient information to enable citizens to make informed decisions about
their lives (Lattimore et al., 2009:308).
•
Identity Management- getting the relevant stakeholder to recognise which services
are provided by which government department -who is responsible for what
(Theaker, 2004:219).
156
•
Make the public aware of their rights and obligations (Theaker, 2004:220).
Monitoring media coverage is one of the most important functions of government
communicators because it forms a foundation to which communication strategies are built.
Through monitoring media coverage, government communicators can establish which
journalists cover their beat (industry) and how the press generally represents them
(government). This allows government communicators to frame issues in a way that is
attractive to the media.
Senior government officials depend on government communicators for advice on policies
and on “facing the media in awkward or uncomfortable situations” (Edes, 2000:458).
Occasionally, government communicators encourage a workable relationship between
government officials (officialdom) and the media. However, in order to do this, senior
government communicators must have unrestricted access to top officials within their
ministry (Edes, 2000:458).
The media remains an essential vehicle through which the public is informed. In this case,
government communicators spend a significant amount of time building relations with the
mass media. Another function of government communicators involves sharing information
across the administration, facilitating internal communication with the department (Edes,
2000:460).
The role of formulating communication strategies and campaigns encompass formulating
general campaigns and social marketing campaigns. From time to time, campaigns are
conducted for the marketing of government policies to educate and encourage public’s
support on major government initiatives. (Edes, 2000: 461).
Measuring and evaluating public opinion is an essential way of understanding public
perceptions, needs, and desires. This is facilitated by formal and informal research such
as polls, questioners, focused groups, public hearings (Edes, 2000:461). Research helps
to formulate campaigns that are directed to the right section of society, addressing the
right issues of concern using the right set of communication tools.
157
Additional research is still required to further understand the role, purposes and functions
of government communicators (Glenny, 2008:165). It is essential to probe for a strategic
role of government communicators that surpasses publicity and one-way communication.
Because government communicators work in a different context with different constraints
and problems, they often face unique challenges different from their private sector
counterparts.
5.5
Edes
CHALLENGES CONFRONTING GOVERNMENT COMMUNICATION
(2000:463-464)
listed
some
of
the
challenges
confronting
government
communicators in emerging democracies. Firstly, government communicators often face
an ‘immature media’, one that lacks professionalism and ethics required for a balanced
and objective coverage of the government and its proceedings.
According to Edes
(2000:463), facts are not always double-checked and news is based on unsubstantiated
rumours and sensationalism.
Secondly, government is often criticised for a lack of transparency, falsification of
information, secrecy, and spin. These are formidable limitations to government
communication (Gelders & Oyvind, 2010:34). Secrecy hampers the ability of government
communicators to perform their mandate with poise (Edes, 2000:463). Fairbanks,
Plowman and Rawlins (2007:25) offer Cotterrell’s (1999:414) definition, that “transparency
is the availability of information on matters of public concern, the ability of citizens to
participate in political decisions, and the accountability of government to public opinion”.
Transparency entails opening up of organisation to both media and public scrutiny. Albeit
policies against state secrecy exist, their implementation, adherence to complete
transparency and public access to information are non-apparent at worst and moderate at
best. “The Promotion of Access to Information Act, (2000) was enacted to ensure access
to information held by the state and public bodies. However, despite much activity, it has
proved difficult to translate principles into practical and well-coordinated measures to
improve access to government information (Lor & van As, 2002:101). The Protection of
Information Bill and the Media Appeals Tribunal in South Africa are cases in point.
158
A study by Fairbanks et al. (2007:23) sought to understand how government
communicators value and practice transparency. It was found that transparency is rated
high amongst government communicators even if it is a concept difficult to materialise in
government (Fairbanks et al., 2007:28; Liu & Levenshus, 2010:9). This finding is
corroborated by Vos (2006:252) who established that “to make government business
transparent” was seen as the most essential goals of government communication.
A
follow-up study by Vos and Westerhoudt (2008:22-23) accentuates that government
communicators acknowledge transparency as the foundation of all successes of
government communication, such as legitimacy, trust, accountability, positive media
coverage, and public participation.
Political influence is another challenge noted by Edes (2000:464). Government
communicators are torn between being objective communicators explaining policies and
services for public understanding on one hand, and justifying and marketing the policy for
public acceptance on the other (Gaber, 2009:85-86; Gelders & Ihlen, 2010:34-35).
Furthermore, government officials expect government communicators to support them
regardless of inappropriate policies and behavioural misconduct, essentially soliciting an
‘advocacy’ role of PR.
Increases in the complexity of government policies, rules, and practices; the widening
chasm between citizens and their government; and the escalating demands made by
citizens are additional difficulties faced by government communicators (Lattimore, et al.,
2009:311).
Lack of training and skills may pose an additional constraint. Comtask (1996) found that
lack of training and skills in South Africa sometimes results in poor performance,
particularly regarding primary functions, like media liaison. Edes (2000:464) exposes lack
of training, hard work and minimum pay as plights of many public relations officers in many
government
organisations.
Education
programmes
specialised
for
government
communication is scant in higher education, which most often choose to specialise on the
lucrative
corporate
communication
of
the
private
sector,
leaving
government
communicators with no specialised differential training (Lee, 2000:216). Adding salt to
159
wound, most transitional democracies, including South Africa have no specialised
professional
fraternity
for
government
communicators
within
which
they
share
experiences, skills, and knowledge (Meintjes & Niemann-Struweg, 2009:9). This deficiency
leaves government communicators ill equipped to untangle the complicated web of
government communication.
Although challenges of government communication are worthy of concern, there are
significant measures in training and development that may alleviate some of the noted
challenges
(Glenny,
2008:165).
The
training
and
development
of
government
communicators is the next topic of discussion.
5.6
PROFESSIONALIZING GOVERNMENT COMMUNICATION
A number of researchers have sought to operationalize indicators of professionalism in
government communication. Research on professionalism attempt to explore in
measurable terms what is meant by professional government communication (Canel &
Sanders, 2012:92). An example is Gregory‘s study of British government communicators.
Gregory (2006) devised a framework suggesting that effective research, planning,
implementation, evaluation and management processes provide the platform for effective
communication activity that should be underpinned by the organisation using the
appropriate skills and competencies.
Vos (2006), and Vos and Westerhoudt (2008)
inspired by quality management literature, have designed an instrument to assess
government communication in relation to transparency, accessibility and communication
uses (roles). Sanders et al. (2011) examined the professionalization of central government
communication in Germany, Spain, and the United Kingdom applying a framework derived
from sociology at work and from strategic planning and quality literature.
Dozier (1992:64) defines the attributes of a profession as follows: “a set of professional
values, membership in strong professional organisations, adherence to professional
norms, an established body of knowledge or theory to guide practice, and technical skills
learned through professional training”. Adding to Dozier, Van Ruler maintains that one of
the characteristics of ‘management style’ public relations is the possession of a ‘body of
160
knowledge’ that enables an intellectual and systematic approach to the profession. This
implies a specialised higher education or a comparable level of knowledge gained through
experience and training.
Professionalization of government communication is an essential step towards its
legitimisation. “Professionalization occurs through certain stages, from an occupation
being performed full-time, to academisation, the founding of professional organisations,
the introduction of licensing or certification and the development of professional standards
laid down in a formal code of ethics” (Sanders et al., 2011:3). This begs the question, on
which stage of professionalization is government communication in South Africa for
example.
A study conducted by Meintjes and Niemann-Struweg (2009:1) explored the opinions held
by practitioners on the role of public relations professional associations in the processes of
professionalising the field in South Africa. It was found that overwhelming support (97%)
exists for a professional body but fewer than 10% register for professional association
such as PRISA (Meintjes & Niemann-Struweg, 2009:9). The study concluded that
professionalization in South Africa has become the responsibility of practitioners
themselves. Professionals will be judged on the merits of their ethical values, integrity,
passion, responsibility, and the quality of their work. The limitation of this study as noted by
the researchers themselves is in not distinguishing between the sectors or the working
context of the respondents.
Elmer’s (2000) study explored the nature of professionalism in government public
relations, testing Brante’s relational model as a market-based model of professional value
in the ministry of Defence in the United Kingdom (UK). The study explored ways in which
professional value is created and what constitutes professionalism. Elmer’s (2000:192)
study demonstrated that education and training was crucial for professionalism. It is
postulated (Elmer, 2000:195) that “those with a formal public relations education have
different values and expectation to those without. If we remain true to established
functional definitions, educated practitioners are more professional”.
161
Gregory (2006:200) also alludes to an interesting discussion about how education plays a
role in professionalising government communication. Meintjes and Niemann-Struweg
(2009:9) illustrates the obstacles created by inadequate education and training of
communicators. Poor strategies and application, poor writing skills, poor command of the
English language, inadequate understanding of roles and purposes, are cases in point.
Educated practitioners are deemed more professional. If education is the foundation of
professional government communication, maybe then, differential specialist education is
imperative.
Gregory’s (2006) research focused on the training and development of government
communicators in order to devise a process-driven model for government communication
in the United Kingdom (UK). Professional development and training needs identified by
Gregory (2006:200-201) include among others:
•
honing traditional skills of government communication in media relations while
exploring other avenues of information diffusion such as e-government;
•
improving standards in the recruitment, promotion and continuous professional
development of government communicators;
•
Improving the connection and interaction of all government communicators from
internal communications to stakeholder managers, e-government, marketing, and
media liaison. This would improve co-ordination, consistency and cohesion and
reduce the multiplicity of divergent voices;
•
enhancing communication strategies that meet audience and customers’ needs; and
•
Seeking professional development for government communicators.
Sanders et al. (2011) address the issue of professionalization of government
communication, exploring how the development of professionalism is expressed in
structures and processes in three Western Europe countries (Spain, Germany and United
Kingdom). This study unravels a (practice) dimension of professionalization largely
unexplored in government communication. In summary, the study concluded the following.
In an effort to formalise, professionalise, and depoliticise government communication, the
development of formal rules governing the practice and the structures of government
communication are notable in all three surveyed countries. Although, the establishment of
162
professional profiles, specialised education, and training are underway, communication
practices are still far from being fully systematised. Sanders et al. (2011:15) documented
the influential professionalising and standardisation roles of government institutional
bodies such as the German Federal Press and Information Office (Germany) and the
British Government Communication Network (UK). These are counterparts to the
Government Communication and Information Systems (GCIS) in South Africa.
Government communication budgets figures were however not readily available. This
proves to be a sensitive subject in many government departments. What was startling
about the findings was that senior positions in government communication are largely
occupied by political appointees rather than career communicators in Spain, Germany,
and UK (Sanders et al., 2011).
5.7
COMMUNICATING GOVERNMENT SERVICES
It is unfeasible to explore the distinctiveness of the public sector in all practices of
government communication. For simplicity reasons, only one flow of communication is
considered, namely communication with the public as external stakeholders. That is
external communication. Corporate reputation is about the after-effect, brand equity - the
total result of all external communication efforts. Therefore, government reputation can be
evaluated as an indicator of the overall outcome of good communication management.
The measurement and even the inference of government reputation are outside the scope
of this thesis. Nonetheless, rhetoric, identity management and media relations are
discusses as strategies towards communicating with the public. It is through the mass
media that governments construct and communicate its corporate identity. Government
communicators ought to be more proactive and persuasive in selling government
information to the mass media. Lee (2000:458) defines direct communication as an
“activity that can be performed by communicating directly with the public, instead of being
dependent on the media as an intermediary”. Social media are added as the most recent
tool of direct communication. Each of these elements is explored next.
163
5.8
COMMUNICATING THE CORPORATE IDENTITY
Organisational silence that historically prevailed is no longer possible. Organisations and
even governments increasingly operate in the public spotlight. They are therefore forced to
reveal more about themselves and justify their activities for the sake of transparency. As
they are pushed to open up, they look for ways to present an attractive face to their
constituents. The objective of a corporate identity management (CIM) is to establish and
maintain a positive reputation between the organisation and its various publics (Bick,
Abratt & Bergman, 2008:10). An organisation’s identity matters because it creates
identification as discussed in the rhetorical theory.
Corporate identity is often used synonymously with related terminologies such as
organisation identity, business identity, corporate image, branding, and reputation (Bick et
al., 2008:10). The nuances in meanings must be clarified among the identified concepts.
For instance, reputation, like corporate image, resides in the minds of individual
stakeholders (Luoma-aho, 2008:448). Reputation is developed over a long period given
that it is the overall outcome of corporate identity management, corporate branding, and
publicity
(Luoma-aho,
2008:448;
Wood,
2004:96).
Therefore,
corporate
identity
management is within the controls of the organisation, while corporate reputation is within
the prerogative of stakeholders.
The actual definition of corporate identity is still highly contentious despite the attention
given to it over the past two decades (Melewer & Jenkins, 2002:76). This leads to the
illusion and confusion of the term with regard to its usage, application, and management
(Bick et al., 2008:10). Corporate identity can be enacted through the corporate identity mix:
communication, behaviour, and symbolism. They are the means by which a company
manifests its personality. Nevertheless, there is no consensus of what constitutes the
components of the corporate identity mix and which of the three is most essential (Wood,
2004:97-99).
Governments must establish and maintain a commendable ‘corporate identity’. The reason
is that government departments are committed to all communities. Therefore, they must
164
maintain a high level of awareness in the community (Bezuidenhout & Van Heerden,
2003:6). Government services must be made highly visible and accessible to the public.
To a certain extent, branding in the public sector correlates with private sector branding
since all branding seek to maximise customers’ satisfaction and inspire confidence. The
primary reason for branding in the public sector is to render government services known
and accessible to the public (Whelan, Davies, Walsh, & Bourke, 2009:1164). The other
reason is to create awareness and loyalty to the brand that only arise from positive
associations stakeholders and customers make towards the brand (Whelan et al.,
2009:1164). An advantage of a strong corporate identity is that it enhances tolerance,
support, and goodwill for a government department (Bezuidenhout & Van Heerden,
2003:5).
The purpose of a corporate brand is to personalise the (government) organisation as a
whole in order to create value and an emotional association (Bick et al., 2008:10). This
casts a favourable halo over everything the organisation represents (Van Riel, & Fombrun,
2007:40). It is argued that a good reputation or identity will be translated by stakeholders
(various publics) into a propensity to buy that organisation’s products and services, to work
for, or to invest in the organisation (Van Riel & Balmer, 1997:342).
Brand awareness refers to how aware customers and potential customers are of the
organisation and its services. The ultimate success of brand recognition is that the brand is
well known and easily recognisable. The goal of any brand management team is to make
certain that the consumers and the public are familiar with the brand. In government, brand
awareness would have been achieved if citizens as external stakeholders were fully aware
of the government department and its services. The corporate identity mix is discussed
next.
The behavioural element encompasses internal values, corporate culture, rituals, and
norms (Wood, 2004:99). Companies reveal their identities through the initiatives they
support and behaviours they enact (Wood, 2004:99). Behaviour includes actions of the
organisation, managers, and its employees. Through interaction with stakeholders,
165
employees form the first impression which influences what customers make of the brand
which in turn shapes the external view of the brand (Whelan et al., 2009:1164).This same
experience may damage the corporate brand when employees fail to deliver on brand
promise (Whelan et al., 2009:1166).
A symbolic definition of corporate identity focuses on the more tangible aspects of identity
which are easy to manage such as graphics, brand marks, names, logos, sounds (jingles)
and corporate colours (Van Riel, & Fombrun, 2007:62). Visual images are powerful
symbols for implementing a corporate identity strategy (Wood, 2004:99). In contrast,
Melewer and Jenkins (2002:77) caution that a solitary focus on the visual aspects of
identity neglects other factors. Identity is more than the general ‘logomotion’ or visual
presentation; it includes a corporate culture, values, and morale (Kiriakidou & Milward,
2002:50).
Bezuidenhout and Van Heerden, (2003:7) study questioned the viability of creating one
unitary corporate identity for all South African government departments. However, the
study focused only on the behavioural and the visual elements without evaluating the
communication element of corporate identity. For them, behaviour is a stronger indicator of
corporate identity than any other element of the corporate identity mix. In contrast, the
proposed study focuses solely on the communicative element of the corporate identity mix.
Hence, the proposed study adopts Bick, Abratt and Bergman’s (2008:10) definition of
corporate identity as “a concept that deals with what managers want to communicate
about their organisation”.
The third element of corporate identity is rooted in the organisation’s communication
strategies, publicity, advertisements and corporate stories told. Corporate identity is a
concept that deals with what managers want to communicate about their organisation
(Bick, Abratt & Bergman, 2008:10). This includes the brand promise – communication of
the primary benefits associated with the government department, its mandate, and its
services. Much of the communication element of the corporate identity mix can be
identified from the perusal of the departments’ communication strategies and other
publicity material.
166
The objectives of branding in the public sector differ from those from the private sector. It
cannot be the same because the sectors differ in functions, scope, publics, and objectives.
Unlike the corporate sector, the public sector (and most of politics) does not have a
commodity to sell except rhetoric and a promise of service delivery. It is through the mass
media that a (government) department anticipates communicating its corporate identity.
The next section discusses media relations in government communication.
5.9
GOVERNMENT COMMUNICATION AND THE MEDIA
Lee (2000) observes that the press remains a vital channel of communication between any
public administrator and his clientele. It is assumed that the primary responsibility of the
press is to disseminate information about events and activities of government,
communicate ideas and educate the public on public policy issues (Lee, 2000:456).
Therefore, one of the most important functions of government public relations’ practitioners
is to establish and maintain good media relations (Lattimore et al., 2009:173).
Media relations (publicity) are the backbone of the public relations practice. Person and
Patching (2008:2) argue that government media relations command a serious study
because it forms an interface between an informed citizenry and democracy. The
relationship between government and the media has been a subject of a plethora of
studies (Person & Patching (2008:4). However, only a few of these studies investigate the
relationship from the practitioners’ point of view. Van Slyke Turk (1986), and Jackson and
Lilleker (2004) are some of the few studies that consider the role of government
practitioners in media relations.
In government communication, the media remains an essential vehicle through which the
public is informed. In this case, government communicators spend a significant amount of
time building relations with the mass media. On the contrary, Edes (2000:459) claims that
a contentious relationship is more apparent. A cordial relationship is advised considering
journalist and government communicators are interdependent, the former for publicity and
the latter for news feeds.
167
Journalists see themselves as watchdogs over public institutions, seeking the truth, putting
it in perspective and publishing it in the public interest (Cutlip, 1976:6). For this purpose,
stories that are accurate, fair, and balanced are covered regardless of whether they
represent government in a negative light. On the other hand, government organisations
see journalists as a medium through which to reach the larger public (Seitel, 1984:321).
Moreover, government organisations often distrust the news media for fear of prejudice
and constant negative coverage (Lattimore et al., 2009:172-174). Hughes (1995)
discusses how this discord of perception can be problematic.
Government communication dominantly expresses a process model of communication.
Hughes (1995) discusses the practical and conceptual limitations of the process model of
communication as applied to the relationship between government communicators and the
media. He proposes other models such as the semiotics and cultural studies models as
prospective alternatives to the process model.
Within the process model, a transmitter (government) sends a message through one or
more channels to a receiver (publics), upon whom the message has some effect (Hughes,
1995:1). Government communication is still treated as information transfer or as “a sender
who tries to persuade a receiver” (Gelders et al., 2007:327). Government communicators
make the mistake of seeing the media as neutral channels through which to express a
message or to exert influence (Hughes, 1995:1). This model fails to accept the media as
“active communicators in their own right” (Hughes, 1995:1).
Hughes (1995) introduces semiotics and cultural models as alternatives to the dominant
process model. Within the semiotic model of communication, there is no distinction
between transmitter and receiver. It is not only the transmitter (government) who sends a
message that the channel (media) dispatches unaltered to the receiver (stakeholders), all
participants are equally responsible in the production of meaning (Hughes, 1995:1).
Because communication requires a shared meaning and shared experiences (Hughes,
1995:2), government and the media must create a shared experience through constant
interaction, as they are equally responsible for the end message received by citizens.
168
The central assumption of the cultural model resonates with the semeiotics model on the
premise that communication is a constant struggle over the creation of meaning. This
notion was earlier articulated by Cutlip, Center and Broom (1985:359) who claimed that
“the struggle to shape and manage the news has escalated in intensity as the media’s
power and the political stakes have increased”. Thus, communication between the
government and the media not only involves shared meaning, but also contains with it,
contradictions, and contestations. However, according to Hughes (1995:3), this does not
denote a failure of communication.
Gaber (2009:86) complained of government communication inundated by ‘good news
only’. There is an over-supply of government information and a corresponding overemphasis on the positives (Gaber, 2009:86). This is called the permanent campaign. The
cult of ‘good news only’ contributes to the growing distrust of government by the media
and the public.
On the relationship between the media and government public relations, Lee (2000)
bemoaned the growing media disinterest in government news. He discussed the
despondency pertaining to the efforts of government communicators to convince the
media to run government stories. The media often accuses government news to be boring
to viewers. Lee (2000:454) found that media coverage of government is mostly about the
failure of government agencies and programmes, followed by misappropriation of funds
and corruption.
5.10 DIRECT COMMUNICATION (DIRECT REPORTING)
According to Lee (2000:454), in order to overcome the impasse of media disinterest,
government public relations practitioners should focus on improving three traits. One is
enhancing the policy of entrepreneurship role. Government communicators ought to be
more proactive and persuasive in selling government information to the mass media and
most importantly in being able to define the angle of coverage (Fairbanks, et al., 2007:24).
Secondly, practitioners must learn to talk to the media on its own terms. That is packaging
information in a way that is attractive to the mass media.
169
Governments can do public reporting directly or indirectly. Lee (2007:145) distinguishes
between direct and indirect reporting, “Indirect reporting refers to communicating efforts
through the intermediary institutions of the news media. Direct reporting focuses on nonmediated communications from the agency to the public at large”.
Lee (2000:458) defines public reporting as an “activity that can be performed by
communicating directly with the public, instead of being dependent on the media as an
intermediary”. To do so, new media technologies such as the internet prove helpful.
Although the media remains an essential instrument for information diffusion, it is
occasionally wise to approach the public directly with pertinent information. Edes
(2000:460) outlines two reasons why this is necessary. The first is that the mass media
may be uninterested in the issue and the message might be too important to be left to the
latitude of the journalist.
Government public reporting is essential for two reasons; one, for using publicity as a
substitute for regulation and having the public serve as eyes and ears of the government
department. Secondly, direct reporting is vital for providing information for information sake
in order to contribute to an informed public/citizenry. Two key elements identified to be
essential for effective direct public reporting are content and distribution. “Effective
reporting also requires significant efforts to disseminate reports as broadly as possible”
(Lee, 2008:146). Social media are useful here.
5.11 SOCIAL MEDIA AND WEBSITES AS DIRECT COMMUNICATION
“As the government breaks new grounds in Web/Gov 2.0, there is likely to be many unknowns and much
uncertainty, as well as technical, security, and privacy concerns that can have a significant impact on whether
government will actually utilise new media” (Byars, 2012:139).
Sadeghi (2012:126) projects that “companies around the world, regardless of their
location, have recognised the value in using Web 2.0 to spread the word about their
products and services as well as listen to feedback from their customers”.
Web 2.0
represents a collection of internet-based tools that enhance communication through
openness and interactive capabilities (Sadeghi, 2012:126). These tools may include blogs,
170
and social media platforms such as Facebook and Twitter, YouTube, flicker, microblogging, social networking, wikis and mashups. Byars (2012:136) claims that Facebook
and Twitter are the most used social networking platforms so they are suitable for
government communication. Web 2.0 technology continues to evolve at a very rapid pace
making peer-to-peer connectivity easier and faster. Web 2.0 is still relatively new and we
can expect to be introduced to more innovative technologies. According to Byars
(2012:131) social networking sites can be defined as web-based services that provide
users with the ability to connect share and create content.
In government, web 2.0 demonstrates “powerful examples of how internet-based tools can
enhance digital democracy and diplomacy efforts” (Sadeghi, 2012:127). In that regard,
Gov 2.0 is a term introduced by the Obama administration to refer to the government use
of web 2.0 and the adoption of social media as a government communication tool. Many of
Gov 2.0 efforts have been well received. Gov 2.0 can assist government departments
improve e-government services and to simplify online interactions with citizens. This can
improve government transparency by providing accessibility to data and online documents,
which will in turn increase government effectiveness holistically. Participation and citizen
input are vital components of Gov 2.0. (Byars, 2012:135).
Many citizens around the world have started using social media to gain new information
pertaining to government services, post questions and comments, and provide innovative
ideas to address government’s complex problems (Sadeghi, 2012:127). “It is estimated
that the average user spends about seven hours per month on Facebook” (ibid).
Government can use Facebook to engage citizens, post events and news, and shape
photos and short videos (Byars, 2012:132). Internet based technologies are increasingly
becoming go-to sources for government information.
Micro-blogging is similar to blogging. Micro blogs provide the same service although with
more limited character space to post content. “With a 140 character limit, governments can
use titter to post short and relevant messages such as a reminder to attend a meeting, or
to participate in a free-event, or take an online poll” (Byars, 2012:132). On twitter, publics
171
are free to follow departmental posts, alerts, messages and all stories through their twitter
page.
By using traditional methods of communication, many government departments are
missing an entire niche audience who use internet-based technologies (Sadeghi,
2012:127). Most governments lack a systemic plan to implement Gov 2.0. While a handful
of government departments can be found on Facebook, many have not yet entered this
social media platform. However, some have entered the platform but remains stale, some
government Facebooks are largely stagnant. The reception of social media in government
has been mixed. Some government departments have made these services a central part
of their communication strategies, while many others are ambivalent and concerned that
social media may be destructive, unruly, and unnecessary.
One of the most significant challenges in social media has to do with time. Because of the
24-hour service associated with social media networks, some government communicators
feel pressured and compelled to act on issues quickly and report outcome back to citizens
instantaneously. “Many working in government, while realising the vast potential in using
web 2.0 also assume that citizens expert them to function at a 24/7 level of availability to
respond to comment and fix reported problems” (Byars, 2012:136).
Despite the promising new that web 2.0 offers, many governments are reluctant to use
them, partly due to antiquated technologies, computers, and users. Byars (2012:134)
adds, “Another barrier has to do with fear of technology and the age of the typical
government employee”. On one hand, the majority of government communicators are
baby-boomers age between 43-63 years with very little technology training. On the hand,
the younger generation has grown up with Smartphones, ipods, iPad, blackberries,
laptops, and web 2.0 technologies. However, Byars (2012:135) is optimistic as he projects
that “as the baby boomers retire and phase out of government, it is likely that this new
generation of workers will influence change within organisation structures and in how they
collaborate with the public”.
172
Byars (2012:130) argues, “The best examples of government implementation of web 2.0
were developed with a strategy”. This Gov 2.0 strategy must identify a core team or
individual who is expected to maintain and respond to citizens’ enquiries, a right platform
must also be selected as best serving both the needs of the department and those of the
target audience. The platform must match identified outcomes. The strategy must make
account of the policies for utilisation also detailing how government communicators should
respond to negative comments, inaccuracy of information and misrepresentation of news
online (Byars, 2012:130).
5.12 CONCLUSIONS
With the purpose of discussing government communication as a practice, not only was the
concept of communication practice defined, the roles, functions and challenges of
government communication were also described. In addition, chapter 5 deliberated on the
professionalising of government communication. Practitioners’ descriptions of the practice
of government communication in KZN are presented in chapter 9, which is the findings
chapter.
5.12.1 CONCLUSION TO THE LITERATURE
There cannot yet be a conclusion to the government communication debate. It is an ongoing issue, constantly influx and responding to the dynamics of changes in the sociopolitical spheres of society both nationally and globally. Much of the literature here is
written from the perspective of the west. However, “scholars have finally realised that
some, but not all, aspects of the Anglo-European-American concept and practices of
communication management can be transplanted onto the field in Africa” (Rensburg,
2007).
Perhaps the question to ask is not only whether government communication is distinctive
and different to that of the private sector, but also whether it is distinctive and context
based. It is worth extrapolating Marsham, Skinnner and Rensbur’s (2011) debate on
whether South African communication management is indeed unique to Africa and thus
173
different to western practices of communication, which laid the foundation to the literature
discussed here? It is essential to study and evaluate the nature of government
communication in South Africa as a quest to creating our own theories and models, which
are distinctly African.
Academic researchers should embark on building an African body of knowledge of
communication management and theories based on an African philosophy and worldview
(Marsham, Skinnner & Rensburg, 2011:2). It is to this end that Marsham, Skinnner and
Rensburg (2011) inquire how should an African model of communication management be
structured? In this, it may be further extrapolated, how a model of (South) African
government communication can be framed. Accordingly, the following chapter outlines the
developments of government communication in South Africa.
174
CHAPTER 6: GOVERNMENT COMMUNICATION HISTORY AND
DEVELOPMENTS IN SOUTH AFRICA
6.1
INTRODUCTION
The purpose of this study is to explore the extent to which the distinctive communication
environment of the public sector impacts upon the nature of communication management
practiced in the South African government sector (KZN) and the degree to which this
distinctiveness is perceived and experienced by government communicators. In addition,
the study aims to examine the role of the GCIS in standardising and professionalising
government communication at a provincial departmental level. The purpose of this chapter
is to introduce the context of the study. For that purpose, the chapter discusses the
historical development of government communication in South Africa and an outline of
policies guiding government communication in the country. In addition, the status of
academic research on government communication in South Africa is described. The
second part of the chapter is the outcome of a thorough document analysis examining
government communication guidelines and policy documents in order to paint the context
and describe the nature of government communication in South Africa.
6.2 THE STATUS OF GOVERNMENT COMMUNICATION RESEARCH IN
SOUTH AFRICA
Government communication research in South Africa centres predominantly on mediated
political communication (Johnston, 2005) and political rhetoric (Van Audenhove, 2003).
Such studies are analysed mainly through discourse analysis. Another interest focus is on
political rhetoric during election periods, particularly political campaigns such as political
posters (Fourie, 2008), print advertisement (Teer Tomaselli, 2005) and the role of political
blogs (Goldfain & Van der Merwe, 2006).
Much of government communication research conducted in South Africa is predisposed to
a notion of government communication as a tool of participatory development (e.g. Msibi &
Penzhorn, 2010; Netshitomboni, 2007). The importance of effective communication in
175
promoting successful implementation of developmental initiatives cannot be understated
(Rasila & Mudau, 2012:134). For instance, Msibi and Penzhorn’s (2010) study questioned
the extent to which the Kungwini local government implement acceptable participatory
communication principles and practices in order to communicate with the local community
of which they found participatory communication to be appreciated and successfully
applied. Likewise, Rasila and Mudau (2012) attempted to create a new effective
communication model that will bridge the communication gap between the structures of
government and the community members in order to encourage sustainable public
participation.
With regard to participatory communication in governance, Mabelebele (2006), like
Netshitomboni (2007), evaluated Imbizos as a model of communication and governance
while Abibio (2007) analysed the notion of ward committees as collaborators in
participatory democracy within local governance. Another research focus in South Africa is
the analysis of the general role of the Government Communication and Information
Systems (GCIS). None of the above-mentioned themes is near exhaustion. However, it
seems that the general category of government communication research is on the decline
as compared to an uptake of e-government research, which have become ubiquitous and
a norm in South African government communication research.
Notwithstanding a vibrant government communication research in South Africa, there
remains a dire need to understand government communication from an organisational
perspective. This is because the individual government department remains responsible
for the actual transmission of government communication to the public. As such, the
practice dimension is necessary to understand the nature of government communication in
South Africa. There are a few noble studies in this area. For example, Steyn and Green
(2001) investigated the roles of communication managers in the Department of Housing.
Price and Bezuidenhout (2005) analysed leadership communication management (i.e.
internal communication) in government departments. Bezuidenhout and Van Heerden
(2003) evaluated the corporate identity of government departments in South Africa.
Haycock & Lambuschagne (2006) investigated the process of developing communication
strategies in local government (Mogale city).
176
Rasila and Mudau (2012) contend that government communication systems currently lack
effectiveness due to lack of effective models of communication. Rasila and Mudau (2012)
noted that in South Africa, all government departments and major local municipalities have
a communication unit or personnel responsible for communication. There is also a budget
in each government institution dedicated to the communication function.
6.3 THE
HISTORICAL
DEVELOPMENT
COMMUNICATION IN SOUTH AFRICA
OF
GOVERNMENT
Berger (1997) recommends that the South African government should operate from a
philosophical perspective of acknowledging the right to communicate. Entrenched within
such a philosophy, the government should aim for interactive government communication
with the public, rather that the one-way ‘push’ model of communication. For this type of
government communication to be possible, Berger (1997) offers three recommendations to
the South African government. Such is for government to boost its press liaison capacity;
improve direct communication with the public and create an enabling environment for
citizens to communicate with government by developing more avenues through which the
public may communicate back to the government.
The dawning of democracy in 1994 in South Africa compelled the ‘new’ government to
restructure the way it communicates (Rasila & Mudau, 2012:138).
In 1996, the then
deputy president Thabo Mbeki set up a Task Group on government communication
(known as the Comtask) to look into communication within government, the structure of
the media and the relations of government with the media, international communications
and other aspects of governmental communications (Lor & van As, 2002:106). The
produced report was entitled Communications 2000: a vision for government
communication in South Africa. Rasila and Mudau (2012:1398) put forth an argument that
many of the findings of the Comtask report are still applicable in today’s government
communication system in South Africa.
The Comtask group (2000:13) reported that under the old apartheid government of the
National Party, “a culture of secrecy, disinformation, and restrictions on press freedom had
177
infused government thinking”. The constitution of the ‘new’ government makes provision
for freedom of expression that requires a transparent government, a culture of
accountability and the right to know. A strong government communication and information
service can only coexist within a culture of freedom of expression and information.
Therefore, the report stressed the need for improved communication between the
government and its citizens, with emphasis on disadvantaged communities in rural and
urban areas (Lor & van As, 2002:107).
Today, the government communicators’ handbook (2011) still identifies a fundamental
need for government communication to reach the majority of the population, especially the
disadvantaged and those previously marginalised through all forms and channels of
communication. For that reason, “having communicators who are always at the cutting
edge of their profession and understanding the environment better is critical”.
With regard to government communication as a profession, early in the 1996s, the
Comtask report acknowledged the low status accorded to government communication.
The document stated that “there is poor recognition of the need for a professional
government communication and information service in South Africa”. Communication is
not taken sufficiently seriously at a high enough level. Related to this, the Comtask group
perceived an existence of a poor understanding of the role of communications and its
functions in government. The report (2000:47) advocated for the status of the profession of
government communication to be elevated:
“Whatever structural, infrastructural or other changes are made, if government in its entirety does not
develop an understanding of the role of communications, together with the political will to ensure
professionalism, efficiency and information delivery at all levels, the opportunities presented by the
new recommended system cannot be realised”.
The challenges of government communication units identified in the Comtask report
(2000:21) were that “there is no clear standard for setting budget levels or defining the
functions of the communication personnel. The line reporting structure, combined with a
tradition of rigid control of information severely hampers creativity and responsiveness of
communications professionals”. Moreover, a lack of communication and information policy
178
was acknowledged in the Comtask report. According to the report, “there is no clear policy
in relation to government communication and information in South Africa”. In addition,
government communicators identified a lack of media access and media responsiveness
as significant challenges. Poor training of communication officials, a lack of human
resources and a lack of finance were also ranked as major concerns.
On integrated government communication, the Comtask report (2000:14) bears
recognition of the interdependence of government departments and the need for balance
between its three tiers. The report provides that “the policy and practice of the new
government needs to recognise the importance of the communication and information
function within every department of state and within all three tiers of government”. The
provincial government is positioned in the middle of the three tiers between the national
government and the local government. Consequently, the provincial government acts as a
robust link between the tiers of the South African government. It is for this very reason that
the provincial government was selected for the present study.
On strategic government communication, the Comtask report identified a need for
strategies and objectives in the South Africa government communication practice. The
question of how to develop budgets, goals, and strategies needs to be visited. Ad hoc
communications is expensive and often wasteful. Furthermore, it often fails to meet targets
and reach audiences. In this regard, a more professional (strategic) approach towards
government communication was advocated. The guideline policy document titled
‘Strategising for communication 2007’ delineates further guidelines on the formulation,
processes and implementation of strategic government communication in South Africa.
On government identity management, the Comtask report recognised a failure of the
South African government to present a coherent image to the public. Government must be
seen to be transparent, accessible, and indeed part of the fabric of society. Currently
government communicates through the Public Participation Programme (PPP), formally
known as Imbizos. “During the PPP, the president, the deputy president, ministers and
their deputies visit the municipalities accompanied by premiers and members of provincial
executive councils (MEC’s) and political leaders at local sphere to listen to challenges
179
facing communities” (Rasila & Mudau, 2012:140). In South Africa, PPP are synonymous to
public participation and bringing ‘branded government’ to the people. The ‘Corporate
identity and branding guidelines’ document provides further details concerning government
branding.
On politics, the Comtask report did not mention anything regarding the relationship
between government communication and politics. The GCIS Government Communication
Handbook of 2011, on the other hand, identifies a harmonious link between politics and
the government communicator. According to the handbook, “the communicator straddles
the relationship of political administrative operations and harmonises the varying emphasis
of these two fraternities to emerge with messages that reflect their unity of purpose”.
However, the handbook also recognises a need “to make the fine distinction between
communicating government policies and improperly using one’s position to promote the
interest of a political party”. According to the handbook, government communicators are
public servants whose operational code includes impartiality and professionalism as
encapsulated in section 36 of the Public Service Act of 1994. Government media relations
in South Africa and the role of the GCIS in encouraging a harmonious relationship are
discussed next.
6.4
GOVERNMENT MEDIA RELATIONS IN SOUTH AFRICA
Much of the debate on government media relations in South Africa centres upon the
concept of the national interest and the public interest. The national interest has been
described as the “aggregate of things that guarantee the survival and flourishing of a
national-state whereas the public interest is meant to represent the interests of the
aggregate collective of citizens” (Wasserman & de Beer, 2005:199). However, the media
presume the national interest to be counter to the public interest (Fourie, 2002:35). The
question of who decides on the national interest remains the point of contention. The
invocation of the public right to know may serve as an excuse for sensationalism and
gross antagonism of the government as the media masquerades as a watchdog of the
people in power (Wasserman & de Beer, 2005:202). Wasserman and de Beer (2005:202)
180
council that the notion of the public interest can be linked to a libertarian ethic best suited
for societies with developed social, economic, and technical infrastructures.
An uneasy relationship exists between press and the government in South Africa. On the
one hand, government complains that its actions and initiatives do not receive adequate
media coverage. “Reports are often superficial, incomplete, and distorted” (Comtask,
1996:17). On the other hand, the press alleges that government communication efforts are
often incomplete, opaque, and superficial. Media complains of the general unwillingness or
clumsiness of government communicators in providing in-depth and background
information to government policies and decisions (Comtask report, 1996:17). Recently, the
GCIS 2010/2011 annual year report depicts that the GCIS increased its engagement with
the media having convened meetings with the South African National Editors Forum and
Foreign Correspondents Association to ensure that all local and foreign media were
informed of the plans of government.
The GCIS has since put together a government and media liaison programme. The
purpose of this programme is to provide strategic leadership to government departments in
an attempt to assist in the development of departmental and provincial communication
strategies informed by the National Communication Strategy (NCS). This ensures that
communication policy guidelines are used to improve government communication and that
the media is informed of government initiatives and activities. There are additional subprogrammes in support of this initiative such as the National Liaison, which promotes
interdepartmental cooperation and integration of communication to encourage integrated
planning and coordination of government’s communication programmes. The News
Service (BuaNews) provides government news and information to communities and
mainstream media, locally and abroad while the Parliamentary Liaison provides
government information to Members of Parliament (MPs) through the Information
Resource Centre (IRC). The International and Media Liaison on the other hand, are
responsible for communication at an international context.
Three direct reporting initiatives are worth noting in South Africa’s government
communication. During 2010/11, the GCIS produced and distributed 10 million copies of
181
Vuk’uzenzele magazine. It is also available as an A4 magazine in Braille and available on
the internet. GCIS translated some pages from English to other official languages to be
distributed in communities where the language is dominant. GCIS is working on a strategy
to optimise this publication. The public Sector Manager Magazine produced two trial
editions at the end of 2011. The magazine highlights work of managers in the public
sector, sharing knowledge and best practice. In attempt to strengthen provincial and local
government communication through unmediated communication and face-to-face
initiatives, the Thusong Service Centers were established. GCIS has put systems in place
to ensure that the public has constant access to information on programmes, policies, and
opportunities by opening up 4056 local development communication projects. Fifteen (15)
Thusong Service Centres were opened in 2010/11 bringing the total number of operational
centres to 165.
6.5 GOVERNMENT COMMUNICATION AND INFORMATION SYSTEM
(GCIS)
Comtask recommended the closure of the South African Communication Service (SACS)
to be replaced by a Government Communication and Information System (GCIS). GCIS
was formally launched on May 18th 1998. The Government Communication and
Information System (GCIS) is established in terms of section 239 of the constitution,
following section 7 of the public service Act of 1994. The Chief Executive Officer (CEO) of
the GCIS attends cabinet meetings and is the official government spokesperson. The
GCIS is located in the presidency and is responsible for government communication
systems mandated to communicate and inform the public about policies and programmes
of government. The new mandate of the GCIS is to coordinate communication in ministries
and government departments. This includes the establishment of a national coordinating
mechanism for officials responsible for communications.
GCIS strives to achieve professionalism, integration, and coordination of government
communication through the Government Communication Handbook and other guideline
policy documents. The Government Communicators’ Handbook is a toolkit for government
communicators aimed at assisting them to understand and implement the objectives and
182
philosophies of the central government communication. In combination, government
communication guideline policy documents provide practical guidelines to everyday and
special communication efforts of government to ensure uniformity of practice. In addition,
the GCIS provides strategic support in media bulk buying in order for government to
benefit from an economic of scale realised through coherent and centralised government
media bulk buying. Moreover, the GCIS provides media monitoring and content analysis
services for government programmes, departments, and policies. The concerning question
is whether these guideline documents are being utilised within the South African
government departments and whether the function of the GCIS is felt within provincial
departments?
The Comtask report had noted that the “SACS provincial offices operate with varying
degrees of efficiency”. Today, a very essential role of the GCIS concerns the restructuring
of provincial communications (Lor & van As, 2002:112). The GCIS runs a provincial
coordination programme support. The purpose of the provincial coordination programme is
to “strengthen the system of government communication and implement development
communication through sound stakeholder relations and partnerships to ensure that the
public is informed about government policies and programmes to improve their lives” (46,
GCIS annual report 2010/11). This function is supposed to provide strategic leadership
and advice to provincial and local spheres of government, coordinate government’s Public
Participation Programme (Imbizos) across all three spheres of government and to
strengthen intergovernmental communication alignment.
Currently, government communication in South Africa starts at the Government
Communication and Information Systems (GCIS), which is now the highest communication
office, based in the presidency. Every year, the GCIS sets the communication tone for
government. The provincial governments only develop their communication strategies after
receiving guidelines from the GCIS. Therefore, “provincial departments, districts, and
municipalities also align their communication strategies to the provincial one” (Rasila &
Mudau, 2012:139). Sanders et al., (2011:5) posit that the structure of the communication
unit is an essential determinant of the practice of government communication. For this
183
reason, the Comtask/GCIS proposed structure of communication units inside ministerial
government departments is discussed next.
6.6 THE STRUCTURE AND POSITION OF THE COMMUNICATION UNIT
WITHIN GOVERNMENT DEPARTMENTS IN SOUTH AFRICA
The reasons behind the structure of government communication is to ensure efficiency
and cost effectiveness, professionalism, political control of the communication process and
credibility and transparency (Comtask, 2000:64). The head of communications (HOC) is
appointed by minister and must operate from the ministry office. If HOC is a public servant,
he/she will be the head of communications in the departments. If hired externally, director
reports to him/here. According to the Comtask (2000:64) recommendations, the ministry
departments should author their own communications strategies and manage daily news
under the coordinating eye of the GCIS.
Government has both a duty and a right to present the case for its policies and actions and
this advocacy role needs to be strengthened. This requires that the minister take the lead
in developing and managing the communications strategy through the ministry.
Recommendation 21 of the Comtask report (2000:64) proposed for “the management and
direction of the communications line function to be transferred from the departments to the
ministries, reporting directly to the minister whose responsibility will be to determine overall
communications policy in respect of her/his ministry and department”. The minister should
be free to select an individual of the necessary seniority to act as head of communications.
The communication functions in the ministry department should report through the
ministerial head of communications who shall be directly accountable to the minister.
Close co-operation of the department director general (HOD) should be sought. However,
“formal approval will be required only with respect to his/her role as accounting officer for
budgetary approvals”.
184
Figure 1:
Position of the communication units in government departments
Ministry
MEC
Communication
Units
Administrative
Department
[HOD]
Source: Adapted from the Comtask report 1996
6.7 POLICY GUIDELINES FOR GOVERNMENT COMMUNICATION IN
SOUTH AFRICA
As already noted, the role of the GCIS is in coordinating, standardising and
professionalising government communication in the national, provincial and local tiers of
the South African government. The Government Communicators handbook confirms that
the Government Communication and Information System (GCIS) strives to achieve
integration, coordination and high levels of professionalism in the government
communication profession. In order to facilitate this role, the GCIS has developed a
number of government communication policy guidelines for government communicators in
all levels or tiers of government. The following is a summary of the government
communication guidelines policies:
•
Access to Information Manual of August 2013 – is a guide on how members of the
public can access information held by the GCIS. It describes what information is
accessible and what information has been classified. “The promotion of Access to
information Act, 2000, states that each body must designate an information officer
and deputy information officer(s) who will be responsible for processing applications
for access to information, and help applicants lodge their applications”.
185
•
Best practice guidelines for the procurement of marketing, advertising, and PR
services (2008). The aim of this policy document is to encourage diversity and
promote transformation by encouraging small, medium, and micro-enterprises
(SMMEs) to participate in the industry. The purpose is to ensure uniformity and
consistency in the implementation of government procurement policies in
outsourcing marketing, advertising, and PR services.
•
Corporate identity and branding guidelines – this policy document contains
guidelines for the use of the National Coat of Arms. The current national coat of
Arms was adopted by the cabinet in the year 2000 thereby replacing the one that
served South Africa since 17 September 1910.
•
Editorial style guide (March 2013) – this is a style guide on writing different
government communication documents and dealing with the media. It contains
language issue, grammar, and referencing styles.
•
Government Communicator’s Handbook. This is a 230-page guideline on the
practice of government communication in South Africa. The first handbook was
published in 2003 and the last (current) one was published in 2010/11. The
government
communicators’
handbook
is
designed
to
assist
government
communicators to locate themselves in the overall government communication
system. It contains guidelines on government communication, government
communication strategy, media liaison, campaign management, development
communication, marketing and advertising and the management of government
corporate identity. “The handbook also helps government communicators by putting
issues into context and providing background, easy reference tips, and practical
guidelines on issues they will come across in their daily work”.
•
Marketing communication sponsorship guidelines for government (June 2007) –
This guideline document provides a framework for government departments and
institutions who engage in sponsorship to ensure that such partnerships are held in
government integrity and the corporate image of government is not brought into
186
disrepute in the process. It defines sponsorship guidelines for use when attracting
additional resources for government programmes and initiatives.
•
Policy guidelines for South African government websites – this policy guideline
came into effect in October 2012. The policy guideline of government websites was
necessitated by the inconsistencies that existed between government websites. The
purpose is to create a seamless, consistency and unified experience for users of
South African government websites. Issues of content management, language use,
advertising, design and navigation are discussed in the policy document.
The
government website is seen as an extension of the government communication
strategy in that “it should tell the user everything about the department and what the
department does and enable users to talk to the department”.
•
Research guidelines for government communicators (Jan 2009) – this is guideline
for government communicators doing communication research. The document
emphasise that the effectiveness of government communication and the
dissemination of government information can be enhanced through the application
of appropriate scientific research processes and methodologies. The document
provides general information on approaches of research. However, very little is
presented on conducting communication effectiveness research.
•
Social Media Guidelines (April 2011) – The social media guidelines came into effect
in April 2011. The purpose of these guidelines is to create awareness of some of
the opportunities and challenges that social media presents for government
communication. The guidelines focus on guidance in the use of social media within
the South African government communication environment, in order to improve
government transparency, participation, and interaction with the public.
•
Strategizing for Communication (July 2007) – developed in July 2007, the
strategizing for communication document provides an outline of the process of
strategizing for government communication. The document identifies nine steps in
187
the formulation and implementation of government communication strategy
documents. This document is discussed further in chapter 8.
6.8 CONCLUSIONS
This chapter outlined the historical development of government communication in South
Africa. It also discussed the scholarship of government communication in South Africa. In
that way, this chapter provides the necessary context in which the nature of South African
government communication can better be comprehended. Moreover, such context is of
vital importance in understanding the foundation of the present study. The outcome of this
chapter was a thorough document analysis of government communication documents.
Document analyses was conducted for this purpose because limited scholarly studies
currently exist in South Africa to fill the role of: (1) tracing the development of government
communication in South Africa, (2) providing an overview of the practice of government
communication in South Africa and (3) and elaborating on the policies that influence and
guide the practice. It is imperative for the reader to understand the context of the research
before approaching the results and discussion chapters. The following chapter describes
the research methodologies used in the data gathering and analysis process.
188
CHAPTER 7: RESEARCH DESIGN AND METHODS
7.1
INTRODUCTION
This chapter outlines the methodology plan selected for the study. The chapter begins with
a description of the inquiry strategy and the research design, while the characteristics of a
descriptive research are explained next. This is followed by a methodology triangulation
on which the study is based. Moreover, the elected data collection methods and
instruments are delineated. The study is predominately qualitative, although aided by a
limited-scale survey. From a qualitative approach, the multiple case-study method is
chosen. The data collection methods selected for this purpose are in-depth interviews and
document analyses. A questionnaire survey of 30 respondents complimented the study by
providing quantifiable data. This mixed methodology ensures validly and reliability of the
research findings. A discussion regarding the quality of the research design concludes the
chapter. However first, the research philosophy is demarcated next.
7.2
RESEARCH PARADIGM / PHILOSOPHY
In this section, the main research philosophies guiding the research question are
presented along with their implications for the study. This study is positivist in its attempts
to verify the distinctiveness theory and constructivist in exploring the effects of such
distinctness to the practice of government communication. Although espoused by some
elements of positivism, the study is predominately constructivist as a way of ensuring
validity and reliability.
A research paradigm sets the scene for the entire study as it typically influences the choice
of methodology, tools and sample (Ponterotto 2005:128; Saunders, Lewis & Thornhill,
2009:108). A paradigm is a set of beliefs representing a worldview, which in turn guides
perception and action (Denzin & Lincoln, 2003:9; Plack, 2005:224; Saunders et al.,
2009:107). It contains the researcher’s assumptions about knowledge (epistemology). The
parameter of the study is therefore determined by the paradigm selected (Guba & Lincoln,
1994:108).
189
The positivists’ paradigm is an objective, controlled and rigid study predominated by
quantitative research methodologies (Plack, 2005:224). Here, truth is considered objective,
singular, and apprehensible. Positivists advocate a context-free, value-free, bias-free, and
replicable research inquiry (Plack, 2005:226). Hence, this paradigm is devoid of opinions,
beliefs, assumptions, and feelings. Some of the elements associated with a positivist
approach include the presentation of hypothesis, controlled experimental studies, and
statistical data leading to the verification of theory (Saunders et al., 2009:113). Positivism
typically works from a deductive methodology. This study does the same to test the
distinctiveness theory and gauge its effects on the practice of government communication.
The primary goal of positivism is not only to explain, but also to predict and control
phenomenon (Ponterotto 2005:128). A model that demonstrates the conditions in which
government communication can be distinctive, strategic, and ethical could facilitate such
prediction and control.
Constructivism contradicts the positivist research paradigm that assumes a single
objective reality (Ponterotto 2005:129). It conceives a multiplicity of reality that is not only
external but also internal (Plack, 2005:228). Primarily the purpose of a constructivist
research is to unearth and bring into surface the unconscious lived experiences of the
subject matter (Ponterotto 2005:129). Therefore, a constructivist paradigm, assumes
relativist ontology where multiple realities exist, as well as, a subjectivist epistemology
where the researcher and the respondent co-create meaning (Denzin & Lincoln, 2003). On
epistemology, constructivism attests to knowledge being comprised of multiple
interpretations that are value-laden (Plack, 2005:229).
Axiology pertains to the personal value of the researcher in the inquisition of knowledge
(Saunders et al., 2009:116). Whereas positivism assumes an objectively detached
researcher, constructivism prefers an involved scholar (Ponterotto 2005:129). Interactions
between the researcher and the object of study are encouraged as they are expected to
jointly construct knowledge. The focus of constructivism is on explaining phenomena
rather than predicting and controlling (Plack, 2005:229; Ponterotto 2005:129).
190
The trustworthiness of a constructivist research is customarily judged by positivist’s
credibility criteria of internal validity, external validity, reliability, and objectivity. However,
some researchers (Mouton 2001:410) contest the above methodologies as insufficient for
the qualitative constructivist approach. In their place, criteria such as creditability,
transferability, dependability, and conformability are endorsed (Denzin & Lincoln, 2003:35).
As for determining the trustworthiness of the research findings, constructivism discerns
multiple interpretations of data, while positivism does not. Consequently, the validity of a
constructivist research is not as accentuated as that of the positivist paradigm (Ponterotto
2005:131).
For constructivism, the trustworthiness of a study is judged by its ‘functional fit’. The latter
refers to how the findings ‘fit’ a given research project and achieves the set objectives. The
fit criteria include the contribution of the research findings to extant knowledge and the
relevance and applicability of the results to a given context (Plack, 2005:230).
Transferability is another concept usable in validating a qualitative constructivist research.
Transferability refers to the degree in which the findings are transferable from one situation
to the next (Plack, 2005:231). The research inquiry strategy is described next.
7.3 INQUIRY STRATEGY: DESCRIPTIVE STUDY
A descriptive research may be an extension of an exploratory study or a forerunner to an
explanatory study (Saunders et al., 2009:140). Explanatory studies are those that establish
causal relationships between variables, whereas an exploratory study is one that simply
explores a phenomenon. As such, a descriptive research stands at the centre of the two
above mentioned research purposes. This means, a descriptive research contains with it
the features of both exploratory and explanatory research. This is where the proposed
study is demarcated.
There has been some considerable exploration to the study of the distinctiveness of the
public sector communication environment but none of these studies are conducted within
an African context (see Gelders, Bouckart & Van Ruler 2003: Rainey 2003: Pandey &
Garnett 2006: Liu et al., 2007, 2008 & 2010). Whereas, a basic exploratory study runs a
191
risk of reinventing the wheel, a pure explanatory study is impossible considering that too
much remains unknown of the relationship between the distinct communication
environment of the public sector and the communication management practice that results.
The scholarship around this research field has not yet confirmed a conclusive causal
relationship.
Whilst the topic of study (the uniqueness of government communication) is currently
insufficiently explored in South Africa, there is an emergent research, internationally, that
provides some exploratory grounding applicable to this particular study. Hence, a purely
exploratory study is academically insufficient, yet necessary for the context of study. For
this reason, a descriptive study is proposed. In addition to being explorative, the study
takes a notch up towards the descriptive. A research project that utilises description is
likely to be a precursor to explanation, which is essential for this study.
A descriptive research aims to describe the nature of a phenomenon such as the
characteristics of the communication environment of the public sector. However, a
descriptive research may fall short of depicting correlations between government
communication and the distinctive environment in which it is practiced. Descriptive studies
cannot definitively test cause-effect relationships (Babbie & Mouton, 2001:81). This is
where an explanatory research would fill the gap. Explanatory studies build on descriptive
studies to investigate causes and reasons for the described phenomenon (Neuman,
2000:23). For example, in what ways the described distinctive features of the public
sector’s communication environment affect government communication in practice. An
explanatory research enables control and prediction, which are ultimately its goal. Neuman
(2000:22) indicates that descriptive and explanatory research has many similarities. They
blur together in practice. As much as this study is descriptive, it attempts to explain the
relationship between the internal context of public organisations and the nature of
communication management that result.
The above discussion proves that no research paradigm can claim to fully comprehend all
inquiry into human life and knowledge (Plack, 2005:226). No research methodology is
better than the other is. Each methodology is better at doing different things and answering
192
specific questions (Saunders et al., 2009:116). For that reason, a triangulation of
methodology is proposed.
7.4 RESEARCH
METHODOLOGIES)
DESIGN:
TRIANGULATION
(MIXED-
The research question primarily informs the selection of the research strategy, the choice
of collection techniques and analysis procedures, and the time horizon over which the
study is undertaken. (Saunders et al., 2009:136). The research design is, therefore, the
general plan of how one goes about answering the research question. It must describe
research strategies, research choices, and time horizons. Moreover, strategies of inquiry
connect the researcher to specific methods of collecting and analysing empirical materials
(Denzin & Lincoln, 2003).
The research design situates the researcher in the empirical world. Not only does it guide
the data collection process and the analyses of the collected data, it also specifies how the
investigator will address the two critical issues of representation and legitimation (Denzin &
Lincoln, 2003:13). Through a research design, a link is forged between the research
question, the data collection, analyses, and the research results. The research design
chosen for this study is a methodology triangulation incorporating in-depth interviews,
surveys, and document analyses.
Triangulation is the display of multiple, refracted realities simultaneously. It entails the
permutation of multiple methodological practices, empirical materials, perspectives, and
observers in a single study. A methodology triangulation adds rigor, breadth, complexity,
richness, and depth to any study (Denzin & Lincoln, 2003:8). Triangulation equates the
researcher to a bricoleur who makes quilts deploying whatever strategies, methods, or
empirical materials available (Becker, 1998:2 in Denzin & Lincoln, 2003:6). If new tools
have to be invented or pieced together, then the researcher will certainly do so. The choice
of methodology selection depends on the question asked (Denzin & Lincoln, 2003:6;
(Seidman, 2006:11).
193
Triangulation employs multiple investigators, theories and various methods of data
collection to ensure the quality and validity of a study (Plack, 2005:232). Methodology
triangulation is the use of multiple methods of data collection procedures in a single study
(Leedy, 1992:143). Another form of triangulation is the use of various theories to interpret
the same data (theoretical triangulation). Investigator triangulation is yet another form of
triangulation. The latter makes use of multiple observers to gather data. The proposed
study adopts a methodology triangulation, particularly a mixed-method entailing in-depth
interviews, document analysis and self-administered surveys. Mixed method research are
often used in ensuring validity in a predominately constructivist approach. Effective and
efficient research draws on methodologies from diverse research approaches and
traditions (Leedy & Ormrod, 2010:147).
Methodology triangulation combines both quantitative and qualitative approaches, and
may consider both primary and secondary data (Saunders et al., 2009:151). Method
triangulation is also known as a mixed method research. A mixed method research is
different and should not be confused with a multi-method research. The latter refers to the
combination of methods within the confines of a single approach, either quantitative or
qualitative (Saunders et al., 2009:153). Although, different methods can be used for
different purposes, in this study, all three methods are designed to augment each other in
answering the research question proposed in the study. A mixed-method is
complementary in nature because the limitation of one method is often complemented by a
different method (Leedy, 1992:144; Saunders et al., 2009:154). This inspires confidence in
the findings and conclusions of the study. Neuman (2000:124) puts it frivolously when he
states, “It is better to look at something from several angles than to look at it in only one
way”.
A key to the success of mixed-methodologies is thick descriptions. The researcher must
provide sufficient details of the methodology to allow the reader to make appropriate
judgments regarding the transferability and validity of the study (Plack, 2005:231-232). All
methodologies start with demarcating a representative sample for the study at hand. What
follows is a brief discussion of the sampling plan elected.
194
7.5
POPULATION
A sample is drawn from a population. In research, the term population refers to aggregates
of texts, institutions, or anything that is being investigated. A population can be very small
or very large (Deacon, Pickering, Golding & Murdock, 1999:41). Deacon et al. (1999:45)
maintain that defining a population provides a basis for deciding upon an adequate and
appropriate sampling strategy and signals how broadly the findings can be extrapolated.
The study population is delimited to government communicators and communication units
in the KZN provincial government. Thence, the findings of this study do not extrapolate to
communication units in government municipalities or ministry regional offices within the
KZN province nor does this study attempt to reflect the situation in all communication units
in the various provinces of South Africa nor the opinions of all government communicators
in the country. Nevertheless, the results may easily depict, to a certain extent, the realities
of government communication in in other provinces.
South Africa hosts about 35 national ministries such as department of education,
department
of
health,
department
of
transport,
COGTA
et
cetera
(http://www.info.gov.za/aboutgovt/contacts/ministries.htm). These ministries are in the care
of a minister and a chief director (Head of Department). Each ministry has a central office
in Pretoria (national government), provincial offices in all nine provinces (provincial
government) and regional offices in each municipality (local government). Of special note,
this research is confined to provincial ministry departments in the KZN province (in
Pietermaritzburg). It is acknowledged that the situation described in the results of this
study may, or may not, be similar to other nine provinces.
There are in overall 16 provincial (ministry) government departments in the KwaZulu Natal
province. Table 8 contains a comprehensive list of all provincial government departments
in KZN. The study profiles eight (8) departments, accumulating to half of the population
targeted, for this reason, the sample is sufficient. The sampling list is presented in table 9.
195
Table 8:
List of all KZN provincial government departments (Ministries)
6.
Economic
Development
and
1.
Office of the premier
2.
Agriculture and Environment
7. Department of Education
12. Planning Commission
3.
Arts and Culture
8. Department of Health
13. Sports and Recreation
4.
Community Safety and Liaison
9. Human Settlement
14. Social Development
5.
Cooperative Governance and
Traditional Affairs
7.6
Tourism
11. Provincial Treasury
15. Department of Transport
10. Legislature
16. Public Works
SAMPLING
This section presents a review of units of analysis chosen for the study. There are of two
categories of unit of analysis selected: eight (8) government departments (for multiple a
case study) and 30 government communicators (for in-depth interviews). Sampling
techniques usually fall under two comprehensive categories: random sampling (probability
sampling) and non-random sampling (non-probability sampling). In random sampling, units
of analysis are selected by chance; every unit of a population has an equal chance of
being selected. Non-random samples are purposively selected. The selection chance of
each unit is known, hence, it cannot be guaranteed that every unit of a population has an
equal chance of being selected (Deacon, Pickering, Golding & Murdock, 1999:41).
The units of analysis selected for this study are provincial government departments
located in the KwaZulu Natal province whose primary external stakeholders are the
general public. The identified government departments are usually at the forefront of
service delivery protests as they are considered the custodians of basic social services.
For this reason, communication with the public (citizens) is not only essential, but
mandatory. The population of the study is largely provincial ministerial government
departments in South Africa. It is nonetheless noted that the generalisability of findcings
can only be applied to the KwaZulu Natal province following a lack of representation in
other provinces. See table 9 below:
196
Table 9:
List of sampled government departments
Department
Mission statements
KZN
The Provincial Government Communication's mandate is to provide a coordinated Government
Communication service within the Province of KwaZulu Natal. It has also been tasked with
improving and sustaining a positive Provincial Government image as well as implementing the
Provincial Communication Strategy. The unit also manages and promotes the KwaZulu Natal
Provincial Government's corporate identity. It provides professional media services to the Premier
and the Department, thus ensuring accessibility of Government to the media and the
public.
http://www.kznpremier.gov.za/
Office of the
Premier
(Provincial
Communication
Service)
Mission statement: "We will lead in infrastructure development and property management in
KwaZulu Natal"
http://www.kznworks.gov.za/
KZN
Public Works
Mission statement: “Fighting disease, fighting poverty, giving hope”.
http://www.kznhealth.gov.za/
KZN Department
of Health
197
Mission statement: “To provide equitable access to quality education for the people of KwaZulu
Natal”.
www.kzneducation.gov.za
KZN
Department of
Education
Mission statement: “Our task is to develop and monitor the implementation of social policy that
both creates an enabling environment for and leads to the reduction in poverty. We ensure the
provision of social protection and social welfare services to all people who live in our province”.
http://www.kznsocdev.gov.za
KZN Social
development
Mission statement: “To strengthen cooperation amongst all spheres of government, support and
build capacity of local governance institutions, facilitate and coordinate stakeholder engagement,
in pursuance of people-centered, accelerated service delivery”.
http://www.kzncogta.gov.za/
KZN
COGTA
Mission statement: We will maximize opportunities through the promotion, development and
transformation of sport and recreation to create cohesive and sustainable communities and
enhance the quality of life of the citizens of KwaZulu Natal.
http://www.kzndsr.gov.za/
KZN Sports and
Recreation
Mission statement:
KZN
Economic
Development and
tourism

Develop and implement strategies that drive economic growth;

Be a catalyst for economic transformation and development;

Provide leadership and facilitate integrated economic planning and development; and

Create a conducive environment for investment.
198
http://www.kznded.gov.za/
The aim was to interview a total of 40 government communicators in eight KZN provincial
government departments classified by various levels of employment and responsibility.
Interviews were supposed to be held with five (5) respondents working at various levels of
government communication in each of the eight departments as follow: Head of
communication, senior communication manager, communication officer, media liaison
manager and a webmaster (social media). This would result in a total of 40 respondents (5
x 8= 40). However, a total of 30 out of the targeted 40 respondents was achieved.
Departments that did not employ a dedicated webmaster responsible for social media
platforms caused the reduction in the number of the response rate. The other reason was
due to two instances where the head of department delegated a senior communication
manager to handle the interview on his/her behalf. In such situation, the respondent
represented both the senior manager and the head of department. The sample achieved
for both the interviews and surveys is tabulated in table 10. However, this table excludes
the two interviews held with the GCIS since they did not complete the questionnaire and
were asked different questions from those answered by communicators working in
government departments. Given its purpose as a custodian of government communication,
the functions of the GCIS are different.
Table 10:
Units of analysis: Interviewees
Department
Head of
communicat
ion
Senior
Manager
Media
Liaison
manager
General
communication
officer
Webmaster
Social
media
Total
1.
Office of the
Premier
1
1
1
1
1
5
2.
1
1
1
2
0
5
Public Works
199
3.
Health
4.
Education
5.
Cogta
0
1
1
1
0
3
1
1
1
1
0
4
1
1
0
1
0
3
6.
Sports and
Recreation
1
0
1
1
0
3
7.
Economic &
tourism
development
1
1
0
1
1
4
1
3
3
30
8.
Social
Development
10 Total
7.6.1
1
9
1
7
6
6
PROBABILITY PURPOSIVE (NON-RANDOM) SAMPLING
Despite the fact that probability sampling is generally considered the best, it cannot be a
standard appropriate for all research. Non-probability sampling is generally associated with
qualitative methodologies. The most important element about a sample is that it can
provide answers to the research question (Sumser, 2001:66). Unlike their quantitative
counterpart, qualitative researchers rarely assemble a large representative sample from a
population. The primary goal of sampling in qualitative research is less concerned with
representation than it is with the relevance of the sample to the research topic (Neuman,
2000:196).
The present study employs a purposive sampling method. Purposive sampling is different
from random sampling in which every unit has an equal chance of being selected
(Neuman, 2000:197). This type of sampling allows the researcher to select special cases
that are most suitable and abundantly informative in answering the research question
(Leedy & Ormrod, 2010:147). It is for this reason that purposive sampling is also called
judgmental sampling (Du Plooy, 2002:114). Purposive sampling is more useful and
sufficient for a very small sample such as those required in a case-study research
(Saunders et al., 2009:237). A purposive sampling technique is appropriate for a subject
matter of which little is known (Kumar, 1999:163) as the case is for this study.
200
A heterogeneous sampling is best suited for this study because whilst the sample is small,
there are maximum variations within it. Each government department is different in its
mandate and services offered to the public (Luoma-aho, 2008:450). This diversity must be
taken into account. A considerable drawback of purposive sampling is its lack of external
validity. There is often a contradiction between selecting information-rich cases and
obtaining statistically representation of the population (Saunders et al., 2009:214).
Two forms of purposive non-probability sampling methodologies have been used in this
study. The theoretical sampling and the snowball sampling method were chosen. In
theoretical sampling, the researcher deliberately seeks out respondents who are most
likely to aid theoretical development by extending and even confounding emerging
hypothesis. The theoretical sampling was reasonable for this study as it was imperative to
sample government communicators working in various departments and in different
employment levels. The employment levels were categorised as follows: (A) one head of
the communication unit (referred to as head of department), (B) senior communication
manager, (C), Media relation manager/officer and (D) General communication officer.
Where possible, and highly unlikely, a web-manager or anyone responsible for social
media (E) was included. However, web-manager/social media practitioners were found
only in three departments.
Snowball sampling is often adopted for practical reasons rather than clearly identified
theoretical objectives. “Snowball sampling is mainly used where no list or institution exist
that could be used as the basis for sampling”. A snowball sample grows through
momentum whereby initial contacts suggest further contacts. Snowball sampling is
opportune in a closed nit network where entry/access is difficult and where members of the
group are secluded. In this case, initial contacts become invaluable in opening up and
mapping out tight social networks. For this study, a snowball sampling was applied purely
for practical reasons as the sampling frame was already determined from the theoretical
sampling. Thus, the snowball sample was used only to identify people within the sampling
frame.
201
The snowball sampling was indispensable in this study because the social network of
government communicators is a closed nit and access is difficult because government
communicators associate research with unnecessary scrutiny. They are habitually
distrusting of media and other evaluators. Moreover, the high degree of public scrutiny in
government means that government communicators are frequently bombarded with
requests for interviews for different reasons. This research took place at the highest level
of provincial government, so it was necessary for the researcher to be guided and
introduced by key members of the in-group.
The reason government communicators were difficult to locate is twofold. First, most
government communicators are not affiliated to any professional fraternity from which a list
of contacts could have been archived. Secondly, there is a high degree of job-hopping
between departments in the province. For instance, a media relation officer would be
identified from contacts in the website, only to follow up and be informed that the particular
media liaison officer has moved to another department, which may or may not be in the
sample frame. Because of the reasons identified above, a snowball sample as guided by a
theoretical sampling proved to be the most useful sampling techniques for the study.
What size does a sample need to be for it to be considered credible? The common sense
that a larger sample is best is often directly challenged by qualitative research. Big is not
always beautiful. This is because a lot of qualitative studies are less concerned with
producing extensive generalizable findings than in providing intensive examination of
complex human and social phenomena in highly specialised circumstances (Deacon et al.,
1999:43). Thus, qualitative research tends to use comparatively small samples than do
quantitative studies. The aim of qualitative research is not to build a large number of
similar cases essential for making broad inferences, but rather to stop gathering
information once the research reaches a point of saturation (where the data collection
stops revealing new findings and the evidence start repeating itself) (Deacon et al.,
1999:41). This study reached a saturation point at the end of interview number 20, but the
researcher continued with data collection until the predetermined sample of 30 had been
acquired. Such continuation provided validity as evidenced by repetitive data. Once the
sample was identified, data collection methods were selected and their corresponding data
202
collection instruments prepared. The next section focus on the data collection process
applied in the study.
7.7
DATA COLLECTION
This section describes the instruments and methods of data collection utilised. As already
indicated, the study employs a methodology triangulations. To this end, methods of data
collection are considered from both qualitative and quantitative methodologies. The
selected qualitative collection instruments are interviews and document analysis while selfadministered questionnaires added a quantitative element to the study.
7.8
QUALITATIVE RESEARCH
Qualitative researchers study things and people in their natural settings. They attempt to
make sense of phenomena in terms of the meanings people ascribe to them (Denzin &
Lincoln, 2003:5). Qualitative research is invaluable for under-explored research topics. In a
case where theories and concepts are not well delineated, variables are often not clarified
enough to command a quantitative study (Leedy & Ormrod, 2010:135). Qualitative
researchers posit that objectivity in the study of relationships and social structures is
neither desirable nor possible (Leedy & Ormrod, 2010:135).
Qualitative research affords the researcher the luxury of description, interpretation,
verification and the evaluation of phenomenon (Leedy & Ormrod, 2010:136-137). Three of
these characteristics are relevant to this study. First, the study seeks to describe the
elements of government communication. Secondly, this study seeks to examine the
existence of a distinct communication environment. Lastly, a qualitative approach will grant
the ability to interpret the practice of government communication within a context of
distinctiveness. Interpretation enables a researcher to (a) gain new insights about a
particular phenomenon, (b) develop new concepts or theoretical perspectives about the
phenomenon, and/or (c) discover the problems that exist within the phenomenon (Leedy,
1992:141).
203
In attempt to study, describe and understand the subject matter comprehensively, and
without omission, qualitative research employs an assortment of various data material
from case study, personal experience, introspection, life story, interview, artefacts, cultural
texts, observations, historical archives, visual texts, et cetera. The methodology of a
qualitative research may continue to evolve with the development of the study (Leedy &
Ormrod, 2010:135). However, the approach is often criticized for lack of generalizability
and for being incapable of replication (De Vaus, 2002:5). To redress this critique,
qualitative research often makes use of multiple forms of data collection in a single study
(Leedy & Ormrod, 2010). For this reason, a multiple case study was selected for this
study.
7.8.1
MULTIPLE- CASE STUDY
This is a cross-sectional study as it takes place at a single point in time. It differs from a
longitudinal study that captures data over a longer period in order to capture change and
development of a phenomenon (Saunders et al., 2009:146). A case study is valuable in
investigating a less known and poorly understood area or subject matter. A case study
examines a phenomenon within its real life context (Saunders et al., 2009:146). This
affords the researcher an understanding of the context and the processes of the
phenomenon in question. A researcher is able to collect extensive data regarding the case
study. The data collection method of a case study research may be various and all
encompassing. It may include interviews, observations, documents analysis and surveys
(Leedy & Ormrod, 2010:135). Saunders et al. (2009:146) argue that a case study is worthy
in that it provides a safe context to test, validate or falsify theory.
A particular case is selected because it is unique. Alternatively, it may be selected
because its features are comparable to similar situations (Saunders et al., 2009:146). In a
situation where a single case study is considered, one should be careful of generalising
the findings to similar situations (Saunders et al., 2009:147). In contrast, a study may
incorporate multiple cases as proposed in this study, of eight (8) government departments.
A multiple or a collective case study is a study that groups together a number of similar
cases (Saunders et al., 2009:146). A collective case study enables comparisons and thus
204
a legitimate generalisability of findings (Leedy & Ormrod, 2010:137). In addition, a case
study does not only sanction a comparison of cases with each other, but allows a
comparison of the results with those of previously reported cases (Leedy & Ormrod,
2010:137). However, the challenge of a case study research is that negotiating entry into
an organisation for conducting a case study is sometimes difficult and stressful. Some of
the issues to consider in access negotiation are explored next.
Access is a formidable impasse in organisational research and case studies in general.
Without gaining access to the primary source of data, there is no research. In addition, a
lack of access may reduce the representativeness of the sample, which in turn reduces the
reliability, and validity of the study. Access could be declined by the highest level of
management in the organisation. In such cases, the research cannot proceed regardless
of the willingness of the participant employees themselves. On the contrary, even if access
is formally granted by the organisational management, further negotiations remain to be
conducted with employees participants who reserve the power to volunteer in the research
or not to partake in it (Saunders et al., 2009:170).
Saunders et al. (2009:170) advise that it is better to negotiate access to the organisation
as a continuing process. In this, a researcher gains entry to conduct an initial part of the
data collection and then seek further permission for the next set of data collection. This
strategy proved useful for the present study. Saunders et al. (2009:170) identified some of
the factors that may cause an organisation to deny access for research to be conducted in
their organisation. One reason could be a lack of perceived value or relevance of the
research to the organisation in question. In this case, it is advisable for the researcher to
highlight possible benefits of the proposed research to the organisation. This also proved
to be a valuable strategy in gaining access. An analysis of a communication environment
provides an opportunity for government communicators to not only understand the
environment, but also, to be able to predict and control it for the enhancement of
communication performance. Access can be denied due to the potential sensitivity of the
research matter. Fortunately, the topic discussed by this study is of a professional
concern, which relatively reduces potential sensitivity.
205
7.8.2
IN-DEPTH INTERVIEWS
The proposed study makes use of semi-structured interviews. Interviews are generally
open-ended or structured. Interviews are one of the most powerful ways in which
researchers attempt to understand fellow human beings; they offer a deeper
understanding of the issues, structure, processes, and policies (Seidman, 2006:130).
Interviews generate useful information about lived experience and its meanings (Denzin &
Lincoln, 2003:47). This research made use of in-depth face-to-face interviews. Interviews
are considered suitable for this study because they are the primary way in which
researchers can understand institutions and their processes by questioning individuals
who carry out and experience those processes (Seidman, 2006:7).
7.8.2.1
Structured interviews
Interviews can be structured, semi structured or unstructured. “In structured interviewing,
the interviewer asks all respondents the same series of pre-established questions with a
limited set of response categories (Denzin & Lincoln, 2003:68). All respondents receive the
same set of questions asked in the same order or sequence (Denzin & Lincoln, 2003:68).
The interviewer works with formal interview schedules and is required to repeat the
wording of each question exactly the same way and to observe the order in which the
questions are listed (Deacon et al., 1999:64). Thus, structured interviews generally leave
little room for the interviewer to improvise as he/she advance with the research (Denzin &
Lincoln, 2003:69). The interviewer records the responses according to a coding scheme
that is already established. This makes reliability the strongest advantage of a structured
interview in that a replication of a study is possible. The drawback is that structured
interviews do not easily accommodate emerging issues (Du Plooy, 2002:138).
7.8.2.2
Unstructured interviews
Open-ended interviews accord the respondents the latitude to explain and build on their
responses, which is valuable for qualitative studies (Saunders et al., 2009:325). The
advantages of open-ended interviews are their flexibility to accommodate emerging issues
206
(Leedy and Ormrod, 2010:148). The disadvantage, however, is that each interview may
yield different results that may not fit any category or correlate with the next interview.
This research made use of open-ended questions, doing so encouraged the respondents
to expand on their own experiences. Thus, a wealth of information was obtained from indepth interviews. The researcher travelled from Durban to Pietermaritzburg to conduct
interviews with government communicators at a place of their natural settings, in their
workplace. The interviews lasted for two hours, on average. The timing of the interview
depended largely on the comfort of the interviewee. Time was extended or shortened with
consideration of the interviewee’s availability and willingness to engage further with the
study. Where the respondent seemed anxious with time, the interview was shortened.
However, it was found that most interviews started with the participant being anxious, but
once the conversation commenced, they relaxed into the discussion without being
cognisant of time.
In-depth phenomenologically based interviews resemble life-history interviewing. Openended questions are used for this approach. “The goal is to have the participant
reconstruct his or her experience within the topic under study” (Seidman, 2006:11). Given
its qualitative nature, unstructured interviews yield a greater breadth of data than any other
type of interview structures. Whereas structured interviews attempt to capture precise
codable data in order to explain behaviour within pre-established categories, unstructured
interviews aim to understand the complex behaviour of a phenomenon without imposing
any priori category that may confine the inquiry (Denzin & Lincoln, 2003:75). The purpose
of in-depth interviewing is to get answers to questions, and not to test hypothesis
(Seidman, 2006:8). Some renowned researchers offer guidelines to appropriate and
effective in-depth interviews:

Accessing the setting: the researcher must find an insider, an associate who is an
admired member of the in-group under evaluation, someone willing to be an
informant. The associate would act as a guide and a translator of cultural mores
and, at time, jargon or language (Denzin & Lincoln, 2003:77). The identified allies
207
for the study were the KZN director of Provincial Government Communication and
the director of KZN GCIS. They ushered the process of entry and introductions.

Seidman (2006:7) warns that at the heart of every interview is an interest in other
individuals and their experiences. This requires the interviewers to keep their egos
in check. To remember that it is not about them but the interviewees.

Gaining trust: the interviewer must cultivate trust with the respondents. Gaining trust
is essential to the success of the interviews (Denzin & Lincoln, 2003:77). However,
establishing rapport is risky as the researcher could possibly go native, and start
acting as a representative of the subject group. This researcher managed to
maintain the academic distance required for objectivity.

Avoid leading questions: leading questions are those that may influence the
direction of the responses. Seidman (2006:84) recommends open-ended questions
that set the scene while allowing participants to take any direction they want. Such
has been done for this study.

Collecting empirical material: researchers must take notes regularly and promptly.
They should write everything down and analyse their notes frequently. (Denzin &
Lincoln, 2003:79). This researcher kept notes of emerging issues and observable
data.

Elaboration and digression: structured interviews can only deliver answers to the
questions asked. They do not allow the researcher to trawl around for new issues
(inductively). Unstructured interviews, on the other hand, do not impose restrictions
upon the interviewer and the interviewee. Although the interview guide was followed
in its entirety as to accommodate some deductive issues essential for theory
verification, the interviewer was given enough space, courage, and time to discuss
any other issue of concern within the overall theme of the research (government
communication). Thus providing a wealth of inductive data.
208
The interview structure generally trailed the intuition of the interviewee by allowing him/her
to jump from section to section, thus making the interview as natural a conversation as
possible. However, Deacon et al. (1999:69) caution, “interviewees might spend so much
time talking about the things that interests and concern them, that they never adequately
address the issue that concern the researcher”. In the beginning, this seemed to have
been an issue of concern, but later it was established that most of the inductive data
emerged from nonchalant discussions about government communication and the
individual experiences of communicators. As the data reached saturation, these emerging
issues started to repeat themselves as reiterated by other respondents. Some of these
issues would have never emerged from direct structured interviews because they were not
yet identified by prior research, theory and literature.
No matter how organised a researcher may be, he or she slowly becomes buried under an
increasing amount of field data. Research based on in-depth interviews is labour intensive.
Seidman (2006:112) explains the demands:
“Keeping track of participants through the participant information forms, making sure that written
consent forms are copied and filed in a safe place, labelling audio types of interviews accurately,
managing the extensive files that develop in the course of working with the transcripts of interviews,
keeping track of decision points in the entire process all requires attention to details”.
According to Seidman (2006:113), it is difficult to separate the process of gathering and
analysing data. Some researchers claim that the two stages of gathering and analyses
should be integrated in order to inform each other. In most cases, interviews would be
held, then the researcher would analyse them before formulating new questions as a
results of what had been found, then further interviews would be conducted. In contrast,
this study avoided all in-depth analyses until all interviews data was collected so as to
avoid imposing meaning to interviews. Nonetheless, after each interview, the researcher
made a list of follow up questions to probe further in subsequent interviews.
In order to help the researcher establish enough information to ask appropriate questions
in the survey questionnaire, often interviews are held prior to a survey research. It was
planned that the researcher will conduct in-depth interviews after the analysis of the survey
209
in order to identify some patterns and issues to explore further in the interview sessions.
However, because of time constraints, both data clusters were collection concurrently.
Surveys were administered during the interview session. Questionnaires aided in obtaining
quantitative
information
about
the
opinions
and
experiences
of
government
communicators, while in-depth interviews explored deeper into those opinions and lived
experiences.
Barbour and Kitzinger (1999:11) claim that people are more likely to attend in-depth
interviews that take place in a familiar venue. For that reason, all interviews were
conducted at government departments during the most convenient time for the
respondent. In-depth interviews are easier to conduct with a group of respondents that is
already sympathetic to the issue at hand. This study dealt with the most concerning issue
for government communicators, which had received little attention before. The significance
of this study to government communicators optimally increased participation in the study.
7.8.3
DOCUMENT ANALYSIS RESEARCH METHODOLOGY
Document analysis is a remnant of content analysis. According to krippendorf’s (1980:21)
definition, “content analysis is a research technique for making explicative and valid
inference from data to their content” (in Fico, Lacy & Riffe, 2008:119). By analysing the
content, we can make a number of inferences about the people and organisations and
even the environment that helped to produce the content (Wigston, 2009:4). A clearer
definition of quantitative content analysis is provided by Wimmer and Dominick (2012:158)
who maintain that “content analysis is a method of studying and analysing communication
in a systematic, objective, and quantitative manner for the purpose of measuring variable”.
According to Bowen (2009:27), document analysis is a systematic procedure for reviewing
and evaluating both printed and electronic documents. Documents that may be reviewed
for research analyses may take a variety of forms such as organisational or institutional
reports, public records or press releases. Through document analysis, researchers can
examine how organisations have documented their activities, strategies and decisions
(Deacon et al., 1999:14).
210
For the purpose of this study, government department’s communication strategy
documents were analysed. Like other analytical methods in qualitative research, document
analysis require that the data be examined and interpreted in order to elicit meaning, gain
understanding and develop empirical knowledge (Bowen, 2009:27). Documents are
produced by individuals and groups in the course of their everyday practices and are
created exclusively for their own immediate practical needs (Mogalakwe, 2006:222). They
are therefore credible sources of data. Documents are unobtrusive and non-reactive. This
means they are unaffected by the research process. The presence of the researcher does
not alter the subject of study and stability of documents makes them suitable for repeated
reviews.
Document analysis is usually used in combination with other qualitative research methods
as a means of triangulation (Bowen, 2009:27). Nonetheless, document analysis are
equally used in a single methodology study as a stand-alone method. Document analysis
is particularly applicable to qualitative case studies as they offer data about the context
within which participants operates. Much can be learnt from taking into account internal
documentations (Deacon et al., 1999:14).
For Bowen (2009:30-31), the purpose of documents analysis is to provide background and
context, supplementary data, a means of tracking change and development, and
verification of findings from other data sources. Documents provide background
information as well as historical insight. The researcher may use data drawn from
documents in order to contextualise data collected during the interviews. Moreover,
information contained in documents may suggest additional questions to be explored in
subsequent
parts
of
the
triangulation
process.
Furthermore,
documents
add
supplementary data as they are able to verify findings from other data sources. Therefore,
documents analysis contributes richly to the data reservoir.
Some of the limitations of document analysis are that they provide insufficient details
because such data is not produced with the research agenda in mind. In this case, the
researcher should be prepared to search for additional documentation in order to fill in the
gaps. The other challenge is in the low irretrievability of documents (Bowen, 2009:31).
211
Organisations do not welcome researchers probing behind their carefully constructed
public relations front (Deacon et al., 1999:15). Therefore, studies that draw upon
documentation are obviously constrained by the quality of what is available. Additionally,
document analysis requires reflexivity, which requires awareness or an acknowledgement
of the possibility of the investigator’s influence on the research (Bowen, 2009:30). This
study mitigated the challenges because (1) communication strategy documents were
mostly comprehensive and detailed, (2) government departments willingly supplied the
documents and (3) the researcher maintained a high degree of objectivity in the analysis of
the documents. In addition, the documents were analysed following the themes found in
the interview data.
7.9
QUANTITATIVE METHODOLOGY: SURVEY QUESTIONNAIRES
Quantitative research produces measurable mathematical analysis (Leedy, 1992:143).
Albeit without depth, quantitative research can assist in understanding a wider aspect of
the subject matter, (Babbie & Mouton, 2001:51). They illuminate information about the
experiences, opinions, and characteristics of the subject matter (Neuman, 2000:246). The
researcher starts with a conceptual research question and ends up with quantifiable
empirical results suited for data comparison (Saunders et al., 2009:144). Self-administered
surveys are the quantitative methodology employed in this study. Due to limitation in data
quantity (30 surveys), the quantitative methodology employed here is not meant to offer
generalisation of data but rather to quantify the qualitative themes, patterns and responses
gathered from qualitative data (interviews and documents).
Surveys are used in this study as one of the three methods of data collection. Survey
research (questionnaires) is inherently quantitative and positivist in nature (Da Vaus,
2002:5). A draft of the questionnaire is included as Appendix A. One of the major
advantages of questionnaires is width and breadth. A larger pool of a population may be
sampled in a questionnaire survey (Saunders et al., 2009:144). Another advantage is the
inherent guaranteed anonymity to respondents (Leedy and Ormrod, 2010:189).
212
Electronic mail (e-mail) were used to distribute the questionnaires. E-mail surveys provide
speed and are cost effective. An interactive questionnaire can be sent as an email
attachment, answered, and retuned by email (Da Vaus, 2002:123). In addition, the
researcher can send reminders to non-respondents. This may improve the response rates.
The disadvantage of e-mail surveys is their dependency on the availability of computers
with internet and their proclivity to yield low responsiveness. This was problematic for the
study as government communicators did not respond to requests are reminders to
complete the online questionnaire. For this treason, questionnaires were delivered (by the
researcher), completed, and returned on the day of the interview by the interviewee. This
ensured that the same person being interviewed also completed the surveys for correlation
between the qualitative and quantitative data.
The major disadvantage of questionnaires is a low return rate (Saunders et al., 2009:144).
This may reduce the validity of the results. Neuman (2000:267) discusses some of the
reasons behind the growing trend of low response rate to surveys. Some of the factors
discussed are, an overload of surveys, insensitive researchers and inadequate
explanations of the importance of the survey and inadequate directives on responding to
the survey (Neuman, 2000:267). Questionnaires can be an invaluable data collection
instrument if the above pitfalls are acknowledged and accounted for. As mentioned, this
study accounted for these pitfalls by delivering the questionnaire in person, and having it
completed by the respondent on the day of the interview. As a result, a 100 percent return
rate was achieved.
7.10
DATA ANALYSIS
It was previously unnecessary for qualitative researchers to explain how they analysed
their data (Neuman, 2000:417). Recently, a detailed account of the data analysis process
has become an expected feature in all qualitative research projects.
213
7.10.1 DATA CODING
Coding data for qualitative research implies that the researcher organises the raw data into
conceptual categories and creates themes or concepts, which he or she then uses to
analyse data (Neuman, 2000:420). According to Neuman’s (2000:429) definition, “codes
are tags or labels for assigning units of meaning to the descriptive or inferential information
complied during a study”. Codes are usually attached to chunks of varying sizes, words,
phrases, sentences or paragraphs. A question to ask in terms of coding is what counts as
a theme. A theme is a collection of data collated into a category of related information,
which captures patterns within the data (Braun & Clarke, 2009:83).
Both a deductive and inductive approach was used in the coding of this data. A number of
features resembling a distinct communication environment of the public sector were
identified from literature (see chapter 2). A deductive data analysis approach is best suited
to test theories, features, and variables (Saunders et al., 2009:489). A deductive approach
signals that the researcher already has ideas about how the world operates and would
want to test these ideas against ‘hard data’ (Neuman, 2000:49). This approach is
instrumental in investigating the existence of the proposed features of public sector
communication environment and their likely impacts on government communication
practices in South Africa. In a deductive analysis, the pre-existing theory (e.g the
distinctiveness theory) provides the empty boxes to which the researcher gathers evidence
to fill them.
Using an inductive method on the other hand revealed emerging issues, themes and
features of the public sector communication environment that were not previously
identified in extant literature. Thus, coding of the data was conducted without trying to fit it
into any pre-existing coding frame (Braun & Clarke, 2009:83). An inductive study builds the
theory from the ground up by refining concepts, developing empirical generalisations and
identifying preliminary relationships (Neuman, 2000:49). Once the data was coded, the
codes were merged into themes.
214
7.10.2 THEMATIC ANALYSIS
Thematic analysis is a dominant method for the analysis of qualitative data. According to
Braun and Clarke (2009:79), “Thematic analysis is a method for identifying, analysing and
reporting patterns (themes) within data”. Thematic analysis is seldom seen as a distinct
data analysis method. On the contrary, Braun and Clarke (2009:79) contend that thematic
analysis should be treated as a methodology in its own right. One of the benefits of
thematic analysis is flexibility. As mentioned, themes or patterns within the data can be
identified in one or two ways: inductively or deductively. A deductive approach can
generate unanticipated insights and themes while an inductive approach sources the
themes from the data themselves. Braun and Clarke (2009:84) outlined steps involved in
conducting a thematic analysis. These are illustrated in table 11 below:
Table 11:
Phases of thematic analysis
PHASE
1. Familiarizing yourself
with your data:
2. Generating initial codes
3. Searching for themes:
4. Reviewing themes:
DESCRIPTION OF THE PROCESS
Transcribing data (if necessary), reading and re-reading the data, noting down initial
ideas.
Coding interesting features of the data in a systematic fashion across the entire data
set, collating data relevant to each code
Collating codes into potential themes, gathering all data relevant to each potential
theme.
Checking if the themes work in relation to the coded extracts (Level 1) and the entire
data set (Level 2), generating a thematic ‘map’ of the analysis.
5. Defining and naming
themes
Ongoing analysis to refine the specifics of each theme, and the overall story the
analysis tells, generating clear definitions and names for each theme
6. Producing the report
The final opportunity for analysis. Selection of vivid, compelling extract examples, final
analysis of selected extracts, relating back of the analysis to the research question
and literature producing a scholarly report of the analysis.
Source: (Braun & Clarke, 2009:83).
7.10.3 ANALYSIS OF QUESTIONNAIRES OF LIMITED SCALE
Data analysis refers to a search for patterns in data such as recurrent behaviour, objects,
or a body of knowledge (Neuman, 2006:426). Because this study incorporated a surveys
of a limited scale (30 questionnaires), there was no need to use computer programmes
such as SPPS to analyse the content of the questionnaire. An Excel modelling programme
was used to quantify responses of each question. A percentage was then calculated for
each question. Please refer to a copy of the survey in the appendix.
215
7.10.4 ANALYSIS OF INTERVIEW DATA
The difficulty of interview data emanates from the question of how to analyse the
transcripts once the interviews are completed. Semi-structured, in-depth, interviews were
conducted and the interviews recorded on the audio recording. The audio were transcribed
in full. The data analysis of interviews was modelled from Burnard’s (1991) method of
analysing interview transcripts in qualitative research:
 Stage 1 - For this study, throughout the research project and during the data
collection process, notes and memos were kept. The researcher recorded
everything that seemed important or intriguing about the interview, the environment
(observation) and the actual notes of the interview session. The researcher
transcribed the audio interviews using verbatim, taking into account all verbal and
non-verbal signals such as pauses, coughs, and laughs. Albeit time consuming,
interviewers who transcribe their tapes come to know their interviewees and
understand the data better (Seidman, 2006:115). This was achieved.
 Stage 2 - The aim of stage two is to immerse oneself in the data. This allowed the
researcher to enter the participants’ frame of reference and to perceive the livedexperience of the respondent and his environment.
 Stage 3 - Transcripts were read thoroughly. Codes were determined by marking as
many headings as necessary to describe all aspects of the content. At this point, all
data were coded. Those un-coded were given interim headings. Both deductive and
inductive coding were used at this stage. Mostly open coding were used for the
inductive coding while distinctive features were sought deductively from the data. In
open coding, the researcher locates themes and assigns initial codes or labels in
first attempt to condense the mass into categories (Neuman, 2000).
 Stage 4 - In stage four, the list of categories (codes) were surveyed by the
researcher and then grouped together into higher-order headings (themes). “The
aim, here is to reduce the number of categories by collapsing some of the ones that
216
are similar into broader categories” (Burnard, 1991:461). Stage four made use of
axial coding where the researcher evaluates whether the codes and themes have
some conceptual and structural order. During this axial coding, some themes were
discarded, while others were explained further.
 Stage 5 - The new list of categories and sub-headings was reworked through and
repetitious or very similar headings were merged to produce a final list.
 Stage 6 - In stage six, two colleagues are supposedly invited to code the data
independent of each other and without seeing the researcher’s list. This enhances
validity by eliminating researcher’s bias. For the present study, this stage was done
by re-coding the data again, this time purely inductively, without any categories or
list of issues. Different codes and themes emerged from the data. Much of the
emerging issues were not anticipated or even conceived by the researcher. This
stage was a useful one.
 Stage 7 - Transcripts were meticulously perused to establish if the final list of codes
and themes covers all aspects of the interview data. No oversights were detected.
 Stage 8- Each transcript was worked through with the list of categories and subheadings and then the script was coded according to the list categories (themes).
 Stage 9 & 10 - In these stages, the data was cut into pieces and all elements of
each code were collated together in one separate document. The researcher ended
up 23 different documents, each containing data of one theme and several subthemes relating to the overall theme.
 Stage 11 & 12 - Respondents were asked to check the validity of categories in
which their quotations appear. In stage 11, all sections were filed together for direct
reference during the writing process. Everything was kept; the original transcript
was kept clean for rechecks in order to prevent distortions in data interpretation.
Seidman (2006:114) advises that “preserving the words of the participants, (means
217
that) researchers have their original data. If something is not clear in the transcripts,
the researcher can return to the source and check for accuracy”.
 Stage 13 - In the last pass through the data, the major themes of the research
should already be identified. The purpose here is to look for evidence in all
categories of themes that support the major argument/theme/focus (Neuman,
2000). Once all sections were aligned together, the writing process began. Each
theme was analysed selecting various examples from the data to offer ‘verbatim’
(direct quotations) that exemplifies the theme. The researcher continued until all
sections were done.
 Stage 14 - The data findings were separated from the data analyses. This meant
that the results and the commentaries (analysis) were kept separate, each within its
own chapter. Such separation arguably lessens researcher’s bias.
7.10.5 ANALYSING OF COMMUNICATION STRATEGY DOCUMENTS
The basic two types of document analysis are qualitative and quantitative document
analysis. Whereas quantitative document analysis focuses on counting content in a
rigorously scientific method, qualitative document analysis in contrast contains very little
physical counting and does not attempt to be positivist in its approach. Quantitative data
are usually numerical in value or frequencies. Quantitative document analysis is
reductionist in nature as it reduces communication phenomena into manageable data
(Fico et al., 2008:119). Quantitative document analysis is particularly useful when the
volume of documentary evidence is beyond the investigator’s capacity for examination
(Fico et al., 2008:120). According to Wigston (2009:5), quantitative document analysis
proves more useful for examining manifest messages while qualitative document analysis
is preferred for analysing latent messages. Because, this study sought to examine
manifest and latent messages in communication strategy documents, qualitative document
analysis was employed.
218
The analysis procedure entailed in document analysis entails “finding, selecting,
appraising (making senses of), and synthesizing data contained in documents. Document
analysis yields data – excerpts, quotations, or entire passages – that are then organised
into major themes, categories, and case examples specifically through content analysis”
(Bowen, 2009:28). Following Scott (1990:1-2), Mogalakwe (2006:224-5) identifies the
following quality control criteria for handling documentary sources:
“Authenticity refers to whether the evidence is genuine and from impassable sources;
credibility refers to whether the evidence is typical of its kind, representativeness refers to
whether the documents consulted are representative of the totality of the relevant
documents, and meaning refers to whether the evidence is clear and comprehensible”.
Documents analysis involves skimming (superficial examination), reading (thorough
examination), and interpretation (Bowen, 2009:32).The analysis of documents may take
the form of content analysis and thematic analysis. Content analysis is the process of
organising information into categories as guided by the research question (Deacon et al.,
1999:17).
Thematic analysis is a form of pattern recognition within the data, demonstrating emerging
themes from the document. Thematic analysis requires data coding and category
construction. Bowen (2009:32) advises that in thematic studies, “Predefined codes may be
used, especially if the document analysis is supplementary to other research methods
employed in the study”. Following this advice, predefined codes and themes were
established from the interview findings.
The foremost requirement of document analysis is not the quantity of documents selected
for analysis, but rather the quality of the documents. “When documents are being used for
verification or support, however, even a few can provide can effective means of completing
the research” (Deacon, et al., 1999:26). This study evaluated eight communication
strategy documents. The number is sufficient for a triangulated study. The following
section discusses the credibility standards achieved in this study.
219
7.11
ASSESSING AND DEMONSTRATING THE QUALITY AND RIGOUR
OF THE PROPOSED RESEARCH DESIGN
Reliability ensures that measures are stable and consistently produces the same results
(Du Plooy, 2002:121). This means similar observations are reached by other researchers
who replicate the study in a similar context (Saunders et al., 2009:156). Moreover, there is
transparency in how conclusions were drawn. A researcher must attempt to reduce threats
to reliability such as participant bias and observer bias. Participant-error refers to
inconsistence of results from the participants while observer-error refers to inconsistency
of data capturing and analysis by the researcher (Saunders et al., 2009:156). Internal
reliability refers to inter-observer consistency in coding the in a uniform, consistent and
systematic way. External validity refers to the degree to which findings can be generalised
and replicated (Mouton, 2001:410). External reliability is difficult to ascertain in a
qualitative research (Mouton, 2001:410).
Du Plooy (2002:124) argues that “a measure cannot be valid unless it is also reliable”.
Validity refers to the degree to which a methodology adequately measures what was
intended to calculate (Du Plooy, 2002:124). Saunders et al. (2009:157) opine that validity
is particularly relevant in a causal relationship. There must be absolute truth in suggesting
that x causes y or that x and y are related. Validity does not concern qualitative
researchers because they value authenticity rather than validity. For them, authenticity
(Neuman, 200:171) is achieved by giving a fair, honest, and balanced account of a
phenomenon from the perspective of those who experiences it. The proposed research
attempts to achieve authenticity in its quest to explore the distinct communication
environment of the public sector in which government communication is embedded.
Authenticity is mainly promoted by a high degree of research ethics to which we turn next.
7.12
RESEARCH ETHICS
Leedy and Ormrod (2010:101-104) caution that whenever human beings are observed as
objects of study, ethical conduct should be considered. Nevertheless, the same standard
of ethics should be maintained when investigating organisations. Saunders et al.
220
(2009:183) define research ethics as the appropriateness of behaviour of the researcher
towards his object of study. The value of any research is in the honesty and integrity of its
findings. With all ethical implications considered, this researcher conformed to the
following ethical standards:
•
Permission for government communicators to participate in the proposed study was
sought from the managing echelons of the selected government department. In this,
a full disclosure of the purpose and intentions of the study were offered. Appendix B
contains a draft of the informed consent form used.
•
The findings of the research were accessible by all participants seeking them.
•
Voluntary participation to the study was encouraged and the participants reserved
the right to withdraw from the study if the need arises.
•
No financial or bribery incentives were granted to the participants prior to, or following
their contributions to the study.
•
All contributions made towards this study remain anonymous and confidential unless
the participant wished otherwise. In which case, permission of disclosure was
granted in writing.
•
The researcher remained objective and honest to ensure that no falsification of data
or misrepresentation of findings occurred.
•
The researcher’s objectivity, honesty and integrity guided the data analysis pertaining
to this study.
Denzin and Lincoln (2003:13) counsel, “Because the objects of inquiry in interviewing are
human beings, researchers must take extreme care to avoid any harm to them”. Ethical
concerns in interview data have traditionally revolved around issue of anonymity, informed
consent and right to privacy. Informed consents were submitted by the respondents after
they had been carefully and truthfully informed about the study and its purpose. Ethics are
intrinsic to the constructivism paradigm because of the inclusion of the participants’ values
in the inquiry. “The close personal interactions required by the methodology may produce
special and often sticky problems of confidentiality and anonymity” (Guba & Lincoln,
1994:115). These concepts are discussed next.
221
7.12.1 CONFIDENTIALITY AND ANONYMITY
Issues of confidentiality and anonymity are essential when government is the subject of
study. Wiles, Crow, Heath and Carles (2008) are of the opinion that confidentiality is
underpinned by the principle of respect for autonomy and is taken to mean that identifiable
information about individuals collected during the process of research will not be disclosed
without permission. This demonstrates that the concept of confidentiality has become
closely interwoven with anonymity. Anonymity is one way in which confidentiality is
operationalized. Confidentiality means, “not disclosing any information gained from an
interviewee deliberately or accidentally in ways that might identify an individual” (Wiles et
al, 2008:417).
Wiles et al. (2008:423) argue that protecting peoples’ identities is challenging for
organisational research because identifying an organisation may shed light into the
identities of its members. Wiles et al. (2008:423) noted that peoples’ stories can be very
specific and that simple anonymisation, or even changing key characteristics is not
sufficient to avoid their identities being disclosed.
Ensuring anonymity was challenging for this study because the
sample of the
interviewees contained purposely selected government communicators, at various
employment levels, working in various government departments in the KwaZulu Natal
provincial government. This meant that identifying an organisation or the level of
employment would automatically identify the participant by default. This made it ethically
cumbersome to identify the eight departments that participated in the study and the
employment title of the respondents. At the same time, such identifications were mandated
for comparison across departments and across levels of employment of government
communicators. To protect the identities of the participants, such comparisons were
refrained unless necessary. In such cases, where the data cannot be omitted altogether,
key characteristic were altered to ensure the anonymity of the respondent.
In conclusion, chapter seven outlined the research design founded by a triangulation of
methodologies, containing both qualitative and quantitative methodologies. This study is
222
predominately constructivist, aided by positivism. For this reason, a multiple case-study
method was nominated. Interviews and document analysis are excellent qualitative
methods for case studies. Surveys of limited scale helped to quantify the data.
Questionnaires were administered immediately following each interview session. This
strategy ensured a 100 percent return rate. However, such strategy is not feasible in
administering surveys of a broader scale. Chapter 8 discusses data emanating from
document analysis of government communication strategy documents.
223
CHAPTER 8: REVIEWING
STRATEGY DOCUMENTS
GOVERNMENT
COMMUNICATION
8.1 INTRODUCTION
This chapter contains a preliminary response to research objective four (4) that aims to
examine the link between government communication policies, strategies, and government
communication practices. The purpose of this chapter is to understand the policy and
strategies that guide the practice of government communication in South Africa. The actual
practice of government communication in the KZN province is detailed in chapter 9.
Chapter 8, on communication strategies, and chapter 9 on practice, are synthesised in
chapter 10 (discussion and conclusions) in order to interpret the usage of communication
strategy documents in the actual practice of government communication. In this section,
eight government communication strategy documents are analysed. Within the eight (8)
government departments that participated in this study, six departments claimed to have
approved communication strategy documents (table 12). Two departments reported that
they had draft communication strategies that were not yet approved by management.
Table 12:
Availability of communication strategy documents
Department
Availability of communication strategy
Office of the premier
Yes – document provided
Sport and recreation
No- a draft strategy was compiled in 2007, but it has not yet been accepted by senior
management of the department (Not approved)
Cogta
Yes I do- We have a strategy to communicate how government is performing on those
mandates.
Health
Yes, it was developed for year 2011-2012
Public works
Currently we don’t have an approved communication strategy. We do have a draft strategy
which is under review as we speak. We are trying to revive this one. (Not approved)
Education
We are developing a communication strategy and policy for the department of education
because we have been operating without one.
Economic
and
Tourism
Yes we do have a communication strategy linked to our communication policy for the
Development
department.
Social development
Yes, I do. (document not provided
224
8.2 THE
ALIGNMENT
OF
DEPARTMENT
COMMUNICATION
STRATEGIES WITH THE GCIS PROVINCIAL STRATEGY
In addition to the actual analysis of government communication strategy documents, this
section examines the procedures and the processes involved in their development. Hence,
sections 8.2 to 8.5 are based on the results from the interview sections while the rest of
the chapter reports on document analysis of government communication strategy
documents.
It was essential to evaluate the extent of alignment between government departments’
communication strategies with the provincial GCIS strategies. All departments claimed that
their communication strategies were to a certain extent aligned with the GCIS provincial
communication strategy: “It (communication strategy) is very much aligned with the GCIS
communication strategy; we use policies and acts from the legislative framework of the
GCIS”.
Some practitioners also claimed that their communication strategies are aligned with the
national government strategy, which is standardised for five years. The Head of Provincial
Communication had articulated, “I develop communication strategies which are particular
to KZN but still informed by the central GCIS national strategy. They are interpreted from
that five (5) year strategy” (R1). Respondents concur on the notion that government
departments’ communication strategies should take into account the national government
strategy because it determines where government as a whole is going: “The strategy for
the province depends on the priorities set by the national department. Our strategy has to
be aligned with that one (national strategy)”. A senior communication manager of another
department explains, “I operate on a five year communication strategy which is informed
by the priorities of government which are education, health, rural development, economic
development and job creation. We devise a strategy to communicate how government is
performing on those mandates”.
The results indicate that the provincial GCIS communication strategy and the national
communication strategy documents are essential and considered in the formulation of
each government departments’ communication strategy. In addition, the environment of
225
each department is also considered relevant to the formulation of communication strategy
documents.
8.3 THE VALUE
STRATEGIZING
OF
THE
ENVIRONMENT
OR
CONTEXT
IN
The majority of respondents emphasised the importance of the uniqueness of context.
They argued that it was essential for each department’s communication strategy to take
into account the unique environment of each province and the unique character of each
department. Moreover, they claimed that the environment is the point of differentiation
between various (department) communication strategies. Three levels of environments
were found essential to the drafting of government communication strategies in each
department. Namely: the national environment, the provincial and the departmental
environment:
8.3.1
THE NATIONAL ENVIRONMENT
It seems that there are two environments at the national level that must be considered.
The first one is the national government environment as determined by the theme and the
priorities of government as a whole. The second is the national environment of the ministry
itself as per developments in the head offices of each ministry in Pretoria. The central
offices of each ministry such as health, transport, education, et cetera are in Pretoria.
According to this, the communications strategies of each ministry will have similar
agendas, but the strategies will be differentiated by the unique context of each province:
“National government have general (communication) strategies, which are tweaked for
KwaZulu Natal (province) because we may have issues that are different”.
“We cannot be communicating differently from national, that I can assure you. The
programmes that they communicate, we also communicate. And we should not contradict
what national communicates. So we communicate more or less the same”.
226
8.3.2
THE PROVINCIAL ENVIRONMENT
It was recommended by senior communication managers that each department
communication strategy be fairly aligned with the provincial government communication
strategy. The provincial communication forum was identified as an avenue in which such
synergising could be facilitated:
“Here in the province we have a structure called the Provincial Communication Forum
(PCF). Because there are peculiarities in provinces, what is produced is a framework that
will guide and accommodate the unique features and characteristics of the province. We
have to take into account who is our target audiences. We have about four languages. As
provinces, we sit and analyse our own environment. When you do a communication
strategy, you have to analyse your environment such as the mood of the media and the
public”.
8.3.3
THE DEPARTMENTAL ENVIRONMENT
The departmental environment is determined by the nature of the department, services,
communication programmes, and target audiences. “Once we have sat in the
communication forum (PCF) and developed the communication strategy for the province
and is adopted by cabinet, we then look at the specific environment of our own
department, stakeholders and the services we provide, then we develop our
communication strategy”.
“We have tried very much to align with the provincial strategy - there are elements that link
with the provincial strategy, but one must also remember that that ours is a dynamic
department, so there will be things that are particular to us as a department within the
strategy as well”.
What becomes different is the programmes and target audiences. “For example in my
department, we deal with the LSM such as traditional leaders and councilors and so forth.
They are a different LSM with that of the department of economic development (for
example) who interacts with captains of industry, entrepreneurs and so forth. So the nature
227
of the media will be influenced by that LSM. So these are some peculiarities that
differentiate a departmental strategy from another”.
The departmental environment is also determined by the mission and goals of the
department: “You should acknowledge that each and every portfolio has its own dynamics.
The strategy starts by indicating the mission of the department, who we are in relation to
the rest of the provincial government”.
8.3.4
SYNERGY OF THE THREE LEVELS OF ENVIRONMENT
Some participants noted the importance of synergy between the three levels of the
identified environment. It was recommended that each communication strategy document
demonstrate this alignment. There should be synergies between the departmental, the
provincial and the national communication strategy. There should be a common thread
relating to the theme of government to promote a united front. Each communication
strategy is related although unique in consideration of its departmental circumstances.
In fact, government communication strategy is a matter of adaptation. It actually speaks to
what the province want us to say and do. The approach at the provincial level is that we
should work in unison, we should complement each other rather than working in solos.
8.3.5
THE VALUE OF GOVERNMENT COMMUNICATION STRATEGIES
A number of senior communication managers noted the value of government
communication strategy documents. The following values were acknowledged:
Firstly, government communication
strategies can be used to enforce accountability:
“Communication is a strategic tool for government. No wing of government should work
without policy because people account where there is a policy”.
228
Secondly, government communication strategies can assist government communication to
become more proactive rather than reactive: “Upon inquiring, I was told that there is no
communication strategy. So we, in communication were reactive”.
Thirdly, the communication strategy guides government communication programmes: “The
communication strategy sets the tone of what you communicate, how you communicate,
and what type of channels you utilise based on the various stakeholders you deal with”.
Fourthly, government communication strategy documents (especially a collection of them)
outline the history of the communication unit in the department, past successes and
failures, past programmes and a direction of the communication unit. All of which
invaluably provide history, structure and direction to new communication employees in the
department. Some communication managers better express this point:
When I first came looking for a communication strategy, I was told stories. There was no
strategic planning conduct by the department. When everyone was new HOD, MEC, we
did not have a history in terms of where communication has been and where it is going”
(Mid-level Management).
“I am developing a communication strategy and policy for the department because we
have been operating without one. It was literally a takeover. It was not a handover. There
was no communication strategy to base a direction or provide some history. I needed to hit
the ground running” (Head of Communication).
8.3.6 THE PROCESS OF DEVELOPING AND APPROVING GOVERNMENT
COMMUNICATION STRATEGIES
Most of the communication strategies were developed in house, only one came out of a
consultative process with an outsourced company: “I identified a specialist in the
communication field, I found someone who previously worked for government
communication and who is now a consultant. I went to the HOD to seek permission to use
a consultant. Got the go ahead and we started from that”.
229
The process of developing a government communication strategy was explained in the
interviews as follows: The communication unit sits together with guiding documents such
as government communication guideline policies, provincial communication strategy and
other documents detailed in section 8.5. The communication unit brainstorms in order to
come up with a draft strategy. The draft strategy is circulated to different business units in
the department for input. Once input is received from other business units, it is
incorporated into the strategy document. The final draft is then tabled at MANCO
(management committee) for discussion, input and approval. The last level is the approval
of the strategy by the head of the department. The strategy has to be approved by the
HOD (not the MEC) as an administrative head of the department.
Two departments mentioned they were in position of draft communication strategies,
which were not yet approved by management. A senior communication manager of the
affected departments reported:
“I compiled a draft strategy in 2007, but it has not yet been accepted by senior
management of the department. It has been circulated to exco for comments but it has not
yet been accepted because of the lack of capacity to understand. In government, senior
management does not seem to understand the strategic role of the communication in the
department, they see it as technical. In 2010, with the restructuring of the department, I
thought that I could rework the strategy and finally get it approved. However, the
communication strategy is not yet approved and no reason has been given” (department
1).
“Currently we do not have an approved communication strategy. We do have a draft
strategy that is under review as we speak. We are trying to revive it. “We spent so many
days and night to put this document together. There is a lack of understanding or lack of
interest. It is still not approved. We present to exco – but nothing so far”. (Department 2)
Practitioners ascribed the un-approval of communication strategy documents to the
devaluation of communication by the dominant coalition as reflected by a lack of
understanding of government communication added with relegating communication to a
230
technical tool.
However, for some departments, the process of approval “was quick
enough. It didn’t take that long”. Some respondents proposed that the delay is cause by
time constraints. “These things must be tabled formally, so sometimes MANCO do not
make time to put it into the agenda. That demonstrates that communication is not
prioritised”. Section 8.4 to the end of this chapter focuses on document analysis of
government communication strategy documents.
8.4 DOCUMENT ANALYSIS OF GOVERNMENT COMMUNICATION
STRATEGY DOCUMENTS
The strategizing for communication guideline document (2007) provides that a well-written
communication strategy document is a critical instrument for good communication. It
becomes a guide for future actions, the standard against which the success or failure of
communication is measured. The strategizing for communication document (2007) and the
government communicators’ handbook (2011) provide guidelines and formats on how to
formulate and implement government communication strategy documents. The guideline
document identifies nine steps in the formulation and implementation of government
communication strategy documents. The following is the officially recommended format for
writing a government communication strategy. This is similar to the model discussed in
section 4.8. (The rest of the chapter will follow this structure):
•
background
•
objectives
•
environment
•
communication challenges
•
messages and themes
•
messengers, audiences and channels, types of event
•
a phased communication programme
•
structures and processes
•
action plan, including budget implications.
231
8.4.1
STRATEGIC OBJECTIVES
All strategizing is about achieving objectives. Failure to determine such objectives would
lead to the overall failure of the strategy. Communication strategies should be translated
into achievable and measurable goals. The following section outlines the objectives of
government communication strategies of various government departments in the KZN
province.
8.4.2 PROVINCIAL GOVERNMENT COMMUNICATION (OFFICE OF THE KZN
PREMIER)
The strategy objective of the provincial government communication is to provide an
integrated and co-ordinated government communication service in KwaZulu Natal. The
strategic communication objectives are as follows: the first one identifies a need for an
effective co-ordination and branding of all government information and messaging. The
second one relate to effective positioning of the provincial government in the media
environment provincially, nationally and globally. Both the first two outcomes are geared
towards the promotion of government image. The third strategic communication outcome
aims at achieving an “effective management, monitoring and reporting on provincial
government service delivery efforts”. The fourth outcome talks to an “effective provincial
government stakeholder engagement both internally and externally to build and enhance
brand loyalty”. All four outcomes in combination are predominated towards image,
branding, and reputation management.
8.4.3
DEPARTMENT OF KZN EDUCATION
The Department of Education (DoE) forms the biggest part of the KwaZulu Natal
government in terms of budget size, and number of employees and schools. This places a
particular onus on the department to fulfill a wide range of communication functions, such
as marketing, media, advertising, branding, perception, image, reputation, stakeholders,
and direct and intensive unmediated communication. The draft communication strategy
document of the KZN Department of Education realises that “communication and media
232
operations and matters of corporate image, reputation, perception, and stakeholder
relations have become increasingly crucial to the success or failure of any administration,
particularly government”. The strategy document of the DoE defines “government
communication as a strategic and planned process aimed at ensuring effective dialogue
between government, stakeholders, and communities”. The communication strategic
objectives of the KZN department of Education (DoE) are summarised as follows:
•
Profile the programmes of the MEC,
•
Profile the HOD as DoE’s Service Excellence Champion,
•
Be the official voice of the DoE,
•
Provide a co-ordinated, coherent, consistent and effective communication service
that accounts for the Department’s programmes and activities,
•
Promote corporate identity and image,
•
Promote DoE’s reputation as a good employer and a competent service provider,
•
Create and consolidate relations and partnerships with stakeholders,
•
Set clearer targets for a communication programme and establish monitoring
measures,
•
Establish evaluation and monitoring mechanism.
8.4.4
DEPARTMENT OF PUBLIC WORKS KZN
The public works communication strategy document outlines the roles and objectives of
the government communication unit in the provincial government. The following are the
identified objectives of the KZN Public Works communication strategy document and its
implementation:
The strategy document provides that communication service is a directorate responsible
for promoting the image of the department internally and externally and has a mammoth
task to disseminate relevant and accurate information to the public through various media
tools and techniques. To achieve this role, a positive image of the department must be
created and its programmes be marketed vigorously through tailor-made messages to suit
the specific target audience (both primary and secondary) in terms of their current
233
behaviour, their level of awareness, their level of knowledge and preferred methods and
tools for receiving information. In addition, the document outlines that the communication
services will also ensure continuous liaison with other stakeholders such as national,
provincial, and local government structures, Government Communication Information
System (GCIS), and various media to promote cooperative and good governance. In
overall, the document provides, “the aim of this strategy is to promote the department of
public works as a construction and property management brand in the province of
KwaZulu Natal”. The overall purpose of the strategy is to create a climate of understanding
between the department and relevant stakeholders through continuous liaison using
appropriate channels of communication. Image, branding, and identity, management seem
pronounced in the Public Works strategy document.
8.4.5
DEPARTMENT OF HEALTH KZN
The strategic objectives of the Department of Health appeared more balanced than those
of other departments. Positioned on top of the list is an objective of information provision
and education. Image management comes second, followed by encouraging public
participation, and then ending with media management. The purposes of the
communication strategy of the Department of Health are as follows:
•
Provide a concise, simple, user friendly and all-encompassing communication
approach that will promote effective communication platforms that keep external
and internal stakeholders informed through information, education, and public
awareness.
•
Enhance the positive image of the department through active, vibrant, open, and
transparent internal and external communication.
•
Promote public participation.
•
Establish and manage on-going media services by ensuring that the media is
provided with timely and accurate information and reporting.
234
8.4.6
DEPARTMENT OF SPORT AND RECREATION
The department of KZN Sport and Recreation identifies the following strategic objectives in
its communication strategy document. The first objective concern image and three concern
information dissemination, while two concern internal communication:
•
To project the department as taking a lead in certain areas,
•
To promote access to department information and services,
•
To provide an media monitoring service,
•
To manage department displays internally,
•
To provide photography and videography service for internal activities,
•
To create and manage information dissemination tools such as the website,
intranet,
•
To promote feedback mechanisms and opportunities so as to assess internal
perception and opinion on the status of the department.
8.4.7
THE DEPARTMENT OF KZN COGTA
The strategy communication document of COGTA outlines the framework of the function
of the communication unit and provides a basis for communication in order to advance the
department’s agenda. The communication strategy is also geared towards the promotion
(image) of the political leadership of the department. It requires all employees and
representatives of the department to communicate the strategy, vision and action plans of
the department (page 5). The COGTA communication strategy has been developed to
further to department’s objectives, which are identified as follows (the first and the last one
are concerned with image management, while the middle is about relationship
management with the publics):
•
To promote a positive image of the KZN department of Cooperative Governance
and Traditional Affairs.
•
To increase the public understanding of KZNCOGTA policies and services.
•
To profile KZNCOGTA to other government departments.
235
8.4.8
DEPARTMENT OF KZN ECONOMIC DEVELOPMENT AND TOURISM
The communication unit of the KwaZulu Natal Department of Economic Development &
Tourism is responsible for a range of crucial communication functions that govern the
relationships between the Department of Economic Development & Tourism (DEDT) and
its partner-organisations and other related various stakeholders. The following are the key
objectives of the DEDT communication strategy. The first objective is integrated internal
communication, second is information provision the last is about image management:
•
The primary responsibilities of the communication unit include strengthening
relations between the ministry (MEC) and the department (HOD).
•
The corporate communications unit is also responsible for all communication
activities including the production and distribution of all media, advertising and
promotional material that is aimed at facilitating better working relations for the
aforementioned stakeholders.
•
It is the communication unit’s responsibility to look after the reputation of the
ministry and the department.
8.4.9 SYNTHESIS AND DISCUSSION OF GOVERNMENT COMMUNICATION
STRATEGY OBJECTIVES
There is a direct relationship between the perceived functions of government
communication and the communication strategy objectives. There are various functions of
government communication as detailed in chapter 5. Ideally, each communication strategy
document must reflect a balance of these functions. It was found in the interview and the
survey research in chapter 9, that most government communicators rated the promotion of
government services and image management as the most profound function of
government communication. From the analyses of strategy documents, it was also found
that publicity, branding and image management featured profoundly in government
communication strategy documents. Information diffusion and public participation come a
close second and third, respectively. What was surprising was an emergent role of
government communication in monitoring. This role is described briefly in chapter 9. Again,
it can be concluded that there is a direct link between the perceived functions of
236
government communication and communication strategy objectives. The most perceived
communication function is often translated into communication strategies.
Regardless of their own perceptions on the formulation of government communication
strategy documents, government communication
are guided by the following policy
documents in the formulation of government communication strategy documents. Those
are identified in the next section.
8.5 POLICY
DOCUMENTS
COMMUNICATION STRATEGIES
GUIDING
GOVERNMENT
Most communication strategy documents identified policy documents and communication
legislations that guided the formulation of the department’s communication strategy
document. Excluded from these are policies relating to the terms of trade of the
department. Non-communication related legislative documents are excluded from this list.
The Public Works communication strategy is guided by the following legislative document:
•
Strategic framework for government communication (2009-2014)
•
Government Communication Information Service (GCIS)
•
Government Communicator’s Handbook (2000)
•
Communication Task Team Report (Comtask 1996/97)
•
Batho Pele Principles
•
KZN Citizen’s Charter
•
Provincial Communication Strategy
•
National Public Works’ communication strategy
The KZN Department of Health communication strategy is guided by the following
legislative document:
•
GCIS policies and guidelines
•
Provincial Branding Policy
•
Departmental media policy
•
Departmental events management policy
237
•
Departmental branding policy (from the provincial branding policy)
•
Departmental lingual policy
The COGTAKZN communication strategy is guided by the following legislative document:
The framework for communications for the Department of Cooperative Governance and
Traditional Affairs (COGTA) KwaZulu Natal is informed by the Provincial Communication
Strategy, department’s mandate as outlined in the MEC’s budget speech, government’s
ten point plan, provincial and national government’s priorities as expressed in the state of
the province and state of the nation address, as well as by the national communication
framework (NCF) issues by the Government Communication and Information Systems
(GCIS) (COGTA Page 4).
The KZN Department of Education prescribes, “The formulation of its communication
strategy is guided by the country’s constitution, laws and policies, and input from
government’s legislation and policies on communication that ensures active citizens
participation, transparency and accountability. The KZN Department of Education draft
communication strategy document identified a greater spectrum of legislations informing
the nature and standard of government communication in the KwaZulu Natal provincial
government:
Legislative and Policy Framework on Government Communication
The Constitution of the Republic of South Africa, 1996, also contains a number of sections,
which set the tone for government communication.
(a)
Promotion of Access to Information Act, 2000 (Act 2 of 2000)
This Act operationalises sections 8 and 32 of the Constitution. It aims to foster a culture of
transparency and accountability, and to promote effective access to information to protect
an individual’s rights. The Act applies to the records of public and private bodies,
regardless of when the record came into existence (Section 3)
(b)
Communication Task Team, October 1996
238
The Comtask Report adopted by cabinet in 1996 laid the foundation for an integrated and
coherent system of government communication. The Government Communication and
Information System (GCIS) must be designed in a way that is geared to the optimization of
relationships and partnerships within and between the structures of government, as well as
between government and civil society. The emphasis of the GCIS is therefore on coordination from the centre and aggressive implementation within government departments.
(d)
Government’s Communication Guidelines
This Communication Strategy emphasis the following government’s best practice
guidelines in the execution of
Communication programmes, namely;
•
Best practice guidelines for the procurement of marketing, advertising
and PR services/products.
•
Marketing,
communication
and
sponsorship
guidelines
for
government.
•
Social media guidelines.
8.5.1 SYNTHESIS AND DISCUSSION OF GUIDING POLICY DOCUMENTS IN
THE FORMULATION OF GOVERNMENT COMMUNICATION STRATEGIES
There is no standardisation of the documents used as guidelines for development of
government communication strategies. There is a long list of possible documents to
consult in the drawing of government communication strategies. These are outlined in
chapter 6. All are important in their unique ways and in the contribution to the
communication strategy document. Various departments use various policy sources and
end up with different themes for the communication strategy document, those for example
who draw primarily on information dissemination policies such as the promotion of access
to information act, 2000 and the Batho Pele Principles may end up with a communication
strategy more focused on participation and information dissemination than those who had
for example drawn on the branding policy. There should be some standardisation of
documents to be consulted in the formulation of government communication strategy
documents.
239
8.6 POLITICS
Regardless of fact that the majority of government communicators claimed that politics has
an effect on the practice of government communication, this issue is obscure in
communication strategy documents. It is only the provincial communication strategy
document of the office of the premier that made reference to politics and the ruling party.
All other communication strategy documents remained silent about politics and its effects
on government communication. The provincial communication strategy seemed to endorse
the ruling party in the following passage: “the latest local government elections confirm that
the ruling party is not only consolidating its gains, but growing stronger in the face of
weakening opposition” (Feb 2012). The effects of politics (referring to one party
government in KZN) on government communication can be witnessed in the following
extract: “This stability and unity of purpose on the political front has made it possible for
great strides to be taken in the creation of a streamlined, co-ordinated and integrated
communication system. It is believed that one part government (ANC) in KZN has
contributed positively to a unified communication, in which government has largely done
away with fragmented messaging, caused by two party political agendas (provincial com
strategy).
In its communication strategy document, DEDT acknowledges political and legal
challenges to which government communication functions. “The Ministry also operates
within a framework of politics and the law. It is thus important to ensure that the activities
of the department and communication programmes follow proper legislative processes and
demonstrate the department’s commitment to the rule of law and constitutional
imperatives”.
8.7 LEGAL CONSTRAINTS
Chapter 9 will describe the effects of legal constraints on the practice of government
communication. From various communication strategy documents analysed, the following
are some of the legal constraints identified in relation to government communication and
government communicators:
240
In media relations;
a) Media liaison officers and other communicators below the level of the general
Manager for corporate communications may deal with general media enquiries.
However, the general manager for corporate communications must be informed and
consulted at all times,
b) It will always be advisable for all media enquiries to be in a written format, so as to
ensure accountability and easy sign off,
c) A list of issues which the media liaison officers (MLOs) may comment on without
first seeking the mandate of their principals should be made known to MLOs so as
to ensure speedy responses and avoid the micro management of the
communication process,
d) No official from the department will be allowed to respond to media enquiries
without seeking advice or approval from Corporate Communication Unit
In social media:
a) All employees shall ensure that at all times when engaging in the social networking
and other new forms of communication, such as Facebook or Twitter they don’t
conduct themselves in a manner that damages the brand of the department,
b) No departmental official is allowed to speak or make comments, purportedly, on
behalf of the department,
c) Departmental officials, who, through their actions in the social networking space
and other new forms of communication, wittingly or unwittingly, damage the image
and the reputation of the department shall face disciplinary action.
8.8 BUDGETING
Chapter 3 identified budget constraints as one of the feature of the distinctive
communication environment of the public sector. It was unanimously acknowledged in the
interview data that budget constraints are a recurrent feature in all communication units.
Section 9.6.3 in chapter 9 describes how budget constraints negatively affected the
practice of government communication. It was therefore unsurprising that all government
communication strategies would address this issue.
241
The provincial government communication strategy noted the challenges in limited
budgets for government communication in KwaZulu Natal. The document projects that “the
government has to fulfil its mandate in the context of a belt-tightening exercise initiated in
response to over-expenditure in the previous years. In this regard, cabinet has imposed
constraints on marketing and advertising activities. As service delivery needs escalates
further, it is always going to be a challenge to prioritise communication over basic needs
such as houses, electricity and clean water”. This strategy document seems apologetic
and accepting that– communication is less important than other services. Communication
has to be in equal weight with other service delivery because communication is in itself
service-delivery and it is essential in service-delivery in terms of creating awareness of
services rendered. The Department of Sports and Recreation strategy document also
noted the limitation in budget; “The members of this committee shall work as a cohesive
team, especially in the light of the limited resources available”.
The Department of Sport and Recreation KZN recognises the fact that the strength of any
communication strategy document is in its implementation based on the budget available,
without which a strategy document remains a dream, and merely a policy without practice.
The DSR communication strategy document provides that, “The allocated budget for the
communication sub-directorate shall determine, to a large extent, the activities and degree
of effectiveness of the component”. The Department of Health communication strategy
document also recognises that “the ability to achieve (communication objectives) will be
dependent upon the resources that will be made available for the financial year”.
According to the communication strategy of the department of Economic Development and
Tourism, “it is the ministry’s responsibility to ensure that the communication unit has the
necessary resources to carry out its work effectively. These resources will include
personnel, appropriate skills, technology and information”. All the communication strategy
documents noted constrains in communication budgets and the challenging this imposed
the attainment of excellence and effectiveness in the practice of government
communication. Although the challenges of budget constraints have been noted, no
solutions have been prescribed. Budget and adequate resourcing are essential in the
enactment of strategic government communication, which is discussed next.
242
8.9 STRATEGY GOVERNMENT COMMUNICATION
Recognising the strategic role of government communication is the DEDT communication
strategy document which reads “communication should be an integral part of the planning
and delivery of the departments’ programmes”. The document further states that “the
corporate communications function is, without a doubt, of strategic importance to the
Department of Economic Development & Tourism. It should be managed at the highest
level to ensure that stakeholders have a sustained awareness about the department’s
programmes and projects”. This demonstrate KZN government commitment (at least in
policy) to uphold government communication as a management function.
The DEDT communication strategy document provides for the strategic position and
strategic role of the communication manager in KZN government departments. It
prescribes that the executive authority of the communication unit is the chief communicator
of the department, with the title Head of Communication. He/she is expected to provide
policy and strategic direction for communication activities (page 7). The Head of
Communication shall report, operationally/politically, to the MEC and, administratively, to
the Head of Department (HOD) as per the KZN Cabinet Resolution No 1 of 31 January
2007 and the Public Finance Management Act regulations. The document reads:
The reporting lines will ensure better alignment of the government’s strategic goals.
a) The general manager for communication shall be responsible for the day-to-day
activities of corporate communications and stakeholder relations,
b) The general manager for communication shall be the official spokesperson for the
Ministry and the Department,
c) The general manager for communication shall ensure that all the systems and
resources that will contribute to the effective execution of the communications unit’s
responsibilities are in place,
d) The general manager for communication shall be a member of both Management
and Executive Committees (Manco and Exco) of the department.
243
Some communication strategy documents identified the importance of management’s
support in the realisation of government communication strategic objectives. For instance,
the Public Works communication strategy states, “The success and the realisation of the
impact of this communication strategy and the implementation plan thereof can only be
achieved through the support of the MEC; HOD, senior management and the commitment
of all members of the department” (page 15). The suggestion is that top management must
decisively engage and drive the strategic communication process. “Top management must
passionately and consistently live, lead, support, deliver and communicate DoE’s
communication values, over and over again”. The DoE communication strategy provides
that “successful strategic communication begins with clear leadership intent and
guidance”. In addition, top management must properly capacitate (resources) strategic
communication as a priority equivalent to other important operations in the department.
The communication strategy of the DEDT makes a similar point in stating that “the success
of the ministry’s communication efforts is dependent on support from the department’s
executive and management committees” (page 15).
According to the communication strategy document of the KZN Department of Public
Works, government communicators are responsible for prioritising and interpreting
government policies and articulating them to ordinary citizens. It is also the responsibility of
government communicators to regularly assess the communication environment, identify
communication gaps, and be proactive in identifying opportunities created because of
interaction with the public (page 4). The nest section describes the value of the
communication environment in the formulation of strategic government communication
documents.
8.10 THE COMMUNICATION ENVIRONMENT
The strategising for communication guideline document (2007) recommends that actions
must be preceded by an understanding of the environment, of the public to be reached,
their thoughts and how best to reach them. This guideline document adds, “Research must
inform communication strategies because it gives insight to the dynamism of the
environment and the challenges it brings”. Accordingly, scanning of the communication
244
environment makes it possible for the communication strategy to take actions that are
appropriate and therefore effective.
The provincial government communication strategy document cantered its environmental
scanning on the analysis of the media environment in particular. The provincial
communication strategy document provides that government communication “happens in a
media environment that is not particularly favourable to the government due to a variety of
historic reasons”. The document argues that 18 years into democracy there is still no
media plurality. “Print media ownership is still largely concentrated in the hands of a few
dominant media houses while vernacular media struggles for survival”. The document
adds, “While the media in KwaZulu Natal has a positive attitude towards government,
there is a tendency by some sections of it, particularly print, to perceive government
developmental programmes as a futile, extravagant public relations exercise and
occasionally distort, fabricate or become cynical about government efforts”.
Due to the media challenges identified above the provincial communication strategy
document recommends that “it is imperative for government to have its own unmediated
communication with its constituencies”. However, on the positive side of the media
environment, the KwaZulu Natal province has shed an image of a politically violent and
AIDS infested region towards a stable, prosperous and leisure destination.
The COGTA communication strategy document also identified the media environment in
which the department currently functions. The strategy document reports, “Recently local
government is a subject that seems to be on top of the media agenda, in recent times, we
saw an increase in content-driven media discourse on local government in particular
fuelled in the main by community concerns over service delivery issues. The media is still
putting more focus on the news administration to deliver as well as the cost of
implementing the electoral commitments” (page 8).
In
addition
to
the
challenging
media-scrutiny
environment,
the
KZN
COGTA
communication strategy document also identified additional communication challenges.
The first challenge speaks to a need to heighten integrated communication with COGTA
245
nationally, thereby signalling a move towards centralisation. The second main
communication challenge is to sustain public confidence in local government given the
pace and quality of service delivery in some instances. The third challenge relate to
identifying the issues best communicated in partnership with other business units
(directorates) and municipalities for greater coherence and synergy (integration and
centralisation). The fourth challenge is in measuring the overall impact of communication
initiatives in a manner that will enable the department to identify and quantify
communication gaps and additional information needs and wants of target audiences. The
fifth and last challenge is moving from events-driven communication towards proactively
enhancing the KZNCOGTA story in order to increase and sustain media interest (page 9).
The Department of Sport and Recreation communication environment is currently
characterised by the following: First, is the belief that sporting programmes currently
benefit the previously advantaged communities in the main. Second, is the media
tendency to promote sporting programmes from outside South Africa, and that of local
(South African) sport and sportspersons are relegated as inferior. Thirdly, lack of media
access by marginalised, rural communities minimizes the benefits enjoyed by these highpriority communities because of poor access to information. These are all media relation
challenges.
The Public Works communication strategy document provides that “to implement the
strategy successfully, the situation analysis strategy will consider the strength, weakness,
opportunities, and threats for communication services”. The public works communication
strategy document identified stakeholder management and new media/social media as
opportunities (in situational analysis). The threats identified are that public works is poorly
branded. Poor coordination of departmental events and internal delays in the approval of
printer’s proofs are additional threats. Also identified as a threat to the communication unit
is the notion that “communication as a ‘science’ is less recognised” (page 7). This means
that communication is treated as a technical rather than a strategic tool in the department.
Among the internal threats identified are an understaffed communication unit, budget
constraints, and that “communication in the department is re-active that proactive” (page
7).
246
With regard to the operating environment, The Department of Economic Development and
Tourism Communication Strategy document only mentions two challenges. The first
challenge is with regard to the competition emanating from other provinces, international
agencies, which pressurise the department to offer services that are innovating, and
adaptable to changing circumstances. The second challenge mentioned is stakeholder
discontent that according to the document must be redressed not to result in antipathy
towards the department.
The communication strategy document of the KZN Department of Health acknowledges
that, for government communication to be effective, “the actions of officials must be
informed by an understanding of the environment in which they are working, of who the
communication is trying to target, what people are thinking, and how they are best
reached”. Effective communication must be able to read and understand the public mood,
expectations and concerns and respond to these appropriately (page 2). The document
provides that “communication operates in a dynamic environment and requires a response
which will be proactive and at other times, reactive” (page 3). The environment of Health is
characterised by the following:
•
Health is high on the government agenda
•
Changing expectations and health needs
•
Different levels of understanding based on population dynamics
•
Growing number of platforms
•
Ability to keep pace with modern technology
•
Political and cultural diversity
•
Ability to balance expectations with available resources
•
Urban vs rural reach based on geographical spread
•
Public perception of government and services delivery and its impact, both positive
and negative
According to the communication strategy document of the Department of Education,
scanning the communication environment enables the communication unit to take action
that are appropriate, effective, and anticipate changes, crises and challenges, and make
timely intervention. The draft communication strategy is formulating within DoE’s
247
environmental circumstances as expressed through strengths, weaknesses, and
opportunities and threats (SWOT) analysis (page 14). The DoE environment is described
as follows:
•
A communication unit operating without a strategy.
•
A communication team without clear roles within communication.
•
Insufficient capacity among team members.
•
Reactive approach to media.
•
Channels of communications are slow and haphazard in getting messages across,
in addition, staff do not use existing tools to past on messages.
•
Unnecessary work brought about by duplication of information distributed
•
No annual events calendar.
•
Weak stakeholder relations (unions, partners etc.).
•
Negative coverage by media.
8.10.1 SYNTHESIS AND DISCUSSION OF THE COMMUNICATION
ENVIRONMENT IN THE FORMULATION OF GOVERNMENT COMMUNICATION
STRATEGIES
The importance of both the internal and the external environment in drafting
communication strategies is well recognised in literature. In overall, all examined
government communication strategy documents similarly recognised the value of
environmental scanning. However, as per Watson and Noble’s (2007) projection, the
media environment is often on top of the list of external environments considered. All
sampled KZN government communication strategy documents also focused heavily on the
media environment. Although other environments have been considered, very little has
been mentioned about the public and citizens themselves. Such projections on public
opinion require sophisticated and consistent environmental scanning research. However,
techniques, methodologies and processes on the actual scanning of the environment are
not sufficiently details in the government communication strategies analysed (this is taking
into account that the objectives of environmental scanning are different from
communication evaluations).
Nonetheless, most communication strategy documents
identified the need for communication evaluations in government communication.
248
8.11 COMMUNICATION EVALUATIONS
The Sports and Recreation communication strategy document acknowledges, “The
concept of monitoring the effectiveness of the communication service is crucial to the
success of the component”. The document recommends, “The services of a tertiary
institution specialising in media and communication studies should be utilised to provide a
media monitoring service”. Public Works communication strategy document also
concedes, “The success of any strategy or campaign is dependent on the continuous
monitoring and evaluation to test its validity and value for money. Essential to the entire
strategy and campaign is the question of measuring the value of each rand spent.
However realising that, it is not always simple to assess the true effectiveness of a
campaign without extensive and costly market research before and after the process”
(page 14).
The KZN Public Works communication strategy document also adds, “A (communication)
strategy must be measured against the organisational objectives to assess whether or not
the messages are reaching its intended targets. This exercise requires extensive research,
planning, implementation, continuous assessment, and review as well as developing a
coordinated communication plan of action. There is no point measuring an increase in
awareness where there is no base research” (page14). For evaluation to be effective and
accurate, it is essential that it become an interactive process that is ongoing from begin to
end (KZN Public Works, 14). According to the Department of KZN Health communication
strategy document, communication evaluations should be conducted on the four pillars of
government communication, namely, internal communications, external communications,
and media liaison and events management.
Communication evaluations are recognised as essential to the effectiveness of
government communication. However, the interview data found that there were insufficient
communication evaluations taking place in KZN. For example, the KZN COGTA
communication strategy document reports, “Currently there is little true evaluation of the
work carried out by the corporate communication business unit. This is a strategic priority,
as the monitoring and evaluation of communication efforts will not only inform future
249
communication programmes, but will also help in ensuring that the messages convinced
are developed and adapted in light of the interests and preoccupations of public opinion”.
With the above obstacle noted, the majority of government communication strategy
documents projected an improved forecast on communication evaluations. For instance,
the communication strategic document of KZN COGTA forecast that evaluations would be
woven into programme planning from the outset. It will involve the ongoing pretesting and
evaluation of strategies and tactics during communication development and delivery to
ensure that programmes meet stakeholder needs’. Also promising a better prospect for
communication evaluations is the KZN Department of Education communication strategy
document. According to the DoE, the department of KZN Education will improve
communication evaluations by incorporating media tracking, ensuring regular meetings
with stakeholders and assessing communication programmes against their pre-determined
objectives. KZN Department of Economic and Tourism promises that from time to time the
corporate communications unit will conduct research and undertake all forms of practical
initiatives that will provide a better understanding of the environment within which the
department operates (page 4). It remains yet to be seen if the communication evaluations
articulated in all KZN communication strategy documents will ever be implemented and
carried out in practice.
8.11.1 SYNTHESIS AND DISCUSSION OF GOVERNMENT COMMUNICATION
EVALUATIONS
This
review
of
government
communication
strategy
documents
suggest
that
communication evaluations are held in high regard in the KZN provincial government.
However, none of the communication strategy documents articulates how such
communication evaluations are actually conducted in practice, or how many have been
conducted with what results. Moreover, the methodologies also remain unarticulated.
Literature had projected that there are poor communication evaluations in the government
sector (Liu, Horsley & Levenshus, 2010).
250
8.12 GOVERNMENT MEDIA RELATIONS
The KZN provincial government communication strategy declares that it approaches the
media from the premise that they are partners in communications, both sharing the
responsibility to keep the public informed for the purpose of empowerment... therefore,
media relations will have to be continually built and natured using various mechanism. The
KZN provincial government media strategy aims to establish a rapid response unit to
perform the following roles:
•
Establishment of a credible and up-to-date media database for all departments.
•
Produce continuous and proactive media releases with emphasis on positive
service delivery initiatives by government.
•
Establishing a media briefing programme and standing timetables
•
Embark on radio and television advertisements and infomercials to cover both
mainstream and community radio.
Media relations in the Department of Health consist of managing mutually beneficial
relations with various media houses in order to ensure that their information needs are
addressed appropriately. The department aims to employ a variety of media platforms to
communicate and provide information in multiple formats as an attempt to accommodate
diverse information needs.
The role of the media liaison officer in government is aptly described by the draft
communication strategy document of the Department of Sport and Recreation. It
prescribes, “The Media Liaison Officer (MLO) shall provide an advisory service to the MEC
on communication and media-based issues”. The MLO shall address all media quarries,
route them to the relevant officials and ensure that responses are relayed to all queries. It
is the function of the media officer to comment on behalf of the MEC, collate information
from relevant components of the department and prepare press releases. The media
officer identifies media opportunities and arranges media interviews for the MEC according
to the strategy document. The MLO shall compile a detailed database of all media houses.
251
The communication strategy document of KZN Public Works claims that the media is
currently not hostile towards the department and there is a fair amount of positive reporting
on departmental programmes. The public works media strategy seeks to promote the
interest of the department by purposefully disseminating planned messages through the
media. This can be achieved through professional handling of the media, regular briefing
session with editors and senior journalists on departmental achievements.
The Department of Economic Development and Tourism communication strategy
envisages a relationship between the government communication unit and the media that
shall be based on professionalism and mutual respect. All media inquiries are to be treated
with the urgency they deserve. A two-way communication process between the
department and the media will be promoted. The communications unit will at all times
endeavour to have a proactive engagement with the media rather than a reactive or
responsive one. In overall this section demonstrates that positive media relations are
envisaged by the majority of government communicators. The strategic documents project
media relations as both a challenge and an opportunity depending on how media relations
is tactfully managed. Strategic media relations is vital primarily for information diffusion,
reputation and identity management. These aspects are discussed next.
8.13 IMAGE-BUILDING AND CORPORATE IDENTITY
The KZN provincial communication strategy provides that “clear and consistent corporate
identity is required to assist the public in recognising, accessing and assessing
government and government services”. It is deemed imperative for the KZN provincial
government to maintain a recognisable and unified corporate identity in order to ensure
that buildings, facilities, programmes, services and activities are clearly identified and
appropriately branded. According to the KZN Provincial Communication Office, key
corporate identity activities include the production of promotional material and exhibitions
to profile the image of all government departments and their various programmes. Also
identified is the production of the electronic version of departmental reports highlighting
key successes and activities of the government department. Moreover, the provincial
communication strategy identifies the need for developing and maintaining a modern
252
government website and the utility of multi-media community centres as a form of image
building and identity management.
According to the Department of KZN Health, “the corporate brand refers to the corporate
identity of the department, its image and the marketing strategies adopted to ensure
maximum visibility” (page 6). The branding policy of the department should guide the
corporate branding initiative, which entails implementing the new branding policy across
the department and marketing the brand at all opportunities that present themselves and
creating promotional materials. “The branding policy will be aligned with the provincial
branding policy” (page 7). The communication strategy document of the department of
KZN Health recommends that all employees of the department are brand ambassadors.
They are vital in ensuring that the corporate brand is respected and sustained in order to
uphold the reputation of the department. This was the first time that non-visual branding
was mentioned. The rest of the communication strategies were delimited to visual
branding.
In relations to branding and corporate identity management, the KZN Department of
Education communication strategy pinpoints a need to ensure consistent and visible
branding and corporate identity in all DoE events. It is postulated that branding will ensure
coherent, coordinated and integrated DoE communication messages and programmes
and build a strong culture of communication, coordination and ownership of DoE brand in
order to promote the DoE’s brand image locally, regionally and internationally. Also an
emphasis is on visual branding.
In relation to image- building, the communication strategy of KZN Sports and Recreation
provides that, the DSR department will utilise appropriate promotional material and
exhibitions/displays at opportune moments to profile the image of the department and its
programmes. “Artwork, layout and design of promotional material, including departmental
branding, shall be provided as per needs”. Moreover, branding shall include adequate
internal (inside the building structures) and external (outdoor) equipment. Outdoor visual
branding proves invaluable in external organisational rhetoric avenues such as
government outreach programmes, which are discussed next.
253
8.14 OUTREACH PROGRAMMES
The KZN provincial communication strategy document asserts that outreach programmes
to communities are central to the government communication strategy. According to the
provincial communication strategy, key outreach campaigns include, “periodic izimbizo to
raise awareness and receive feedback on key provincial issues”. Another feature of
outreach programmes identified in the provincial communication strategy document is the
‘meet and greet’, in which the premier and MECs walk about in areas and communities
targeted for service delivery, attracting ‘photo-opportunities’. The strategy document
mentions that outreach programmes include ‘post izimbizo follow-up’. However, these
types or elements of the ‘follow up’ were undisclosed in the strategy document.
In relation to events management, the Department of Health communication strategy
reflected a need to ensure departmental representation in interdepartmental, provincial
government, intergovernmental and public-private partnership community outreach
programmes and events. The department also aims to facilitate community engagement
platforms for public participation programmes and outreach initiatives inclusive of
community mobilisation.
COGTA’s communication strategy document advocates for the development of separate
and targeted communication strategies for all major events and activities. “When linefunction units (directorates) are planning an event, they should approach the corporate
communication unit for support and assistance, and a communication and project task
team will then assist by developing a communication strategy, a media and marketing plan
including key messages and the thematic thrust of the event/activity and develop
information and communication products including media releases, feature articles,
newsletters, brochures, publications, corporate videos and electronic invitations”. The line
function team leader is responsible for developing a closeout report after the event and
ensuring that all financial and administrative requirements have been met.
According to the communication strategy document of the department of KZN Education,
the communication unit must find a way of getting the most out of events and increasing
254
positive coverage of DoE programmes and activities through the media. Increasing
citizen’s satisfaction and awareness ratings of outreach programmes is an essential
function of the communication unit. For better coordination of outreach programmes, the
strategy document recommends developing and maintaining a calendar for public and
departmental events and disseminates it to all section heads. In terms of improving
outreach programmes, the DoE communication strategy is outmost idealistic in its promise
to: organise and co-ordinate special events almost every month, identify needs of target
audiences and develop programmes that address those needs and hold regular mass
public meeting to promote direct dialogue especially with people in disadvantaged areas.
The communication strategy document, the Department of Economic Development and
Tourism aims to enhance interactive communication between the organisation and its
stakeholder through corporate events in which the department interfaces with different
stakeholders to discuss various aspects of the organisation’s operations. This is in addition
to the enhancement of a visible corporate identity for the department. The communication
unit is responsible for the positioning and the protection of the DeT department’s corporate
brand identity. The image of the political principal shall be treated as the key element
around the corporate image of the organisation and this has to be managed by the
communication unit under the leadership of the general.
8.15 INTERNAL COMMUNICATION
The KZN provincial communication strategy prescribes, “Internal communication is an
integral
part
of
an
institution’s
communication
strategy”.
Fundamental
internal
communication activities in the provincial office include the production of communication
strategy publications to be distributed amongst all departmental communicators in the
province. The provincial government communication office aims to organise periodic
workshops and conferences with communicators to evaluate the impact of the
communication strategy and encourage the use of internal newsletters in line with the
strategy in all government departments. This type of internal communication function is of
course only relevant to the provincial government department in the office of the premier,
which is the custodian of all government communication units in the province.
255
According to the communication strategy document of the department of Sports and
Recreation, the function of internal communication involves updating the department’s
website and intranet and ensuring that the department’s calendar schedule of activities is
published on the website. For the Department of Health, internal communication focuses
on promoting an enabling environment for staff to progress from general awareness to
well-informed ambassadors of the department (employee relations).
Like the Department of Health, the communication strategy document of KZN Department
of Education similarly described internal communication from an employee relations’
perspective. It provides that “a consistent and open internal communication strategy is a
pro-active approach to developing better directed, more committed, and highly efficient
employees”. The DoE internal communication strategy aims to develop a workforce that
understands the vision, mission, goals, value, and procedures of the department. This will
enable all employees to make better and more informed decisions that are aligned with
meeting the long-term goals of the department. According to the document, internal
communication at DoE is aimed at fostering a strong communication culture within DoE by
creating a two-way flow of information between top and bottom employees.
The DEDT communication strategy document states that internal communication must be
promoted to encourage the exchange of corporate information amongst staff members and
management. This is critical in enforcing a sense of alignment with and belonging to the
organisation. Informed employees are likely to exude passion and commitment to the
strategic mandate of the department. The government communication unit is therefore
expected to drive internal communication in equal weight to external communication (page
13). The COGTA communication strategy document cites extent research to illustrate a
direct link between good internal communication and the high performance and motivation
of staff. Effective communication is therefore vital to overall performance of the department
(page 5). In overall, most government communication strategy documents approached
internal communication from an employee relations’ perspective. The most indicated role
of internal communication are employee relation, website management, coordinating
communication between various business units in the department, and the production of
256
internal publications (where applicable). Two-way communication and feedback in
government communication are discussed next.
8.16 TWO WAY COMMUNICATIONS
The COGTA document argues that communication has a significant impact on how the
public and the local government and traditional affairs community judge the work of the
department. Research shows that well-informed clients are more likely to be satisfied with
the departments’ services and to be supportive of its work. Furthermore, the public is likely
to participate in the developmental agenda when the department has created opportunities
for the public to receive information, give feedback and know how to get involved (page 5).
The COGTA communication strategy document realises the need for greater dialogue in
which two-way communication is encouraged between COGTA and its stakeholders.
Symmetrical two-way government communication is empowered by raising awareness,
facilitating opportunities for public discourse, sharing knowledge, and enabling information
from grassroots level to reach decision makers to inform evidence-based planning at all
levels. Also profiling a two-way communication is the DEDT communication strategy which
states that “the Ministry’s communication efforts shall be underpinned by a two-way flow of
information between its constituents’ department and the various stakeholders; through the
use of different media channels and tools” (page 6).
8.17 KEY SPEAKERS /MESSENGERS
The GCIS strategising for communication guideline document states that in a
communication strategy document, it is best to identify the principal spokesperson for the
communication strategy. Someone to represent and reinforce the brand attributes of the
department. The KZN Department of Health defines communication messengers as key
messengers who will become the overall voices when a message is communicated.
The Provincial Communication Strategy outlines the key messengers according to their
hierarchical positions as follows: “The premier, MECs, Director-General, Heads of
257
Departments, the Head of Communication in the Premier’s office, communicators of the
various departments and local government”. Complementary messengers refer to the
premier and his cabinet, mayors and councillors and parliamentarians. The KZN
department of Sports and Recreation identifies its key messengers also, hierarchically, in
which the MEC is the principal communicator for the department. The Department of
Health categorises its key messengers as follows: the (MEC), HOD, Head of
Communication and department spokesperson. Most communication strategies followed
this hierarchical level in defining key messengers of government communication.
COGTA claims that while the Head of Communication is the frontline and official
spokesperson of the department, the MEC is the key spokesperson on policy matters. The
Head of Department (HOD), supported by relevant senior general managers is second.
The DEDT communication similarly states that the MEC, as the political head, would serve
as the chief communication officer on issues relating to the department. While several key
messengers are identified in the provision of internal communication, two-way
communication, strategic communication, identity and image management and outreach
programmes, in practice government communication must be integrated. Integrated
communication is discussed next.
8.18 INTEGRATED COMMUNICATION
The communication strategy document of the KZN Department of Health declares, “A
thousand voices speaking without a common message and a single purpose will, in the
end, just make an indistinct noise that few would hear. The department must therefore
speak with a shared purpose and clarity of message”. Similarly, the KZN provincial
communication strategy document of (2012/1213:40-41) recognises a “need for coordination of communication efforts in the province to ensure consistency and coherence”.
Identified instances of integrated communication are the adoption and implementation of
provincial branding guidelines, the consolidation of various departmental newsletters into a
single weekly newspaper (Simama) and an effective media monitoring system for all
departments. The provincial government communication strategy document identifies the
following initiatives towards integrated government communication in KwaZulu Natal:
258
•
Guidelines have been developed detailing areas of communications
that could be co-ordinated from the premier’s office through
establishing a core centre, for example in photography archives.
•
Developing a calendar of key provincial events to avoid clashes and to
consolidate provincial communication efforts.
•
Improving the system to coordinate all provincial advertising, including
media buying to ensure that the government’s media buying power is
consolidated effectively.
•
Co-ordinate the implementation of the communication strategy through
quarterly provincial communicators meetings and monthly cluster
communicators’ meetings.
•
Develop a consolidated evaluation and monitoring system to monitor
communications of various departments.
•
PCF to meet quarterly & provincial communicators to meet monthly.
•
MLO’s to meet weekly & DCFs to meet monthly
The KZN department of Health aims to promote capacity building of Public Relations
Officers working in various hospitals in KZN through effective PRO forums and workshops
(centralisation). The Department of Health proposes to standardise health communication
by encouraging compliance of protocols and government policies in media and events
management. The department of Sports and Recreation identified a move towards
integrated communication with districts (local government). The interview and the survey
data in chapter 9 report on poor interactions between provincial departments and their
regional offices in districts. Integrated communication is therefore recommended. In
overall, government communication in South Africa is guided by the ten (10)
commandments outlined below.
8.19 GOVERNMENT COMMUNICATION’S TEN COMMANDMENTS
There are certain core principles that guide all government communication strategies. The
Ten Commandments are found in the GCIS Communication Handbook. These “Ten
259
Commandments of Government Communication” apply to government communication in
all spheres, local, provincial and national:
1. Government work is essentially a public activity. We should continually challenge
the paradigm that government work is a secret activity that unfortunately goes
public from time to time. Rather, the approach should be how to manage the flow of
information in the interest of the country.
2. A central communication service should have authority to carry out its work. It
should be located in the highest office, privy to decision-making processes,
including cabinet, and able to exercise discipline among all communicators.
3. Political principals are the main communicators. The public servant employed as
communicators are first and foremost facilitators, creating opportunities for the
principals to articulate their messages, rather than themselves courting publicity.
4. Everyone in government is a communicator, and therefore employees need to be
empowered with skills and information to be good ambassadors of government
policies, programmes, messages and campaigns.
5. Communication should be based on an integrated communication strategy and
programmes, with core messages which guide all the role-players. This is a critical
prerequisite to pro-active communication, instead of just responding to others’
agenda.
6. Communication structures do not determine policy – they articulate it. In doing so, it
is imperative to always tell the truth (or just keep quiet), for if attempts are made to
embellish, this will be found out eventually. Further, it is critical in difficult situations
to examine the real causes of the difficulties, and avoid blaming communicators, as
a rule, for what may in fact be defects in the policy itself.
260
7. Communication is more than just media liaison: a multimedia approach should be
adopted, particularly in implementing major campaigns, including own productions
and other unmediated forms, with specific target groups in mind.
8. Direct communication and mutual exchange of views with the public is the most
effective form of communication. Where resources are available, there should be
communicators in all local offices who are multiskilled workers providing both
information and services.
9. There should be a deliberate effort to understand the communication environment,
including target groups, appropriate media platforms, messages and forms of
interaction
when
compiling campaigns and programmes. In
this
regard,
communication research is a critical element of the trade: communication is an art,
but it should be based on science.
10. Communication campaigns work best when they are carried out in partnership with
others outside of government. This would include researchers, non-government
organisations, role-models for specific sectors and so on – all of which can, if
mobilised and supportive, sometimes transmit similar messages with a greater
measure of credibility and impact
8.20 CONCLUSIONS
This chapter presented a synthesised analysis of government communication strategy
documents. The chapter contains a preliminary response to research objective four (4),
which aims to examine the link between government communication policies, strategies
and government communication practices. The purpose of the ten 10 commandments is to
standardise and professionalise government communication in South Africa.
261
CHAPTER 9: RESULTS AND DATA FINDINGS
9.1
INTRODUCTION
This research merges two emerging fields of study in government communication. One
leading research interest in government communication is in identifying and proving the
distinctiveness of government communication. Another dominant area of focus is in
analysing government communication as a practice. Consequently, this research will
attempt to investigate government communication as a ‘distinctive’ practice. This means
that the distinctive communication environment of the public sector as identified in
literature will be tested in the South African context and its effects in government
communication practices evaluated. In the data analysis chapter, a framework is
presented demonstrating the relationship between the ‘distinctiveness’ features and their
effects on selected government communication practices.
A sample of eight (8) government departments was drawn from a population of 16
provincial ministry government departments in the KwaZulu Natal (see table 9). A
triangulation of methodology was selected for the purpose of the study. Data collection
comprised of interviews, questionnaires surveys and policy document analysis. In-depth
interviews were conducted with 30 government communicators working across eight KZN
provincial government departments. A purposive snowball sampling was used to identify
the respondents. The identified respondents were, in addition to the interview, required to
complete the questionnaires (essential to quantify variables and to tackle sensitive
matters). To achieve a rich data and for additional validity, eight communication strategic
documents were analysed. For the purpose of delineating the policy framework guiding the
practice, the data findings from the analysis of government communication strategies were
presented in chapter 8. On this chapter (9), the
results from the interview and the
questionnaires (surveys) are presented in order to describe the practice of government
communication in the KZN provincial government.
In this chapter, a conscious decision was made not to temper with the data. As a result,
much of the data is presented in participants’ own words. In order to preserve objectivity, it
262
is a strong tradition in science to separate the results from the discussion of their
significance (Perry, 1998:34). Therefore, chapter 8 and chapter 9 discuss findings of the
research project with minimal analysis while Chapter 10 elaborates on the implications of
the findings within the context of literature, theories and the objectives of the study.
9.2
DEMOGRAPHICS
A total of eighteen 18 (60%) male and 12 (40%) female government communicators were
interviewed for the study conducted in the KwaZulu Natal province. Figure 2 demonstrates
gender while figure 3 demonstrates the racial demographic of the sample. In terms of
race, twenty-five participants (25) are of the black race, three are Indian (3) and two are of
the white race (2). Although reflective of the actual population dynamics of the KZN
province, this sample does not reflect much diversity.
Figure 2:
Demographics (gender)
Figure 3:
Demographics (race)
Government Communicators KZN demographics: Gender
Male
40%
60%
Female
263
9.3
PERCEIVED PRIVATE/PUBLIC DISTINCTION
From the interviews, none of the participants disputed that communication in the public
sector is different from communication in the private sector. “The private sector is too
different from government” (R19). However, few respondents seemed cognisant of this
actuality until the subject was introduced. For most respondents, it seemed like ‘an aha’
moment’ – a moment of realisation. The point of distinction however varied from
respondent to respondent.
Although, certain ‘distinctive’ features pertaining to the communication environment of the
public sector were already identified from literature and specific questions pertaining to
each feature of distinctiveness had been investigated separately (and directly), it was also
essential to examine practitioners’ views regarding their own perceptions of the
distinctiveness of the public sector’s communication environment. For this purpose,
participants were asked:
how do you view the similarities and differences of
communication management within the two sectors? From this enquiry, respondents
identified the following points of distinction:
Government communication is a public good evaluated by media scrutiny
The data reflects a robust confirmation of the existence of distinctive features: ‘public
good’, ‘high media scrutiny’ and ‘more stakeholders’ (Gelders & Ihlen, 2010:34; Liu &
Horsley, 2007:379). Some respondents mentioned, “it is different working for the private
sector. Much more eyes see you in here, government this or that; it is a bit more in the
public eye and more stakeholders” (R11). In addition, the media does not respond in the
same way to public and private institutions. “For the fact that this is a public sector, every
member of the public has an interest (public good). There is a higher media scrutiny
because government uses taxpayers’ money (media scrutiny). Therefore, they (citizens)
have the right to know what you doing with their money. You have to make sure they get
what they want” (public good) (R23). “The way they treat public and private entities will be
different” (R13). “Private entities are not obliged to communicate. They communicate
because they want to make money. They communicate to a certain level, because they
are marketing themselves; as government, you must communicate” (public good) (R23).
264
“There is a perception that the media always takes what government say with a pinch of
salt (media scrutiny). But it is important for us to enhance relationships with the media”
(R27). Unlike per Liu et al. (2010:192) findings, government communicators did not view
heightened media scrutiny and public good negatively.
Limited job specialisation in government communication
Communication management in the private sector is considered more glamorous,
specialised and diversified because stakeholders are also specialised. According to some
respondents, “the major difference is that with government communication , there is no
clear distinction and boundaries between communications, public relations, media liaison,
marketing, advertising and audio visuals (photography and video services).The private
sector, on the other hand, acknowledges differentiations between these professional roles”
(R8).
Corporate communication in the private sector was perceived as more specialised in role
performance that government communication: ‘You end up doing everything, just a little
bit, but with no specialisation”. Some respondents’ illustrated this point: “It is the same
work in the private sector, but much more differentiated. Work in the private sector is more
diversified” (R7). “Communication management in the private sector is different, the private
sectors is more glamorous, more specialised than the public sector” (R13). “Stakeholders
for the private sector are more specific and specialised; in government, stakeholders are
very vast” (R13).
Respondents contributed four additional features of differentiations, which are summarised
here. First, it was reiterated that government communication is not profit making
(Public good). “The difference is that government is not profit-making – our adverts are
not profit oriented” (R2). Government communicators are unsure of what they are
promoting or selling: department, policy, MEC or politics? “The main difference of
marketing in the private sector is that you promoting a brand – communicating brand
attributes to the public. In government, you get confused of whether you are promoting a
brand, a program, the department or the MEC. Even in some cases the party in power”
265
(R10). “What you are really promoting is municipal excellent” (R3). “We not selling a
product we market communication” added another respondent (R12).
A group of respondents claimed that there was less work to do in government ….In
private sectors, they have a lot of work, unlike in government, you will find that there are a
large number of people in one department, about twenty people for communication, so
they do not have a lot to do. “Here, the government is trying to create work for people; you
end up doing so little” (R10).
Government communication is political…“I think it is definitely different, here in
government I think is more political, I know it has to be about service delivery. But I have
seen that it is more political because at the end of the day we are working under political
heads” (R4).
The issue that government communication is not profit-making (public good) and that it is
political were already identified in literature. Furthermore, the first point that government
communication is in the public eye (media and public scrutiny) was similarly recognised in
literature. What was unexpected were claims among respondents that there was less work
to do in government and that government communicators were not always certain of what
they are supposed to be promoting, either the MEC, HOD, policies, ruling party or
services. Added to these unexpected findings, is the perception that there is no
specialisation in government communication.
9.4
POLITICS
The question asked in the interview session was “does politics affect your job?” Out of 30
interviewees, 17 respondents reported that politics had a significant effect on government
communication in general and on their daily practices in particular. In contrast, a few (n=6)
responded that politics did not have a major effect on doing their jobs. Two respondents (n
= 2) remained neutral (inconclusive) on the matter while the remaining five (n = 5) chose
not to comment on the question, suggesting rather to skip the question altogether. The
results from the survey data demonstrated a 33% positive, indicating that the effect of
266
politics is high and a 26 % negative, indicating that politics does not have much of an
effect on government communication practices. Figures 4 and 5 demonstrate this point
visually.
Please rate the following as high or low (Survey data)
HIGH
Politics
Figure 4:
Rate the impact of politics on your job
33%
LOW
26%
Survey data –impact of politics on government communication
40%
High
20%
Low
0%
Impact of politics on the practice of government
communication
Does Politics affect your job? (Interview data)
Yes
No
Neutral
No Comment
56%
20%
6%
16%
Figure 5:
Interview data - impact of politics on government communication
Does politics affect your job (interview data)
60%
50%
40%
Does politics affect your job
(interview data)
30%
20%
10%
0%
Yes
No
Neutral
No comment
267
9.4.1 THE EFFECTS OF POLITICS ON THE PRACTICE OF GOVERNMENT
COMMUNICATION
The follow-up question was finding out how politics actually affected the daily practices of
government communication. Six elements appeared to be the most affected by politics. In
order of their importance or intensity, they are as follows: (a) politics sets the agenda for
government communication (b) politics drives outreach programs (c) politics influences
communication content both, direct and mediated. (d) Politics influences appointments and
promotions in government communication positions. (e) Politics demands more energy,
resources and urgency towards the promotion of the MEC office, which is the political arm
of
government.
Lastly,
(f)
politics
influences
self-censorship
for
government
communicators not to appear aligned or unaligned to any fraction of political incumbents.
Each point is discussed next.
The majority claimed that politics sets the agenda for government communication. By
setting the agenda, we mean influencing government communication practices in terms of
what is said and done, when it is said and done, how and when it is said and done. Some
respondent claim: “Politics does affect what we do. Our work is dependent on the political
drive at the time” (R7). For example, another communication officer mentioned that:
“Politics does affect my job because … every time there are elections, the pattern of our
work changes, there is more campaigning, more events, more work. Even after elections,
there might be a reshuffling of cabinet. And maybe I have branding with a certain MEC’s
face; I will have to change them.” (R19). In support to this point, a senior communication
manager had stated that “politicians drives the agenda, ours is to implement” (R4). A
further comment, also from a very senior communication manager illustrates this point:
“We are manifesting the ruling party. Politics sets the agenda - the key is that it should get
to the point of service delivery structure” (R1).
Contrasting this sentiment were some senior managers who opine that, “opposition parties
are setting the agenda” (R16). This is slightly different from what was argued by the
majority of participants regarding this issue. Whilst others see the ruling party setting the
agenda for government communication in terms of what should be done, these
respondents believe that government communication is responding to the agenda set by
268
the opposition parties through the media. A small minority also highlighted a similar point,
hinting that government communication is somewhat responsive to the media and its
politics (external pressure). This resonates with the feature of permeability, meaning,
public organisations are considered ‘open systems’ that are easily influenced by external
events (Rainey, 2009, 75-76).
The second element in which politics affect government communication is by driving
outreach programmes. A fraction of respondents pointed out that politics drives outreach
programmes or the areas in which they communicate. For example, one participant
eloquently articulated that “political pressure determines where we communicate; it is as
blatant as to which district we communicate” (R13). Another participant posits that, “All
imbizo’s are made at black communities” (R6). Within those outreach programmes, politics
may affect the nature of the activity and even the content of the message. “It depends on
the place, if it is politically driven. For example, if it is an IFP dominant, then
communication will be made political. If the MEC knows if it is an ANC area, they push
their agenda. But if they do not know, they try not to make it political” (R10).
The third element emerging from the data was that politics influences communication
content both direct and mediated. A significant number of respondents mentioned this
point. One senior respondent revealed, “It was only in 2009 that we had a one party
government in KZN. This ensured coherent and constant messages” (R4). As declared by
several participants, content is the most affected by politics: “It (politics) only affects me
when I have to communicate decisions taken by political leadership. Otherwise, I am
treated like any other official” (R29). One highly experienced mid-manager cautioned that,
“I can’t go and communicate what I want, it comes from the cabinet” (R3). As mentioned
by some respondents, government communication is inherently political because it
communicates about matters that are inherently political. For example, one participant
states that “programmes and policies come from the politicians (MEC cabinet) and these
are the issues or content on which we communicate”. Further emphasising this point is an
explanation that:
269
“Whatever is being communicated in government is actually reflective of the political
positions that have been taken by government through its diverse political
positions”. For me, the issue is that you have to reflect the policy position. That
policy position has a political content in it. So, in a way, it (politics) does (affect me),
but in the same time, one has to maintain an impartial position. The communication
practitioners must retain an impartial position. Their role is to provide a professional
support to a political incumbent who has to communicate a wide range of policy
position with regard to his portfolio which also takes a cue from the provincial or
national government” (R26).
The following quotations from participants, with the title Head of Communication, illustrate
the influence of the MEC office (the political arm of government) on the content of
government communication:
“The key messenger is the MEC; the MEC goes out there himself. The
spokesperson in the office of the premier communicates about cabinet decisions”
(R1).
The MEC is directly involved in all communication efforts, contributing ideas on how
communication can be improved, (R9)”.
“I had a four hour session with the MEC telling me his vision for communication”
(R21)
Regarding the fourth element, only a few respondents mentioned the point that politics
influences appointments and promotions to government communication positions. The
insinuation is that, “all appointments are political in nature, the MEC can appoint of people
she wants to work with. In practice, education and qualifications have little impact because
appointment and promotions are politically motivated” (R6). Based on in-depth interviews,
the researcher can attest to two communication personnel appointed at senior levels
because the MEC indorsed their appointment. Those communication personnel had no
communication background but they carried with them functional knowledge of the
270
portfolio of the department. Such appointments are against the principles of the excellence
theory, which requires communication units to appoint professionals with a specialised
body of knowledge in the field of communication management (Grunig, 2007:45).
Technically, only communication personnel working in MEC offices, the political arm of
government, are handpicked and linked to the term of office (and the satisfaction) of the
MEC, whereas government communicators in general are government employees and not
particularly linked to the term of the MEC. “The MEC has his own media liaison officer,
who speaks on his behalf. The appointee is politically motivated, because his/her contract
is linked to the term of office of the MEC. Unlike me, if the MEC goes, the other MEC will
have to decide whether he likes to keep me on or not. If He or she prefers to bring
someone else in the department, they will deploy me to another section or directorate,
which will not change my salary level or benefits” (R21).
With reference to the fifth element, a significant number of respondents declared that
politics demanded more energy, resources and urgency to be deployed towards the
promotion of the MEC office, which is the political arm of government. The reason is that
the panic levels of the MEC and the HOD are not the same. “The MEC has a particular
period in office. The MEC must actually perform; (otherwise) they are reshuffled. The HOD
is more secure as he/she is protected by labour laws. Thus, the pace at which both will
want things done will depend on their panic levels. For the MEC, what is in the media can
cause the premier to remove him” (21). This point is later expounded when discussing the
perceived value of communication between the HOD group (administration) and the MEC
group (politics).
The last point (sixth) is that politics influences self-censorship on government
communicators not to appear aligned or unaligned to any fraction of the political
incumbents. A sizable minority mentioned this point under the context of discussing politics
while others made reference to this point in passing when discussing other matters. Some
government communicators expressed the pressure of expectant partisanship to various
structures and individuals within opposing political camps of one ruling party. “You must
always speak positively about them. You cannot speak negatively. Sometimes you feel
271
deceitful in attempt to protect your political leader by making a positive story” (R23). “The
current challenge (partisanship) is as solid as structures and camps, even within one
political party. As communication, you feel compelled to choose sides” (R5). In addition,
“Politics affect what we do. I cannot mention so and so because they are a part of which
camp. You never know, who is who in the zoo” (R10).
9.4.2
IS POLITICS INTRINSIC TO GOVERNMENT COMMUNICATION?
Another point emanating from the data was how accepting or unaccepting respondents
(government communicators) are of the effect of politics on their jobs. A sizable majority
(20) of respondents were accepting of politics being part of government, and hence, an
inherent part of government communication. However, they did not essentially judge the
desirability or distress about this matter; they merely mentioned politics as something
which is there. One respondent for example stated, “Politics sets the agenda - the key is
that it should get to the point of service-delivery”. This insinuates that politics is okay as
long as it leads to service-delivery or at least it should not destruct from service-delivery.
What was surprising however was that even those who said that politics had no influence
on their job (n=6), did not automatically deny the inherent effects of politics on government
communication. They contended rather that they knew how to insulate politics from their
jobs. For example, “I don’t feel that politics affects my job at all. Every organisation has its
own internal politics. It depends on whether you are able to adapt” (R14).
A small quantity of respondents highlighted their attempts to separate politics from
government communication. Practitioners mentioned some of the methods they use to
insulate the effects of politics on government communication:
•
Government branding - no party branding especially for outreach events like
imbizos and project Sukuma Sakhe, which may be mistaken by rural publics as
an ANC’s (ruling-party) visit. There should be a separation between party politics
and government administration. In events, only government branding should be
used. “There is a separation between party politics and government because in
events, we only brand in government branding” (R13).
272
•
Professionalisation – A significant number of respondents claimed that being
professional translates to being able to insulate the effects of politics from
government communication. “One has to maintain an impartial position. The
communication practitioners must retain an impartial position. Their role is to
provide a professional support to a political incumbent” (R26).
•
Work experience – some participants reported that work experience yield the
ability to separate politics from government communication. This follows
recognition
that
government
communication
is
part
of
government
administration, and not part of the political wing of the ruling party. For example,
argued the most experienced respondent (in terms of years employed), “Being
someone who has been here for a long time, I know I have to separate politics
from administration and if there is a new premier he will do things differently. It
doesn’t affect my job at all” (R3).
•
Being able to adapt – being able to adapt refers to acknowledging the nature of
politics and being cognisant not to be implicated by it (R22).
A few respondents denied politics as a unique feature of the communication environment
of the public sector (government). They claimed instead that politics was everywhere, in
the private sector, in government and in non-governmental bodies: “politics is in our lives,
whether you are in the public sector, there is politics and whether you are in the private
sector there is also politics there” (R14). The effect of politics in one’s job is perhaps a
subjective matter as it was found that two government communicators on the same level
and working for the same department perceived the effect of politics differently. One found
politics influential in her daily operations whilst the other found it insignificant. This was
startling.
The effect of politics on government communication depends on the organisational
structure of where the communication department is positioned. “It is a question of
structure, of where the communication unit is positioned in the department” (R2). As
established, politics mostly affects practitioners whose communication portfolios fall under
the auspices of the MEC. “By virtue of working in the political office, one deals with it
(politics). However professional one can be, it is possible to be unaffected by politics”
273
(R20). Another distinctive feature of the public sector communication environment is legal
constraints, which are discussed next.
9.5 THE EFFECTS OF LEGAL CONSTRAINTS ON THE PRACTICE OF
GOVERNMENT COMMUNICATION
The two interview questions covered in this section were: Are there any laws or legal
issues that stifle your ability to communicate? And how affected is government
communication by the bureaucracies of government? A portion of respondents (n = 10)
claimed that legal constraints limit their ability to communicate freely. In contrast, a
minority (n= 4) did not perceive much impact. The rest (n = 16) did not express an opinion
on this matter, commonly stating “I am not sure”. The impacts of legal constraints are
hereby categorised into four related themes: (1) the protocol of consulting and information
gathering, (2) the protocol of consulting and approval, (3) confidentiality and information
classification and (4) bureaucracy and red tape. Each is described in further details.
9.5.1
THE PROTOCOL OF CONSULTING AND INFORMATION GATHERING
Those who mentioned the existence of legal constraints on government communication
highlighted some of the issues that constrain the nature of their practice. One of the
biggest and most cited issue relate to the protocol of consulting and information gathering.
Before responding to government issues in the media, social media and anywhere in the
public sphere, government communicators are expected to consult with the concerned
business unit, directorate or individuals for both research (collating information) and to
attain communication directives. Whilst essential, this protocol is said to be a lengthy and
time-consuming process. The following quotations express this point:
“For you to communicate something, it has to go through too many steps. By the
time it gets approved, the media is no longer interested” (R16).
“With government communication, it does affect it a lot, we are bonded by protocol.
The issues of legality, protocol and processes significantly affect the way we
274
communicate with our stakeholders. It makes things difficult because from the other
side of the fence, we are perceived as concealing information. At the end of the
day, there is nothing to hide. We are just not able to divulge certain information at
certain times” (R15).
The excerpts above regarding the protocol of consultation and information gathering refer
to the top-down communication from the government to key external publics including the
media. With regard to communicating external feedback from key publics to government,
the protocol regarding information flow is similarly too rigid. It takes long for information to
move from key stakeholders on the ground to the designated authorities. For example, a
respondent illustrates this process on environmental scanning: “once information is
gathered using protocol procedures, information would go from the communication officer,
to the supervisor, to senior communication manager, to communication director in a
document and e-mails. Form the general manager; it will then move outside the
communication department to the deputy director general who will then transfer it to the
premier”. This process is excessively long and cumbersome and often distorts the
message in the course of its trajectory to reach top management. This is an indicator of a
closed system.
The protocol of consultation and information gathering pose an even bigger challenge on
social media. The urgency of social media obliterates all lengthy protocols of consultation,
research, information verification and acquisition of communication directives. This is often
a slippery ground susceptible of content mistakes, misinformation and unapproved
information by government. Two respondents entrusted with social media, illustrate this
point:
“On some occasion, I take the liberty of responding to certain matters because on
social media, you can’t say, we noted your comment and someone will get back to
you because that person will think that you deflecting the issue” (R5).
“I would say we working on very slippery grounds, because sometimes someone
could mention something on legislation policy or anything related to a political
matter and when you respond based on your own understanding of the subject
275
matter, which is not necessarily wrong, the citizen might not happy about it. Then
the government authorities can say, ‘I dint say that’. So officially, there is a
discrepancy between what is official and what is personal” (R25).
In addition, only selected people have the prerogative to communicate about cabinet
issues or to respond to the media. Only media liaison officers, the department’s head of
communication and MEC spokespeople are permitted to respond to the media.
9.5.2
THE PROTOCOL OF CONSULTING AND APPROVAL
Another protocol or process mentioned by some respondents is that ‘communication is
controlled’. Government communication content, ideas and output are controlled and must
be approved before implementation: “Everything we produce is controlled because it has
to go to someone else for approval (R8)”. “Everything goes to the higher up – they
(management) change it completely – you don’t even recognise your own work afterwards.
This is a major problem for me because; there are rules in graphic-design within the
branding manual” (R7). Those instructing changes are seldom communication trained, so
they may contravene certain communication conventions as set out by the branding
manual or contravene journalistic conventions regarding news-values. This means that
government communication output many be unpublishable as being devoid of
newsworthiness. This may have a negative effect on media relations.
9.5.3
BUREAUCRACY AND RED TAPE
Related to the above theme, other participants mentioned the impact of bureaucracy upon
the practice of government communication. “One of the disadvantages of government is
bureaucracy. Government is full of systems” (R20). “The organisation is hierarchical which
stifles those who are at the bottom” (R2). An additional challenge to government
communication is the bureaucracy regarding budgeting, timing and planning. It takes time
for top management to approve budgets, communication strategies and appointments. It
also takes time to conclude planning, which means that events are organised in a rush and
invitations to the media and the public are equally rushed: “bureaucracy affects the quality
276
of government communication. If things were better planned, we would not be in a crisis
mode all the time. The quality of the practice would be better. Notifications are given on
the day before an event that branding and communication support would be required.
There is insufficient planning time. At the end of it, the communication department looks
incompetent” (R13).
Adding to bureaucracy, the position of director of communication remained vacant for a
lengthy period of time in two of the sampled departments. Furthermore, in another set of
two departments, communication strategies were not yet approved. Respondents claimed
there were no explanations provided by management reflecting the reasons why
communication strategies were not approved regardless of repeated revisions made on
the documents. There were no explanation either on the reasons delaying the appointment
of the Head of Communication (HoD).
9.5.4
Figure 6:
CONFIDENTIALITY AND INFORMATION CLASSIFICATION
Survey data – value of transparency in government communication
HIGH
Transparency
LOW
Rate your personal value to transparency.
60%
0
Rate the level of transparency in your department.
66%
0
Rate your support of the information bill
40%
13%
Rate politicians/management support of transparency.
33%
20%
100%
50%
High
0%
Personal
value to
transparency
Value of
transparency
in the
department
Support of
the
Information
Bill
MEC/HOD
value of
transparency
Low
277
Figure 6 presenting the interview data and the survey data depicts perceptions regarding
the value of transparency in government communication. The survey data demonstrates
that government communicators perceive a high level of personal value to transparency
and an equally high departmental value to transparency. Government management
structure such as the MEC and the HOD were similarly ranked high in transparency
principles. Conversely and ironically, a high support for the information bill was reflected in
the data.
Confidentiality was mentioned as a communication constraint in government. Some
respondents noted that they often fail to disclose information because of confidentiality.
Two departments in particular mentioned this point. The Department of Health was
especially vocal of the challenge of confidentiality. A senior government communicator
pointed out that “we have an obligation of patient confidentially, and as such, we are not
able to release certain information at certain times. We are not able to discuss these
matters with the media and without such information, the media merely speculates on
issues” (R15). Explaining further is another respondent, “In the Department of Health, we
are controlled by issues of confidentiality. For example, a person could have died of
HIV/AIDS, but we will not be able to disclose this information. Journalists do not
understand this” (R14).
Government has rules and regulations. However, government communicators do not
always know what is classified and what is not: “Sometimes you are not told what is
confidential. You have to know the systems of government” (R15). At an entry level,
government communicators might not understand what can and cannot be communicated:
“You learn as you go in government, there is no one to train you” (R17).
9.6
MANAGEMENT SUPPORT FOR GOVERNMENT COMMUNICATION
The purpose of this theme was to determine the value of government communication
attached by the dominant coalition, especially the politicians (MEC group) and the
administrators. The key question was, ‘do you feel management appreciate the value of
communication? Of the 30 respondents, a sizable number (n=10) reported that
278
government communication is valued by management. On the contrary, the majority
(n=15) claimed that management do not sufficiently value government communication
because they do not understand its role. A portion of the respondents (n=5) remained
neutral, resisting to generalise; claiming rather that in some departments management
understood the value of government communication while others did not. It also depended
on the business units (directorates) and the individual manager. A respondent noted,
“Some managers value communication, some don’t. Some will tell you about
communication when it suits them” (R16). The survey data on figure 7 demonstrates that
46 percent of the respondents rated managements’ value of government communication
highly while 33 percent rated it poorly.
Figure 7:
Survey data- management support for government communication
HIGH
Rate the value of government communication as perceived by
Devaluation of
Communication by
Management
management?
Rate the value of government communication as perceived by the
general public?
LOW
46%
33%
33%
46%
50%
40%
30%
High
20%
Low
10%
0%
Value of government
communication as perceived by
management
Value of government
communication as perceived by
the public
The main reason behind the devaluation of government communication could be ascribed
to poor understanding of the nature and purpose of the communication unit in government.
The majority of respondents suggested that management did not value government
communication because they did not understand it. Those managers who understood
government communication, also valued it. Figure 8 demonstrates the survey data on the
279
perceptions held by respondents regarding the value the dominant coalition accords
government communication.
Figure 8: Management understanding of government communication
YES
NO
Neutral
33%
43%
26%
Management Understanding of Government
Communication
60%
40%
Management Understanding of
Government Communication
20%
0%
Yes
No
Neutral
In summary, the following are some of the reasons behind the devaluation of government
communication. First, managers did not value government communication because they
do not understand it. There is a devaluation of communication because of lack of
understanding (R13). Secondly, management ascribes their own ideologies concerning the
role and purpose of government communication: I really do not think that our senior
management understands exactly what we do. Perhaps they do not understand the value
of communication or they have their own ideologies of what communication should be in
government” (R2). Thirdly, “the challenge is that in most departments, people do not take
communication seriously”. Communication is seen as a supporting function or a technical
tool. Fourthly, communication is only valued when there is a crises or during outreach
programmes for the provision of media coverage and branding. Fifthly, budgets constraint
stifles the ability of communication to provide a quality service. Lastly, management do not
support communication because they have their own fears. “Management and politicians
do not understand communication. If they do, they disregard it; some people have their
280
own fears – fears of the unknown.
Communication is undervalued” (R4).
Thus,
communication is not valued beyond the provision of technical services.
9.6.1 GOVERNMENT COMMUNICATION SEEN AS TECHNICAL OR
SUPPORTING INSTRUMENT
A significant number of respondents mentioned that management does not value
government communication because they perceive it as a technical function, merely a
supporting tool: “Another challenge is a lack of understanding of government
communication by management and politicians because they regard it as a technical tool”.
“Generally government communication is we need banners, flyers and graphic design;
beyond that, government communication is not given the adequate recognition it deserves”
(R19). Referring to business units (directorates), some respondents note, “People have
that idea ukuthi (that) we are just taking photos – there is nothing else that we do, even if
when there are events, they will say okay you’ll come and take photos? They don’t
understand, they think we taking photos and travelling, that is all” (R20). Speaking of the
devaluation of communication, some participants claimed, “Communication is seen as ‘by
the way we need communication” (R16). “Managers also think communication is media
relations” (R22). Communication is much more than media-relations.
9.6.2
POOR UNDERSTANDING OF MEDIA RELATIONS
Related to poor understanding of communication, senior administrative managers and
politicians furthermore misconstrue the practice of media-relations. Management do not
always understand how the media operates. They expect media to be available all the time
and for all coverage to be positive. “They do not understand, politicians want to see media
all the time, otherwise, they think we are not doing our job” (R4). In addition, “They
(management and politicians) don’t understand the news values of the media. One can
devote time and money to media relations but achieve no visible results because the rules
of the media were contravened” (R16).
281
Poor understanding of media-relations, limited understanding of journalistic conversions,
compounded with limited newsroom etiquette and a general failure to understand the
operations of the media are challenges to the process of information gathering in
government communication. Media-liaison officers in various government departments
mainly expressed this point: “In overall, my experience with management is that they don’t
really understand. In addition, with senior officials, you have to drill the matter of ‘urgency’
– they do not understand the ins and outs of the newsroom. Their attitude is that you
cannot just give this question and demand the answer now. Not realising the implication of
when the journalist decides to publish without the response from the department” (R23).
On average, respondents worry of being devoid a seat in the decision-making table at the
Management Committee (Manco) and the Executive Committee (Exco) meetings. In such
cases, government communication managers are not accorded the opportunity to convey
the value of communication or to represent the needs and contributions of the
communication unit to the highest echelon of management (the dominant coalition). One
senior communication manager raises this point, “if I don’t sit at the decision-making table
where the MEC sits. How am I supposed to know what the department is doing?
Communication managers do not have a say on the departmental strategy” (R6). Another
senior manager added, “Communication should be a management function. Not in my
department, communication is not regarded as a management function” (R17).
9.6.3
BUDGET CONSTRAINTS
Some respondents argued that even if communication is valued, not enough support is
provided. This is one of the effects of the devaluation of communication. All respondents (n
=30) complained of budget constraints. They claimed they did not have sufficient budgets
for government communication needs. “Communication budgets are lower than other
business unit in the department” (R1). “One of the most significant challenges in the public
sector is financial restrictions. Communication units receive a tiny budget leading to the
near impossibility of reaching external audiences in remote areas (R13). “There is a lack of
investment in communication. You need the buy-in and the investment from the seniors”
(R5). Government communicators mentioned that budgets constraints affected the quality
282
of their work: “Not enough funding is provided for communications. We cannot do enough
because we don’t have money. Even with fewer staff, you can do whatever it takes if there
is funding” (R16). “We mass produce in black and white because there is no money”
(R13). Please see additional comments on the challenges of budget constraints:
I do not think we have enough budgets, because sometimes we want to do
something and they say we do not have budget, they keep on reducing the number
year after year. We do not have promotional materials (R15).
So when it comes to budgeting, you have to battle to get support because you have
to justify each and every submission you make with regard to the allocation of
resources for communication even if you provide motivation in terms of market
values, you’d have a situation where someone says I did not know that the advert is
so expensive. Is there no other way to communicate this issue? (R26).
Most affected by budget constraints are those working on the technical sides of
communication and most reliant on high technological equipment in order to perform their
jobs. Graphic designers, web managers, photographers, videographers and marketers
exemplify this group. These professionals bemoaned budget constraints and its impact on
upgrading hardware and software required in their professions: “I have been requesting
upgrade causes in graphic-design, when the private sector is moving somewhere
(improving), we are still (left) here” (R7). Another respondent adds:
“Managers are less interested in the technicalities of communication; they just want
to see the end result. However, you do it, as long as it is done despite the technical
challenges caused by outdated technologies. They always say there is no budget
for it.” (R5).
283
9.6.4 ADDITIONAL CHALLENGES CAUSED BY THE DEVALUATION OF
GOVERNMENT COMMUNICATION
Additional effects caused by the devaluation of communication relate to poor working
conditions, particularly being understaffed: “We don’t have time. We are understaffed, we
are tired, we work under pressure” (R2). Such devaluation accounts for poor salaries and
poor professional development: “We earn less than private sectors because there is no
money” (R3). Limited professional development is the reason for the exodus to the private
sectors and the job-hopping between government departments in search for better
salaries, working conditions and career developments: “There is no skill development or
support; I would move to the private sector for job satisfaction and to feel valued” (R19).
Another challenge related to the devaluation of communication is that politicians and
management are not always willing to listen to the advice provided by the communication
unit. “As communicators, we give them advice. However, we have a problem because
politicians think they know everything” (R9). The dominant coalition rather has the media
and communications handled according to management directives, not the other way
around. “There could be something in the newspaper and they want us to respond in a
certain inappropriate way” (R12).
Only two respondents acknowledged that communication devaluation in government might
be caused by the inability of government communicators to depict its value through
constant communication evaluations demonstrating the impact, successes and returns of
government communication. Government communication has “no value because it is not
evaluated” (R13).
When asked whose role it was to educate management of the value of communication,
most respondents recommended that the GCIS should step in to perform this task. “GCIS
would do a better job in terms of enforcing the culture of knowing what communication
does, and what government departments should do to enhance its function (R19).
Additionally, “the GCIS should step in to educate politicians about the role and purpose of
government communication and the nature of the media” (R21). Communication managers
were similarly identified in their role to educate the dominant coalition of the purpose,
284
nature and value of government communication. “I think we (government communicators)
should be doing so with the help of the GCIS, it would be difficult if it is just us, we need
support from the GCIS and other senior managers within the department” (R18). The
GCIS is there to capacitate communicators, when it comes to educating the administrative
structure of the department. However, it is also the HOD’s responsibility unless if he is not
getting through to them. In such a case, the GCIS should step in” (R17).
9.6.5 THE VALUE POLITICAL AND ADMINISTRATIVE
ATTACHED TO GOVERNMENT COMMUNICATION
MANAGERS
It was unanticipated that the administrative and the political managers would be
differentiated by government communicators. The researcher had clustered managers into
a single group, merely asking if the dominant coalition understood the value of
communication. It soon emerged that government communicators viewed the two groups
differently. Albeit government communicators provide services to both the HOD group and
the MEC group, they perceive the value of communication to be differently exerted by
each side. A significant number of respondents indicated that politicians (the MEC group)
value government communication more than the administrative side (HOD & directorates).
The following quotations express this point:
“One of our greatest challenges is that the politicians understand
communication better than the business units. The political principals are
much more knowledgeable of communication than your technocrats” (R9).
“I think the MEC groups understand communication better than the
administrative side. The administrative side is the worst” (R15).
Politicians tend to be more inclined to understand and to value
communication.
Even
though
some
administrators
appreciate
communication, in most cases, line function managers are less likely to have
a full view of government communication (R27).
285
9.6.6
REASONS POLITICAL MANAGERS VALUE COMMUNICATION
Several reasons were offered to explain why political managers (MEC group) valued
communication more than administrative managers. The first reason is that politicians are
more experienced (from their campaigning days) of media-relations and issues pertaining
to public opinion: “In their political trajectory, politicians become media savvy as they
usually started out as activist involved in several campaigns” (R26). Another respondent
added, “The fortune that I have is that my MEC was a former secretary general of the ANC
in the province, so he was dealing much with the media – so he understands the media”
(R21).
The second reason is that politicians (MEC group) are more reliant on the communication
unit as they utilise it more: “The legitimacy of the MEC group is dependent on the
communication unit (PR) to make them look good out there. Hence they valued it better
because they work with it more” (R15). The third reason provided was that administrative
managers consider government communication only as a support function in the core
business of the department such as health, education, social development et cetera. One
participant articulates this point further:
“The administrative side is more focused on service-delivery. Communication is just
support. Their focus is glued on improving the core. They know that as much as they have
to maintain the image of the department in the media and the public, when it come to the
assessment of the department, they will not be assessed on that (image), but rather on the
core business of the department. They are concerned with the output and the servicedelivery, of which they are actually measured on. The department will not be measured by
how much media publicity they got” (R10).
A few of the respondents expressed an opinion to the contrary, arguing instead that
administrative managers valued communication more than politicians did, whereas,
“political appointees value communication only as far as it markets their policies” (R21).
286
A small group of participants claimed that communication was valued by management in
two occasions: when there are events in order to do publicity, media coverage and
branding (the technicals of communication) and during crises or media scrutiny in order to
carry out some spin doctoring. Some respondents declared that those were the only two
occasions in which management is willing to listen and comply with communicators’
advice. “Communication is valued in two ways, you find that people value you when they
have messed up or when the event they were involved in was successful” (R26). Another
respondent adds to this point. “Up until there is negativity or a crisis, they tend to think
everything is smooth, you do not need to communicate”. The devaluation of government
communication falls short of the requisite strategic communication principles.
9.7
STRATEGIC GOVERNMENT COMMUNICATION
(The role of communication in strategic management)
Literature in both strategic management and strategic communication identify specific
elements that must be emplaced for strategic communication to contribute to the
effectiveness of the organisation. In the literature review, five elements were indicated as
benchmarks for organisational effectiveness. First, government communication should be
practiced as a management function. Secondly, there must be a communication manager,
at a senior position, to manage government communication strategically. Thirdly, the
communication unit should be accommodated at the department’s decision-making table,
and fourthly, it must exert significant influence over the overall strategic management of
the department. Fifthly, and finally yet importantly, strategic government communication
should act as a verifying tool through issue management, boundary spanning, and
environmental scanning. These components were evaluated in the context of government
communication in the KZN provincial government. The following findings emerged from the
interview sessions with senior government communicators.
9.7.1
GOVERNMENT COMMUNICATION AS A MANAGEMENT FUNCTION
Literature impose that government communication should be practiced as a management
function. However, half of the participants claimed that government communication was
287
viewed as a technical function, rather than a strategic one. “Communication should be a
management function” (R17). Moreover, “when communication is considered a technical
tool, it becomes very operational; it diminishes its strategic significance” (R26). This is
formidable
because
a
“lack
of
policy
documentation
relegates
communication
management to a reactionary rather than a proactive function” (R16).
There are wonderful pocket of excellent in this department that should have gone
back to the masses. That is not happening because there are those barriers, those
obstacles in between, the red tapes and all of that. This is discouraging. Your
initiatives fall apart. Imagine when you introduce initiatives to people who do not
take communication as a management function, it seems like you are flogging a
dead horse. It is an unfortunate situation (R17).
Some respondents argued that government communication should be a strategic function.
It was acknowledged, albeit by a few practitioners, that for government communication to
be strategic, it must be elevated from being operational: “Strategic communication is
where you elevate it from being operational. Operational is when you communicate the key
element of the strategy, it is about implementation of the strategy. Strategic
communication, on the other hand, is about the high level thinking as to say what is it that
we want to do and how do we want to do it. Once we have agreed about that we may now
start implementing” (R26). Several government communicators referred to strategic
communication management as an act of ‘thinking’. The level of education was perceived
as a catalyst to the ‘thinking act’ essential for strategic government communication. “For
one to put together a policy, one must be educated. You can talk, but one must be to think
as well” (R11).
Strategic communication entails thinking about the genesis, the present and the future of
the organisation, “how we think of audiences, what kind of information is being generated
and how is it packaged, how is it disseminated, what kind of feedback do we anticipate
and how do we respond to that feedback. Government communicators must be cognisant
of how these choices affect the organisation” (R8).
288
9.7.2 COMMUNICATION MANAGER TO MANAGE GOVERNMENT
COMMUNICATION STRATEGICALLY
To manage government communication strategically, a manager at a senior position must
be in charge of the communication unit. It is established in literature that a communication
manager, at a head of communication level, is essential to represent the communication
unit at the management structure of the government department. However, three
departments among the sample did not retain a communication manager (during the time
of study). The effects of this omission are presented below:
The structure says we should have a senior manager. I we do not even have a
senior communication manager. It means that at the higher level, at the executive
level, nobody understands the imperatives of communication (R17).
Our problem is that we do not have a manager since 2009. Hence, projects remain
incomplete and we fail to archive specific goals. Although managers from other
directorship could assist, they do not simply approve certain things because they do
not understand their necessity. The situation could improve if there is a permanent
communication manager acting as a spokesperson for the unit (R20).
The communication manager should sit in exco, the decision-making table, and
offer advice on the direction of the department. If there is no communication
representative there, the department is subject to doom and that should not
happen” (R17).
9.7.3
INVOLVEMENT IN ORGANISATIONAL DECISION-MAKING
One of the central elements defined in literature as a precondition for strategic
communication to work effectively in adding value to the operations of the department is
that the communication manager must sit in the management committee and be involved
in organisational decision-making. This issue was a serious point of contention in that a
289
little more than half of the senior management in this study reported to have permanent
seats at the decision-making table of exco and manco:
“We have the head of communication sitting in two influential structures. He sits in
exco (executive management) and manco (management committees) and has a
direct interaction with the MEC” (R1).
Our manager does sit at the decision-making table
(R30)
Yes, I sit at Exco. I contribute to all deliberations taking place (R29).
Less than half of the sample reported that they do not have seats in those management
committees.
For
example,
an
acting
head
of
communication
observed
“communication managers do not have a seat in the decision-making table.
that,
What
happens currently is a top-down structure whereby the unit is instructed by the dominant
coalition. (R17).
9.7.4
INFLUENCE ON STRATEGIC MANAGEMENT OF THE DEPARTMENT
Respondents were asked to delineate the extent to which the communication unit exert
influence over strategic decisions, programmes, and legislative policies of the government
department. Most participants confirmed that “strategic communication should influence
policy directions” and that “communication is critical in the policy development process”
(R14). Despite having an average amount of communication managers accommodated at
the decision making table, only a few exerted a significant strategic influence over the
overall management of the department. Those who claimed to have an influence in
strategic management identified the points:
Government communicators influence strategic management on an advisory role:
We offer strategic input. Communication fulfils a strategic advisory role. The MEC
office regularly solicits input on communication matters. On that note, we do render
that strategic role (R4).
290
Government communicators influence strategic management decisions by offering
intelligence about the environment:
“I am allowed to sit in these strategic meetings; I am able to advice, to throw light
on the public opinion that is published by the media” (R9).
“There is no legislation of this department that I do not see. When legislations are
drafted, I am part of the process. As communicators, we occupy strategic positions.
We draft notes for principals and that allows us to shape direction and influence
policies” (R8).
The power of government communication to influence policy-decisions depends on
the personality of the head of the communication unit.
“It has to do with the capacity of the head of communication and his/her own
individual drive as a leader. People will value managers who make valuable
contributions. They listen to them. But if communication managers merely go there
to sit and listen, often failing to debate issues, then they are likely to be ignored and
excluded in future” (R9).
The majority of respondents claimed that the communication unit did not have much
influence over the strategic decisions, programmes, or the legislature policies of the
government department. “Communication doesn’t have a say on what happens,” claimed a
respondent. The major reason given for this is already addressed in the section above;
that the communication unit does not have an influence over strategic decision because it
is viewed by management as a technical function:
Not only do we communicate, we also offer advice on issues concerning key
stakeholders. However, officials are arrogant; they stay in their offices, losing touch
with public opinion. This makes it imperative for someone to offer advice on strategy
development. On the contrary, the communication unit rarely contribute to
291
legislation on matters other than media and current affairs. We do sit there just to
listen.
The following are additional reasons preventing the communication unit to influence the
strategic decisions, programmes or the legislature policies of the government department:
Communication managers may have seats in the decision making table, in exco and
manco. However, it seems that they are hardly contributing. Most claimed it was essential
to attend those meetings in order to better understand the policies and strategies enough
to be able to communicate them in the media and to the public:
We always attend the meetings to understand policies.
I listen to the MEC address people so I could comprehend his approach. I sit in all
the strategic meetings of the department when he meets his top management
(MMM – MEC Management Meetings). Just sitting in these meetings, you don’t
have to say anything, just listening on how issues are addressed” (R21).
The third reason given as an explanation why government communication does not have
an influence over strategic decisions, programmes, or the legislature policies of the
government department is that government is in its nature bureaucratic. There are many
processes and people involved at various layers of government (national, provincial and
local) in setting goals and in making strategic decisions. Where does government
communication start to influence strategy within this process? A respondent questioned:
Government communication does not have influence over policies; health is a dual
responsibility at national and provincial level, so policies come from both, we only
communicates information that is sent (R16).
Before the policy is implemented, there are processes of engagement and public
consultation. It is only once that processes have been done that policies go into
effect.I don’t foresee any much effect that communication would have on policy
(R15).
292
9.7.5
STRATEGIC GOVERNMENT COMMUNICATION AS A VERIFYING TOOL
Strategic government communication should act as a verifying tool through issue
management, boundary spanning, and environmental scanning. Some head of
communication participant spoke in details about the use of strategic communication for
monitoring. The respondents mentioned the value of strategic government communication
as a verifying tool necessary to combat foul play and corruptions through transparency.
This is only made possible by constant environmental monitoring, issue management and
boundary spanning between the department and its public. This point is clarified:
The two streams of accountability in government are public (society) and legislation.
The department reports to legislature through annual reports on how well the
department is doing. Half of things in the annual report are not true. We are doing
well in showing legislation that we are doing well, but we are failing in
demonstrating successes to the publics (24).
The department like any other suffers from corruption. Strategic communication is
able to reduce corruption by strengthening accountability that is only achievable by
open communication. For example, by reporting on events and money spent could
bring accountability to these events and the usage of taxpayers’ money (R6).
Currently, government officials claim to have done such and such for a particular
community, when that community knows nothing of the sort. We must use strategic
communication to build accountability by tracking and reporting on government
behaviour. Communication is a verifying tool – no monitoring, no pictures, and no
documentation.
9.8
COMMUNICATION EVALUATIONS
In this section of the interview, government communicators were asked the following
question as expressed below:
293
According to literature, strategic communication involves environmental scanning,
compilation of information from the environment and communicating this to
management. Management will henceforth consider arising information and make
decisions, policies, and legislations in respond to the identified public issues. It
becomes an iterative process. How do you see this process working in your
department?
The respondents unanimously acknowledged the value of public consent in strategic
decisions. It was stated that, “strategic communicating is a consistent way of inspiring
consent to an organisation's strategic direction by its targeted audience”. The purpose of
this section is to explore how feedback from communication evaluations is incorporated
into strategic management processes in the department. The identified communication
evaluations methods include “consultative forums, stakeholder meetings, and the media
analysis”. Most respondents identified media monitoring, informal feedback from the public
and evaluations from outreach programmes as key instruments of environmental scanning
and issue management. These are explored next.
Communication evaluation from formal research (media analysis):
We do media monitoring for all the departments, encompassing print and electronic
media - everyday.
We currently have an agency that checks news report (news clip). That is the only
avenue we have so far. One thing we have not done is sending questioners to
stakeholders to rate us.
We do statistic reports of social media every three months on the websites. It is
working as proved by the increasing number of people who ‘like’ it. The reach itself
is consistently expanding. In that sense, we know it is working; people are viewing it
(Facebook page).
Communication evaluations from feedback emerging from stakeholders:
294
We acknowledge the input that come and whenever there is a complaint, an outcry
or an appreciation, it is directed to the attention of the management structures of the
department. The line functions managers might pick up a vibe in their various
sections. We encourage them to notify us in order to avoid a negative public opinion
(R20).
During radio shows, we were able to gauge public opinion – it is a good barrow
meter. The problem is that it is not official because it is not documented.
Communication evaluation from outreach programmes (Imbizos):
It seems this is a preferred way of collecting data about the communities and their needs.
Information about the community and its issues is gathered prior to imbizos. However,
data is seldom captured and when documented, it is only used to draft speeches for the
outreach programme to be hosted and it is seldom kept for future use. What is thus lacking
is an impact research – after the communication episode (even after the outreach
programme).
In our case, the difference is that politicians go out themselves, they get the data
themselves.
on a regular bases, government, MECs and the cabinet as a whole through the
previous imbizos were able to meet members of the public were they are able to get
the sentiment on the ground on whether the programs of government are effective
enough or perhaps they need to be refined, and how.
People (communicators) go out to events and imbizos. For example, people who do
videos will do a documentary of the area in which the event is going to take place,
take pictures, and speak to the local people on the ground on the day of the imbizo.
There will be an environmental analysis conducted by community development
workers who are paid to collect data as part of project Sukuma Sakhe.
295
We do research at the place where we are visiting. We have a mini-scanning
meeting- we usually put together a report.
“It is not easy to do the evaluation after the event, but we do try our best”
Before imbizos we have environmental scanning to find out what are the problems
and then come with answers for those problems
Communication evaluation from inter-departmental interaction:
Communicators do interact with various stakeholders. We also interact with our own
counterparts in the province; they might pick up something to do with our own
department, so they would share this information with us. We take the information
back to the strategic meetings (R20).
Some respondents reported that there were no serious communication evaluations taking
place:
“There are no avenues for evaluation, no formative research, and no monitoring.
Even when 50 million Rand is used for communication, there are no evaluations.
There are no tools to judge failures or successes. We never certain of success, we
never know what to say or do because there is never prior research”.
“I wish I can say we have done it, we haven’t I must be honest with you.
Evaluations are critical because that is how you gauge yourself if what you doing is
right of wrong”.
“We don’t do any communication evaluations at this point”.
“We don’t collect data about the public, I am being honest”.
9.9
COMMUNICATION STRUCTURES
The issue of where the communication unit should be positioned in the department proved
to be contentious one. “There are two lines of reporting. The MEC is the politician and the
HOD is the administrator”. There is a contention between those who claim that the
communication unit should be incorporated within the MEC office, and those who contend
296
that it is best served by the HOD office. Currently, “some communication units report to the
office of the MEC while others report to the HOD”. The central dispute is that “the
communication unit is an important tool at the hands of an elected representative because
he must account to the public. Administratively however, politicians do not sign budgets.
But programmes and policies come from the politicians (MEC) and those are the content
of what is communicated”. “What compounds the situation is the tension that comes with
the division. These are two big equally important offices with powers. The unit must attend
to both”.
Some respondents maintain that the government communication unit should serve both
interests and equally be responsive to both the MEC and the HOD office:
It is better to keep it somewhere in the middle. When communication is
attached to only one side, it tends to ignore the needs of the other. For
example if communication is attached to the MEC, the danger is that it will
promote only what the MEC is doing, without emphasising the efforts of the
department as a whole. However, if it is attached to the department (HOD), it
loses touch with the MEC. The fact that it serves the interest of both
becomes the check and balance (R21).
9.9.1
COMMUNICATION UNIT AS ALIGNED TO THE HOD
It was found that the structure of where the communication unit is positioned has a
significant impact on how it functions. “The comtask report specifies that communication
should report to the HOD and maintain a dotted line of report to the MEC office” (R19).
Some respondents opine, “I would prefer to report to the HOD. Currently we report to the
office of the MEC” (R13). Several reasons were offered to defend why government
commination units should be aligned to the HOD office:
1. Government communication is strategic when incorporated within the HOD office:
“The HOD is an administrative office, so everything is strategically planned” (R18).
297
“That way government communication could easily exert influence over the
enterprise strategy” (R5).
2. Communication budgets
Communicators at lower levels feel that communication should align more strongly
to the HOD because that is where money comes from.
3. Government communication must be stable. On the contrary, the MEC office is less
stable:
The MEC is only deployed for a specific period; there could be a reshuffling,
once this happens what happens to the staff? Therefore, some
communicators change with the politicians, and some politicians may want to
pick their own communication staff. This would make government
communication a disjointed affair (R12).
4. Politically free government communication:
If communication is part of the MEC, it becomes susceptible to political
influences and partisanship (R10).
The communication unit should be under the auspices of the HOD. We
should be driving the programmes of the department; not selling the policies
of the MEC (R17).
9.9.2
COMMUNICATION UNIT AS ALIGNED TO THE MEC
In contrast, the alternative group, mostly a cohort of senior government communicators,
contend that the communication unit is best served by the MEC groups. They argue that
according to democratic principles and accountability, government communication should
be within the MEC office:
Government communication must be aligned to the office of the political
head because he/she is the key spokesperson of the portfolio. It is on this
basis that the majority of questions are directed to the office of the MEC as
298
he is the first person to communicate the position of the department.
Government communication exist in the political environment, hence it
centres on the political captain (R21).
The MEC groups understand communication better than the administrative
side: The MEC group needs communication more. Remember that
communication will make them look good out there. They utilise it more. So
they will understand it better because they work with it more. They have an
understanding of its value better than the administrative side (R15).
The chief communicator for the country is president Zuma, and for the
province, it will be the premier Mkhize (now Mcunu). The communication unit
is an important tool at the hands of an elected representative because he
must account to the public (R29).
The first question about the operation of the department are direct at the
political head it, makes practical sense to have communication right at the
office of the political head whereas if it was at the office of the HOD there
would be a delay in terms of responding to the external stakeholders with
regard to the key information they inquire about the department (R21).
9.10 GOVERNMENT COMMUNICATION ROLES
9.10.1 ROLES, FUNCTIONS AND RESPONSIBILITIES OF GOVERNMENT
COMMUNICATORS IN THE DEPARTMENT
9.10.1.1
Government communicators employment titles
In an ascending order, the following are an assortment of government communication
employment titles found among the participants: Head of provincial government
communication, head of communication (for various departments), acting head of
communication, acting deputy manager, deputy manager: communication, deputy
299
manager: publications and graphic services, deputy director: media relations, deputy
director:
corporate
communication,
senior
manager,
senior
manager:
external
communication, assistant manager, assistant manager: outreach programmes, assistant
manager:
corporate
communication,
assistant
manager:
internal
and
external
communication, media liaison officer, senior communication officer, communication
officers, webmaster and graphic designer.
9.10.1.2
Perception of role differentiation
Role differentiation is relatively acknowledged. The majority agree that differentiation exist
between various levels of government communication positions: “There is a vast
difference; duties are not the same, for example a communication officer will go to the
field, issues out information, create content, do their own research”. Some noted that
‘communication officers do the technical work”. But “there is a lot of overlap, there are
many technical things that we do as well”. On the contrary, some respondents did not
perceive role differentiation between the communication officers and a senior management
position. For example, one respondent attest that “now as I am senior management, there
is no difference”. Added another, “In 2008, I became an assistant manager (media and
citizen liaison). I was doing more or less the same thing that I am doing now”.
9.10.1.3
Expert prescriber (Level D)
This section describes the role of government communicators with the title (HOD) head of
communication in provincial government departments. Most heads of communications
described the role of an expert prescriber which involves: (1) integrated communication,
“aligning different components of directorates in terms of branding so that they may
communicate in one voice”, (2) the day to day management of the communication unit
in the department: “I am responsible for the overall day to day activities of this section,
including financial management- controlling the budget of the section, managing the team
members, writing and editing articles. (3) Spokesperson for the department, becoming
the face of the department: “My roles and responsibility as head of communication is to
communicate on the behalf of the ministry and on the behalf of the department”. A few
300
respondents (head of communication) noted their roles in developing communication
strategies: “my role is develop a communication strategy for the department, managing
the directorate, handling media queries, producing educational material and managing the
website”. A head of communication eloquently described his role in government
communication:
As an assistant director I was responsible for the communication strategy of the
department which included elements of marketing, publication and branding. Now,
currently as head of communication my role is to drive the strategic communication
approach for the government - Including driving the entire communication strategy
so that the department could fulfil its mandate as directed by the electorate. And
ensuring that there is a two way process of communication between the people that
mandated the government which is the citizens and government is able to account
to the electorate on how they have performed including the challenges that they are
encountering in terms of executing the mandate. My role is to ensure that we drive
the communication strategy by exploiting a number of channels that are available –
and by explaining the opportunities, the achievements, as well as the challenges.
Some head of communication noted limitations towards fully assuming a managerial
position because of shortage of communication staff in the department. They claimed that
managers are expected to perform technical duties at the expense of communication
management roles. “I am supposed to be managing communication staff but there is no
one to manage, so I end up doing everything. Between strategizing, implementation and
the technical of communication, there is no capacity to do anything more”. Section 9.10.1.3
demonstrates that as much as head of communication managers describe strategic
management functions demarcated in the expert prescriber role, they also identified many
assemblages of technical roles in media relations.
9.10.1.4
Problem solving process facilitator (Level C)
A number of respondents mentioned that their roles entailed “providing communication
support to the head of department, the MEC, and other business unit”. Some also
301
mentioned, providing communication support to either, the MEC, other business units or
the department. This was the only statement given that seemed befitting to the problem
solving process facilitator. However, the construct: ‘providing communication support’ was
never defined or operationalized despite the efforts of the researcher to probe further. A
close second was ‘supporting other business sectors in terms of communication’.
However, after probing, this in many instances meant ‘branding, ‘events management’ and
‘media relations’ – which are not a true reflection of the problem solving process facilitator.
An advisory role could perhaps fall in the problem solving process facilitator. This role was
only mentioned in a few instances: “We are experts in communication and we understand
the dynamics of the media so it is our responsibility to advice principals on what is and
should not be done, even how to do it. We give them advice on how to get maximum
coverage in the media. There was a decision that we should educate the principals on the
dynamics of the media”.
9.10.1.5
Communication facilitator (Level B)/ acceptance legitimizer/ the
town crier
The communication facilitator seemed to be a dominant role within the mid-managers and
the communication officers. Some participants made the point that our roles as
government communicators was “creating the media platform for the MEC and HOD to
communicate with the public”.
“Government communicators are supposed to be conduits of information, setting
the stage for politicians to communicate. However, communicators are getting more
popular than the actual politician is. The main communicator for the department is
the MEC and the HOD. They should be the faces of the department, not the
communicator.
The communication practitioners must retain an impartial position. Their role is to
provide a professional support to a political incumbent responsible to communicate
a wide range of policy positions from the provincial or national government.
302
There are different schools of thoughts among the interviewees regarding this very aspect.
There are those that see communication as a go between i.e. communicating on the
behalf of politicians, and there are those that see themselves mainly as conduits, merely
creating a space for politicians to speak or to simply transfer the message of the politician,
themselves removed from the process, thus absolutely taking no ownership or questioning
what is said.
9.10.1.6
The steward conductor (level C)
The steward conductor describes a role were communication practitioners are most
concerned with matters of persuasion, image management and publicity. Broom and Smith
(1979) did not account for this role. A significantly large number of practitioners mentioned
their role to included ‘branding’, ‘events management’, ‘outreach programmes’,
‘advertising’ and ‘being the face of the department’, ‘promoting government’, ‘marketing
the department’ and ‘marketing government service’:
In this sector, I am responsible for marketing the department. We do branding in
terms of image for visual unity. Outside the department, branding is related to
outreach program and events. When they go out, I must make sure the event looks
branded to show that government is there.
We interact with people during this outreach programmes. We educate people
about the programmes. My responsibility involves mostly planning and organising
events, creating a positive profile for the MEC, supporting other business sectors,
exhibitions and putting together branding.
I specialise in outreach programmes. My responsibility involves planning and
organising events, creating a positive profile for the MEC, supporting other business
sectors, exhibitions and putting together branding.
I am responsible for exhibitions if we have departmental events. We also get
invitations from the office of the premier and legislature if they are having events
and izimbizo – taking parliament to the people.
303
I am responsible for corporate identity and for responding to on-going media
inquiries, essentially representing the department.
As communication officers, our role is to promote the HOD and the MEC and the
programmes of the department. So we perform different roles in web-management,
events management, branding and such.
Events managements are the main thing involved in providing communication
support to the head of department, the MEC, and other business unit.
9.10.1.7
Media relations (Level B)
Media relations practitioners specialise in external communication, information production,
and dissemination. This role falls largely (but not always) on the technical side of
communication roles.
In government communication, the role of the media relations officer, which is a technical
function as level B, entails the following roles: To “ensure coverage of different activities of
the directorate’. In media relations, the role of as a communication officer is media
monitoring, media liaison, updating the websites, and preparing articles, press releases
and newsletters for publication. For example, “when the MEC is attending an event, we go
there and write the story”. “To profile the work of the department and to profile the MEC to
the media”, “Once a week we submit an article to Simama”. On the technical side of media
relations, one respondent describes his role in government media relation:
“I have to handle media queries on behalf of the MEC, solicit his respond,
and then report back to the media. I have to issue press statements and
speechwriting for the MEC. I am responsible to compile articles to semama
the department”.
Other roles include: advertising, media buying, internal communication, video
production and photograph, drafting press release, writing stories, graphic
304
design, publications, writing articles, technical roles, video creation, media
monitoring.
9.10.1.8
Media relations (Level C)
Media relation roles at level C are slightly different that those expressed in level B of a
technical orientation. Media relations in level C is more strategic in drafting media strategy
and thus demand more planning for example in media buying and counselling the
dominate coalition on handling the media. However, very few referred to this role except
for media relations practitioners at senior management and directorate levels.
9.10.1.9
Communication liaison / the traffic manager
The communication liaison officer specialises in facilitating communication between
management and key publics, either through traditional mediate channels or through new
media technologies. This role is essentially about information diffusion. Government
communicators who mentioned their roles in social networking, web-management, and
internal communication fitted this role precisely. In Social networking: “I update social
media daily. Messages from the outside come straight to me and I forward them to the
relevant section. In web-management: “I am responsible for updating the websites as a
communication officer and writing stories for the department. I am responsible for internal
communication by sending e-mails to all staff”. I make sure that internal staffs are
informed and aware of the programmes that are happening. My task is to ensure that the
internal public communicates with itself and to direct information from environment to the
relevant clusters.
9.11 THE OVERALL PURPOSE OF GOVERNMENT COMMUNICATION
9.11.1 GOVERNMENT COMMUNICATION (DEFINITION)
In this section, practitioners were asked to define their own understanding of what
government communication is and to identify the overall purpose of government
communication. One solid definition from a participant reads:
305
“Government communication is a kind of a systematic way of expressing, in different
forms, the policy, the strategies as well as the programmes which the government designs
to meet the expectations of the public. So communication as an instrument provides a kind
of a two-way system where the government announces its policy positions and in return
members of the public are able to respond, either appreciating or expressing their
discontent about those policies and programmes designed by government”.
Another participant was more concerned about e-governance given his role in the social
media and website management:
“To me e-governance is making government accessible to all individuals within the
community, state, province and country as a whole by using technology as a
stepping stone towards achieving the end result of government and making life
easier by bringing government services to people’s computer screens”.
What is the purpose of government communication? This was an open-ended question
that simply asked ‘what do you think is the main role or purpose of government
communication? Some roles mentioned were: information diffusion, image building,
promoting or marketing of programmes, protecting government and advising principals on
communication issues. It was determined which role is deemed imperative by counting the
number of people who acknowledged or mentioned each role. “Promoting government
services” was mentioned the most and it seemed to be the foundational role underpinning
a variety of many other roles such as: information diffusion in order to market government
services, events management to promote government services, or media relations to
promote government services and image management or branding to promote
government services. One the other hand, ‘communicating with the public’ and ‘managing
stakeholders’ were the least mentioned roles.
According to government communicators employed at the KwaZulu Natal provincial
government, the following is a top ten (10) list of important purposes of government
communication. The list is presented in a descending order, starting with the most
306
mentioned purpose towards the least mentioned purpose. (1) promoting government
services through branding, identity management and events management, (2) information
diffusion, (3) media relations, (4) tow-way communication and feedback, (5) educating the
public about government and its services, (6) integrated communication, (7) internal
communication,
(8)
stakeholder
management,
(9)
advising
management
on
communication issues, (10) strategic government communication as a verifying tool. Each
is discussed next from section 9.11.2 to section 9.11.11.
9.11.2 PROMOTING GOVERNMENT SERVICES THROUGH BRANDING,
IDENTITY MANAGEMENT AND EVENTS MANAGEMENT:
From this data, it seems that government communication is moving from information
diffusion to image management. Government communication is not seen so much as
‘persuasion’ but rather as ‘promotion’. The data shows a move from public information
model towards an asymmetrical model.
The following will be presented in respondents own words to demonstrate the importance
placed on image and identity management: “In government, branding is important”. “The
role of government communication is to make people aware of government”. Government
communication is about the positive image of the government we serve” because
“communication has an impact to public perception. Government communication serves to
show that government is doing well. But this good is not always emphasised”. “We need to
market our services and our programmes to ensure people know what services we render
and what assistance we provide. We have an obligation to ensure that the public is
informed of our services”. “In order to project the image of the department, we need more
image management; we do that through publications, branding material, flyers and
everything”. “In essence our aim is to promote government programmes, create
accessibility to the publics; these are our stakeholders such as municipalities, districts, and
traditional leaders”.
“As communication officers, our role is to promote the HOD and the MEC and the
programmes of the department”. “As a communicator, I understand the fact that it boils
307
down to image building, sometime just creating a good image for a department goes a
long way. You could have a department that does not function well, but if you promote it
well, people think the best of you. I could say here in this department, we do the work and
we deliver, but promoting it is not really a priority, and that is the problem”. “I have got
basic survival information of what is required of me in terms of how to promote market and
defend the department when required”. Event management in outreach programmes and
branding are seen as supportive activities or tactics towards image management, identity
management, and promotion of government services. Events management in outreach
programmes will be discussed in further details on section 9.13.
9.11.3 INFORMATION DIFFUSION
Information diffusion ranked second in the list of vital purposes of government
communication. Government communication is about informing the public about the
programmes of the department. The purpose is to make sure that the public understand
what government does and what services are available. “It defies the very purpose of
offering good services if people are oblivious to them”. “The objective is to disseminate
information to stakeholders; the public, religious groups, business, NGOs, media and other
departments”. “Stakeholders must be kept informed about the department. People need to
know what government is doing”. “This demonstrates brevity in taking issues to the public
and opening ourselves to public scrutiny”.
9.11.4 MEDIA RELATIONS
Media liaison is one of the most fundamental purposes of government communication
identified. A full section on government media relations is addressed in section 9.15.
Media relations involves “attracting positive media coverage and responding to media
enquiries”. Communicators are supposed to be carriers of information through the media,
for that reason, the approach should be about accommodating the media.
308
9.11.5 TWO-WAY COMMUNICATION AND FEEDBACK
Feedback and two-way communication are essential for the values of symmetrical
communication to be realised. The majority of the respondents acknowledged the
eminence of feedback in strategic communication. However, the degree to which this
realisation translates into practice is beyond the scope of this study. Most practitioners
observed that communication should be a two way process: “we listen as much as we
communicate”. “It is not just listening. Project sukuma sakhe is calling society into action”.
“As much as we communicate with the public, we need to get feedback from them”. We
must not block the external views (feedback) because it is necessary to make government
improve its own systems. Only one person identified a relationship management role: “To
facilitate the good relationship between the office of the MEC and the public”.
9.11.6 EDUCATING THE PUBLIC ABOUT GOVERNMENT AND ITS SERVICES
The role of educating the public is congruent to the role of information diffusion. However,
the purpose here is not only to disseminate information, but also to educate the public
about the public good. Information diffusion, in its purest form, concentrates on one-way
flow of information from the perspective and the self-interest of the communicator. On the
contrary, information dissemination for educational purpose (social marketing) largely
concentrates on the self-interest of the public by communicating for social change and
community development. “We educate people about the programmes, voting right, human
rights, water retention, social grants, HiV/Aids, disaster management, and other social
issues. (R19).
9.11.7 INTEGRATED COMMUNICATION
A significant number of participants mentioned the purpose of government communication
as one of ‘providing information support to other business units (directorates)’. This is one
of the least identified roles in government communication literature. This role bears
similarity to ‘internal communication’. However, this role is explained to be beyond simple
information diffusion to internal publics, but an alignment, linkage and synchronising of
309
communication between the directorates; assisting each directorate to communicate with
each other and with its specific stakeholder. For example, one communication manager
mentions that the central purpose of the communication unit in government departments is
“aligning different components of directorates in terms of branding so that they
communicate in one voice and one identity”.
9.11.8 MANAGING INTERNAL COMMUNICATION
There was very limited data on internal government communication as many respondents
stated that this role is now incorporated and managed by the intranet. “I do internal
communication through the e-mail folder that links to all staff. The information will be
posted to the website (intranet) as well.
9.11.9 STAKEHOLDER MANAGEMENT
According to a few participants, the purpose of government communication is to “inform
stakeholders about activities of government” and “provide a conducive environment for
stakeholders to play their role”. For example, one respondent illustrates that the KZN
provincial government cultivates an effective and efficient communication climate with its
external stakeholders. Government has a huge bank of stakeholders like the media,
NGOs, community leaders, the public and tertiary institutions, just to mention just a few.
Therefore, government communicators are obliged to keep all these stakeholders informed
and attended to:
As a communicator, I have so many clients. I have internal and external clients
and I have to provide a service to them. I have the MEC, who needs to be provided
with research information and media services (inquiries and opportunities to
respond) she must have unmediated contact with the public. The second part is the
HOD who will be assisted with similar services. Thirdly, there are line functions and
business units (directorates) within the department and they need different
services such as branding, media liaison and events management. The media is a
client as well that must be served. Then there are other external clients that are
310
specific to the department (specialised stakeholders). Included here are the
public R9).
9.11.10 ADVISING MANAGEMENT OF COMMUNICATION ISSUES
To a lesser extent, an advisory role in government communication was recognised. Some
practitioners mentioned that “government communicators must play an advisory role”. “As
communicators, we give them advice”. A fraction of practitioners mentioned that they give
advice to the dominant coalition about media relations: “you give advice to your principals
and to dispel the notion that the media is not out to expose them”. “The media is hostile;
we need to advice government to be careful”. On the contrary, other practitioners claimed
that “the role of communication as advisory is underestimated (disregarded)”. “We have a
problem because politicians think they know everything”.
9.11.11 STRATEGIC GOVERNMENT COMMUNICATION AS A VERIFYING TOOL
Two heads of department, spoke in details about the purpose of strategic government
communication in monitoring. This role reinforces the obligation of government
communication in creating transparency, building accountability and combating corruption.
“Communication is the first and important tool to combat corruption – because
transparency builds accountability and transparency is only achievable through open
communication”.
9.12 EFFECTS OF CENTRALISATION
Figure 9: Survey data: centralisation
HIGH
LOW
Centralisation
Rate the frequency in which you interact with the central
government department in Pretoria?
26%
40%
Rate the frequency in which you interact with the districts?
53%
13%
311
60%
50%
40%
30%
20%
10%
0%
High
Low
Interaction with National
Government (Pretoria)
Interaction with Local
Government (districts)
The central purpose of this section was to identify the interrelation between the three
levels of the South African government three-tier system. Because the provincial
government is at the centre, it was essential to establish its interaction with the other levels
of government. The two questions that guided this section are ‘how often do you interact
with your central government departments in Pretoria’ (national government) and ‘how
often do you interact with local government (municipalities and regional offices)’. The data
results from the survey indicate a high interaction with the national government in Pretoria
and a low interaction with local government in districts. Liaison with local government is
difficult because there are scarcely any government communicators deployed in districts
so communication to districts is usually addressed to administrative and political
personnel.
Several respondents reported a functional working relationship with the national
department of the ministry: “We liaise with them. We have a common interest”. The
national ministry liaises with the provincial government department in terms of policies.
The policies and some programmes come from above which then becomes the
responsibility of the provincial government to disseminate such policies to local
government and municipalities: “It is a necessary relationship. You find that there are
national programmes that must be implemented in provinces”. However, some
respondents identified challenges in this relationship with regard to poor understanding of
the provincial environment by the central ministry department in Pretoria:
“One of the challenges is that you find that the national ministry do not understand
the provincial dynamics. National will come with ideas, 12345; these are projects
that should be done and how. They come with their own ideologies. We are then
312
obliged to implement certain projects that are not custom-made for the province. So
there are challenges in that regard and it is a common practice. However, we do
engage and try making them understand that these are the provincial dynamics and
we rather implement things in an alternative way”.
Another challenge identified was the issues of not being informed of events beforehand.
The provincial department would be rushed to accommodate and deliver communication
support to the central national office, from Pretoria, that is hosting an event in the province.
The grievance was that such “information is sometimes not communicated on time and
then the provincial office would have to rush to organise the media, stakeholders, branding
and other logistics for the events”.
The outcome is that government communication
becomes reactive and unplanned or un-strategized.
9.13 OUTREACH PROGRAMMES AND EVENTS MANAGEMENT
This section discusses the process of promoting government services through branding,
identity management and events management.
Figure 10: survey data – relations with the public
HIGH
Relationships with
Primary Publics
LOW
Rate the level of information diffusion to publics?
67%
6%
Rate the level of interaction with publics?
100%
0%
100%
80%
High
60%
Low
40%
20%
0%
Information diffusion to publics
Interaction with publics
313
The communication section of each department is responsible for outreach and events
management for all business units and directorates in the department. Imbizos are open to
the public. Outreach programmes are about “taking parliament to the public”. Events and
outreach programmes are done on a regular basis. There are always events happening.
“Most of the time we are out on events” (R8). These are called community outreach
programmes. One respondent defined community outreach as “any activity where
specifically government gets in touch with the community and brings resources to them,
seeks feedback and reacts to feedback”.
Apparently the word imbizo has fallen out of favour. Imbizos no longer take place, they are
discontinued in KZN or they happen under a different name. “They are called project
sukuma sakhe now. The practice is however the same whereby government, represented
by different departments, goes out to the public to offer services to the community” (R18).
“Imbizos do happen, but under a different name, we now call them project SukumaSakhe under the auspices of the office of the premier where mainly we target areas
that are behind in terms of development. The cabinet as whole would interact with
members of the public. It is a one stop shop approach, where each portfolio comes
to listen to public demands”.
9.13.1 PROJECT SUKUMA SAKHE
The following comments express the role and purposes of project Sukuma Sakhe (rise and
build) in KwaZulu Natal:
At this moment in time, we play a critical role as communication because through
the sukumasakhe programme, we visit various communities and identify the
challenges within those communities. Grievances are recorded in order to ascertain
progress on issues identified.
For example in KwaZulu Natal, on a regular bases, government, MECs and the
cabinet as a whole are able to meet members of the public to get the sentiments on
314
the ground, solicit feedback from the public which then influences strategic as well
as the policy positions.
9.13.2 INTEGRATED COMMUNICATION FOR OUTREACH PROGRAMMES
When the primer organises an imbizo, all departments must be present: “When there are
imbizos, we call SASA for grants, Home Affairs for identity documents (ID), Health for HIV
testing. We are there the whole day. A lot of people come to imbizos, like 5000 people”
(R3). Imbizos provide a one stop shop where all government programmes are provided
simultaneously. Not only a single department is profiled, we all fall under the auspices of
the office of the premier for that purpose. When we take parliament to the people, each
and every department’s corporate identity is absorbed by those imbizos”.
9.13.3 CRITERIA FOR DECIDING AREAS FOR OUTREACH PROGRAMMES
The two questions asked in this section were as follows: Who sets the agenda for outreach
programmes? What is the criterion on deciding which areas to visit? From these question,
respondents provided a number of reasons and criterions used to decide upon the times
and areas visited for outreach programmes, imbizo or project sukama sakhe. Some of
these reasons are identified below:
Very few practitioners noted that “environmental scanning earmarks a certain area or
region to visit” (CN). The majority however declared that outreach programmes depended
on the issue of the month like women’s month, youth month and special days: “Our work is
dynamic so it depends on what is happening, on the theme of that month or the legislation
theme”.
Every department has a calendar of events. This makes planning easier because
communicators are able to plan media and branding ahead of time: “We have an annual
calendar that directs where the MEC is going. The whole year we know what is happening
but this is subject to changes. The diary of the MEC and the cabinet diary will influence our
responsibilities”. However, there are many occasion where outreach programmes are
315
carried out on an ad-hock bases. This may happen when and if the central office is coming
or if the president is visiting an area. The president may request the department to attend
the event. Sometimes, events are decided upon by cabinet. Others are selected by
directorates or business units within the government department. ‘We get approached by
business units to plan an event after they have identified the need area”. Sometimes, but
rarely the communication unit identifies an outreach programme.
Some respondents noted that “it is the office of the premier that drives outreach
programmers of the province. If there are specific programmes that the department is
supposed to run, that is done in liaison with the office of the premier”. On the other hand,
some respondents declared that the areas selected for outreach programmes are
occasionally politically motivated; “Political pressure determines where we communicate, it
as blatant as to which district we communicate”. In addition, a few respondents claimed
that “all imbizo’s are made at black communities” (R6).
9.13.4 PROCEDURES AND RESEARCH PRIOR IMBIZOS
If the department decides on a specific event, an events committee is created. The
communication unit also sits on it, because “there is no event without communication”.
Team leaders would brief everyone (communication staff) about key issues of the
community. In some departments, a strategy document is compiled as part of the planning
committee which will be chaired by a person tasked to organise the event: “We draft a
strategy which will consist of the aim and objective for the particular events, there will be
an environmental analysis collected from community development workers (DCW). District
communicators become part of the planning meetings for events taking place in their
districts.
Government communicators write a letter asking for the date in which government could
visit the community. Before the visit, government communicators engage leaders of the
community to explain the purpose of the event (imbizo). “Formal visits are conducted to
the area where they meet the elders of the community, councillors and inform them that
the premier or the MEC of a particular department is coming”. Team leaders will brief
316
everyone including communication staff about key issues of the community. The speech of
the premier will be released to the press.
According to the respondents, prior research is conducted in order to better understand
the dynamics of the area visited and to understand the key issues of the area. This
information is essential in integrated communication as needed in Project Sukuma Sakhe.
In understanding the key issues of the area, departments responsible for the identified
issues in the community are invited to offer services and to redress those issues.
However, this pre-scanning is not always benevolent as much of its data is designed to
protect the MEC and the government departments visiting the community in the form of a
pre-emptive information strike. The information is used to guide the speech of the MEC.
“When we go to outreach events, we go for the scanning purposes first, to do mini
consultations, to understand the politics of the place – understand who is who, how
they feel about the department, or how they feel about government in general and
all issues they might have as a community. So that when the MEC goes there, he
knows what kind of people he will be dealing with and what issues concern them.
The speech of the MEC is informed by this pre-scanning episode (the information is
used to draft the MEC speech). It is a pre-emptive strike so that the community
does not pound the MEC on issues that does not concern his department. He must
just mention that something is being done. Then he can go on with his business like
opening a school or something” (R22).
9.13.5 ROLE OF COMMUNICATORS IN OUTREACH PROGRAMMES
Communication practitioners have many roles to play during outreach programmes and
imbizos. “People (communicators) go out to events and imbizos. For example, people who
do videos will do a documentary of the area in which the event is going to take place, take
pictures, and speak to the local people on the ground on the day of the imbizo” (R3).
Government communicators are responsible for branding in those events: “I am
responsible for exhibitions, branding and taking photographs”. “We activate media, do a
317
media alert, and we then have to take all those programmes, promote them and make
them known by the public”.
The role of social media in managing outreach programmes was described: “If there is an
event you post it, you don’t want only the older guys, you want the young guys to be part
of those imbizos. Users can also interact, discussing where the outreach programme is
going to be and what time. In Facebook, you can also put in the venue and the time so
people can make themselves available to attend”.
9.13.6 CHALLENGES OF OUTREACH PROGRAMMES
Provincial government communicators are unable to attend all government related events
taking place in districts, so they rely on district communicators to send them information
and images that can be published in the departmental website and other departmental and
media publications. This process is a challenge because there are often no dedicated
communicators in districts to perform this role: “Because districts do not always have
communication officers, we don’t know what is happening there. We are not able to attend
every event. They must send photos and information”. Another challenge arises when
“districts have to handle events and put in the branding, (because) sometimes and in most
cases, they lose these branding in districts and new ones must be bought to replace”.
Several respondents complained that the communication unit does not have a say on
events and outreach management in terms of deciding where and when and why outreach
programmes take place: “The agenda of where we going is set up there. We don’t speak
to that. We are only called when the plenary session is on board, that is when
communication is invited. From communication we want abcd, they don’t ask us what we
can offer; they tell us what they want”.
Some respondents referred to the challenge involved in managing outreach programmes.
Generally, they complained of poor planning of these outreaches programmes, particularly
that information is communicated late. “We don’t plan events, it is difficult because some
people don’t tell you on time – they just tell you that we are in Newcastle and we don’t see
318
media here”. “If things were better planned, we wouldn’t be in crisis mode all the time. The
quality of our work would be better”. At the end of the day, the communication department
looks incompetent”. Another issue emerging from the data is that there are limited post
evaluations or impact evaluations of outreach programmes after they are conducted.
9.14 GOVERNMENT COMMUNICATION: ADVOCACY, INFORMATION
DIFFUSION OR BOUNDARY SPANNING?
On the question, “to what extent is government communication advocacy, information
diffusion, or boundary spanning? Responses were categories into three groups, one that
projected government communication as both advocacy and boundary spanning (liaison),
another group that claimed that government communication should mainly be advocacy
and the last group, that identified other values beyond advocacy and boundary spanning.
A majority of interviewees responded that government communication should be both
advocacy and boundary spanning (liaison): respondents illustrate this position: “we are
caught between the two, we do a lot of advocacy and we do also boundary spanning”.
“Government communication is both liaison and advocacy because, before imbizos, we
have environmental scanning to find out what are the problems and then come up with
solutions to those problems”. “I think it should be in-between to make sure that both parties
are actually served”. “It’s a bit of both; the nature of life detects the need of both”. It was
suggested that “government communication is not supposed to be about the department
only, because we also interact with the community. We not supposed to just protect the
department. “We also have to look at the needs of the community”. In that regard, the
value of external feedback in government communication was advanced.
Another group argued that “government communication should always advocate for
government”. For instance, one participant illustrates this point: “you must always speak
positive about them. So basically you can’t speak negative, you must attempt to protect
your political leader”.
319
Only one person mentioned that government communication should purely be liaison, with
no element of advocacy in it. The rest of the participants identified the importance of
advocacy in government communication. “Government communication must be in
between the government and the community”. Another participant emphasised that
government communication should mainly be “information dissemination”. On the contrary,
some participants argued that government communication in a developmental state like
South Africa should be about ‘development communication’, not advocacy or boundary
spanning: “we as government of the day we are employed as developmental
communication; we inform the public about the programme and projects that are available
to assist communities”. It should be developmental communication, not advocacy,
something in between.
9.15 GOVERNMENT COMMUNICATION AND MEDIA RELATIONS
Figure 11 and figure 12 demonstrate the survey data regarding various media relation
activities on which government communicators dominantly engage.
Question: how frequently do you engage in the following media relations’ activity?
On a scale of 1 to 5, where 1 = “never engage in activity” and 5= “engage in activity daily”.
Figure 11: Survey data- media relation activities (roles)
Never engage
Rarely
Engage
Usually
Engage in
in activity
engage
sometimes
engage
activity daily
46%
13%
13%
6%
13%
Contribute to/edit Website
20%
20%
13%
20%
20%
Media release
40%
13%
13%
6%
20%
Track media clips
26%
13%
6%
20%
26%
Social Network fb, Twitter…
26%
20%
20%
13%
13%
Brochures
65%
13%
20%
6%
46%
Fliers
20%
26%
0
46%
Pitch stories to media
33%
20%
20%
13%
13%
Newsletters
20%
13%
20%
13%
26%
Media interviews
46%
13%
26%
6%
6%
Strategic plans
33%
6%
40%
0
13%
Fact sheet
46%
6%
20%
20%
65
Responding to media
inquiries
320
Guides
46%
20%
33%
6%
0
Train leadership for
53%
26%
1%
13%
0
Crisis communication plans
26%
26%
20%
13%
6%
Print advertising
13%
6%
33%
0
40%
Community meetings
13%
6%
13%
13%
46%
Primary research
53%
13%
13%
0
13%
Radio or TV
46%
6%
13%
13%
13%
News conference
33%
13%
46%
0
0
Broadcast advertising
33%
0
26%
6%
20%
Blog
66%
6%
13%
0
6%
interviews
9.15.1 HIGH MEDIA SCRUTINY
Some participants observed that the media treated the public and the private sector
differently. There was a strong consensus that the government sector was characterised
by high media and public scrutiny. Some respondents observed that media does not
respond in the same way: “For the fact that we work in the public sectors, every member of
the public has an interest, there is higher media scrutiny in education because government
uses tax payers’ money. Therefore, they (citizens) have the right to know what you doing
with their money” (R7). Another participant remarks that “maybe the media feels they have
rights to do so and they do take any government communication as propaganda” (R18).
“Government is the driver of news, for example, in December, when government shuts
down, there is no news” (R20).
9.15.2 NEGATIVE COVERAGE
Figure 12: Survey data- perceptions on tone of media coverage
How would you rate the level of coverage?
Media coverage
evaluation
Positive
46%
Negative
13%
Neutral
26%
Fair
26%
321
Media Coverage
50%
40%
30%
Media Coverage
20%
10%
0%
Positive
Negative
Neutral
Fair
Three groups emerged among the participants on perceptions regarding the tone of media
coverage of government in general and their own departments in particular. The large
majority perceived media coverage of government to be quiet negative. The remaining two
groups seemed equal in weight. One group saw media coverage as neither positive nor
negative, but neutral depending on the story at hand. The other group reported that media
coverage were largely positive of their department and of government at large.
A significantly large majority reported that media coverage was inherently negative of
government and its various departments: “When media realises that among the
stakeholders, there is one who is not happy. They will start reporting on the conflict that is
not even there” (R9). Respondents commented that when it comes to government, the
media is crisis driven and primarily inclined towards parachute journalism while
predominated by the negatives: “Media is more interested in conflict and the negative and
this is the reason they (government) came up with Simama as a form of communication to
the public”. (R21) “The media comes because they want to write a story. They are crisis
driven” (R2). “The nature of coverage is criticism of government. We have an antagonistic
press which means we have to advice government to be careful”.
Because of the perceived media negativity, most government communicators worry of
misquotation and misrepresentation by the media:
As a spokesperson, you have to be careful of what you say because it can be
turned against you. Government communicators are worried of being misquoted
322
and misrepresented in the media. Sometimes it is better not to say anything at all
out of fear of being quoted out of context. (R22)
Others argued that the media approaches government with its own defined agenda and all
responses from the government communicators will be manipulated or constructed to
portray the agenda or angle of the media: “The media want to communicate what they
want to communicate, even if you befriend them. They drive their own news agenda” (R4).
“Reporters don’t give a balanced story” (R2).
A few respondents pointed out that media coverage was negative because it was often
shallow, personified, and inclined towards the human interest genre. Some government
communicators alleged that the media seem to cover events and people rather than issues
and processes. “Currently what is covered is what seems to be scandalous. For example,
a headline would say, a woman has been chased away from hospital with a child in her
uterus, but there is an educational value behind this story that the media will not explore”
(R1). The way media operates, they report on the story; their focus is to get the story
published. Most of the stories are event based, in most cases; they do this without a
background story”. (R15)
Another group of participants saw media coverage as neither positive nor negative, whilst
this was a small group. “Media coverage is both positive and negative” (R26). The media
is our critical tool for accountability. They are not biased against government in my
perspective. They provide service to the government (R6). When some of us sit in
management, we actually highlight to them that the media is not always negative, they can
only become negative if they do not get information (playing an advisory role) (R20).
The other group perceive media coverage as positive towards their department and to
government in general. A head of a government department had boosted, “we are
enjoying the positive coverage of the media because when we provide information” (R21).
A small number believed that media coverage of government was positive towards
developmental issues. As long as the issue was not political a positive or neutral coverage
is likely: “There are positive stories on the government on issues that are not too political.
323
There are times (rightly so) when they have to start a conversation. But there are times
where media has to stir a dialog to get the public talking. I can’t say it is negative or
positive, it is fruitful. But, media usually reports at a time when we haven’t caught up with
the strategy or the solution” (R9).
9.15.3 MEDIA UNDERSTANDING OF THE INTRICACIES OF GOVERNMENT
COMMUNICATION
The question that guided this section was, “do you feel that media understands the
complexities of your department”? Only a few participants responded that the media
understood the complexities of their department and the intricacies of government as a
whole. A large majority claimed that the media do not understand the complexities of their
department and did not understand the intricacies of government itself.
It was stated that the media often do not understand the processes and procedures of
government. The media misconstrue government processes underlining when and how
media issues are commented upon and by whom in government those issues are to be
directed. The perception of several government communicators is that media seem
oblivious to the consultative nature of information provision that accompanies each media
enquiry about government. For example, there are legal constraints regarding whether or
not certain information can be released: “We have an obligation of patient confidentially,
and as such, we are not able to release certain information at certain times. Unfortunately,
without information, the media merely speculates on issues” (15).
You may find that a journalist does not understand how government communication
works. They may give you a question and expect to get responses now, and they
will be telling you about their deadlines, I always tell them that I wish I could help
you. I do not want to be part of a disaster because I will help you meet the deadline
by giving you wrong information. So please bear with me when I say we need to
research. The information will be coming. In most cases, they will be frustrated with
you. However, as they grow, they understand, a seasoned journalist will tell you
ahead of time that they are doing a story on you so that you can prepare on time.
324
The media in general does not understand the key issues and complexity of government.
The two reasons perceived as primary reasons for poor understanding of government by
the media are commercialisation of the media and the juniorisation of the newsroom:
It is juniorisation of the newsroom. These young journalists do not fully understand
key issues. They don’t even stay long enough in one beat to develop a
specialisation on it. Journalists do not understand the difference between legislature
and cabinet. Media do not understand the structure of government. They should
educate themselves about the fields they are dealing with. However, we facilitate
access through our openness. It is in the interest of government for the media to
understand the nature of government (R1).
The media does understand the procedures, but soft news does not sell, that’s
number one. Second, is the way the media is structured. When you have journalists
particularly freelancers who wants to get the story first (to sell to different
newspapers), they want responses quickly. They do not have time to wait.
I think they (media) understand, but they work under pressure so they do not have
time to wait. They (media) also think that if they give you more time, then you will
have time to cook/spin the story to protect the image of the department. There is
distrust between the media and government (R9).
Another reason given for poor understanding of government or departmental issues by the
media is a lack of beat reporters who would remain in the field long enough to understand
its intricacies. Even when government departments initiate educational seminars or
workshops, it is always different reporters in attendance. There is little progression: “We
don’t have journalist who are interested in health. They don’t stay in the area of this
specialisation; they lose interest quickly before they learn the technicalities and the
terminology of heath communication” (R1). “I do not think the media understands the
complexities of government except for political reporters. However, they are not even
interested. For them, if it bleeds it leads – that is the mantra in journalism” (R20).
325
Among the participants, there is also a perception that some portfolios are more difficult
than others and consequently the media will struggles with them differently: “I can assure
you, health is the most difficult department. I have been a government communicator for
15 years, and I have worked in a variety of departments, but I can assure you that health is
the most difficult and the most complex. Issues of health are complex”. (R15) The media
does not understand health issues. The media does not have a clear understanding of the
complexities (R16).
Some
respondents
commented
that
media
journalists
think
that
government
communication is purely media relations so they expect government communicators to be
constantly available and to drop everything in order to attend to their queries. “They
(media) think communication is only media relations. If I do not comment, they think I am
not doing my job. They think there is nothing else I am doing” (R6). “In government
communication, there is a lot more being done beside media relations, such as events
management, research, branding, feature writing, internal communication and so on…
media relations is just one of the aspects we do” (R18).
The other reason behind poor understand of government issues, structures and intricacies
is due to the practice in which government-media workshops and other initiatives are
reserved for senior media workers like editors and sub-editors, people who are not writers
of government stories, instead of the normal day-to-day journalist who is responsible for
the actual writing of the story: “People like editors understand because they attend
conferences and seminars where the department will inform the media of policies and
legislations of the department, but the ordinary journalist and freelancers who are chasing
the story don’t understand. They want something that they can see, like hard news!” (R9).
Only four out of thirty participants responded that media actually understood the intricacies
of government and their individual departments.
326
9.15.4 TRAINING MEDIA ABOUT GOVERNMENT ISSUES, STRUCTURES AND
PROCEDURES
Some former journalist reported that they did not understand the complexities of
government when they were still practicing as journalists. They advised that media liaison
officers of each government department should do more to achieve a better understanding
of government by the media sector. Several respondents recommended that once a month
each department should organise briefing sessions with key media. Nonetheless, such
initiatives often failed due to time constraints from both the media and the government
side.
There is a consideration that government has the responsibility to educate the media
about issues of each ministerial department: “And government is starting to do that. For
instance, there is a workshop at Nkosi Albert Luthuli Hospital for half a day. The invitation
has been sent to beat reporters that specialise in health communication. The aim is to
inquire what the media needs in order to cover the department better” (R16). “Although,
the media’s role is educating the public, we still have to define what is newsworthy is in our
department”.
The question that emerged on education and training was ‘Whose responsibility it was to
educate and train the media about government (department) issues, structures, and
processes? A number of respondents recorded that it was a shared responsibility between
the government and the media itself: “Both the department and the media houses have a
responsibility to understand the issues around the department. For example, you find a
journalist reporting on a certain topic of which you can see that this person is clueless of
what he/she is talking about, having done no prior research”(R15). Another remarked, “We
both at fault because we need one another. In our department, there are no specific
workshops where we could sit and discuss issues of mutual interests” (R23).
A few other respondents identified the GCIS as primarily responsible for bridging the
knowledge gap between the media and government: “The GCIS should take the
responsibility, but the communicators themselves must take the initiative too” (R9). Only a
minority reported that media educational initiatives were already taking place in various
327
departments through media briefings and press conferences and thus there was no need
to further augment these initiatives: “When new legislation comes into place, media
briefing meetings take place. That proves that there is information sharing between
government and the media”. (R16)
9.15.5 MEDIA – GOVERNMENT RELATIONSHIP
It seems an interdependent relationship is acknowledged by most government
communicators and therefore a harmonious relationship is sought imperative and
invaluable: “I will say we are two separate entities (government and media), both of us
have to provide different services. We have the content and the information and they have
the platform. So we need each other. It is up to both of us to create that conducive working
environment in which we can respect each other. If both of us make an effort to
understand each other, we work better. Otherwise, naturally, these are two competing
entities” (R21). “We are the needed devils of each other” (R11).
The provincial GCIS commented that there is good relationship with the media in KwaZulu
Natal: “We conduct good media engagement because the GCIS convenes meetings with
community media four times per year. “It is important to build good relations with the
media” (R13) The media is a voice close to the people. Another senior respondent
confirms that,” the relationship with the media is good, but there is a lot to be done” (R4).
The value of the media is acknowledged and the need to build relationships identified: it is
very important to build media relations as it improves their understanding of the
department and its initiatives” (R14). “The media is our critical tool for accountability. They
are not biased against government in my perspective. They provide service to the
government” (R6). Indeed, there is a perception that the media always takes what
government say with a pinch of salt. But it is important for us to enhance relationships with
the media (R29).
Most government communicators conveyed a willingness to accommodate the media. “We
work very hard to meet journalists’ needs” (R1). “We use mass media to get access to the
328
public, thus, we need to have good relations with beat reporters”. “Our department initiate
communication with the media all the time” (R23)
Instead of being a spin-doctor, let us adopt an approach of acknowledging the
challenge and initiate intervention steps to improve those challenges. Out of that,
there could be a positive spin off. In other words, surprise the journalist with new
information. Meaning, government communication should not only be responsive,
the approach should be of accommodating of the media (R16).
The sentiment among participants was that it is the prerogative of each department to
create a favourable relationship with the key media with whom they work. “When it comes
to government communication and media relations, we cannot say there is a standard
strategy for cultivating profound partnership with the media. It is the prerogative of each
department” (R17).
9.15.6 DOMINANT COALITION’S UNDERSTANDING OF THE MEDIA
The issue of whether the dominant coalition, politicians and management structures
understand media relations or how the media works was comprehensively addressed in
the previous sections. The findings in this section was that politicians (MEC group) had
more understanding and respect for the media than did administrative managers such as
the HOD division. It was recommended that senior communication managers should
uptake the role of educating the dominant coalition about media relation issues.
The following quotation should serve as reminder:
Overall, my experience with politicians is that they do really understand. However,
with senior officials, you have to drill the matter of the urgency. They do not
understand the ins and outs of the newsroom. Their attitude is that you can’t just
give this question and demand the answer now. Not realising the implication of
when the journalist decides to publish without the response from the department
(R20). Naturally some principals get disappointed of non-coverage and negative
329
stories from the media. Some of the disappointment is based on ignorance of what
is newsworthy (R18).
9.15.7 MEDIA CHANNELS
Government uses a range of media platforms (R3). However, “the choice of media will
depend on the issue to be communicated’ and ‘the nature of the target audiences’. Local
provincial mass media is dominant, followed by community media and direct
communication respectively: “What is in use for example is community radio and
newspapers like ilanga and isolezwe, including the local newspapers in the area you are
targeting”.
Media channel choices are determined by the peculiarities of the programmes and target
audiences: “The media channels depend on the issue. For you to communicate, you need
to gauge your target audience” (R16). For instance, “in my department, we deal with the
LSM such as traditional leaders and councillors and so forth. They are of a different LSM
with that of the department of economic development who interacts with captains of
industry, entrepreneurs, and so forth. So the nature of the media will be influenced by that
LSM. These are some of the peculiarities that differentiate a media strategy from another”
(R9).
Most government departments use a diversity of media platforms; “Awareness campaigns,
media briefings, media statements, stakeholders meetings, outreach programmes and
external websites. We use a lot of vehicles to communicate with the public”. A respondent
reported, “According to our latest statistics, we seem more prevalent on print and online”.
“We use a lot of provincial media. Mostly we do well in KZN media coverage”. The types of
media predominately targeted by the department are newspapers, magazines, radio,
television, the internet (our website), main stream radio, community newspapers,
community radio, television” (R11).
330
9.15.8 EX-JOURNALIST GOVERNMENT COMMUNICATORS (EXPERIENCES
FROM THE OTHER SIDE)
What emerged from the interviews was the fact that most respondents were ex-journalists,
having completed their training in journalism and worked for several years in the news
media as journalists. This group of respondents were therefore required to report upon
their perceptions of government before they were co-opted into government and after they
were inside the system of government. The idea was for them to explain the perception of
government communication from inside and outside the system. For most of them, their
perceptions of government have changed:
The first few months were difficult because at first, I was balanced (as a news
reporter) and now I have to represent government (R4).
I did not understand the complexities of government as a journalist…
While I was a journalist, I use to be frustrated with government, but now I am inside,
I know the processes pertaining to communicating the messages of government, I
know the challenges as well (R1).
“In the newsroom, you think of government communication as spin. When you enter
government, you understand that it is not like that” (R30)
Many ex-journalist government communicators claimed to be sympathetic to the needs of
the media:
My perception of government communication before joining the system was that, in
government, there was a lot of rigidity, there was no flexibility. The turnaround time
was very long, even when information was not damning. Your story will be delayed
because you do not have comments from the other side. Government appeared to
have limited understanding of how media works. As someone who is inside now,
my perception has changed. I think those of us, who are here, are supposed to
change the system to the benefit of our colleagues who are left in the mass media.
If a journalist calls me now, I drop everything to attend to him because I know how it
works (R22).
331
A majority of such respondent identified their journalistic background as a major advantage
in government communication: “It helps for someone who has worked in the newsroom
like me. Some government communicators do not understand the process of news
gathering” (R20). Another ex-journalist advises, “We are dealing with a limited reservoir of
media space. That demands creativity. It helps if you were a journalist because you can do
a good write-up. You can influence the agenda and frame it in a newsworthy way (R20).
9.16 DIRECT COMMUNICATION
9.16.1 DIRECT COMMUNICATION IN THE KZN PROVINCIAL GOVERNMENT
The KZN provincial government seems to be moving increasingly towards direct
communication with the public as external stakeholders: “Direct reporting is an excellent
way to access the public. Government should communicate unmediated as much as
possible”. The reason provided is that direct communication is essential in an uncertain
environment of the mass media that has the propensity of being drawn towards the
negative: “Media is more interested in conflict and the negative and this is the reason they
(government) came up with Simama as a form of communication to the public” (R8). The
other reason was that direct communication is more effective and universal because it is
free to the public: we do direct communication with the public because it is more effective.
You get responses and results” (R4). Reaching specialised audiences is another
advantage of direct government communication: “With own publications (direct
communication), the advantage is that they are specialised and directed at targeted
audience who get direct information sent by the relevant section”. Another participant
clarifies the motivation behind direct communication:
One of the reasons behind the establishment of publications like Simama and
vukuzienzele is because government felt that information about government
programmes are not adequately covered in mainstream media. Moreover, people
who are disadvantaged in the rural areas do not have access to a variety of
mainstream media whereas those in urban places suffer an information overload.
They can choose which newspaper to buy, but those in rural areas do not even
332
have a disposable income. For them, it is a choice between buying bread and
buying a newspaper. This meant that government publications have to be free.
There must be a distribution strategy so that it reaches everybody. Simama used to
be inserted in several magazines such as ilanga, isolezwe and others, but not
anymore. Right now, each department must pick up copies from the office of the
premier.
9.16.2 SIMAMA
Simama is produced by the office of the premier with Mr Madlala as the chief editor of the
newspaper. All departments contribute to Simama. Government “publishes about 400
thousand copies of Semama each week”. However, the challenge of government’s own
publication is the distribution strategy. “Right now, each departments must pick up copies
from the office of the premier”. In addition, “districts officers (at local government) are
supposed to diffuse the newspaper, but they don’t they don’t always comply. Simama is
not marketed. Our own people in districts don’t know what is happening”. Simama is an
initiative welcome by most participants, but there are very small dissenting views of those
concerned with ‘centralisation’ of government communication:
Each provincial department previously had their own publication. However, they
were stopped, abrogated. There is a provincial newspaper now (Simama) and we
spend a huge amount of money for Simama. There is interference there. The aim of
this centralisation is to control information.
9.16.3 DEPARTMENTAL PUBLICATIONS
Some provincial departments have their own publication running, while others rely on the
publication of the national office and others on the communal KZN provincial government
publication (Simama). The trend seems to be moving towards a greater dependency on
Simama. Nonetheless, there are initiatives to establish or resuscitate departmental
publications:
333
Now we are working on a newsletter that is supposed to be out in December, we
were not doing any publications, we submitted articles to Simama (Public Works).
We are working on that, we do not have a publication of our own besides Simama
and the publication that comes from our national office (Education).
Magazines and newsletters are longer produced because we not getting information
(from districts). Therefore, there is nothing to report (Sports and Recreation).
We have Ezomnotho (DEDT)
9.16.4 OTHER FORMS OF DIRECT COMMUNICATION
Direct walk-ins: More than 50 people per day would visit a government department
seeking information; some take publications, job circulars, acts and bills of rights, contact
details.
Websites and social media as direct communication: What we trying to achieve is that if
someone is looking for anything with regard to the province of KwaZulu Natal, the first
point of contact should be the kznonline government. Even if you looking for the
department of arts and culture, you just go to the website. There are also social media of
each department.
Annual reports: The two streams of accountability in government are public (society) and
legislation. The department reports to legislature through annual reports on how well the
department is doing. We are doing well in showing legislation that we are doing well, but
we are failing in demonstrating successes to the publics.
Events and outreach programmes; we do not have much direct communication with the
public except during events. We interact with people during these outreach programmes
such as imbizos and project sukuma sakhe.
Controlled media: There are promotional material for the department, exhibitions, banners,
posters, and pamphlets.
334
9.17 SOCIAL MEDIA AS FORM OF DIRECT COMMUNICATION
9.17.1 SOCIAL MEDIA IN GOVERNMENT COMMUNICATION
A number of webmasters and communicators involved with social media were included for
the interviews. However, this tended to be a smaller group because not all surveyed
departments had webmasters and certainly not all surveyed departments were using
social media. For that matter, only four participants responded to questions concerning the
uses of social media for government communication.
One participant defined e-governance as follows: “e-governance is making government
accessible to all forms of individuals within the community, province, and country as a
whole and using technology as a stepping stone towards achieving the end result of
government. E-governance makes life easier to achieve certain services such as paying
your water and lights”.
For social media purposes, some government departments engage both Facebook and
Twitter. For example, one participant illustrates the uses of social media in his department,
“There are two Facebook pages, one is for the office of the premier and the other one is
public – all you can do is like it, whereas on the official Facebook page, you have to send a
friend invite”. Another remarked that “both Facebook, Twitter, we felt that is good for us to
have a presence on both mediums”. “Social media can be used for attaining votes and
service delivery as well as the general dissemination of information”.
9.17.2 INTEGRATED COMMUNICATION
Respondents identified some form of integrated communication between the departmental
websites, Facebook, and Twitter sites. There are Facebook and Twitter links on the
websites: “You more likely to get people looking at what the department is doing in
Facebook than in the websites. But communication is integrated”:
335
“When I update the website, I simultaneously update Facebook with more or less
the same content”. “Every status on the webpage, I post it to Facebook and most
people will comment on it, respond or send inquiries about it or refer to other
issues”. (R25). “On the social networks, we try our level best to focus people back
to the website, because Twitter is short. We can simply say that the premier was in
such and such event, for more information and images go to our website” (R5).
Some respondents spoke of the future of the mass media in the age of social media as
direct communication. The consensus here was that both social and mass media would
coexist side by side in government communication, rather than one would substitute the
other. A respondent explains:
I believe that both forms of media should harmoniously coexist, side by side. There
are certain things that social media may not be able to satisfy. For example, in
relaxed spaces, the traditional mass media such as newspapers & broadcast are
more stronger as people are relaxed enough to be more acceptable of information.
Whereas with social media, there is limited time and airtime to thoroughly engage
with information.
9.17.3 INTRODUCING SOCIAL MEDIA IN GOVERNMENT COMMUNICATION
Respondents commented that one of the most difficult things to do was motivating and
encouraging their seniors to consider social media as part of their integrated government
communication. Fear was seen as a formidable challenge against adoption of social media
in many government departments. What follow are some explanations of processes of
encouraging managers to adopt social media:
The way Facebook or social media started here “ammm…iyoh, I would say
hukuthanda izinto”. Our communication bosses actually believe in creativity, so they
motivated us to be creative. In one of those meetings, they said we should do things
that would put our department in the map. Hence, I asked them, if we could
introduce Facebook for the department. Initially, they did not buy into it since they
336
were worried about controlling criticism and insults. I assured them that I would try
to manage that (R25).
9.17.4 ADVANTAGES AND USES OF SOCIAL MEDIA IN GOVERNMENT
COMMUNICATION
The digital divide was acknowledged as a significant challenge: South Africa access to the
internet is limited in terms of the number of households that have access to it. However,
the majority of South Africans have cell phones. And with the advent of mobile internet on
your handset, you have access to everything that is available on the internet. Even though
everyone has technology and cell phone, many people are still not computer literate”. I
think more needs to be done in making people more computer savvy. Come 2015, if
someone is not computer literate; they are going to be on par with being fully illiterate”.
The main aim of social media is to engage the youth as the primary target audience. After
all, it is generally the younger generation that is on Facebook and on Twitter. They are the
main seekers of government communication: “The outcomes are excellent because you
get to communicate with young people of which are the targets audience of almost
everyone, government, and businesses; and most businesses are headed by them”. “By
using that platform, government is thus able to communicate with the youth on their own
level”. The youth are the primary market for government communication because in the
next coming election, they are the ones who will be voting. “So by using social media,
because they are the predominant users of it, we now have direct access to them”.
Social media can be used for attaining votes and service delivery as well as the general
dissemination of information. A participant reminisced of one person who mentioned that,
“previously we use to hear about service delivery and now we see it on Facebook and
Instagram”. Whenever there is an event taking place, the public will get the date as well as
what happened in that event in social media platforms. In this case, Facebook is said to
work as a verifying tool and an accountability tool as one participant had already specified:
I feel that social media does contribute to trust because everything that happens is now in
the public domain where everyone can see it in Facebook. For example, a picture paints a
337
thousand words”. Pictures could verify if, and how an event took place. “The mass media
also sources their pictures from these social sites”.
Social media can be used for accessing information. “The dissemination of information in
itself is service delivery,” said a respondent. “It is one thing building houses and putting
infrastructure, it is of no use if the public is not aware of what you are doing. So part of that
service delivery is informing the public of what we are doing with taxpayers’ money”.
All the participants in this study identified the uses of social media in events management:
“People could inquire about events because we post where the department is going and
provide details about such an events. People will inquire for more information about the
events such as direction or an agenda. They may even comment about the events while
they are attending it. Another respondent added, “If there is an event you post it, to invite
those who want to be at the event, you don’t want only the older guys, you want the young
guys to be part of those imbizos. They can also interact, discussing where it is and what
time, immediately in Facebook you would mention the venue and the time of the event so
that people can make themselves available to attend”. One of the identified key values of
social media is the timely response to any queries, comments, and feedback.
9.17.5 DISADVANTAGES AND FEARS OF SOCIAL MEDIA
There is still a major fear of social media among government in general “everyone is
afraid of it”. All participants identified this as a formidable challenge stalling the adoption of
social media for government communication in many departments: “I believe that all
government departments should start using social media in a responsible manner. I know
it is a scary trend because it is something new in South Africa”. Some respondents were
concerned about the misconstruction of which society may see social media as a platform
for complaints and the susceptibility to which issues may easily be misconstrued:
You suddenly now opened up a new communication channel, even on Facebook or
Twitter, whatever is posted can be misconstrued or misinterpreted. It can open up a
can of worms, things that were not even an issue suddenly become an issue.
338
This thing is not for addressing individual issues. It is for us to demonstrate what the
department is doing. It needs you to be responsive (reciprocity). It does not need to
be an avenue for complains. Most people go there to seek help – not to attack.
Several respondents claimed that social media demanded an intensive dedication that
often goes beyond the calls and the hours of duty because it is open 24 hours a day,
seven days a week and 375 days a year: “Any other person may say social media is work
intensive. However, because I am so passionate about it and I love the job that I do, I find
it as all in a days’ job. However, it goes outside of my working hours and it can affect my
family time and my relaxation times. But it’s part of the game”.
9.17.6 RESPONDING TO SOCIAL MEDIA QUERIES
Some participants advised that “government communicators using social media need to be
cautious of how they say certain matters to avoid offending a particular segment of society:
“It has happened on a few occasions, where certain things said by certain politicians on
their Twitter or Facebook accounts had been misconstrued and it created an issue”.
Most of these participants complained of the volatility of social media and the lack of
procedures and guidelines on responding to enquiries. For the mass media, there are
structured procedures of consultation and a timeframe to research information and seek
confirmation from principals on how to respond to enquiries and specific questions. The
procedure of consultation is not present for social media and there is often no time to
research, verify fact or consult for guidance. Once government communicators respond on
their own accord, there is often no support or protection from the principals because they
did not ordain the response:
You have to respond then and there, but, if I say something on Facebook and
Twitter, it can be misconstrued, so you have to look at it in every direction.
On some occasion I take the liberty of responding to certain matters because on
social media, you cannot say, we noted your comment and someone will get back
to you because that person will think that you deflecting the issue.
339
On social media, you working on very slippery grounds, because sometimes you
could say something about legislative policy or whatever political matter and the
managers would say I did not say that. So officially, there is a discrepancy between
what is official and what is personal.
9.17.7 EVALUATING SOCIAL MEDIA
Some participants outlined the evaluations processes used to gauge the successes and
failures of the social media platforms. The dominant way in which social media are
evaluated is through quantitative ‘hits statistics’ that gauge how many people are ‘liking’
the Facebook page. No qualitative evaluations were identified. It could perhaps be
worthwhile to analyse the comments sections and what type of information is generally
sought by the public.
Currently there are 166 likes, in just a few months, the advantage we have with this
design is that if you like the page, all our post will appear in your Facebook page.
You can then forward it on or whatever. So the reach is growing on a daily bases.
What is happening now is that they have given us statistics to see how many
people have seen the site, how many people clicked on that particular post, how
many people have ‘liked it’ and what they have commented on.
One participant acknowledged the efforts on the GCIS in standardising and helping bridge
the knowledge gap on the uses of social media among government communicators: I
have attended a few seminars on web-development in January 2012. In those GCIS
workshops, the focus was on identifying who responds, how and what they say. The
comment that came out of the GCIS was that this is a new territory so it is going to be a
trial and error. However, there is a document released about the guidelines of using social
media.
340
9.18 PROFESSIONAL DEVELOPMENT
Figure 13: Survey data- perceptions on professional development
HIGH
How satisfied are you with your employer’s support to your
professional development?
Professional
How satisfied are you with the GCIS’s support to your professional
Development
development?
Rate your satisfaction of promotion and advancement opportunities
within your organisation?
LOW
46%
33%
46%
33%
20%
53%
60%
50%
40%
30%
High
20%
Low
10%
0%
employer's support to
professional
development
GCIS's support to
professional
development
Satisfaction with career
advancement
(promotion)
The objective of this theme is to explore the perception held by government
communicators regarding their professional development prospects. Figure 13 of the
survey data demonstrates that 46 percent of the respondents are satisfied with their
employers’ (government department) support to their professional development. 46
percent also reported to be satisfied with the GCIS’s support on professional development.
However, 53 percent reported dissatisfactions with promotions and advancement
opportunities in government communication. The interview data demonstrate that a
majority of midlevel communication managers reported a slow growth rate pattern of
professional development within the public sector. The senior managers were less
optimistic of further professional growth while communication officers were the most
optimistic about professional development prospects in government communication.
341
Most midlevel communicators see prospects of growth in other departments away from the
department they were currently employed: ‘I think there is (growth), I started in 2009 and I
am still a communication officer, but I know one day I will be a senior communication
officer, the deputy director… It is not easy to apply for promotions, I am telling you. The
growth I was talking about is not here in the department, it is in other departments. But
vacancies in government communication are very seldom and far in between to come by”.
It was mentioned that promotions are a rare occurrence in government and this was a
reason for job hoping as communicators found it easier to apply for senior level jobs at a
different department than to await the resignation or retirement of an existing senior
manager in the department of their current occupancy. “Promotions are not something you
see every day. They are rare. They may do it if you say you are leaving, they might try to
give you a counter offer. People job-hop, even in the same level, for a possibility of growth”
(R12). “It is a small environment, you move sideways. Once you are in there for a while,
there is no opportunity for promotion unless if someone resigns” (R25). On the contrary,
some respondents argued, “Job hopping is not generic to government”. Although small is
quantity, there are those who were optimistic: “Currently I am very optimistic, I think there
is room for growth definitely”. “I think there is a bit of a promise, and I feel that I can grow”.
The mid managers were generally hopeful of professional development even though they
noted the sluggishness of career growth and promotions within one department. The
senior managers were less optimistic of further professional growth in their careers in
government communication: “I think I have reached a ceiling”. “In terms of career
development, I feel stagnated”.
Most head of communication managers in various
government departments expressed this point. Some noted the only growth beyond the
position of head of communication is to diversify into other avenues of government or other
directorates within their department. “There scope of growth with regard to communication
is very strange; it is reflective of what is happening in the newsroom. Until an editor dies or
retires, you will always remain in the same position because you hardly have a massive
workforce in communication or in the newsroom. If someone is really ambitions, they will
grow outside of communication”.
342
9.18.1 LIMITED SPECIALISATION OF COMMUNICATION PROFESSIONAL
ROLES
One element that emerged from the data was the comparison of activities in the public and
the private sector. It was revealed that there is no specialisation of responsibilities, roles
and tasks in government as they case may be in the private sector: “Communication
management in the private sector is different, the private sectors is more glamorous, more
specialised than the public sector”. There is little distinction between public relations,
marketing and advertising: “You end up doing everything. I do a lot of media work, writing
speeches, organising media briefings, events management, marketing, act as a
spokesperson of the department, draft speeches for the MEC and the HOD,” said a medial
liaison officer. One of the recurring reasons provided for a lack of specialisation in
provincial government communication is the shortage of communication staff members.
Most departments are understaffed, so resident staff members must be adept in
interchanging between various roles, from branding, marketing, advertising, events
management et cetera. Poor budget also contribute to this as in most cases only one or
two people are sent out into community outreach programmes, imbizos or any other
stakeholder engagement. The person who is sent is expected to put together the branding,
take photos and a video were necessary, write the story about the event and liaise with
media if present.
Three communicators noted that national departments were more specialised than the
provincial departments are. One is able to specialise in one area of communication in the
national departments: “There are specialised components in national departments,
whatever component you are in, you have to be a specialist in that portfolio. When you
come to the province, your job description becomes congested in that you have to do
everything under the communication umbrella”.
Lack of specialisation was not particularly considered a professional disadvantage. A
group of communicators noted this phenomenon as an advantage.
Being adept in a
variety of roles was considered a career advantage that may set one on a career growth
path both within and outside the public sector: “I feel there is a growth opportunity, there is
343
a potential for people in government communication to grow”. “Because we do everything
ourselves, there is a bigger scope for people to grow”.
Some respondents expressed a desire to work for the private sector: “There is little
opportunity for growth in government. I would go to the private sector”. “I would work for
the private sector if I had an opportunity. I feel like I still have a lot to learn. I think it is very
different, in the private sector, there are more targets, and you work harder. Although, I am
learning in government, I need a bit of both”.
There was a great contrast between two groups of communicators. One group complained
of being overworked due to understaffing and another group of communicators who
complained of being under-utilised, generally idling and therefore feeling undervalued. For
example, “I am idling now. I am redundant”. “In government, we have experienced people,
but you get in then you are underutilised”. Mostly those in mid-management reported
feeling underutilised. They mentioned that they were not particularly sure what their roles
were. A gap was identified between the responsibilities of a communication officer beneath
them and a senior manager above them. In the contrary, those at the bottom performing
technical roles, reported to be overworked. The senior managers in contrast did not
mention anything regarding being overworked or feeling underutilised.
9.18.2 EDUCATION AND PROFESSIONAL MEMBERSHIP AFFILIATION
Higher qualifications and further studies are recognised as catalyst for professional growth.
In this case, the value of education is upheld. Communication qualifications are a
requirement for promotions in government communication positions. Underqualified people
see no prospects for career growth regardless of the number of years or experience they
have as government communicators. This sentiment is held for example by one highly
experienced government communicator as measured by the years of service in
government: “There is enough growth potential in government for new people, not for me
because I don’t have the qualification”. Several communicators mentioned that they were
currently registered students in various higher education institutions. Four are in
communication related studies while two are in the general management field, and one is
344
in public administration. Eight other respondents expressed an interest to study further in
communication related studies: “I do want to do a degree; it will be able to move me away
from what I am doing now”.
All 30 participants were asked about their professional affiliation to any professional
fraternity in South Africa or abroad. None of the participants are affiliated to any South
African or international professional fraternity. Two respondents noted the desire to join
Prisa someday: “If there was one for government communication, I probably would join”.
Several training needs were identified. The training needs identified were as diverse as the
communicators themselves. It was however possible to categories the needs according to
job responsibilities. For example, most senior communicators spoke of needing assistance
with drafting communication strategy documents while very few others mentioned training
on communication evaluations. Media liaison officers and communication officers generally
referred to technical skills in writing, media monitoring and web-management: I think I still
need to learn more, whether it is improving writing skills, events management or
photography. I do not think I have learnt enough.
No senior manager complained of limited leadership opportunities. Only some head of
communication complained of having to perform technical roles because the department
are understaffed: I am supposed to be managing communication staff but there is no one
to manage.
It was imperative to ask how new government communicators are inducted into
government communication and how they acquire knowledge about the intricacies of
government systems and the role of communication within that system. It was established
from 10 communicators that there is a general induction programme designed to educate
all staff members about the system of government in general and the working of the
specific department in particular. Upon the question: “did you have any induction
programme? Communication officers responded:
345
“Yes, the first one was with the department of transport – they were just telling us
about the department things such as objectives, policies, and HR. issues – different
section of the department would present on different aspects. In Agriculture, there
was an induction as well. It was also about the department”.
“They have one for all staff members so it is not only just communication. It is useful
for someone who doesn’t have a clue of how government works; it does give insight
on how government operates”.
The induction themselves are not communication specific. There is however, an intern
system that seems to be working well. 60 percent of government communicator at various
levels started off as interns in government communication and worked their ways up. A
number of respondents displayed excitement of overseeing interns as a form of leadership
or mentorship role.
9.19 THE ROLE OF THE PROVINCIAL GCIS IN STANDARDISING AND
PROFESSIONALISING GOVERNMENT COMMUNICATION
The major focus of this section was to rate the usefulness of the GCIS in terms of practical
communication support, standardisation and professional development support as
measured by the perceptions of government communicators who partook in this research.
It was similarly necessary to investigate the level of attendance and interaction between
the GCIS and government communicators. The use of the government communicators’
handbook as a standardisation tool for government communication practice was also
evaluated by asking practitioners how often they consulted the tool kit and how useful they
found it to be.
9.19.1 RATING THE USEFULNESS OF THE PROVINCIAL GCIS IN KZN
Figure 14: Survey data- survey data- interaction with the GCIS
HIGH
GCIS
LOW
Rate the level in which you consult the handbook?
50%
50%
Rate the level in which you interact with GCIS?
20%
67%
346
70%
60%
50%
40%
High
30%
Low
20%
10%
0%
Consultation of the GCIS handbook
of government communication
Interaction with the Government
Communication Information
Systems (GCIS)
Communicators’ perceptions of the GCIS are as divided as the communicators
themselves. The direct question that was asked in the interview was how useful do you
find the GCIS in terms of professionalising and standardising government communication
in the province? Of the 30 respondents who answered question, the majority (n =16) rated
the provincial GCIS high in its performance, role and purpose. A number of nine (n=9)
respondents rated it low, noting that the GCIS was not sufficiently visible in the KZN
province. Two respondents (n=3) mentioned the good and the bad of the GCIS in the
province thus recording their response as neutral. On the other hand, the survey data
(67%) in figure 14 demonstrated that the level of interaction between government
communicators and the provincial GCIS is low.
Another group commended the improvement heralded by the provincial GCIS in both
communication support and professional development since the appointment of the new
communication head in KwaZulu Natal: “The current GCIS is different from the previous
years”. “I think of late, they are very active. In the past, I did not know whether they were
under resourced or not stable enough to perform any profound role in the province”. This
sentiment is added by another respondent, “In the past, there wasn’t enough training, but
now, with the new head of GCIS in KZN, we are much close”. Respondents acknowledged
a greater visibility and appreciated assistance received on daily professional practices
such as media buying, advice on adverting procurement and pictures et cetera.
347
9.19.2 INTERACTION BETWEEN THE GCIS AND GOVERNMENT
COMMUNICATORS IN KZN
Government communicators at midlevel and lower entry level reported not having much
interaction with the GCIS except for occasional GCIS training attended. This group
claimed that the provincial GCIS is not sufficiently visible. They report having not had
frequent contact with the GCIS both in communication practical support and in
professional development. The comments from the following communicators illustrate this
point: “I won’t lie, I haven’t had much interaction with GCIS, and yes here and there we
have inquired for their expertise. But other than that, I think they should do more, you
know” (R19). “We don’t interact, the only time I hear of GCIS is when it is about media
buying” (DH). “I think I understand what they do. I don’t interact with them very often” (R9).
Three communicators midlevel confessed having no knowledge of the GCIS’s purpose
and role. They also claimed not having sufficient knowledge of the existence of the GCIS
communicators’ handbook: “The GCIS? I don’t interact with them and I don’t know about
the handbook (R17)”. “I barely understand the role of the GCIS” (R25).
Whereas, government communicators reported having low interactions with the provincial
GCIS, senior government communication managers enjoyed high interactions with the
provincial GCIS. These senior level communicators mostly interacted with the GCIS at the
Provincial Communicators Forum (PCF): “We invite them to the PCF; we talk about
communication related issues. We must complement each other so that we can establish if
there are contradictions in government communication”. “GCIS has a critical role to play,
when you interact with them you get expert advice. We liaise with them on regular bases
at the PCF”. “Interaction with the GCIS is facilitated through provincial communicators’
forums”. A few communicators noted a limitation in this dispensation: “If we don’t interact
with them at the PCF level (meetings), you don’t interact with them at all”. “We only
interact with them through the above mentioned forum of the PCF”.
348
9.19.3 GOVERNMENT COMMUNICATORS’ COMPLIANCE TO GCIS
INITIATIVES
The GCIS complained mostly of low attendance in workshops, seminars and other
initiatives developed for the standardisation and professionalization of government
communication. However, many respondents mentioned that they have not attended any
GCIS training because they have never received any information from the GCIS regarding
any invitation for GCIS initiatives of any sort. Lack of information was the major reason
provided for poor attendance to GCIS initiatives, training and projects. The issue regarding
insufficient information about GCIS projects did not emerge as directly questioned about
reasons for low attendance. This issue emerged elsewhere in the interviews as the GCIS
was mentioned. The following comments illustrate this point:
“I am still yet to hear what they offer! I do not know what training they offer. I don’t
think they communicate well” (1).
Nothing has come to me (information). I do not know whether my bosses have
received anything. (R25)
“I have never been approached by GCIS or any course or programme” (R11)
“I haven’t heard much about career development” (R13).
The GCIS is currently a regular member of the PCF meetings that are held at the office of
the premier once a month. All government communication heads are supposed to be in
attendance. This is one avenue where most practitioners from various departments and
municipalities interact with the GCIS. In many respect, this group that interacts with the
GCIS at the PCF meetings, rated the GCIS high in terms of usefulness in practical
communication assistance, standardisation and in professional development in KZN.
Practitioners, who seldom interact with the GCIS at any level, rated its professionalising
role low depending on whether they had attended any workshops previously or not. It
seemed that those who had attended some workshops in the past were more lenient and
more approving of the GCIS. They generally offered recommendations and suggestions
for improvements on areas that they were dissatisfied. Those communicators, who had no
previous experience with the GCIS and having had less contact with them, were less
lenient. They rated the GCIS low in terms of usefulness regarding practical support and
349
professional development. The following quotation succinctly recapitulates some of the
recommendations:
“They come in with a lot of information about new ways of doing things. For me it
was useful. It was like an induction programme. For older people, it is not useful.
Therefore, it should be according to different ranks of specialisation. They did a
fancy presentation but it was not emailed to us. That was the last I heard from them.
We forget about it and we forget about them” (R10).
9.19.4 THE ROLE OF THE GCIS IN STANDARDISING GOVERNMENT
COMMUNICATION
A significant number of respondents frequently noted the role of the GCIS in standardising
government communication: “The GCIS is a critical tool for government because it can
create standardisation in communication”. “They are useful because overall they are the
custodians of government communication”. Some respondents mentioned the value of the
GCIS in sharing good practice in government communication: “GCIS organises
workshops, they bring people who deal with specialist communication to explain good
practice”. Several respondents referred to the need for GCIS to assist in both guiding and
standardising government communication uses of social media.
Only about a fraction of the respondents reported having attended a GCIS training,
seminar or workshop at least once in their professional lives. Almost all who attended
some GCIS initiated workshops judge them as useful and worthwhile: “The GCIS
workshop was useful. For me it was the first time I was coming to government. I found a lot
of information about the department” (R10). “I attended three training sessions provided by
the GCIS and they were very beneficial for me” (R18). I have attended a few of their
training on developing communication strategies and on branding” (R21).
Some respondents mentioned the role of the GCIS in integrating the provincial
government communication strategy with the local communication strategy and the
national communication strategy. This would strengthen the relationship between the three
tiers of government: “We are not islands as provinces. Our strategies, programmes and
350
actions are supposed to align with that of the national government in terms of the theme or
plan of action. The GCIS helps us to stay on course, that we do not go astray and that we
do not lose sight of the communication strategy (R20). The role of the GCIS in
standardising provincial communication strategies of different departments was also
recognised. It was however cautioned by some participants that although there must be
uniformity of communication strategies in various departments in KZN, there must be room
left to accommodate the unique environment of each department.
9.19.5 THE ROLE OF THE GCIS IN PROVIDING PRACTICAL
COMMUNICATION SUPPORT
Some respondents acknowledged the role of the GCIS in providing practical
communication support. In this category, communicators mentioned assistance provided
by the GCIS in conducting their daily practice. GCIS is needed for bulk media buying, “for
example if you need to communicate with a number of radio stations, they have a hub
where the information is recorded at once and then distributed. It is cost effective”. GCIS is
useful for archive material, “for example if we need photos of our departments’ heads; we
get those photos from them”. The GCIS is present at some outreach programmes: “We
interact with them when we have events, we always invite them and sometimes they
come”. “They are always supportive of government initiatives”. Moreover, they (GCIS)
assist with other practical communication support, for instance, “we consult them for logos.
We consulted the GCIS to give us direction to prepare the communication strategy”. This
seems to be the most popular service that most government communicators make use of
and value.
9.19.6 THE ROLE OF THE GCIS IN PROFESSIONALISING GOVERNMENT
COMMUNICATION
The lesser understood role of the GCIS is one of professionalising government
communication. Nevertheless, there are a few who comprehended this role: “GCIS has a
critical role to play in training communicators. It has a number of good programmes and
strategies to make you grow as a communicator”. “In terms of training, it helps. I think
351
continuous training is important”. However, some respondents were not impressed with
professional development support provided by the GCIS: “I haven’t heard much about
career development” said one respondent. “I did my own training, not paid for by anyone.
There is no skill development or support”.
9.19.7 ADDITIONAL ROLES OF THE GCIS
Respondents recommended a number of other avenues where the GCIS may be of
assistance. They mentioned that the GCIS should take a stronger lead in educating
principals (the dominant coalition), politicians and administrative management about the
role, purpose and value of government communication: “The GCIS should step in to
educate politicians about the role and purpose of government communication and the
nature of the media”. A similar view was shared by other communication officers: “I think
the GCIS should be the ones bringing in certain programmes or making more efforts to
teach people in government (managers/employees) on the important in communication.
That way, it will make it easier for us when people know what we all about”. The second
role mentioned is that of advising government communicators who may seek expert advice
on practical, policy or strategic government communication issues. A new HOD of
government communication in a certain department best expresses this point:
“GCIS helps because when you hit the ground running, you immediately have
guidance about the dos and don’ts. There is a government communication
handbook, it helped me a lot, and it precipitated my knowledge of communication”.
A few respondents mentioned the role of the GCIS in capacitating government
communicators. One respondent stated that “They (GCIS) are making a mark in terms of
capacitating government communication”. In addition, “It (GCIS) should concentrate on
ensuring that all departments have all necessary tools such as communication policy,
strategy and capacity. Currently these are lacking”
some experienced government communicators mentioned that there was generally more
training in the 1990s than the case is in recent years: “There was more training in the
352
1990s, it was the beginning of government communication and the transformation of
government in South Africa”. One respondent noted that “the GCIS does not have a final
word. So its impact is very limited”. Another participant made view of the point that “In
overall, operationally, things are going well. GCIS is very good, but they are very slow”.
9.19.8 USES OF THE GCIS GOVERNMENT COMMUNICATORS HANDBOOK
A large majority of respondents reported that they consulted the GCIS government
communication handbook. Four communicators from various departments went to the
extent of calling it ‘the bible’: “yes I use it, it is useful. It’s our bible” (R2). “I have used it, I
call it a bible” (R17). Although most communicators make use of the handbook, the
frequency of use is different among the participants. For example, there are those who use
it frequently: “I use it extensively, it is very useful” (R15), “I have the government
communication handbook – I have downloaded that thing. I look at it every day” (R8), “I
consult it constantly”. “It is very helpful and every government communicator should have
one and consult it all the time” (26). Then there are those who use it occasionally: “I use it,
but I read it once a year. I refer to it now and then. The old stuff I already know”. Others
refer to it “from time to time” (SM). Others “use the manual as a reference if we have to
justify anything internally”.
A few respondents (n=6) reported never to have used the government communicators
handbook. Several respondents said they did not use it frequently because they did not
have time to do so. “I don’t use it much – because with other work, I don’t have time to
look at the book”. Another respondent stated that the handbook was used “not often as it
rarely translates to the direct working environment we face at department level”. Some
respondents did not use it completely because they did not know about it: “I don’t interact
with them and I don’t know about the handbook”. Two other respondents acknowledged
the book even though they themselves never use it: “I will be honest, I have never used it,
but I know about it” (R6). One participant argued to have never used the handbook
because they were never ‘workshopped’ (trained) to use the book:
353
“No, I don’t use it! I do know about it. It is very difficult to use a manual that was
never workshopped (trained). For example, when the branding manual was issued,
we were called and we were introduced to it, and it was explained to us how to use
it. It might be wrong professionally not to use the manual but what is the point of
using a manual that you were never been trained to use. I believe that when you
issue a manual, you must train people”.
9.19.9 CONVERSATIONS WITH THE GCIS
This section describes the conversation held with the leadership of the GCIS, most
particularly the chief managing director of the GCIS in KwaZulu Natal. The role of the
GCIS is one of custodianship, providing leadership for government communication at
national, provincial and local levels and integrating the three tiers of government. The
GCIS provincial manager noted that “We are a custodian for a system that is complex”.
“Our role is setting the standard for professional government communication”.
One of the challenges that were noted by the provincial GCIS is that of implementation:
“setting communication policies at the national level is easier than implementing those
policies at a provincial and district level”.
Among the biggest challenge faced by the provincial office are those of monitoring and
compliance. The GCIS manager details this point, “We set the standards and develop
guidelines, but we do not have any legal mandate, hence we face challenges of
monitoring, compliance and implementation at all levels of government”. It was mentioned
that “other departments are responsible for enforcement”. Those departments form the
provincial core team. The provincial core team is made up of Cogta, Salga, office of the
Premier and GCIS. The core team shapes the provincial communication strategy. The
core team in KZN meets on a monthly basis while other provinces only manage four
annual meetings. The GCIS felt that “the core team is not very functional” because
sometimes there are disagreements and is bureaucratic in that decisions are taken
gradually.
354
The office of the premier is the unit responsible for provincial government communication
such as publications, engagement meetings, media briefings and the entire provincial
government communication support.
GCIS conducts alignment workshops once a year where heads of communication in
government departments must bring their communication strategies so that they could be
aligned to both provincial and national communication strategies. All communication
strategies must express the core message of government which is “working together we
can do more”. The national communication strategy stays in existence for about five years.
The provincial GCIS claims to have a presence in the districts: “We have to make sure that
provincial communication system is functioning and that it is healthy and the government
communication system includes the provincial and local level”. At all districts the GCIS
provincial role is to make sure that the system is functioning at the local level. It is reported
that “they (municipalities) have a core team at the local level which meets once a month in
which heads of communication at regional levels (municipalities) are supposed to
attended”. The provincial communication strategy has to be communicated at the local
level. “The NCS (National Communication Strategy) is diffused at a local level” said the
provincial GCIS managing director. Whether this is happening in practice is beyond the
scope of this study and perhaps a good recommendation for future studies in this area.
9.19.10 CHALLENGES OF GOVERNMENT COMMUNICATION IN KZN THE
PROVINCE
The following are identified challenges of government communication according to the
respondents of this study. It is important to note that some of these problems are related
and intertwined with each other. The data is presented in a point form because all of the
issues identified here were already addressed. This section will thus serve as a summary
for the chapter. The discussions and conclusions of the study are offered in the next and
final chapter.

Lack of budget / financial constraints.

Communication devaluation, limited seats as department decision making
table, government communication seen as a technical tool.
355

Information gathering
(bureaucracy).

The position of communication within the departmental structure (where
communication is placed between the HOD and the MEC).

Poor understanding of government communication by principals (business
units’ directorates).

Poor understanding of the complexities, structures and processes of
government (department) by the media.

Negative public perception, Poor professional development.

No communication managers in some departments

Feeling understaffed and overworked.

Feeling underutilized and obsolete.

No specialisation in government communication roles (this was noted without
any feelings involved, it was not seen as a negative feature but rather a
unique feature).

Limited communication evaluations (no qualitative evaluations at all).

Fear of social media

GCIS lack of monitoring and compliance

Limited training attendance and uses for GCIS guideline policies
processes
and
the
culture
of
consultation
356
CHAPTER 10:DISCUSSIONS AND CONCLUSIONS
10.1 INTRODUCTION
The purpose of this study is to explore the extent to which the distinctive communication
environment of the public sector affects the practice of communication management in
government departments within the KwaZulu Natal provincial government. In addition, the
study examined the extent to which government communication can be strategic, ethical,
and distinctive.
This chapter contains both the discussion segment and the conclusion segment. This is
bearing in mind that the discussion section could easily retain a chapter of its own.
However, because the findings have already consumed two chapters (8 and 9), the
discussion, and the conclusions are consolidated here in chapter 10. The discussion
section synthesises the two results chapters with the literature and theoretical chapters.
This chapter is structured as follows:
First, the distinctiveness of the public sector and its impacts on the practice of government
communication in the KZN provincial government is discussed. It should be noted that
because these distinctive features affect various elements of government communication,
they are dispersed and incorporated within a theme of practice wherein their impacts are
felt most.
Secondly, strategic government communication is discussed inclusive of its inherent two
principles of ‘excellence’ and ‘effectiveness’. For strategic communication management to
be achieved, these two principles must be fulfilled. The excellence theory provides
essential elements for the measuring of excellence in communication management while
the Pretoria School of Thought contributes essential elements for the evaluation of
effectiveness in communication management.
The issue concerning professionalization of government communication in KZN and the
role of the provincial GCIS in standardising and professionalising government
357
communication is discussed third. This is followed by exploring the question of ethics in
government communication by reviewing the external rhetorical theory. Once this is done,
conclusions about research propositions and objectives are offered. The distinctive,
strategic and ethical framework of government communication is proposed. This is
followed by conferring the research implications for theory, methodology, policy, and
practice. Future research recommendations are then suggested. The research completes
by briefly summarising conclusions on the research problem.
10.2 THE DISTINCTIVENESS OF GOVERNMENT COMMUNICATION
Chapter 2 argued that government communications is theoretically haunted by debates
between scholars of traditional public administration (public policy) and scholars of the
New Public Management (government as business). Each side pulls government
communication into differing perspectives, objectives, and purposes. Such competing
movements in public administration seem to have a significant impact on both the practice
and the theorising of government communication. The New Public Management advices
government to run more like a business (Beckett, 2000 & Box 1999). It procures business
models as the standard for measuring government success (Morgan & Cook, 2014:3).
However, performance of the public sector when judged with models developed in the
private sector is likely to be found inadequate.
The public sector distinctiveness theory on the contrary argues that government should
run like a democracy, not a business. The starting point towards achieving objective one
(1) was to investigate if government communication in the KZN provincial government is
indeed as distinctive as predicted by literature presented in chapter 2. In so doing, chapter
2 responded to objective one by describing the scholarship surrounding the public sector
distinctiveness theory and its recent incorporation to communication management.
•
Objective 1: To identify distinctive features of the public sector communication
environment and to explore their impacts on strategic government communication in
provincial government departments.
358
Chapter 2 began by outlining a comprehensive list of assertions about the distinctive
features of public organisations as described by Allison (1983), Boyne (2002:100), Rainey
(2009, 75-76), Ring and Perry (1985), and Rainey (2003 - 2009). These studies identified
several features of the external circumstances and the internal characteristics of public
organisations that proponents of the public sector distinctiveness theory suggest are
distinctive and different about the managerial environment of the public sector as
compared to the private sector.
The public sector distinctiveness theory describes internal features of public organisations
that are distinctive to the public sector. Those are outlined as follows: More bureaucracy
(Boyne, 2002:101), more red tape (Rainey & Bozeman, 2000:453), lower managerial
autonomy (Allison, 1979:462; Boyne, 2002:101) and personnel constraints (Allison,
1983:19), policy and goal ambiguity and the sheer size of public institutions. The external
features characterising public organisation external environment are outlined as follows:
Complexity, permeability, instability, absence of competition, publicness and severe media
and public scrutiny.
By studying the communication environment of the public sector, communication
management scholars have recently joined in on the debate regarding the public-private
sector distinction. However, significantly little literature was found on this considerably
under-researched area. In addition, no such studies were found in reference to South
Africa and Africa at large. The only study that evaluated the impacts of the distinctive
communication environment of the public sector was Liu and Levenshus (2010) who
interviewed 49 government communicators in the United States. In order to illustrate
further developments and for the purpose of comparison, the present study will refer to Liu
and Levenshus (2010) more pronouncedly.
Liu and Levenshus’s study (2010) found 13 attributes that are distinctive about
communication management in the public sector. The first nine features were identified by
Liu and Horsely (2007) are as follows: politics, public good, media scrutiny, lack of
managerial support for communication practitioners, poor perception of government
communication, lagging professional development and federalism (Liu & Horsley, 2007).
359
With
subsequent
research,
additional
features
were
added:
limited
leadership
opportunities, internal vs external communication, limited financial resources, poor
communication evaluations and multiple communication responsibilities (Liu & Levenshus,
2008; Liu, Horsley & Levenshus, 2010b). Each feature of distinctiveness was investigated
one by one and its impact on government communication evaluated.
Prior to evaluating features of the distinctiveness of government communication as
advanced in extant literature, respondents were asked to explain what they considered
distinctive about government communication. None of the participants disputed that
communication in the public sector was different from communication in the private sector.
The emerging data reflected a robust confirmation of the existence of distinctive features
of ‘politics’, ‘public good’, ‘high media scrutiny’ and ‘more stakeholders’ in the KZN
provincial government. The issue that government communication is not profit making
(public good), political and in the public eye were already identified in literature (Gelders &
Ihlen, 2010:34; Liu & Horsley, 2007:379. What was unexpected were claims among
respondents that there was less work to do in government and that government
communicators were not always certain of what they are supposed to be promoting, either
the MEC, HOD, policies, ruling party or services. Added to these unexpected findings, is
the perception that there are no specialisations of roles in government communication. In
no account, did the policy documents and communication strategy documents of KZN
provincial government make any acknowledgment of the public sector communication
environment. However, the following issues, synonymous of features of the public sector
communication environment were identified: high media and public scrutiny, budget
constraints, legal constraints, centralisation, and poor public perceptions. These issues
were mentioned as challenges of communication management in various departments.
Each feature of distinctiveness will now be interrogated, one by one, starting with how
media scrutiny affects the practice of government communication.
360
10.2.1 EFFECTS OF HIGH MEDIA SCRUTINY ON THE PRACTICE OF
GOVERNMENT COMMUNICATION
The relationship between government and the media has been a subject of a plethora of
studies for years (Person & Patching, 2008:4). However, only a few of these studies
investigated this relationship from the practitioners’ point of view. The present study has
now approached this relationship from the perspective of the practitioners (government
communicators). This section also discusses the effects of high media scrutiny on the
practice of government communication and other media relations issues that emerged
from the data and the literature.
The publicness of government processes was perceived and confirmed in the data.
Government communicators confirmed that government management processes tended to
be exposed to public scrutiny. The role of the media was indeed cited frequently as one of
the major differences in the working environment of the public sector. There was a strong
consensus that the government sector was characterised by both high media scrutiny and
public scrutiny.
The survey data pertaining to the perceptions of government communicators with regard to
the tone of media coverage demonstrated a 46% positive, 13% negative, 26% neutral and
26% fair. These results were contrary to literature projection that media coverage of
government communication was generally negative (Edes, 2000:458; Lattimore et al.,
2009:173; Lee, 2000:454). On the other hand, the interview data confirmed extant
literature on the projection that the coverage of government was generally negative. It was
observed that when it comes to government, the media is crisis driven. It is however
difficult to expound on the discrepancy between the interview and the survey data.
The data results regarding the effects of media scrutiny on the practice of government
communication demonstrate the following findings: It was perceived that the media treated
the public and the private sector differently. In addition, media seemed to cover events and
people rather than issues and processes. Coverage is personified on prominent politicians
and inclined towards the human-interest genre. The media is crisis driven and primarily
inclined towards parachute journalism while predominated by the negatives. However, it
361
was observed that media is less likely to be negative when sufficient information is
provided, constantly.
A large majority of government communicators reported that the media does not
understand the intricacies of government and the complexities of each department. Media
seem oblivious to the consultative nature of information provision that accompanies each
media enquiry about government. Commercialisation of the media and the juniorisation of
the newsroom were perceived as primary reasons for the poor understanding of the
complexities and processes of government communication by the media. An additional
factor is that government often extended educational invites to senior media workers such
as editors to the exclusion of junior journalists who actually write government related
stories.
There is a perception that some portfolios are more difficult than others are and
consequently, the media would struggle with them differently. Department of Health and
the Department of Economics and Tourism Development claimed to be most poorly served
by the media. In addition, it was perceived that the media considers government
communication as purely media relations and so expected government communicators to
be constantly available for interviews.
Government
communicators
often
face
an
‘immature
media’,
one
that
lacks
professionalism and ethics required for a balanced and objective coverage of government
and its proceedings (Edes, 2000:463). On the question of whose responsibility it is to
educate the media on government (department) issues, structures and processes? The
data demonstrates that that the majority of respondents recommended a dual-shared
responsibility between the government and the media.
Most government communicators acknowledged an interdependent relationship and
therefore a harmonious relationship was considered imperative and invaluable. Most
government communicators conveyed a willingness to accommodate the media. What
emerged from the interviews was the fact that most respondent were ex-journalists, having
completed their training in journalism and worked for several years in the news media as
362
journalists. A majority of such respondents identified their journalistic background as a
major advantage in government communication because they were sympathetic to the
media; they understood newsroom processes, comprehended newsworthiness and
retained many media contacts.
All of the analysed communication strategy documents acclaimed the importance of good
media relations between the department and the media and identified some proactive
efforts in media engagement. For example, media relations in the Department of Health
consisted of managing mutually beneficial relations with various media houses in order to
ensure that information needs are addressed appropriately. The communication strategy
document of KZN Public Works aims to enhance positive media relations to encourage
accurate and fair reporting. The Department of Economic Development and Tourism
communication strategy envisage a relationship between the government communication
unit and the media based on professionalism and mutual respect.The KZN provincial
government media strategy aims at establishing a rapid response unit responsible for
maintaining a media database for all departments, providing proactive media coverage
and promoting the image of the KZN provincial government.
In order to overcome the impasse of media disinterest, government communication must
invest in direct reporting (Lee, 2000:454). Whereas indirect reporting refers to
communicating efforts through the intermediary institutions of the news media, direct
reporting focuses on non-mediated communications from the agency to the public at large
(Lee, 2008:145). As a way of dealing with uncertainties emanating from a reliance on the
mass media, the KZN provincial government seems to be moving increasingly towards
direct communication with the public as external stakeholders.
Reasons behind a move towards direct communication are provided in section 9.16.1.
Most departmental publications have been discontinued in favour of more centralised
publications. Vukuzienzele is a national government newspaper while Simama is a KZN
government newspaper produced by the office of the premier. However, challenges of
government publications were apparent in the form of distribution and marketing
strategies. Additional forms of direct communication employed by the KZN provincial
department are specified in section 9.16.4.
363
Social media are used in KZN as additional forms of direct communication. Web 2.0, in
government, demonstrates the potency of internet-based tools in enhancing digital
democracy and public diplomacy (Sadeghi, 2012:127). The data findings identified the
utility of social media in attaining votes, communicating service delivery as well as in
information diffusion. The ability of social media in engaging the youth and in outreach
management was acknowledged. Fears that social media may be misconstrued as a
platform for complaints and criticism was seen as a formidable challenge against the
adoption of social media in many government departments. Additional advantages and
challenges of using social media as a form of direct government communication are
outlined in section 9.17.4.
For web 2.0 to add significant value to government communication, communication
policies and strategies should outline guidelines for utilisation standards and recommend
directives on how government communicators should respond to negative comments,
inaccuracy of information and misrepresentation of information online. The next section
addresses the effects of politics in government communication.
10.2.2 THE EFFECTS OF POLITICS TO THE PRACTICE OF GOVERNMENT
COMMUNICATION
It is only the provincial communication strategy document of the office of the premier that
made any reference to politics and the ruling party. All other communication strategy
documents remained silent about politics and its effects on government communication.
On the contrary, the interviews and survey data had plenty to say about the effects of
politics in government communication.
The majority of interviewees reported that politics had a significant effect on government
communication in general and on their daily practices in particular. The results from the
survey data demonstrated a 33% percent positive, indicating that the effect of politics is
high and a 26% percent negative, reflecting that politics do not have much of an effect on
government communication. This result conceded with extant literature. However, no the
literature addressed the effects of ‘politics’ on the practice of government communication.
364
The following six elements appeared most affected by politics. They are hereby outlined in
order of their importance or intensity: (a) politics sets the agenda for government
communication. By setting the agenda, we mean influencing government communication
practice in terms of what is said and done, when and how it is said and done. (b) Politics
drives outreach programmes. Respondents claimed that politics drove outreach
programmes inclusive of areas in which they communicate. (c) Politics influences
communication content, both direct and indirect. (d) Politics influences appointments and
promotions of government communication positions. (e) Politics demanded more energy,
resources and urgency towards the promotion of the MEC office, which is the political arm
of
government.
Lastly,
(f)
politics
influences
self-censorship
on
government
communicators not to appear aligned or unaligned to any fraction of political incumbents.
Section 9.4.1 discussed these factors in more details.
Another point emanating from the data was how accepting or unaccepting government
communicators were of politics being part of their jobs. A sizable majority of respondents
accepted politics as part of government, and hence an inherent part of government
communication. Politics was not seen as having a positive or negative effect on the
practice; it was just something that was inherent of government communication. However,
it was seen as something that could be managed. Practitioners mentioned some of the
methods they use to insulate the effects of politics from government communication:
professionalism, work experience, adapting to changing dynamics of politics and
separating government from ruling-party through visual branding. Section 9.4.2 explored
these strategies in detail. Closely related to politics are legal constraints discussed next.
10.2.3 EFFECTS OF LEGAL CONSTRAINTS
GOVERNMENT COMMUNICATION
TO
THE
PRACTICE
OF
The purpose of this section was to evaluate if and how legal constraints affected the
practice of government communication. The existence of legal constraints was confirmed.
The data findings furthermore validated literature assumption that legal constraints often
reduce the capacity of government communicators to communicate freely and openly (Liu
& Horsley, 2007:379; Liu et al., 2010:191). The impacts of legal constraints are hereby
365
categorised into four related themes: (1) the protocol of consulting and information
gathering, (2) the protocol of consulting and approval, (3) confidentiality and information
classification and (4) bureaucracy and red tape. Section 9.5 describes these effects in
further details. They are briefly summarised here.
The protocol of consulting and information gathering insinuates that before responding to
government issues in the public sphere, government communicators are expected to
consult with the concerned business units in order to ascertain communication directives.
This process is lengthy and time consuming. In addition, the protocol regarding information
movement of external feedback into government is too rigid and passes through too many
phases to a point of distorted by the time it reaches top management. The protocol of
consultation and information gathering pose an even bigger challenge in social media.
Also identified are the volatility of social media and the lack of procedures and guidelines
on responding to enquiries. The urgency of social media obliterates all lengthy protocol of
consultation.
The protocol of consulting and approval infers that the content of government
communication, ideas, and output are controlled and must be approved before use or
implementation. Those instructing changes are seldom communication trained, thus likely
to contravene journalistic conventions, which would engender negative effects on media
relations.
The effects of bureaucracy and red tape regarding budgeting, timing, and planning were
mentioned as significant challenges to government communication. It takes time for
budgets, communication strategies, and employment appointments to be approved. In
certain departments, communication managers were not appointed and communication
strategy documents were not approved. It also takes time for planning to be concluded,
which means that events are occasionally organised in a rush.
Confidentiality and information classification were mentioned as formidable communication
constraints in government. Government communication is guided by rules and regulations.
However, government communicators do not always know those rules or have a full
366
comprehension regarding classification of information. The finding in this section
corresponds to assumption that communication managers in public institutions have less
freedom to react as they see fit to the circumstances that they face (Boyne, 2002:101;
Allison, 1979:462).
Government is often criticised for a lack of transparency, falsification of information,
secrecy, and spin. These are formidable limitations to government communication
(Gelders & Oyvind, 2010:34; Edes, 2000:463). On the contrary, the data demonstrated a
high-level rating of personal values towards transparency complemented by a
corresponding high rating of departmental values towards transparency. Similarly,
departmental management committees such as the MEC and HOD were also ranked high
in transparency principles. Transparency was considered an essential element in
achieving a legitimate government communication. These findings corroborate with
Fairbanks et al., 2007:28; Liu and Levenshus, 2010:9; Vos, 2006:252; Vos and
Westerhoudt, 2008:22-23 who found that transparency is rated high among government
communicators even if it is a concept difficult to materialise in government. None of the
communication strategy documents identified how transparency should be materialised in
government, although its importance of was specified.
10.2.4 EFFECTS
OF
CENTRALISATION
GOVERNMENT COMMUNICATION
ON
THE
PRACTICE
OF
Because the provincial government is at the centre of the three-tier system, it was
essential to establish the nature and frequency of its interaction with the other levels of
government. Whist the data from the surveys indicated a higher interaction with the
national government in Pretoria, a lower interaction with local government in districts was
reflected in the data. Provincial government communicators identified challenges in their
interactions with national government. They referred to the poor understanding of the
provincial environment by the central ministry department in Pretoria.
The provincial communication strategy document of 2012 recognises a “need for coordination of communication efforts in the province to ensure consistency and coherence”.
367
A few examples of this are the adoption and implementation of uniform branding
guidelines, the consolidation of various departmental newsletters into a single weekly
newspaper (Simama) and an effective media monitoring system for all departments.
Therefore, there is a notable move towards centralisation in the form of integrated
communication. The following section evaluates the perceived value of the communication
unit in government departments.
10.2.5 EFFECTS OF THE DEVALUATION OF COMMUNICATION TO THE
PRACTICE OF GOVERNMENT COMMUNICATION
The purpose of this theme was to determine the value management attach to the
communication unit in government. This entailed the evaluation of government
communicators’ perceptions pertaining to the value of government communication as
viewed by the dominant coalition (MEC and HOD groups). The data results from this
section were rather tentative. On the one hand, the results confirmed literature projection
regarding the devaluation of communication in government as measured by the majority of
respondents who rated management’s support of government communication poorly. On
the other hand, a significant number of government communicators felt that the
communication unit was sufficiently supported and valued in government departments.
The standard answer however was that it differs from department to department, some
dominant coalitions valued communication, while others did not.
This result reaffirms Killingsworth’s (2009:62) findings that the perception and value of
communication varies according on the individual and his experiences and expertise in
communications as a profession. The majority of respondents reported that management
did not value government communication because they did not understand it at all. It was
conclusive that managers who understood government communication also valued it.
Additional reasons for the devaluation of communication in government are discussed in
section 9.6. Next, the impacts of the devaluation of government communication are
presented.
368
Some respondents argued that even if communication is valued, not enough support is
provided. The majority of government communicators complained about budget
constraints. It was mentioned that communication budgets are extremely limited as
opposed to other business units in the department. Budget constraints affected the quality
of work. Most affected by budget constraints are practitioners working on the technical
sides of communication and most reliant on high technological equipment in order to
perform their jobs. Graphic designers, web managers, photographers, videographers and
marketers exemplify this group.
The provincial government communication strategy document acknowledged challenges
perpetuated by budget constraints in KwaZulu Natal. All other communication strategies
similarly identified budgets constraints and challenges imposed by budget restrictions
towards the attainment of excellence in communication management. It was observed that
the strength of any communication strategy document is in its implementation based on
the budget available, and without which, objectives of communication strategies become
unattainable.
These additional effects caused by the devaluation of communication were mentioned:
respondents complained of poor working conditions, being understaffed, poor salaries, and
poor professional developments. Another challenge related to the devaluation of
communication is that politicians and management are not always willing to listen to the
advice provided by the communication unit. This threatens the most critical boundaryspanning role of the communication unit as the voice of the public and a conscience of the
government department.
The findings illustrate a challenge related to poor understanding of communication by the
dominant coalition and other business units. Government communicators claimed that
management do not always understand how the media operates. Management demands
the constant presence of positive media, timeously. Poor understanding of media relations,
compounded by limited understanding of journalistic conversions, poor comprehension of
newsroom etiquette and a general failure to understand the operations of the media
369
proved challenging to the process of information gathering. The urgency of responding to
the media was not realised and this precipitated problems for media relations.
The results indicate that government communication is not valued because management
perceive it as a technical tool or merely a support function. Communication is therefore
relegated to a technical tool rather than elevated to a management function. Being devoid
of a seat in the management structure of government decision-making at the Management
Committee (Manco) and the Executive Committee (Exco) meetings suggests that
communication managers are not sufficiently accorded the opportunity to convey the value
of communication or to represent the needs of communication at the highest echelon of
management.
Senior
communication
managers
acknowledged
that
government
communication should be a management function with a permanent seat in the decisionmaking table of the departmental management structure.
What was surprising from this data was the distinction made between administrative
managers and political managers. Government communicators mentioned that politicians
(the MEC group) better understood and valued communication more than administrative
managers (the HOD group) and directorates. The reasons provided were that politicians
were more experienced (from their campaign days) of media relations and in matters of
public opinion. Moreover, politicians are more reliant on communication support and they
utilise it more. An additional reason is that the administrative side is more focused on
service delivery. For them, communication is just support. They are concerned with output
and service delivery of which they are primarily measured.
The devaluation of government communication is further perpetuated by the inability of
government communicators to depict their contribution through constant communication
evaluations that demonstrate the impacts, successes, and returns of government
communication. Communication evaluations conducted in government are sporadic,
inadequate, and insufficient. This steered a failure in demonstrating the contributions of
government communication towards the success of the core business of the government,
which is essentially the main contribution to organisational effectiveness. This debate is
further explored in the next section.
370
10.3 STRATEGIC GOVERNMENT COMMUNICATION
According to Grunig (2007:29), the principle of strategic communication management is
based on the idea that communication management should be planned, managed by
objectives, evaluated, and connected in some way to organisational objectives. Grunig and
Jaatinen (1998:220) had previously argued that government departments were moving
towards a strategic, managerial and symmetrical form of communication even though they
were not quite there yet. For the purpose of this study, it was therefore imperative to
evaluate the extent to which government communication in the KZN province was
congruous to strategic communication. The following study objectives are fulfilled in this
section.
•
Objective 3: To investigate the organisational structures, communication practices,
roles and functions, and evaluation measures of communication management in
provincial government departments.
•
Objective 4: To examine the link between government communication strategies and
government communication practices.
10.3.1 EFFECTIVENESS IN STRATEGIC GOVERNMENT COMMUNICATION
Literature in both strategic management and strategic communication indicate certain
elements that must be put in place for strategic communication to be able to contribute to
organisational effectiveness. For strategic communication management to be possible,
both excellence and effectiveness in communication management must be achieved. The
excellence theory offered 14 principles of excellence that are fundamental in strategic
communication management. The extents to which they are fulfilled in the KZN provincial
government are summarised in section 10.3.5. The reason to which they are delayed in
analysis is that they consist of many practices of communication management (such as
roles, evaluations, planning, organisational structure et cetera) which are discussed
throughout this section. In that way, section 10.3.5 will serve as a check box, identifying
the degree to which excellence is attained by the KZN provincial.
371
Following an explanation of what makes communication excellent (as described in the 14
features), it become imperative to elaborate upon the elements of the effectiveness
principle in communication management. This discussion was explored thoroughly in
chapter 4. To recap, the following five (5) aspects are characteristics of the effectiveness
of communication management: In addition to the excellence principle, Grunig and
Repper (1992:117) described the strategic role of communication management as that of
building
long-term
relationships
with
organisational
stakeholders
(symmetrical
communication). Moss and Warnaby (1998:136) accent the point that strategic
communication entails diagnoses of the environment (environmental scanning).
Strategic communication contributes to organisational effectiveness by making the
organisation aware of stakeholders, public and issues as they evolve leading to the
development of programmes that can help resolve the identified issues (contributing to
enterprise strategy). Steyn (2004) added that strategic communication is based on a
premise of communication management as a management function (Steyn, 2004).
Now that the five (5) elements of effectiveness in communicating management have been
outlined, the discussion will now focus on each of the elements of effectiveness in
communication management, starting with communication as a management function,
10.3.1.1
Effectiveness feature 1: Communication as a management function
Literature describes the principles of strategic communication as only attainable when the
communication manager retains a permanent seat in the management committee and is
indefinitely involved in organisational decision-making. The six KZN departments, among
the sample, retained the services of communication managers with the title: Head of
Communication. However, the two remaining departments did not have a permanent
communication manager. This contributed to the poor comprehension of the imperatives of
communication by the executive administrative management at senior levels.
Both the KZN Cabinet Resolution No 1 of 31 January 2007 and the Public Finance
Management Act, legislatively provide for the strategic position and strategic role of the
communication manager in KZN government departments. Together, the documents
stipulate that: (1) The general manager for corporate communication shall be responsible
for the day-to-day activities of corporate communications and stakeholder relations, (2)
372
The general manager for communication shall be the official spokesperson for the ministry
and the department, (3) The general manager for communication shall be a member of
both management and executive committees (abbreviated as Manco and Exco
respectively). In terms of policy articulation, the KZN provincial government appreciate
government communication as a management function.
More than half of senior government communication managers in KZN reported to have
permanent seats in the decision-making table at exco and manco while a little less than a
half reported that they did not have seats in the mentioned management committees. For
simplicity, it can be said that only half of the respondents in senior communication
management (Head of Communication) retained a permanent seat at various government
management structures. This affirms that despite policy, government communication is not
practiced sufficiently as a management function in some KZN government departments.
The majority of government communicators claimed that government communication was
viewed as a technical function, rather than a strategic one. It was confirmed that lack of
communication policy (strategies) led to the problem of communication being relegated to
technical roles. For government communication to be strategic, it must be elevated from
being operational by incorporating it into cognitive planning. Strategic communication is
about a high-level of thinking. Thus, education is perceived as a catalyst for the ‘thinking
act’, which is essential to strategic government communication. The hypothesis is that
the more educated government communicators are, strategic they become.
10.3.1.2
Effectiveness feature 2: Contribution to enterprise strategy
In accordance to the Pretoria School of Thought, strategic government communication is
only possible when the communication unit succeed in making inputs to the enterprise
strategy at top management level (the role of the strategist); developing communication
strategies at the middle management level (the role of the manager), and developing
operational strategy at the implementation level (the role of the technician) (de Beer, Steyn
& Rensburg, 2013:310).
373
With reference to the Pretoria School of Thought, it was essential to determine the extent
to which the government communication unit contributes to various strategic decisions,
programmes or legislature policies of the government department. Although it was
recommended in various government communication policy documents for communication
managers to retain seats in the management table, and it was confirmed in the data that
half of those seats are indeed occupied, it was surprising to note that only a few reported
to exert a considerable influence to strategic management and policy legislation of the
government department. Several reasons were enlisted to explain the poor contribution of
the communication unit to the enterprise strategy: Firstly, it was emphasised that
management views government communication as a technical function. Secondly,
government by its nature is bureaucratic. Hartle (1985:350) suggested that the sheer size
and complexity of the federal government create managerial and leadership problems.
Taking into account the many processes and layers in government decision-making, the
communication unit in provincial departments would barely make a significant impact on
the higher-end of decision-making. Thirdly, most communication managers only attended
Manco and Exco meetings in order to adequately understand the policies and strategies of
the department enough to communicate them better in the media, and not necessarily to
provide input in those meetings. Hence, they are there to consume information than to
impart it. This behaviour serves no strategic purpose.
Moss and Warnaby (1998:315) are of the opinion that “communication has been treated
primarily as an enabling function, facilitating the successful implementation of strategic
decisions, but it is not in itself seen as a key element in the strategic decision making
process”. Paul (2012) mentions that the biggest challenge in government communication
is that “strategic communication is often an afterthought. Concentrated strategic efforts
seem relatively rare in government communication (Mertinelli, 2012:144).
The communication strategy document of the KZN provincial government acknowledge
that the success and the realisation of the impact of communication strategies and their
implementation plans can only be achieved through the support of the MEC, HOD and
senior management. Only through this support will the communication unit be able to
contribute aptly to the enterprise strategy. Most of the analysed communication strategy
374
documents concur with the above postulation. It is therefore conclusive that the success of
the communication efforts is dependent on the support from the department’s executive
and management committees. The communication unit could encourage and enhance this
level of support by demonstrating proof of its contribution to the running of the department
(the enterprise strategy) and by validating the success of government communication
through consistent communication evaluation research and environmental scanning that
reduce a crisis in legitimacy.
All the strategic documents recommend for government communication units to regularly
assess the communication environment, identify communication gaps, and be proactive in
identifying opportunities created by interacting with the public. The next section outlines
the extent to which this recommendation is implemented in practice.
10.3.1.3 Effectiveness feature 3: Environmental scanning and communication
evaluations
Permeability as a feature of the public sector distinctiveness, suggests that public
organisations are considered ‘open systems’ that are easily influenced by external events.
Strategic communication literature conceptualise the organisational environment as a
source of competitive advantage. The environment is not considered static, but open to
negotiations, persuasion, accommodation and alterations (Grunig & Repper, 1992:123).
Thus, the pivotal role of communication in strategic management is in defining and
understanding the organisation’s environment through environmental scanning and issue
management (Grunig & Repper, 1992).
The strategizing for communication guideline document (2007) recommends that research
should inform communication strategies because it gives insight to the dynamics of the
environment and the challenges it brings. The communication strategy document of the
KZN department of Sports and Recreation opines that “the concept of monitoring the
effectiveness of the communication service is crucial to the success of the component”.
Public Works’ strategy concurs, “The success of any strategy or campaign is dependent
on the continuous monitoring and evaluation to test its validity and value for money”. This
375
infers that communication evaluations are held in high regard in the KZN provincial
government (at least in policy articulation).
With the above said, it is paradoxical that none of the communication strategy documents
outline the procedure in which environmental scanning would be conducted in practice.
The methodologies for communication evaluations are also unarticulated. There was no
mention of formative and summative communication evaluations or strategies to conduct
environmental scanning beyond media analysis. Consequently, even though the media
environment may come to be comprehended, the public and their issues remain
unidentified.
In reference to the interview data, it was essential to explore how communications
evaluations are used to impart information into strategic government communication and
therefore inform the policies and strategies of the department as a whole, thereby
contribution
to
organisational
effectiveness.
Most
government
communicators
acknowledged the value of communication evaluations and expressed a desire to have
them conducted. On the other hand, they also confirmed that little evaluations were taking
place in their various departments.
Environmental scanning and issue management in the KZN provincial government are
composed of: media monitoring and informal feedback from outreach programmes.
Communication evaluations from outreach programmes were identified as the most
preferred method of pre-environmental scanning prior to outreach programmes (imbizos).
However, limited impact-research was conducted post outreach programmes. Employee
progress reports were used to gauge the performance of individual government
communicators. This means that there are limited strategies and efforts to evaluate the
performance of the entire communication unit and its contribution to organisational
effectiveness.
The results from this study concurs with Hiebert and Devine’s (1985:46) research which
found that government information officers almost universally proclaim the importance of
research and evaluation to their work. However, there was a huge gap between the
376
admission of importance and the actual conducting of communication evaluation. Most
strategy document noted the limitation of communication evaluations and promised to
make efforts towards improving communication evaluation in government. Hiebert and
Devine (1985:46) identified the following barriers preventing the uptake of communication
evaluations in government: lack of budget, lack of time, lack of knowledge and qualification
to conduct communication evaluations. All of these elements appear to have played a part
in impeding communication evaluations in the KZN provincial government.
Research on the efficacy of communication management is essential to identify the
contribution of communication management to an organisation itself. Communication
management attains value only by helping an organisation achieve its goals. Practitioners
are however slow in adopting evaluation research to prove their worth in the department
(Dozier, 1992:336). This seems to be the case in the KZN provincial government.
In summary, three features of effectiveness in communication management have been
discussed in this section. Namely: communication as a management function, contribution
to the enterprise strategy, and environmental scanning plus communication evaluations.
Feature 4, symmetrical communication, will be discussed in the ethics segment in section
10.5.5 while feature 5, excellence in communication management, will be discussed in
section 10.3.4. The excellence theory will form the conclusion of the discussion on
strategic communication management.
10.3.2 ORGANISATIONAL STRUCTURE OF THE COMMUNICATION UNIT
On the subject of communication structures, opinions of where the communication unit
should be designated in the department proved contentious. Allison (1983:19) annotated
that the government sector is comprised of two groups of management fraternities that are
occasionally hostile to each other: the civil servant (executive, administrators, Office of
Head of Departments) and the political appointees (Office of the MEC).
Some government communicators in this study advocated for the communication unit to
be incorporated within the MEC office, while others contended that the communication unit
377
is best served by the HOD office. The latter group argued that government communication
should be aligned with the HOD (administrative group) for the following reasons. First,
government communication becomes more strategic when incorporated within the HOD
office. Secondly, it is easier to attain augmented communication budgets since the
administration side is the custodian of government finances. Thirdly, the MEC office is less
stable whereas government communication must be steady. Fourthly, the HOD office
accounts for a politically free government communication because they are concerned with
public administration and service delivery. In contrast, the main argument of the former
group was that in terms of communicating for democracy and accountability, government
communication is best served by the MEC office. Moreover, the MEC group understands
communication better than the administrative side and utilises it more.
Gregory (2009:27) illuminates that the position of the most senior communication manager
within the organisation provides a good indication of how the communication function is
valued within the organisation. An optimal structure is one that permits direct access to top
management; wherein such access is used to exert influence in the planning of the
enterprise strategy (Moss, Newman & DeSanto, 2005:873). For that reason, it is essential
to determine the roles of communicators within an organisation. The roles of government
communicators are discussed next.
10.3.3 GOVERNMENT COMMUNICATION ROLES
Broom and Smith (1979) operationalized five conceptual roles in communication
management: the expert prescriber, technical service provider, communication process
facilitator, problem-solving process facilitator, and the acceptant legitimizer. The Pretoria
School of Thought (PST) identified three South African communication management roles:
the strategist, the manager and the technician.
Most head of communication in provincial government departments identified with the role
of an expect prescriber (level D). This role entails managing integrated communication
between
various
business
units
(directorates),
day-to-day
management
of
the
communication unit, and developing communication strategies. However, section 9.10.1.3
378
demonstrated that as much as head of communication managers describe strategic
management functions demarcated in the expert prescriber role, they also performed a
consortium of technical roles in media relations.
With reference to the problem solving process facilitator, a number of respondents
mentioned that their roles entailed providing communication support to the head of
department, the MEC, and other business units. The support described were ‘branding,
‘events management’ and ‘media relations’ which are not a true reflection of the problem
solving process facilitator as they do not involve problem solving and problem identification
thorough environmental scanning and issue management. An advisory function would
have resonated better with the problem solving process facilitator role. However, an
advisory function was mentioned very minimally in the data.
The communication facilitator seemed to have been a dominant role within the midmanagers and the communication officers. This entailed creating media platforms for the
MEC and HOD to communicate with the public. This role brought into question the proper
function of government communication. The debate was polarised between practitioners
who argued that government communicators were advocates who must communicate on
the behalf of politicians. In the contrast, are government communicators who regarded
themselves as conduits, merely creating a space for politicians to speak or simply
transferring the message of their principals. They sought themselves removed from the
process and absolutely taking no ownership or questioning what is said.
The data demonstrated a significantly large number of practitioners whose key roles
included ‘branding’, ‘events management’, ‘outreach programmes’, ‘advertising’ and
‘becoming the face of the department’, ‘promoting government’, ‘marketing the department’
and ‘marketing government service’. These functions are not accounted for by the
traditional roles of public relations described by Broom and Smith (1979), Broom (1982)
and Dozier (1992). In performing these functions, government communication practitioners
are more concerned with issues of persuasion, image management and publicity. These
roles are therefore closely aligned with the press agentry model described by Grunig
(1992, 2007). However, it included more than just media relations. A clearer description of
379
this role is in Van Ruler’s interpretation of the steward (public relations is pampering) and
the conductor (public relations is harmonic performance). Both these roles view public
relations as persuasion.
Media relations practitioners specialise in external communication, external organisational
rhetoric, information production and dissemination. Media relations falls largely (but not
always) on the technical side of communication management. The data reported a
distinction between media relations on level B and media relations on level C. Media
relations roles at level C are slightly different from those expressed in level B that tended
to be technically orientated. Media relations in level C is more of a strategic role in drafting
media strategy. This role involves planning and strategizing in media buying and liaison
with the dominate coalition of the department (management) on how to deal with media
related issues. However, very few respondents referred to this role.
The communication liaison officer specialises in aligning communication between
management and key publics, either through traditional mediated channels or through new
media technologies. This role is essentially about information diffusion. Government
communicators whose responsibilities included level B media relations, social networking,
web-management, and internal communication fitted this role precisely.
10.3.4 THE ALLIGNMENT
STRATEGY DOCUMENTS
COMMUNICATION
Moss
and
Warnaby
(1998)
BETWEEN GOVERNMENT COMMUNICATION
AND THE PRACTICE OF GOVERNMENT
distinguish
between
strategy
communication
and
communication strategy. While strategy communication entails the role of communication
in facilitating the strategy-making process (such as described in effectiveness feature 2:
contribution to organisational effectiveness), communication strategy is concerned about
the nature and focus of communication strategy itself. The focus here is on governmentcommunication strategy documents and their application to the practice of government
communication.
380
The strategizing for communication guideline document (2007) provides that government
communication strategy documents becomes a guide for future actions, the standard
against which the success or failure of communication is measured. The value of
government
communication
strategy
documents
were
identified
by
government
communicators as follows. Firstly, government communication strategy documents can be
used to enforce accountability to the communication unit. Secondly, government
communication strategy documents are essential to move government communication
from a reactive, towards a proactive practice. Thirdly, government communication strategy
documents set the tone for the practice regarding what is communicated, to whom and
how it is communicated. Fourthly, government communication strategy documents
(especially a collection of them) recounts a history of the communication unit in the
department. They narrate details of past successes, failures and past programmes. In that
way, they usher a direction for the future of the communication unit. Section 9.1.3 in page
322 describes these values in more details.
In spite of the availability of excellent government communication strategy documents, the
results from this study confirmed Grunig and Jaatinen’s (1998:229-230) findings reflecting
a
challenge
in
the
implementation
of
government
communication
strategies.
Communication strategy documents are not sufficiently translated into practice. The
impediment could be ascribed to a lack of budget necessary to bring into life the oftenexorbitant communications strategies or due to negligence of the document once created
and filled. This segment on strategic government communication concludes by evaluating
the extent to which the KZN provincial government is upholding the excellence principle in
communication management.
10.3.5 EXCELLENCE IN STRATEGIC GOVERNMENT COMMUNICATION
This section deliberates on the relationship between the excellence principle in
communication
management
and
the
attainment
of
a
strategic
government
communication. It is already established that strategic communication is strongly linked to
the principle of effectiveness and excellence in communication management. The
effectiveness principle has already been delineated in the previous sections of the chapter.
381
The excellence theory identifies 14 key features that are fundamental to the enactment of
the excellence principle in communication management. These features are summarised
next and the extent to which they are fulfilled by the KZN provincial government is
appraised:
1. Strategic management is the interlink that integrates excellence and
effectiveness in communication management. Government communication in
the KZN provincial government department may be excellent, but it does not yet
contribute to effectiveness. This is because the excellence principle is only one of
the five elements that must be present for the attainment of effectiveness in
communication management.
2. Excellent communication departments engage in environmental scanning.
Very few environmental scanning are being conducted formally. There are some
data captured from outreach programmes and continuous media analyses.
3. Excellent public relations departments contribute to decisions made by the
dominant coalition of senior management by providing information to that
coalition about the environment of the organisation. Very few environmental
scanning are currently conducted, formally. However, there are unconventional
methods of data capturing about the environment. For example, a lot of data is
being captured during outreach programmes (imbizos) and media analysis through
newslink. The preliminary data captured from outreach programmes are usually
used to inform communication strategies for imbizos. However, it is not clear
whether this data is captured formally and saved for any use. A follow up question
was whether the communication unit delegated this research data to top
management for strategic planning. The answer to this question is not really.
However, there is an acknowledgement that data should be fed to strategic
planning but government communication units have not yet reached this point
beyond providing intelligence or data about media relations to the dominant
coalition.
4. Organisations with high environmental turbulences are more likely to engage
in environmental scanning; often leading to excellent communication
management. Several departments’ communication strategies identified their
382
external environment as turbulent, particularly denoting the attitude of the media.
Nevertheless, no communication evaluations were offered as solutions to further
understand and engage with the identified turbulent environment.
5. Communication must be a management function if it is to contribute
excellently to organisational effectiveness. For government communication to
be a management function, it must have a senior manager who manages
communication strategically. The results indicate that there are communication
managers in various government departments with the title head of communication,
whose role is not technical but strategic. Their functions are to facilitate integrated
communication between various business units (directorates), manage the day-today practice of the communication unit and to develop communication strategies.
6. Excellent communication department must have access to the dominant
coalition. The results demonstrate that most senior communication managers
retain seats in the dominant coalition, in EXCO and MANCO which are the highest
management structures in provincial government departments. However, not all
communication managers are accorded those seats in the decision-making table,
and certainly not all use these seats to effect the strategic management of the
department by imparting intelligence about the environment, issues and publics to
the enterprise strategy. These seats are dominantly used to comprehend
information about strategic management, legislation, and policies in order to
regurgitate them to the public sphere and the media.
7. Integrate
all
communication
public
relations
management
functions
efforts
have
in a
single
department.
been
integrated
in
a
All
single
communication unit in most government departments. There were two instances
where the corporate communication function was separated from the media relation
function. However, the norm is one communication unit with a few additional
communicators delegated to the MEC group.
8. Separate from other functions such as marketing departments. The
communication unit is not separated from the marketing function. This has not
particularly contributed to the sublimation of the communication management
function, but it has to a certain degree co-opted government communication into
marketing terminologies and objectives in promotion, brand awareness, visual
383
branding, identity management and various other advocacy roles performed by
marketing.
9. Enactment of the two-way symmetrical model. The two-way symmetrical model
is based on research. It seems that the KZN provincial government is moving
towards the asymmetrical model wherein attempts are made to improve the image
of the government department and promote the values of the department without
changing or significantly incorporating the input of the public.
10. Design and manage communication programmes strategically. no data was
found. The present study focused predominantly on the meso level (departmental)
of communication management. Hence, communication programmes (at the micro
level) where excluded from the study.
11. Diversity is essential for excellent communication management. Diversity of
communication practitioners in terms of race, gender and ethnicity is essential for
excellent communication management (Likely, 2013; Grunig, 2002:19). However,
the sample as depicted in section 9.2 does not reflect such diversity and therefore
fails to uphold this principle of the excellence theory.
12. Excellent communication management does not exist in isolation; it is a
characteristic of an excellent organisation. No data was found since the study
only focused on the perspectives of government communication practitioners and
their strategy documents to the exclusion of the overall department management
fraternity and their strategic documents. It is therefore impossible to judge whether
any of the government departments are in themselves excellent.
13. Participative rather than authoritarian organisational culture. The results found
that rigid control of information, a culture of consultations and bureaucracy (what
has been termed legal constraints) hamper the freedom, participation and
responsiveness of communications professionals.
14. Employ communicators with specialised body of knowledge in the field,
professionalism. This study found that 95 percent of government communicators
employed in the KZN provincial government have a communication educational
background. Of this, about 40 percent of senior managers have practical journalistic
backgrounds. With the auspices of the GCIS, government communication in KZN is
moving towards professionalism although there is still much to be improved in this
384
area. The issue of professionalism in government communication and its impacts
on strategic communication is discussed further in the next section.
10.4
•
PROFESSIONAL DEVELOPMENT AND THE ROLE OF THE GCIS
Objective 4: To explore the role of the GCIS in standardising and professionalising the
practice of government communication at a provisional-departmental level.
It was essential to explore at which stage of professionalization the KZN provincial
government was designated. The purpose is to understand the impacts of the
distinctiveness of the public sector communication environment upon the professional
practice of government communication. Although there are various measures in which
professionalism can be gauged, this study only considered four measures: (1) fraternity
membership in strong professional organisations, (2) education and training, (3) role of the
GCIS, and (4) alignment of the practice with government communication guidelines and
policies. Each of this is discussed below.
10.4.1 EFFECT OF (POOR) PROFESSIONAL
PRACTICE OF GOVERNMENT COMMUNICATION
DEVELOPMENT ON THE
Literature on the distinctiveness of the communication environment of the public sector
projected that there is poor professional development in the government communication
profession (Liu and Levenshus, 2010). It was therefore critical to explore the perceptions
held by government communicators regarding their professional development prospects. A
majority of midlevel communication managers reported a sluggish progress pattern of
professional development within the public sector. Senior managers were less optimistic of
further professional growth while communication officers were the most optimistic about
professional development prospects in government communication.
In their South African research on professional fraternity membership, Meintjes and
Niemann-Struweg (2009:9) found that although an overwhelming support exists for a
professional body, very few practitioners register for professional associations such as
385
PRISA. Similarly, of all 35 government communicators who participated in this study, none
of them mentioned an affiliation to any South African or international professional
fraternity. Most argued that none of the professional bodies contributed value on their roles
as government communicators because a distinction of practice is seldom recognised.
Elmer’s (2000:192) and Gregory (2006:200) demonstrated that education and training
were crucial for professionalism. Government communicators in KZN confirmed that
further qualifications were recognised as catalyst for professional growth. Without
differential education, especially focused on government communication in South Africa, it
was imperative to inquire how new government communicators were inducted into the
profession of government communication and how they acquired the prerequisite
knowledge about the intricacies of government systems and the role of communication
within that system. It was established that there were induction programmes but these
induction programmes were general and not communication specific. The GCIS is thus
recommended to provide these induction programmes. It is ultimately the role of the GCIS
to standardise and professionalise government communication in South Africa. The next
section discusses the role of the provincial GCIS in standardising and professionalising
government communication in KwaZulu Natal.
10.4.2 THE ROLE OF THE GCIS IN STANDARDISING GOVERNMENT
COMMUNICATION
Sanders et al. (2011:15) documented the professionalising and standardising roles of
government institutional bodies such as the German Federal Press and Information Office
(Germany), the British Government Communication Network (UK) and the Government
Communication and Information Systems (GCIS) in South Africa. It is therefore critical to
rate the usefulness of the GCIS in terms of practical communication support provided to
government communicators, standardisation of practice, and professional development
support in the KZN provincial government. For that matter, only efforts of the provincial
KZN GCIS were considered.
386
The data demonstrated that the majority of government communicators rated the
provincial GCIS high with regard to its performance, role and purpose. However, the
survey data (67%) demonstrated that the level of interaction between government
communicators and the provincial GCIS was low. Government communicators at midlevel
and lower entry-levels reported not having much interaction with the GCIS except for
occasional GCIS training that they have attended. Conversely, senior government
communication managers noted high interactions with the provincial GCIS in the KZN
Provincial Communicators Forum (PCF) hosted by the office of the premier.
In an effort to formalise, professionalise and depoliticise government communication, the
development of formal rules governing the practice and the structures of government
communication are essential (Sanders et al., 2011:15). To this end, the GCIS has
produced a long list of government communication guideline documents in attempt to
standardise the practice. This study was only able to evaluate the practical use of only one
of the guiding document called the handbook of government communication. A significant
majority of respondents declared the use the GCIS government communication handbook.
A significant number of respondents acknowledged the role of the GCIS in standardising
government communication. However, only a margin of the respondents had attended
GCIS training, seminar, or workshop at least once in their professional lives. The findings
demonstrate that the most popular GCIS role among government communicators in KZN
is in providing practical communication support such as in media buying and sourcing
archive material. In addition, the GCIS was sometimes consulted to provide expert advice
on practical, policy or strategic government communication issues and in capacitating
government communicators with additional resources. The GCIS was encouraged (by
practitioners) to step in and educate politicians about the role and purpose of government
communication.
The role of the GCIS is one of custodianship, providing leadership for government
communication within the three tiers of government. Some government communicators
indicated that the GCIS did not have a final word and thus only had a limited impact on the
practice of government communication. The conversation with the provincial GCIS
confirmed challenges in the implementation of government communication policies at
387
provincial and district level. Additional challenges faced by the provincial office involve
monitoring and compliance.
10.5 THE QUESTION OF ETHICS IN GOVERNMENT COMMUNICATION
MANAGEMENT
•
Objective 6: To investigate whether the practice of government communication in the
KZN provincial government is moving towards the dialogic or the self-advocacy
rhetoric (reputation)?
10.5.1 THE PURPOSE OF GOVERNMENT COMMUNICATION
It was essential to establish which function was considered the most fundamental to
government communication. The following functions were mentioned: information
diffusion, image building, promoting and marketing of programmes, protecting government
and advising principals on communication matters. The function deemed imperative was
determined by counting the number of people who mentioned each function. “Promoting
government services” was found to be the most dominant function. Conversely,
‘communicating with the public’ and ‘managing stakeholders’ were the least mentioned
roles. The data demonstrates that government communication is moving from ‘information
diffusion’ to ‘image management’. Government communication is not seen so much as
‘persuasion’ but rather as ‘promotion’. The results project a move from the public
information model towards an asymmetrical model.
The following is a top ten (10) list of important government communication functions in
accordance to the perceptions of government communicators employed at the KwaZulu
Natal provincial government. The list is presented in a descending order, starting with the
most mentioned function towards the least mentioned function. (1) Promoting government
services through branding, identity management and events management, (2) information
diffusion, (3) media relations, (4) tow-way communication and feedback, (5) educating the
public about government and its services, (6) integrated communication, (7) internal
communication,
(8)
stakeholder
management,
(9)
advising
management
on
388
communication issues, (10) strategic government communication as a verifying tool. Each
of these roles is discussed in further details in section 9.11 of this document. The following
unexpected results demanded further analysis:
•
The advisory role: To a lesser extent, an advisory role in government
communication was recognised. It was claimed that the role of communication as
advisory is disregarded by the dominant coalition (the management structure of the
government department) as they do not always listen to the communication unit.
•
Integrated communication: One of the least identified roles in government
communication literature is integrated communication, which involves providing
communication support to the head of department, the MEC, and other business
units. This role bears similarity to internal communication. However, this role is
explained beyond the simple information diffusion to internal publics. The role
facilitates an alignment, linkage and synchronising of communication between the
MEC and the department, among directorates in the department, and within the
three tires of government (Intergovernmental relations).
•
The monitoring role: The purpose of government communication in creating
transparency, building accountability, and combating corruption was identified. This
function is not evident in extant literature. The proposal is that communication is an
important tool to combat corruption because transparency builds accountability and
transparency is only achievable through open communication.
10.5.2 ADVOCACY AND IDENTITY MANAGEMENT IN GOVERNMENT
COMMUNICATION
It was imperative to explore the extent to which government communication was perceived
to be advocacy, information diffusion, or boundary spanning. The majority claimed that
government communication is a fusion of advocacy and boundary spanning (liaison).
Another group indicated that government communication is primarily advocacy and the
least group argued that government communication in a developmental state like South
389
Africa should be about ‘development communication’, not advocacy, or boundary
spanning.
Matters of corporate image, reputation, perception, and stakeholder relations have
become increasingly crucial to the success or failure of any administration, particularly
government. According to the Department of KZN Health, the corporate brand refers to the
corporate identity of the department. It includes the image and the marketing strategies
adopted to ensure maximum visibility. A clear and consistent corporate identity is required
to assist the public in recognising, accessing, and assessing government and government
services. According to the KZN provincial communication strategy document, fundamental
corporate identity activities include the production of promotional material and exhibitions
to profile the image of government departments and their various programmes. All other
communication strategy documents reflected a strong need towards identity management
through various forms of visual branding that included adequate internal (inside the
building structures) and external (outdoor) branding. No other elements of the identity mix
(communication and behaviour) were mentioned beyond visual branding. Perhaps
outreach programmes could act as the communication element in the identity
management mix.
The KZN provincial communication strategy document states that outreach programmes to
communities are central to the government communication strategy. Outreach
programmes include, periodic izimbizo to raise awareness and receive feedback on key
provincial issues. All analysed communication strategies reflected a need to ensure
departmental
representation
in
interdepartmental,
provincial
government,
and
intergovernmental community outreach programmes and events.
Outreach programmes are about taking parliament to the public. Imbizos are open to the
public. Apparently, the word imbizo has falls out of favour in KZN. They are now called
outreach programmes or Project Sukuma-Sakhe under the auspices of the office of the
premier. Imbizos provide a one-stop shop where all government services are delivered in
one area. This epitomises an effort towards integrated government communication. The
communication section of each department is responsible for outreach and events
390
management for all business units and directorates in the department. From the
interviews, it was established that (in summary) outreach programmes are decided upon
based on the following criterion: (1) they are decided upon by the office of the premier, (2)
There is a calendar of events, (3) Events are decided by cabinet, (3) Requests come from
directorates and their business unites, (4) they are based on presidential requests when
visiting KZN, (5) Outreach programmes and events depend on themes of the month such
as women’s day and lastly,(6) they are politically motivated.
Several respondents complained that the communication unit does not have a say on
events and outreach management in terms of deciding where, when and why outreach
programmes took place. If government communicators were conducting rigorous
environmental scanning, they would be able to identify where and when and what issues
to address in various outreach programmes. In this way, outreach programmes would be
managed
strategically.
The
success of
identity management
through
outreach
programmes depends on exceptional external communications.
10.5.3 EFFECTS OF INTERNAL VS EXTERNAL COMMUNICATION ON THE
PRACTICE OF GOVERNMENT COMMUNICATION
Liu and Levenshus (2008:9) found that most public organisations, particularly in
government valued external communication than internal communication. The present
study in KZN found very limited data on internal government communication as many
respondents stated that internal communication was now incorporated and managed by
the intranet (ICT department). For that reason, practitioners delegated to internal
communication also retained responsibilities in other elements of external communication.
With
government
communication
moving
towards
advocacy,
marketing,
identity
management, and reputation management within the asymmetrical model, internal
communication seems to be falling out of the wagon. One of the distinctive features of
government communication is that it is a public good. This feature of distinctiveness
connects government communication with issues of advocacy, strategic management, and
ethics. This discussion is explored next.
391
10.5.4 GOVERNMENT COMMUNICATION AS A PUBLIC GOOD
The issue that government communication is a public good dictates that it cannot be left at
only being strategic in terms of the excellence theory. Government communication can be
practiced excellently to benefit the organisation, but that would not fulfil the distinctive
feature of government communication being a public good. In order for government
communication to be a valuable public good contributing to democracy, it must have an
impact on organisational effectiveness. It is already established that government
communication can contribute to organisational effectiveness by assessing thoroughly the
needs of the citizens and not only communicating those needs to the dominant coalition,
but also advising on how the public can better be served. This act would thus influence
service-delivery, legislations, and policies. Government communicators in various
departments acknowledged the importance of the communication unit to contribute to
organisational effectiveness. However, there was despondency in how this can be
achieved in practice.
The argument in this study is that it is improbable for government communication to
contribute to organisational effectiveness if it is still practiced within the press-agentry and
the public-information model. As noted from the interviews, communication strategy
documents and surveys, improving media relations and publicity were considered the most
vital functions of government communication in KZN. This insinuates the press-agentry
model. In addition, the public information model which emphasise information
dissemination is enacted correctly, if not impressively, through direct and indirect
communication avenues such as imbizos, social media and own publication like Simama.
The combination of the press-agentry and the public information model with minimum
evaluations added with promotional tactics coalesce into the asymmetrical communication
model. This is where government communication in KZN seems to be moving. The public
good argument brings into question the issue of advocacy in communication management.
The subject of advocacy is particularly relevant to ‘ethical’ government communication,
which is discussed next.
392
10.5.5 EXTERNAL RHETORICAL THEORY IN ETHICAL GOVERNMENT
COMMUNICATION
Scholars such as Hamalink (2007) and Wring (2005) distress over the professionalisation
of government communication as they see it as causing disempowerment to citizens and
further contributing to a situation of democracy without citizens (Sanders et al., 2011:20).
The argument heralded is that “the professionalisation of political communication further
widens the inequality between politicians and citizens because of the former’s ability to
control messages and perception” (Sanders et al., 2011:20). Simply put, the
professionalisation of government communicators is dangerous in the hands of a
manipulative government that masters the art of advocacy and persuasion for the purpose
of propaganda (spin).
Scholars have begun observing the abuse of communication management in government.
For example, Glenn (2014) interrogated the abuse of communications in the Canadian
government while Mabelebele (2007) evaluated the abuse of Imbizos as a form of
government communication by the ruling ANC in South Africa. Glenny (2008) on the other
hand investigated the role of government communication in Australia, probing the extent to
which government communication is intended to persuade or to engage the public. These
studies bring issues of advocacy and ethics to the fore of government communication
research and theory. These studies also demonstrate the ‘outcome’ or perceived role of
government communication could be used to gauge its ethical value.
External organisation rhetorical theory is critical to the study and the theorising of
government communication because in practice most types of external communication are
in fact advocacy. For example, Gelders and Ihlen (2009:2) concluded that government
communication about potential policies was both governmental PR and propaganda. The
present study has revealed that advocacy communication is indeed present in external
government communication as documented by the findings that there is an increased
focus on identity management, branding and image management in the KZN provincial
government.
393
Self-interest communication cannot be ignored in the theorising of government
communication purely because it is not supposed to be there. In practice, government
communication can be advocacy, and therefore theorising must be cognisant of this
reality. Advocacy communication has been poorly reflected in government communication
theories and literature because it was historically associated with propaganda and spin.
These two words have been excluded in communication management literature because it
is assumed that to be strategic is to be devoid of self-interest (example being the
excellence theory, the system theory, symmetrical and the stakeholder theory).
Rhetoric argues that effective symmetrical communication is only achieved by the dialogic
form. However, unlike, the excellence theory, rhetoric does not assume that such
communication between the public and the government will naturally be equitable as
projected in the excellence theory. Rhetoric argues instead that communication
management has to be dialogic in order to be ethical, but being ethical is not innate for
organisations so they must consciously make the effort (Heath, 2011:415). External
organisational rhetoric is meant to serve two purposes: first, to improve an organisation’s
ethical practices by paying attention to external perception (public opinion), and secondly,
to improve an organisation’s self-interest communication by responding appropriately to
that public opinion (Boyd & Waymer, 2011). This leads to organisational effectiveness as
reflected in communication management literature.
The second point of contribution is that the rhetoric approach provides the base necessary
to understand the self-presentation motives and tactics through which organisations and
governments attract legitimacy and reputation. The first purpose of external organisational
rhetoric is the establishment and maintenance of credibility, reputation, and legitimacy.
The ‘good organisation communicating well’ analogy emphasises the character of the
organisation as the basis for, and the result of its communication management (Heath,
2007:58). This means that primarily, external organisational rhetoric serves its own interest
(Palenchar, 2011:571). It is essential to understand that external organisational rhetoric is
itself partisan, and therefore external government communication will relatively be
partisan.
394
Not all advocacy communication is appalling, argues Heath (2007:43). Good advocacy is
one that is comfortable with counterarguments and debates in the public sphere.
According to this thesis, government communication can afford to be persuasive as long
as such persuasive discourse is met by other counter-discourses emerging from the public
itself, the media, opposition parties, and so forth. Again, government communication can
afford to be persuasive as long as such persuasion is ethical and considerate of counter
views. The weakness of this thesis however that that it is not always the case that the
rhetorical battles are equitable, balanced and open for all. In a rhetorical battle where there
are fewer voices, and imbalances of contributions, then dialectic is set to fail in guiding
enlightened choices.
Sanders et al. (2011) noted that “because there are few opportunities to address the
people directly, (government) communication activities are mostly oriented towards the
media, which plays an intervening variable”. What does this now mean for government
communication which is moving robustly towards direct communication (controlled media
through social media, imbizos and own publications) with the public, away from the gaze
and ‘intervention’ of the media which provided possible counter-dialogue? This
phenomenon further proves the need for government communication scholarship to
incorporate advocacy and other ethical issues in the theorising of government
communication.
Relationship management (symmetrical communication) is the third principle of external
organisational rhetoric. The end goal of relationship management is ethics, morality, and
social capital (credibility, reputation, and legitimacy) (Kent & Taylor, 2002:22). Heath
(2007:42) argues that advocacy is not inherently contradictory to symmetry. Rhetoric
presumes that all parties are symmetrical in terms of the right to speak. The challenge
arises when bias and self-interest distort communication. The process of co-creation of
meaning (dialectics) requires recognition of self-interest and the interests of others to take
place (Edwards, 2011:534). Symmetrical communication is one of the features of
effectiveness in communication management as discussed in section 10.3.1. It can be
argued that external organisation rhetoric best serves the enactment of this principle.
395
The fourth function of external organisational rhetoric is the facilitation of dialogue. Herein,
the underlying paradigm is about multiple voices engaged in battles within the public
sphere. However, it should be noted that dialogue is not a panacea. Dialogue cannot make
government behave morally or force it to respond to the public. Government itself must
first be willing to make dialogic commitments to the public.
It can be argued and recommended that advocacy should not be excluded from the
theorising of government communication. Advocacy should be acknowledged as
something present in government communication. Once acknowledged, it then becomes
an element that must be regulated and managed. Therefore, government communication
theories must find a way to manage advocacy so that it does not take away from
government communication being an essential public good. The following section offers
conclusive remarks concerning the main research objective.
10.6 CONCLUSIONS
(OBJECTIVES)
ABOUT
RESEARCH
PROPOSITIONS
The distinctiveness of the public sector communication environment as measured by 13
identified features has been confirmed in the data. It is conclusive that these features
have a significant impact on the practice of government communication, as they affect the
organisational structures, communication practices, roles and functions, and evaluation
measures of communication management in provincial government departments.
Liu and Levenshus (2010) recommended that in order to contribute to theory building, the
study on the impacts of the distinctive communication environment of the public sector
must be replicated elsewhere for comparison. The present study has contributed to such a
comparison in an entirely different context. Similarities would mean that the distinctive
features are not necessarily context specific but universal. The present study, in
comparison to Liu and Levenshus (2010) and other studies discussed in chapter 2, found
that the existence of the distinctive features of the public sector are suggestively universal.
However, their impacts are relatively dissimilar and therefore context specific. Sometimes
396
they differed from department to department as the present study evaluated eight
provincial government departments.
The conclusion is that although the distinctive features of the public sector communication
environment are suggestively universal, their impacts are context specific. This conclusion
brings into question what causes distinctions in impacts. To this question, it was found that
the impacts of the distinctiveness of the public sector on the practice of government
communication are dependent and regulated by the extent to which the government
department (provincial government if taken holistically) is strategic as measured by the
principles of excellence and effectiveness in communication management. An additional
factor is the extent to which the practice is being professionalised. It can therefore be
suggested that the negative impacts of the public sector communication environment are
significantly reduced by the extent to which communication management in the public
sector is strategic (excellent and effective) and professional.
The regulation of government communication by institutions such as the GCIS to a certain
degree reduces the negative impacts associated with the distinctiveness of the public
sector communication environment. Certain features of the distinctiveness of the public
sector are manageable by the GICS. For example, the GCIS can elevate the status of
communication in the public sector by educating government management structures of
the values of government communication. This may have a positive impact on budgeting
and resourcing of government communication units to a point where they are capacitated
enough to contribute to organisational effectiveness. Politics can be managed by
designating the communication unit equally between the MEC and the HOD offices and by
ensuring that the MEC group does not co-opt government communication towards the
political. It is suggested that when government communication moves away from the MEC
group is likely to be strategic and less political. The findings demonstrate that
professionalism in government communication is the ability to insulate and manage all
features of the distinctive communication environment of the public sector so that they do
not negatively affect the practice of government communication.
397
The practice of government communication in the KZN provincial government is moving
towards the self-advocacy rhetoric by focusing immensely on identity management,
branding and reputation management. Identity management and other variations of
external organisational rhetoric are indeed essential in a young democracy where the
public are still uninformed about the bill of rights, the functions of various government
departments and services provided by each ministry department. With time, a democracy
must move from talking educationally at the public towards communicating with them.
Government communication in the KZN province can move towards symmetrical
communication by incorporating dialogue and dietetics. An important step towards
symmetrical communication is the incorporation of continuous environmental scanning and
not only opening, but also encouraging public participation.
Notwithstanding the key argument of extant theories in communication management such
as the systems theory, symmetrical model, stakeholder’s theories, and the excellence that
ethical communication is without self-interest, advocacy is unavoidable in communication
management as predicted by the materialism theory of ethics. For that reason, the external
rhetorical theory has demonstrated other measures in which government communication
can be ethical without being devoid of self-interest presentations.
Having fulfilled the ‘excellence’ requirement of strategic communication, government
communication in the KZN provincial government is relatively strategic. It is conclusive that
participating government departments in KZN fulfil various elements of the excellence
principle as documented in the excellence theory. However, many of the sample
departments currently do not fulfil the ‘effectiveness’ principle of strategic communication.
Communications units do not contribute sufficiently to organisational effectiveness as they
do not contribute enough to strategic decision making about the legislations, policies, and
strategies of their government departments (i.e the enterprise strategy). Their role is
limited to communicating about departmental strategies once decisions are made. The
major obstacle is poor environmental scanning and communication evaluations. The
failure of which further contributes to the devaluation of communication in government.
398
10.7 THE DISTINCTIVE, STRATEGIC AND ETHICAL FRAMEWORK FOR
GOVERNMENT COMMUNICATION
•
Objective 2: To design a framework for government communication that takes into
account the strategic, ethical and distinctive elements.
Figure 15: The distinctive, strategic, and ethical framework for government
communication
399
10.7.1 INTRODUCTION
Graber (2003:13-14) suggests that much like the study of organisational communication,
government communication studies lack an overarching theory, both in relation to the level
of analysis and ideological lenses. This study contributes to this literature gap by
proposing a three-dimensional framework from which government communication and be
practiced and theorised. This framework lays the foundations for the development of a
government communication model that predicts effective and strategic communication
management within the distinctive communication environment of the public sector. The
framework posits that for government communication to be efficient, it must be strategic,
distinctive, and ethical.
In order to develop a framework for government communication, this study drew on the
theoretical chapters of this document and the findings from the study. Chapter 2 outlined
the distinctiveness of the public sector communication environment. Chapter 3 presented
the theoretical literature on organisational effectiveness and excellence in communication
management. Chapter 4
discussed the
philosophy of
strategic
communication
management and its incorporation to (strategic) government communication. In overall,
chapter 2, chapter 3 and chapter 4, described the key elements that must be considered in
the theorising of government communication. Once the data was analysed in chapter 8
and chapter 9, the mapping of the interrelationship between these elements became
probable. Through the consideration of history and developments, chapter 6 provided the
contextual background in which government communication is practiced in South Africa.
The thesis statement presented by this study is that communication management is vital
for democracy. Hence, for government communication to be professional and strategic, it
must be organised excellently and effectively (excellence theory) while taking into account
the advocacy nature inherent in external organisational rhetoric which may threaten the
ethics and legitimacy of (government) communication management. It is also essential that
the distinctive communication environment of the public sector (the public sector
distinctiveness theory) be considered in both the theorising and the practice of government
communication.
400
The proposed framework describes the internal context of government communication. It
presents the structuring of the elements, which must be in place for government
communication to function optimally for organisational effectiveness and for the benefit of
citizens within a democracy. It is therefore, essential to determine what makes government
communication strategic, distinctive, and ethical. These elements have been discussed
throughout the study, in theory (literature and theoretical chapters) and in practice (result
chapters).
As suggested in the introduction, this study adopts Sanders’ et al. (2011) framework for
the analysis of government communication. The framework surveys three central
components of an organisation, namely, structure, processes, and outcomes (Sanders et
al., 2011:5). Structure concerns the conditions in which an activity takes place (i.e. the
distinctive communication environment of the public sector), processes are a set of
ordered actions such as roles, functions and communication practices, and outcomes are
the results or consequences of processes (such as government reputation as an
outcome). Each component along with its features is discussed next. The features of all
components in combination provide a checklist or a benchmark in which to evaluate the
extent to which a communication unit is moving towards the practice of government
communication that is strategic, distinctive, and ethical. For this reason, this model
provides recommendation for practice.
The effects of the distinctiveness of the public sector communication environment upon the
practice of government communication are context specific. They are dependent on: (1)
the level of democracy within a specific country, (2) the government department
management style, (3) the ethical orientation of the communication unit, (4) the extent to
which government communication is strategic and (5) the extent in which government
communication is professionalised.
10.7.2 STRUCTURE OF GOVERNMENT COMMUNICATION
The first component to be discussed is structure, which concerns the conditions in which
an activity takes place. This study identifies the distinctive communication environment of
401
the public sector as an internal condition in which government communication is
embedded. It was empirically established that the distinctive communication environment
of the public sector (structure) influences the way government communication is practiced.
From literature, the features that make government communication distinctive were
suggested, and proven in practice. Liu, Horsely and Levenshus (2007, 2010, 2012)
provided the features for the distinctive communication environment of the public sector,
which are incorporated in this framework. The following thirteen 13 features make
government communication distinctive:
1. Politics affect the practice of government communication
2. Government communication is a public good
3. Government communication faces heighten media and public scrutiny
4. Government communication functions within a myriad of legal constraints
5. There is a devaluation of government communication
6. There is poor public perception of government communication as propaganda
7. There are poor professional developments in the government communication
8. There is limited leadership opportunities
9. Centralisation and integration of communicational between the three tier system
10. External above internal communication
11. Government communication is challenged by budget constraints
12. There is poor (insufficient) communication evaluations taking place
13. There are multiple communication responsibilities
It is conclusive that these features significantly influence the practice of government
communication, as they affect the organisational structures, communication practices,
roles and functions, and evaluation measures of communication management in provincial
government departments. It was therefore essential to evaluate the extent to which the
‘distinctive communication environment’ of the public sector along with its inherent
features, enables or deters against the enactment of government communication as a
strategic function. The findings confirm that these features deter against the practice of
strategic
communication.
Nonetheless,
with
the
restructuring
of
government
communication to incorporate excellence, effectiveness, and ethics in strategic
402
communication management, the negative impacts associated with the distinctiveness of
the public sector are possibly reduced. Furthermore, the professionalization of government
communication also lessens these negative impacts.
The effects of the distinctiveness of the public sector communication environment upon the
practice of government communication are context specific. They are dependent on the
level of democracy within a specific country, the government department management
style, the ethical orientation of the communication unit, the extent to which government
communication is strategic and the extent in which government communication is
professionalised. These are expanded upon throughout the description of the framework.
10.7.3 PROCESSES OF GOVERNMENT COMMUNICATION
From the findings, it is conclusive that strategic communication reduces the negative
impacts associated with the distinctive communication environment of the public sector.
The discourse of strategic communication management according to Grunig (2007:29)
consists of loose references to the idea that “public relations should be planned, managed
by objectives, evaluated, and connected in some way to organisational objectives”.
Strategic
communication
is
composed
of
the
excellence,
effectiveness,
and
professionalization of communication management. Strategic government communication
is therefore operationalized as follows: Excellence + effectiveness + professionalism =
strategic government communication. These elements are co-dependent and cannot exist
without each other. They co-create each other. These features are discussed next.
10.7.3.1
Excellence in government communication
Through the excellence theory, Grunig (1992, 2007), outlined the fourteen features of
excellence in communication management which are also incorporated in this framework.
From this literature, it is suggested what brings excellence to government communication
as a requisite to the enactment of strategic communication. These features are
summarised as follows:
403
1. Strategic management is the interlink that integrates excellence and effectiveness
in government communication.
2. Excellent communication departments engage in environmental scanning.
3. Excellent public relations departments contribute to decisions made by the
dominant coalition of senior management by providing information to that coalition
about the environment of the organisation.
4. Organisations with high environmental turbulences are more likely to engage in
environmental scanning; often leading to the excellent government communication,
5. Government communication must be a management function if it is to contribute
excellently to organisational effectiveness.
6. Excellent communication departments must have access to the dominant coalition,
7. All communication management functions must be integrated in a single
department (however, there must be specialisation of roles).
8. There must be a separation of government communication from other functions
such as marketing departments.
9. Government communication must demonstrate an enactment of the two-way
symmetrical model by initiating dialogue, seeking and attending to feedback.
10. Design and manage government communication programmes strategically.
11. Diversity is not only essential, but also mandatory for excellence in government
communication management. This should reflect the diversity of the citizenship.
12. Excellence in government communication does not exist in isolation; it is a
characteristic of an excellent government and excellence in governance.
13. Government communication functions better within a participative rather than an
authoritarian organisational and management culture.
14. Employ communicators with specialised body of knowledge in the field,
professionalism.
10.7.3.2
Effectiveness in government communication
Effectiveness in government communication is a prerequisite to the enactment of strategic
government communication. The features of the effectiveness principle in communication
management were collated and integrated from the readings of the Pretoria School of
404
Thought, Moss and Wanerby and Grunig. These features were then incorporated within
the framework as follows:
1. Government communication must implement the fourteen (14) features of
excellence in order to structure, manage, and effect strategic government
communication (Grunig, 2007).
2. Government communication must manage long-term relationships with the citizens
as external stakeholders through symmetrical communication (Grunig & Repper,
1992:117).
3. Government communication must significantly enhance efforts in environmental
scanning, issue management and communication evaluations as methods to
understand the public, the environment, emerging issues and the effects of
government communication programmes (Moss & Warnaby, 1998:136).
4. The government communication unit must actively and continuously, contribute to
the enterprise strategy. According to literature, effectiveness in government
communication is achieved by (1) conducting environmental scanning, (2) the
compilation of information from the environment and (3) the communication of this
data to government management structures. The dominant-coalition would
henceforth
consider
arising
information
in
decision-making,
policy-making,
legislations, service delivery and towards the general response to identified public
issues. This becomes an iterative and a circular process leading to democracy.
5. Government communication must be duly recognised as a management function
(Steyn, 2004). This means communication managers must retain seats in Maco and
Exco. Within the decision-making table, communication managers must not only
listen to government strategy, but also robustly contribute to it through the process
discussed in number 4.
The Pretoria school of thought recommends a societal approach to communication
management. Central to this approach are issues pertaining to legitimacy and public trust.
For government communication to contribute to democracy, it should be incorporated to
the macro/enterprise level of management of the organisation. Therefore, it is essential for
government communication to be practiced and theorised from a societal approach.
405
To contribute to organisational effectives, government communication must be aligned
with organisational goals and objectives. For that to be possible, government
communicators must fully understand the organisation’s goals and objectives. It is thus
necessary for communication managers to be part of the dominate coalition. Through
environmental scanning and issue-management, communication managers should
influence the enterprise strategy by providing intelligence regarding the socio-political and
economic environment of the organisation. This information should be used to develop
better government policies, goals, and objectives. Only then, will government
communication contribute meaningfully to organisational effectiveness.
For strategic government communication to be truly effective there must be a buy in from
top management or the dominant coalition. If not, the unit is most likely to fail both in its
planning and in operation (Mertinelli, 2012:146). The implementation of communication
strategy documents depends heavily on the knowledge base of practitioners and the
support from management (Grunig & Jaatinen, 1998:230). The knowledge base of
government communicators can be drastically improved by various elements involved in
various professional development initiatives. The professionalism and standardisation of
government communication is discussed next.
10.7.3.3
Professionalism and standardisation of government communication
Professionalism and standardisation of government communication is likely to reduce the
negative impacts associated with the distinctiveness of the public sector communication
environment. Sanders et al. (2011:20) have shown that “professions are usually governed
by codes of practice. These codes typically contain generic statements suggesting that
those working within a particular profession should, for example, act in the interests of both
the people they serve and the wider general public, and promote good practice within their
profession”. Professionalism in government communication relates to the ability to insulate
the negative effects associated with the distinctiveness of the public sector communication
environment. It was found for example, that being professional is the ability to insulate the
effects of politics from doing one’s job, the ability to manage professional media relations,
and the ability to learn more about the practice. The hypothesis is that, the more
406
professionalised government communication is, the less negatively affected it will
be by the distinctiveness of the public sector communication environment.
Government
communication
custodians such
as the GCIS are
able
to
instil
professionalism through training and the standardisation of the practice by providing
directives, policy, and guidelines. The GCIS is recommended to act between the
communication unit and its department management structures (where such intervention is
necessary) to: (1) encourage budget argumentation, (2) educate management structure of
the proper function of government communication in attempt to increase the value
management hold of government communication, (3) advise on the structural position of
the communication unit within the department and (4) educate the media about the
complexities of government communication.
10.7.4 DEGREE OF DEMOCRACY IN THE SPECIFIC COUNTRY
It is conclusive from the study that the impacts of the distinctive communication
environment of the public sector are context specific. The features are indeed likely to
affect the practice of government communication universally, but the impacts may be
different from country to country, depending on the extent to which a country is
democratic. The hypothesis is that the more democratic a country is the less
negatively affected government communication will be by the distinctiveness of the
public sector communication environment. For example, within a democracy, the
practice of government communication is likely to be professionalised. This means that the
practice is standardised with rules and regulations and the structuring of government
communication units is likely to be reflective of the excellence theory. The impacts of
politics and legal constraints may be reduced due to the lessening of legal constraints
stifling the freedom of government communication. Furthermore, within a democracy,
governments are arguably interested in communicating with the public through a dialogic
two-way symmetrical communication, listening to issues, and using those issues to draft
policy, legislations and to guide service delivery.
407
10.7.5 MANAGEMENT STYLE OF THE GOVERNMENT DEPARTMENT
It was found from this study, that the features of the distinctive communication
environment of the public sector affect the practice of government communication slightly
differently from department to department. The hypothesis is that the more open and
engaged the government department’s management style is the less negatively
affected government communication will be by the distinctiveness of the public
sector communication environment.
The management style of the government department seems essential to the practice of
strategic government communication that is ethical and distinctive. The position of the
communication unit in the government department, access to government management
structures, contributions to the enterprise strategy are internal issues influenced by the
management structure of the department. These issues prove the validity of the powercontrol theory, which states, “organisations behave the way they do because the people
who have power in an organisation (the dominant coalition) choose that behaviour”.
The excellence theory indicates that strategic communication is only possible when
government communication is treated as a strategic management function involved in all
aspects of organisational management. This means retaining a seat within the
management structures of the department, contributing to decision-making and having
those contributions acknowledged, respected and utilised. Budgeting and resourcing of the
communication unit stem from how important the communication unit is valued by the
government department. If government communication is valued and adequately financed,
and capacitated with sufficient and skilled employees, then it is possible that there will be
enough resources to conduct environmental scanning and communication evaluations,
which will further elevate the value and the contribution of the communication unit to
organisational or government effectiveness. The positioning of the communication unit
also proved to have an influence on the practice of government communication. It was
found that when the communication unit is positioned in the HOD office, it is more likely to
be strategic and less political than when it is placed within the MEC office. It is therefore
408
truthful that excellence in government communication does not exist in isolation; it is a
characteristic of an excellent government and excellence in governance.
10.7.6 OUTCOME: ETHICAL GOVERNMENT COMMUNICATION
The ethical orientation of the government department also determines the extent to which
the distinctiveness of the public sector affects the practice of government communication.
The ethical orientation of the government communication department on either wanting to
achieve (outcome) advocacy (publicity) or dialogue (public engagement) or both,
influences the choice of government communication practices, relating to the extent to
which they may incorporate strategic, professional and ethical communication practices or
not. Grunig and White (1992) have demonstrated the effect of worldviews on
communication management. “The practice of public relations and theories about its
practice, therefore are affected by the assumptions that practitioners and theorists have
about such things as morality, ethics, human nature, religion, politics, free enterprise, or
gender” (Grunig & White, 1992:32). For example, if government communicators perceive
their profession as ‘advocacy’, they are likely to assume a self-serving, propaganda, and
image-oriented model of government communication. However, if they view the profession
as ‘dialogue’, they are likely to practice a participatory symmetrical form of government
communication that is aware of public opinion and is responsive to it. The public good
analogy demands for a government communication model that services democracy in the
interest
of
the
public.
Literature
suggested
elements
that render government
communication ethical. These features are summarised below:
1. Organisations facilitate identification by communicating its values, goals, and
information (identity management). The first purpose or principle of external
organisational rhetoric is the establishment and maintenance of credibility,
reputation, and legitimacy.
2. Relationship management is the third principle of external organisational rhetoric.
The end goal of relationship management is ethics, morality, and social capital
(credibility, reputation, and legitimacy).
409
3. Symmetrical communication and dialogue - It is only through dialogue that
government co-create and co-define meaning of service deliver, democracy, and
human rights with the public. Arguments and multiplicity of discourse are essential
to the proper functions of democracy. Herein, government listens and responds to
counter dialogue from the public, the media, oppositions, and civil society et cetera.
4. Discourse enactment and enlightened choice - It is assumed that discourse, as
stated above, fosters enlightened choice, and that relationships result from and
often lead to social capital. Through multiple voices engaged in rational debates in
the public sphere, citizens are able to make rational choices about matters of public
policy.
5. Advocacy - The rhetorical tradition has always-recognised advocacy as a tactical
tool in communication management. An advocacy model of government
communication is a way of responding to government critics who challenge
management policies and actions, legislations and issues of service delivery.
Advocacy is essential, and permissive as long as exist in competition and is
respectful of the interests of others.
10.7.7 CONCLUSIONS OF MODEL
The effects of the distinctiveness of the public sector communication environment upon the
practice of government communication are context specific. They are dependent on: (1)
the level of democracy within a specific country, (2) the government department
management style, (3) the ethical orientation of the communication unit, (4) the extent to
which government communication is strategic and (5) the extent in which government
communication is professionalised.
In conclusion, the model demonstrates that the external environment, which is the
enterprise/societal level, the nature of government and the degree of democracy,
influences the internal environment in which government communication is practiced. The
internal environment is the distinctive communication environment of the public sector. The
hypothesis is that the more democratic a country is, the less distinctive the communication
environment of the public sector becomes. In addition, by the incorporating NPM reform
410
strategies, the internal environment of the public sector becomes less distinct and
relatively similar to corporate communication. This would make government run more like
a business.
The internal environment affects the organisational culture of the department. The
declining negative impacts of the distinctive environment of the public sector would results
in an open and strategic organisational culture. As a matter of consequence, the
management style would become susceptible to influences from the communication unit.
Communication would then be valued and treated as a management function. Moreover,
as the management style becomes strategic and democratic, it further reduces the
negative impacts of distinctive features of the public sector. Hence, the structure and the
organisational culture are co-dependent.
The organisational culture (whether communication is valued, transparent, financed,
treated as a management function, and contributes to the enterprise strategy) will have an
impact on the outcomes of government communication such as ethics (transparency &
truthfulness), legitimacy (satisfaction & reputation), and democracy (by being responsive to
public opinion). The above-mentioned outcomes should overtime increase the degree of
democracy.
This study demonstrates that the structure (internal environment of the public sector)
influences the practice (of government communication) which in turn determines the
outcome (ethical & strategic). It can therefore be suggested that all four nodes consisting
of the external environment, the internal environment, the desired outcomes, and the
organisational culture equally affect the practice of government communication.
10.8 CONTRIBUTIONS AND IMPLICATION FOR THEORY
This section outlines how the present study has contributed academically to the field of
communication management and government communication. Because of a variation in
terminologies, locating literature for this study proved problematic. This is because
different
terminologies
are
used for the
same
concept
such
as
government
411
communication, public communication, public relations in the public sector, public
administration, information management and others. The first recommendation to the
research community is to settle on a terminology.
Much of the studies so far in government communication are athoretical. These studies
have paid attention to various elements about the practice of government communication
without theorising about government communication or extrapolating cognate theories
towards understanding these practices of government communication. It is only recently
that strategic management and the excellence theory have been extrapolated to
government communication. There are a small number of studies that applied the
excellence theory in a government communication sector (for example Grunig & Jaatine,
1999; Killingsworth, 2009; Likely 2013), but in overall, research in this area is still lacking.
Liu et al., Gelders et al., Canel, and Sandars have noted the need for theory development
in government communication. Liu and Horsley have contributed immensely towards the
development of a distinctive model of government communication. However, this model is
contextual and does not comprehend much of the South African context.
The suggestion from Liu and Levenshus (2010) and Gelders et al. (2007) is that the
distinctive features of the public sector communication environment affect the practice of
government communication negatively. This led to the proposal that future research and
theories must attempt to find ways to manage these features of distinctiveness to affect
less negatively on the practice of government communication. This study has contributed
to Liu and Levenshus’s (2010) recommendation to lay the foundation for the development
of a theory that predicts effective communication management in the distinctive public
sector environment. For this reason, a framework for government communication that
takes into account the strategic, ethical, and distinctive elements of the practice of
government communication is offered by the present study.
Government communication research in South Africa centres predominantly on mediated
political communication, political rhetoric, political campaigns, participatory communication,
and
development
communication.
Notwithstanding
the
vibrancy
of
government
communication research in South Africa, there remains a dire need to understand
412
government communication from an organisational perspective. The present study adds a
practice dimension, which is necessary to understand the nature of government
communication in South Africa. No studies on the practice and the distinctiveness of
government communication have been conducted within the African context. This study
fills this gap by focusing on South Africa.
Whilst a variety of features contributing to a distinctive communication environment of the
public sector may be identified in extant literature, very few of these studies are grounded
on extensive empirical research (Gelders et al., 2003:327). Moreover, these studies rarely
evaluate the impacts of such ‘distinctiveness’ on the practice of government
communication. This study aimed to narrow this empirical gap. These distinctive features
are now empirically tested to determine the extent to which they influence the function,
structure, and practices of communication management in government (Liu & Horsley,
2007:392).
Extant literature on the exploration of government communication from an organisational
perspective has tended to concentrate on one element of government communication:
such as communication roles (Edes, 2000; Gregory, 2006), external communication
(Gelders & Ihlen, 2009), communication performance and quality (Vos, 2006; Vos &
Westerhoudt, 2008), professionalization (Sander et at., 2011), strategic communication
(killingsworth, 2007), uniqueness of government communication (Gelders, Bouckaert &
Van Ruler, 2007; Liu, Hosley & Levenshus, 2010, 2011, 2012; Waymer, 2013). However,
none of these studies have evaluated the practice of government communication
holistically or the interrelation between these various elements. This study has attempted
to do so.
The
present
study
offers
a
comprehensive
exploratory
study
of
government
communication contributing to an understanding of the complexity of strategic government
communication as approached from an organisational perspective. The study took into
account various elements that were previously studied in isolation and connected the
relationships among these isolated elements and thus consolidating a comprehensive
understanding of the intricacies of government communication.
413
The few studies (Grunig & Jaatinen, 1999; Killingsworth 2009; Likely 2013; Valentini,
2014) that introduced strategic communication in government communication have not
addressed the impacts of the distinctiveness of the public sector communication
environment on how such distinctiveness either advances or constrains strategic
communication. This research has proved that strategic communication is in fact impeded
by various features of the public sector distinctiveness. However, it was also found that as
communication moves towards professionalism, excellence, and effectiveness, strategic
government communication is therefore made possible and its presence further moderates
the negative impacts of the distinctiveness of the public sector communication
environment.
Most research on strategic communication is approached from a communication roles
perspective, particularly measuring strategic communication by evaluating the roles
enacted by the most senior communication manager (Steyn & Green, 2006). The present
study has looked at strategic government communication from various principles of
strategic communication that must be in place for communication management to be
excellent and effective.
Strategic management literature demonstrates that the context affects the management
practices of an organisation. Thus, the context is critical in understanding the nuances in
strategic management processes (Ring & Perry, 1985:276). Extant literature accentuate
that the distinctions between the two sectors involve important differences in
organisational environments, constraints, incentives, and culture, which should be
incorporated to management theory (Perry & Rainey, 1988:182). The critical argument
presented by this study is that such differences in the communication environment of the
public and the private sector should also be incorporated in government communication
theories.
Most studies in organisational communication and communication management tend to be
concerned predominately with how the external environment (context) affects the practice
of communication management. There is very little literature that evaluates the effects of
the internal context on the practice of communication management. The present study has
414
demonstrated how the internal environment (context), which is the distinctiveness of the
public
sector
communication
environment,
affects
the
practice
of
government
communication.
It is can be demonstrated that the some ideals of the New Public Management are
becoming evident in the South African government sector especially in how government
communication
is
practiced,
managed,
financed
and
evaluated
(government
communication is the only section of government activity considered for the study).
However, as these ideals are documented in strategy documents and government
communication policy and legislations, they are not sufficiently enacted in practice. This
means there is still a lot to be done before such ideals of effective; excellence and
efficiency are translated into practice.
Ring and Perry (1985:281) are of the opinion that if public sector performance is judged
against a normative model of strategic management developed in the private sector, it is
likely to be found inadequate. However, judged against standards grounded in the public
sector, different conclusions might be drawn. So far, there were no standards developed
for evaluating strategic communication in the public sector that considered the
distinctiveness of the public sector. This study has demonstrated how strategic
communication management can be judged in the public sector by evaluating elements of
the excellence and effectiveness in the public sector and how these elements are
impacted upon by the distinctive features of the public sector.
The thesis argued that in order for the ideals of the New Public Management to come into
fruition,
strategic
communication
management
is
mandatory
in
government
communication. Only this model of government communication is best able to implement
the objectives of the consultative, networked, responsive, customer-focused mode of
governance envisioned by the NPM paradigm/movement. However, unlike the NPM, this
thesis do not wish away nor deny the ‘distinctiveness’ of the public sector, but rather to
argue that through strategic management, they can be acknowledged, accounted for and
thus managed. This study finds that through strategic government communication, the
negative effects associated with the distinctive communication environment of the public
415
sector can be positively managed and even alleviated. The next section describes the
research implication to policy and practice of government communication in South Africa.
10.9 IMPLICATION FOR POLICY AND PRACTICE
In 1996, the then deputy president Thabo Mbeki set up a Task Group on government
communication (known as the Comtask) to look into government communication as a
whole (that is looking at everything pertaining to government communication). This section
appraises developments and progressions of government communication from the
Comtask era, to this present-day study conducted in the KwaZulu Natal provincial
government, 20 years post democracy, and 14 years post the publication of the Comtask
2000 report about the status of government communication in South Africa.
With regard to government communication as a profession, early in the 1996s, the
Comtask report acknowledged the low status accorded to government communication.
Poor recognitions and poor understanding of the role of communications and its functions
in government were identified by the Comtask report. The findings of the present study are
not conclusive in this area because government communicators claimed that the
politicians (MEC group) understood and valued communication more than the
administrative group (HOD group). In general, there are significant improvements towards
the valuing of government communication in South Africa.
There seems a relationship between the understanding of government communication by
management and the value placed on it by them. Where there is understanding, there is a
corresponding value attached. Where value is recognised, support and budgets are
provided. The key is either to enhance the value of communications by encouraging the
GCIS to step in to educate management and politicians of the nature and purpose of
government communication or by demonstrating the value of government communication
to management and politicians through continuous communication evaluation measuring
the impact, successes, and returns of government communication.
416
The challenges of government communication units identified in the Comtask report
(2000:21) were that “(1) there is no clear standard for setting budget levels or (2) defining
the functions of the communication personnel. (3) The line reporting structure, combined
with a tradition of rigid control of information severely hampers creativity and
responsiveness of communications professionals”. Looking at the results of this study,
there has not been significant improvements on these issues identified here. (1) Selected
communication strategic documents of government departments in the KZN provincial
government and government communicators alike still complained of budget constraints
and poor resources and being understaffed (6.8.3/Pg:236). There is still a struggle in (2)
defining the functions of the communication personnel in government, the result shows
that although there is an acknowledgement of role differentiation in various communication
titles, in practice there is poor job specification and a lack of specialisation in provincial
government communication because of shortages in communication staff. Most
departments are understaffed, so communication staff members must be adept in
interchanging between various roles, from branding, marketing, advertising, events
management et cetera (8.18.1/Pg:302-304). (3) Rigid control of information, consultations
and bureaucracy, what has been termed legal constraints still severely hampers creativity
and responsiveness of communications professionals (8.5.1/Pg228-232).
The comtask report had identified that “there is no clear policy in relation to government
communication and information in South Africa”, poor media access for government issues
and poor training of communication officials. There are notable improvements in this area.
Government Communication and Information System (GCIS) strives to achieve
integration, coordination, and high levels of professionalism in the government
communication profession. In order to facilitate this role, the GCIS has developed a
number of government communication policy guidelines for government communicators in
all levels of the three tiers of government. Policy guidelines of government communication
in South Africa are outlined in section 6.8 in page 619-171. However, the challenge has
been noted in implementation and compliance.
On strategic government communication, the Comtask report identified a need for
strategies and objectives in the South Africa government communication practice. Of the
417
eight departments that partook in this study, six had approved communication strategy
documents and two had draft documents that were not yet approved by the government
department management structures. This shows that it is now a norm than an exception
for government departments to have communication strategy documents and policies.
Again, the challenge had been noted in implementation, application, and compliance. The
communication strategy documents are rightly idealistic but much of the content does not
reflect sufficiently in practice. However, for government communication to be strategic,
there are many other requirements that must be put in place as discussed in chapter 5.
On government identity management, the Comtask report recognised a failure of the
South African government to present a coherent image to the public. Government has both
a duty and a right to present the case for its policies and actions and this advocacy role
needs to be strengthened. Significant strides are noted towards the improvement of the
identity and reputation of governments department. This study found that promoting
government services through branding, identity management, and events management
has been rated as the most vital function of government communication. This has
implications for ethics in government communication that must now be considered.
10.10 IMPLICATIONS FOR METHODOLOGY
10.10.1 METHODOLOGICAL SUCCESSES
This research is predominately constructivist, added with some elements of positivism as a
way of ensuring validity and reliability of the results. For that purpose, a triangulation of
methodology was used. Data collection methods elected for this purpose incorporated indepth interviews and document analyses. A questionnaire survey (35) complimented the
research by providing quantifiable data. Triangulation offered the display of multiple,
refracted realities simultaneously. This triangulation of methodology added validity and
reliability to the research findings. The advantage of using open-ended interviews was the
latitude accorded for the respondents to explain and build on their responses, which
proved valuable for qualitative studies. This provided rich data about the practice of
government
communication
and
the
day-to-day
experiences
of
government
418
communicators. The additional advantage of open-ended interviews was their flexibility to
accommodate emerging issues. In this way, new issues and themes emerged out of the
data that were previously unexplored in the literature. As for Bowen (2009:30-31),
documents analysis of communication strategy documents of selected government
departments provided background and context, supplementary data and verification of
findings from other data sources.
10.10.2 METHODOLOGICAL CHALLENGES
Issues of confidentiality and anonymity are essential when government is the subject of
study. Ensuring anonymity was challenging for this research because the interview sample
was purposely-selected government communicators at various levels, working in various
government departments in the KwaZulu Natal provincial government. This meant that
identifying any department or the level of employment would identify the participant by
default. This made it ethically cumbersome to identify the eight departments that
participated in the study and the employment levels of selected participants.
Access is a formidable impasse in organisational research and case studies in general.
Without gaining access to the primary source of data, there is no research. It was difficult
to get some respondents to commit to an interview over the phone or on emails. So walkins proved useful in explaining the research purpose in details and in personifying the
researcher. It was even more difficult (not impossible) to receive responses on the online
surveys. For that matter, surveys were delivered in person on the day of the interview and
collected after the interview.
The 30-person sample size for the interviews was appropriate as data saturation was at
some point achieved (repetitive responses). However, a 30-person sample size was
insufficient for the survey data. However, for this study it was satisfactory as incorporated
in a methodology triangulation were supplementary data was present. It was also essential
for the researcher to ensure that the same people who provided the interviews answered
the surveys. The quantitative methodology (surveys) employed here was not meant to
419
generalise from the data but rather to attempt to quantify the qualitative themes, patterns
and responses already collected from qualitative means.
10.11
LIMITATIONS OF THE STUDY
The limitation of this study is also its strength. Using the concoction of eight government
departments in the KZN provincial government as a case study, the present study has
looked at various elements of government communication at once and evaluated the
intersections between these elements. While some may see this as a limitation by making
the study big, it may also be considered strength because the study provided a detailed
view of the practice of government communication and its impacts on the theorising of
government communication. In addition, the case study method is permissive of
investigating anything and everything that best describes the case study in order to come
to an optimal understanding of what is happening in the case study. This study has done
essentially that. However, no study is ever completely comprehensive. Despite this study
having closed certain gaps in literature, more research is still needed to further understand
the nature of about government communication in South Africa. For that purpose, some
research recommendations for future studies are presented below.
10.12 FUTURE RESEARCH RECOMMENDATIONS
There are still very limited empirical studies in government communication globally; the
situation is even extreme in South Africa. As a groundbreaking exploratory study that
incorporated various elements of government communication, it was not long until
significant gaps in literature were identified. From these gaps, emerge the following
recommendations:
The study of the distinctiveness of government communication is new in South Africa. With
reference to the distinctive features of the public sector communication environment, it is
imperative to quantify in a broad survey study if indeed these features are present in
various government departments in South Africa. In addition, the identified effects of these
distinctive features upon the practice of government communication, as presented
420
qualitatively, in this study, can also be measured quantitatively to further evaluate their
validity.
The same methodology triangulated study, with the same research objectives to be
replicated in any other province in South Africa for a comparative study. In addition, but
preferably in a different study, the hypothesis identified in this study could be examined
further in order to prove or to disprove their relevance.
There is a need to evaluate the interrelationship of government communication units of a
single ministry government department (e.g. education) from the national, provincial, local
and districts. In this, a single stream should be followed, for example one could focus on
national (Pretoria), provincial (KZN), local (municipality), and regional/districts (Durban).
This would demonstrate the relationship and communication flow among the three tiers of
government. Until this relationship is understood, theorising of government communication
can never be fully complete.
South Africa has many policy guidelines that regulate the practice of government
communication, it is essential to investigate these policy documents (document analysis)
and evaluate their uses in practice (interviews). This would provide an invaluable data
detailing the relationship between government communication policies and practice.
Government communication seems to be moving towards direct communication (in
addition to indirect media relations). In this, social media (Gov 2.0) has been incorporated
into the theme of government communication, bringing with it, opportunities and
challenges in both practice and policymaking.
Government-media relations is still a significant issue to explore. This study has
approached the government-media relations issue from the perspectives of government
communicators. It is advisable to contribute further by approaching this issue from the
perspective of the media.
421
Relationship management has become vital in government communication. This study
focused on one directional flow of communication, from government departments to the
public. There is a lot that government departments are doing to communicate with the
public. It is thus essential not only to evaluate the perceptions of the public about
government communication, but also to study the counter-flow of communication from the
public back into government.
10.13 CONCLUSION ABOUT THE RESEARCH PROBLEM
As Vos (2006:257) had recommended that future academic research in government
communication focus on exploring communication practices and factors that influence
them, the present study has responded to such a call. This study has explored the extent
to which the distinctive communication environment of the public sector affects the practice
of strategic communication management in government departments within the KwaZulu
Natal provincial government.
This research had come to the following conclusion: The distinctiveness of the public
sector communication environment as measured by literature-identified features has been
confirmed in the data. It is conclusive that these features have a significant impact on the
practice of government communication, as they affect the organisational structures,
communication practices, roles and functions, and evaluation measures of communication
management in provincial government departments. It is therefore suggested that the
negative impacts of the public sector communication environment can significantly be
reduced by the extent to which communication management in the public sector is
strategic (excellent and effectiveness) and professional.
It was also concluded that government communication is relatively strategic by fulfilling the
excellence requirement of strategic communication. However, the KZN provincial
government failed to uphold the effectiveness principle, as most sampled communication
departments failed to conduct informative environmental scanning necessary to contribute
substantially to organisational decision-making for the attainment of organisational
effectiveness.
Improvements are obligatory for the fulfillment of the ‘effectiveness’
422
principle of strategic communication. This is the only way that government communication
in KZN can be seen as strategic.
The external organisational rhetoric theory has been used to understand ethics in
government communication. It was found that government communication in KZN is
moving towards asymmetrical communication by focusing more on publicity, marketing,
identity management, and reputation management. For this reason, it can be argued and
recommended that advocacy should not be excluded from the theorising of government
communication. Advocacy should be acknowledged as something that is present in
government communication. Once acknowledged, it then becomes an element that must
be regulated and managed for the attainment of ethical government communication.
This study has reflected upon the interrelationship between, the distinctiveness of the
public
sector communication
environment,
strategic
communication, and
ethical
communication. A model to this effect has been developed. This framework demonstrates
that the structure (internal environment of the public sector) influences the practice (of
government communication) which in turn determines the outcome (ethical & strategic).
This is not withstanding to the fact that all four nodes consisting of the external
environment, the internal environment, the desired outcomes and the organisational
culture equally influences the practice of government communication. For this reason,
study government communication should be approached from a multi-faceted theoretical
perspective.
423
LIST OF REFERENCES
Ababio, E. 2007. Marriage for development: ward committees as partners in participatory
democracy. Journal of Public Administration, 42(7):614-621.
Aertsen, T. & Gelders, D. 2011. Differences between the public and private communication
of rumours: A pilot survey in Belgium. Public Relations Review, 37(3):281-291. [Online]
Available from: doi:10.1016/j.pubrev.2011.03.009 [Downloaded: 2011-03-12].
Alford, J. 2002. Defining the client in the public sector: a social –exchange perspective.
Public Administration Review, 62(3):337-346.
Allison, G.T. 1979. Public and private management: are they fundamentally alike in all
unimportant respects? Washington DC: Brookings Institution.
Andersen, J.A. 2010. Public versus private managers: how public and private managers
differ in leadership behaviour. Public Administration Review, 70(10:131-141.
Babbie, E. & Mouton, J. 2001. The practice of social research. South African edition. Cape
Town: Oxford University Press South Africa.
Barbour, R.S. & Kitzinger, J. 1999. Developing focus group research: politics, theory and
practice. London: Sage publication.
Barker, L. 2002. Customer-focused government: from policy to delivery. Unpublished
manuscript by Public Services Productivity panel (UK).
Barney, R.D. & Black, J. 1994. Ethics and professional persuasive communications. Public
Relations Review, 20(x):233-248.
Beckett.J. 2000. The “Government should run like a business” Mantra. American Review
of Public Administration, 30(2):185-204.
424
Berelson, B. 1952. Democratic theory and public opinion. The Public Opinion Quarterly,
16(13):313-330.
Bernays, E.L. 1955. The theory and practice of public relations: a resume. In Bernays E.L.
(Ed.) The engineering of consent. New York: University of Oklahoma Press.
Bezuidenhout, L. & Van Heerden, C.H. 2003. An exploratory analysis of the corporate
identity of selected government departments in South Africa. Communicare, 22(1):1-20.
Bick, G., Abratt, R. & Bergman, A. 2008. Perceptions of the corporate identity
management process in South Africa. South African Journal of Business Management,
39(3):11-19.
Bowen, G.A. 2009. Document Analysis as a Qualitative Research Method. Qualitative
Research Journal, 9(2):27- 40.
Bowen, S.A. 2012. Ethics in government public relations. In: Lee, M., Neeley, G., &
Stewart, K. (eds.) The practice of government public relations. United States of America:
CRC Press (Taylor & Frances Group).
Box, R.C. 1999. Running government like a business: implications for public administration
theory and practice. American Review of Public Administration, 29(1):19-43.
Boyne, G.A. 2002. Public and private management: what’s the difference? Journal of
Management Studies, 39(1):97-122.
Boyd, J. & Waymer, D. 2011. Organisational rhetoric: a subject of interest(s). Management
Communication Quarterly, 25(3):474-493.
Broom, G.M. 1982. A comparison of sex roles in public relations. Public Relations Review,
8(3):17-22.
425
Broom, G,M. & Dozier, D.M 1986. Advancement for public relation role models. Public
Relation Review, 12(1):37-56.
Broom, G,M. & Smith G.D. 1979. “Testing the practitioner’s impact on clients. Public
Relations Review, 5(3):47-59.
Braun, V. & Clarke, V. 2006. Using thematic analysis in psychology. Qualitative Research
in Psychology, 3(2):77-101.
Burnard, P. 1991. A method of analysing interview transcripts in qualitative research.
Nurse Education Today, 11(6):461-466.
Burke, K. 1969. A rhetoric of motives (Vol 111). United States of America: University of
California Press.
Burke, K. 1951. Rhetoric – old and new. The Journal of General Education, 1(x):202-209.
Buzeman, B. 1987. All organizations are public: Bridging public and private organization
theory. San Francisco: Jossey-Bass.
Byars, N. 2012. Government Websites. In Lee, M. Neeley, G and Stewart, K. 2012. The
Practice of Government Public Relations. New York: CRC Press.
Canel, M,J. & Sanders, K. 2012. Government Communication: An emerging field in
political communication research. In Semetko, H,A. & Scammell, M. (eds.) The Sage
Handbook of Political Communication. London: Sage Publications.
Canel, M.J. & Sanders, K. 2013. (eds). Introduction: mapping the field of government
communication. Government Communication: Cases and Challenges. London and New
York: Bloomsbury Polishers.
426
Cheney, G. 1983. The rhetoric of identification and the study of organizational
communication. Quarterly Journal of Speech, 69(2):143-158.
Clemons, D.C. 2009. Coorientation of the public relations role within the public sector.
(Doctoral dissertation). Howards University. (Publication Number: AAT 3344937).
Craig, R.T. 2006. Communication as a practice. In: Shepherd, G.J & Striphas, T. (eds.)
Communication as Perspectives on Theory. Sage Publications: London.
Cohen, B.C. 1963. The press and foreign policy. Princeton, NJ: Princeton University
Press.
COMTASK Report. 2000. Republic of South Africa: Pretoria, South Africa.
Coombs, W.T. 1999. Ongoing crisis communication: planning, managing and responding.
Thousand oaks, CA: Sage Publications.
Cutlip, S.M. 1976. Government Public Relations. Public Relations Review, 2(2):5-28.
[Online]
Available
from:
http://0-
www.sciencedirect.com.innopac.up.ac.za/science/article/pii/S036381117680001X
[Downloaded: 2011-03-12].
Cutlip, S.M, Center, A. & Broom. 1985. Effective Public Relations. 6th ed. New York:
Prentice-Hall.
Da Vaus. 2002. Surveys in social research. 5th ed. Australia: Routledge.
Da Silva, R. & Batista, L. 2007. Boosting government reputation through CRM. The
International Journal of Public Sector Management, 20(7):588-560.
Deacon, D., Pickering, M., Golding, P. & Murdock, G. 1999. Researching communications:
A practical guide to methods in media and cultural studies. London: Arnold.
427
De Beer, E, Steyn, B & Rensburg, R. 2013. The Pretoria School of Thought: From strategy
to governance and sustainability. In: Sriramesh, K., Zerfass, A., & Jeong-Nam, K. (eds.)
Public Relations and Communication Management: Current Treads and Emerging Topics.
Routledge.
Desmairais, C & de Chatillon, EA. 2010. Are there still differences between the roles of
private and public sector managers? Public Management Review, 12(1)127-149.
Denzin, N.K. & Lincoln, Y.S. (eds). 2003. Strategies of qualitative inquiry. London: Sage
Publication.
De Vries, M. & Nemec, J. 2013. Public sector reform: an overview of recent literature and
research on NPM and alternative paths. International Journal of Public Sector
Management, Vol. 26(1):4-16.
De Wet, J, C. 2010. Persuasive Communication: the historical context. The art of
persuasive communication: a process. 3rd ed. South Africa: Juta Publications.
Dowling, G. & Weeks, W. 2011. Media analysis: what is it worth? Journal of Business
Strategy, 32(1): 26-33.
Dozier, D.M. 1992. The organisational roles of communications and public relations
practitioners in Grunig, J.E. 1992. Excellence in Public Relations and Communication
Management. London: Lawrence Erlbaum Associates.
Dozier, D.M. Program evaluation and the roles of practitioners. Public Relations Review,
10(2):13-21.
Downe-Wamboldt, B. 2009. Content analysis: method, applications, and issues. Health
Care for Women International, 13(3):313-321.
428
Dunleavy, P & Hood, C. 1994. From Old Public Administration to New Public
Management, Public Money & Management, 14(3):9-16.
Du Plooy, G.M. 2002. Communication research: techniques, methods and applications.
South Africa: JUTA.
Edes, B.W. 2000. The role of government information officers. Journal of Government
Information, 27(4):455-469.
Edwards,
l.
Questions
of
self-interest,
agency,
and
the
rhetor.
Management
Communication Quarterly, 25(3):474-493.
Elmer, P. 2000. Beyond professionalism: a government relational model. Corporate
Communications: an International Journal, 5(4):190-196.
Fairbanks, J., Plowman, D.K., & Rawlins, BL. 2007. Transparency in government
communication.
Journal
of
Public
Affairs,
7:23-37.
[Online]
Available
from:
www.interscience.wiley.com.DOI:10.1002/pa.254/ [Downloaded: 2011-03-12].
Fico, F.G, Lacy,S., & Riffe, D. 2008. A content analysis guide for media economics
scholars. Journal of Media Economics, 21(2):114-130.
Gaber, I. 2009. Exploring the paradox of liberal democracy: more political communications
equals less public trust. The Political Quarterly, 80(1):84-91.
Gelders, D., Bouckaert, G. & van Ruler, B. 2007. Communication management in the
public
sector:
consequences for public communication
about policy intentions.
Government Information Quarterly, 24(2):326-337.
Gelders, D & Ihlen, O. 2009. Government communication about potential policies: public
relations, propaganda or both? Public Relations Review, 36(1):59-62. [Online] available
429
from: http://www.sciencedirect.com/science/article/pii/S0363811109001416 [Downloaded:
2011-03-12].
Gelders, D & Ihlen, O. 2010. Mending the gap: applying a service-marketing model into
government policy communications. Government Information Quarterly, 27(1):34-40.
Glenn, T. 2014. The management and administration of government communication in
Canada. Canadian Public Administration, 57(1):3-25.
Glenny, L. 2008. Perspectives of communication in the Australian public sector. Journal of
Communication Management, 12(2):152-168.
Goldfain, K., & Van der Merwe, N. 2006. The role of a political blog: the case of www.
commentary. co. za. Communicare, 25(1):103-116.
Graber, D.A. 2003. The power of communication: managing information in political
organisations. Washington, DC: CQ Press.
Graham, P. 1994. Marketing in the public sector: inappropriate or merely difficult? Journal
of Marketing Management, 10(5):361-375.
Gray, A & Jenkins, B. 1995. From Public Administration to Public Management:
Reassessing a revolution? Public Administration, 73(4):75-99.
Gregory, A. 2006. A development framework for government communicators. Journal of
Communication Management, 10(2):197-210.
Gregory, A. 2009. Management and organisation of public relations. In: Tench, R &
Yeomas, L. (eds.) Exploring Public Relations. United Kingdom: Prentice Hall.
Griffin, E.M. 2012. A first look at communication theory. 8th ed. New York: McGraw-Hill
Higher Education.
430
Grunig, J.E. 1992. Excellence in public relations and communication management.
London: Lawrence Erlbaum Associates.
Grunig, J.E. 2006. Furnishing the edifice: ongoing research on public relations as a
strategic management function. Journal of Public Relations Research, 18(2):151-176.
Grunig, J.E. 2007. Public relations management in government and business. In: Lee, M.
(ed.) Government Public Relations: A Reader. Boca Raton, FL: CRC Press.
Grunig, J.E & Jaatinen, M. 1999. Strategic, symmetrical public relations in government:
from pluralism to societal corporatism. Journal of Communication Management, 3(3):218234.
Grunig, J.E & L.A. Grunig. Guidelines for evaluative research in public affairs: a report for
the department office of science analysis. Public Affairs Research. [Online] available from:
http://www.instituteforpr.org/wp-content/uploads/2001_PA_Research.pdf [accessed: 201201-28].
Grunig, J.E & Repper, F.C. 1992. Strategic management, publics, and issues in Grunig,
J.E. (ed). Excellence in Public Relations and Communication Management. London:
Lawrence Erlbaum Associates.
Guba, E.G & Lincoln, Y.S 1994. Competing paradigms in qualitative research. In Denzin,
N and Lincoln, Y.S. (eds). Handbook of Qualitative Research. Thousand Oaks, CA: Sage.
Hartle, T.W. 1985. Sisyphus revisited: Running the government like a business. Public
Administration Review, (March/April): 341-345.
Haycock, E. & Labuschagne, H.J. 2006. Achieving performance excellence by aligning
strategies and operations in local government context in South Africa. Politeia, 25(3):257272.
431
Heath, R.L. 2001. A rhetorical enactment rationale for public relations: the good
organisation
communicating well. The handbook of public relations. United Kingdom:
Sage publication.
Heath, R.L. 2007. Management through advocacy: reflection rather than domination. In:
Toth, E.L (ed.) The future of excellence in public relations and communication
management: challenges for the next generation. London: Lawrence Erlbaum Associates,
Publishers.
Heath, R.L. 2011. External organisational rhetoric: bridging management and sociopolitical discourse. Management Communication Quarterly, 25(3):474-493.
Heath, R.L, Waymer, D & Palenchar, M.J. 2013. Is the universe of democracy, rhetoric,
and public relations whole cloth or three separate galaxies? Public Relations Review,
39(4):271-279.
Heinze, J, Schneider, H & Ferie, F. 2013. Mapping the consumption of government
communication: a qualitative study in Germany. Journal of Public Affairs, (13(4):370-383
Heise, A.J. 1985. Towards closing the confidence gap: an alternative approach to
communication between public and government. Public Administration Quarterly, 9(2):196217 [Online] available from: http://www.jstor.org/stable/40861057[Downloaded: 2012-1-24]
Hiebert, R.E. and Devine, C.M. 1985. Government research and evaluation gap. Public
Relations Review, 11(3):47-56.
Hiebert, R.E. 2003. Public relations and propaganda in framing the Iraq war: a preliminary
review. Public Relations Review, 29(3):243-255.
Highhouse, S., Brooks, M.E & Gregarus. 2009. An organizational impression management
perspective on the formation of corporate reputations. Journal of Management,
432
35(6):1481-1493[Online]
available
from:
http://jom.sagepub.com/content/35/6/1481
[Downloaded: 2012--3-14].
Hood, C. 1995.
The New Public Management in the 1980s: Variations of a Theme,
Accounting Organisations and Society, 20(2/3):93-109.
Hoffman, M.F. & Ford, D.J. 2010. Organisational rhetoric: situations and strategies.
London: Sage Publications.
Hon, L.C. 1997. What have you done for me lately? Exploring effectiveness in public
relations. Journal of Public Relations Research, 9(1):1-30.
Howlette, M. 2009. Government communication as a policy tool: a framework for analysis.
The Canadian Political Science review, 3(2):23-37.
Howlett, M., Craft, J. & Zibrik, L. 2010. Government communication and democratic
governance: Electoral and policy-related information campaigns in Canada. Policy and
Society, 29(1):13-22.
Hutton, Goodman, Alexander & Genest. 2001. Reputation management: The new face of
corporate public relations? Public Relations Review, 27(3):247-261[Online] available from:
http://www.eric.ed.gov/ERICWebPortal/search/detailmini.jsp?_nfpb=true&_&ERICExtSear
ch_SearchValue_0=EJ638831&ERICExtSearch_SearchType_0=no&accno=EJ638831
[Downloaded: 2011-06-17].
Hutton, G.J. 1999. The definition, dimensions and domain of public relations. Public
Relation Review, 25(2):199-214.
Hughes, P. 1995. The process of government communication : some semiotic and cultural
considerations. Australian Journal of Public Administration, 54(2). [Online] available from:
http://onlinelibrary.wiley.com/doi/10.1111/j.1467-8500.1995.tb01123.x/abstract [Accessed:
2011-08-27].
433
Jackson, A.N. & Lilleker, D.G. 2004. Just public relations or an attempt at interaction?
British MPs in the press, on the web and in your face. European Journal of
communication, 19(4):507-533.
Johnston, A. 2005. The African National Congress, the print media and the development of
mediated politics in South Africa. Critical arts, 19(2):12-35.
Kaboolian, L. 1998. The New Public Management: Challenging the Boundaries of the
Management vs Administration debate, Public Administration Review, 58(3):189-193.
Kaid, L.L. 1996. Political communication. In: Salwen, M.B and Stacks, D.W. (eds). 1996.
An integrated approach to communication theory and research. New Jersey: Lawrence
Erlbaum Associates, Publishers.
Kaplan, A.M. 2009. The increasing importance of public marketing: explanations,
applications and limits of marketing within public administration. European Management
Journal, 27(3):197-212.
Kent, M.L. & Taylor, M. (2002). Toward a dialogic theory of public relations. Public
relations review, 28(1), 21-37.
khan, H.A. 2008. An Introduction to Public Administration. University Press of America, inc.
Kiriakidou, O. & Millward J.L. 2002. Corporate Identity: external and internal fit? Corporate
Communications: An International Journal, 5(1):49-58.
Killingsworth, C. 2009. Municipal government communication : the case of local
government communicators. The McMaster Journal of Communications, 6(1).
Kumar, R. 1999. Research methodology: a step-by-step guide for beginners. New Delhi:
Sage publications.
434
Lattimore, D. Baskin, O. Heiman, S.T., and Toth, E.L. 2009. ‘Public Affairs: relations with
government’. Public Relations: the profession and the practice. McGraw-Hill International.
Lee, M. 2000. Reporters and bureaucrats: public relations counter-strategies by public
administrators in an era of media disinterest in government. Public Relations Review,
25(4):451-468.
[Online]
available
from:
http://www.sciencedirect.com/science/article/pii/S0363811199000314 [Downloaded: 201004-20].
Lee, M. 2007. Government public relations: a reader. Boca Raton, FL: CRC Press.
Lee, M. Neeley, G and Stewart, K. 2012. The practice of government public relations. CRC
Press.
th
Leedy, P.D. & Ormrod, J.E. 2010. Practical research: planning and design. 9 ed. Upper
Saddle River, NJ: Pearson.
Likely, F. 2013. Managing strategically: Canadian federal government communication
branches evaluated against five of the generic principles of public relations. Journal of
professional communication, 3(1):69-96.
Lindenmann, 2003. Guidelines for measuring the effectiveness of PR programs and
activities.
The
institute
for
public
relations.
[Online]
available
from:
http://www.instituteforpr.org/topics/effectiveness-programs-activities/ [Accessed: 2012-0129].
Liu, B.F., & Horsley, J.S. 2007. The Government communication wheel: towards a public
relations model for the public sector. Journal of Public Relations Research, 19(4):377-393.
Liu, B.F., & Levenshus, A.B. 2008. Testing the government communication decision
wheel: towards a new theory of government public relations. Paper presented at the
conference of the International Communication Association, Montreal, Canada.
435
Liu, B.F., & Levenshus, A.B. 2010. Public Relations professionals’ perspectives on the
communication challenges and opportunities they face in the public sector. Prism 7(1):
[Online] available from: http://www.prismjournal.org [Downloaded: 2011-08-30].
Liu, B.F, Horsley, J.S & Levenshus, A.B. 2010a. Comparisons of US government
communication practices: expanding the government communication decision Wheel.
Communication Theory, 20(3):269-300.
Liu, B.F., Horsley, J.S & Levenshus, A.B. 2010b. Government and corporate
communication practises: do the difference matter? Journal of Applied Communication
Research, 38(2):189-213.
Liu, B.F., Horsley, J.S & Levenshus, A.B. 2012. Communication practices of US elected
and non-elected officials: towards a new model of government communication. Journal of
Communication Management, 16(3):220-243.
Littlejohn, S.W & Foss, K.A. 2009. Political communication theories. Encyclopaedia of
Communication Theory. London: Sage Reference Publication.
Lor, P.J. & Van As, A. 2002. Work in progress: Developing policies for access to
government information in the New South Africa. Government Information Quarterly,
19(2):101-121.
Luoma-aho, V. 2008. Sector reputation and public organisations. International Journal of
Public
Sector
Management,
21(5):446-467.
[Online]
available
from:
www.emeraldinsight.com/0951-3558.htm [Downloaded: 2011-08-27].
Lyons, ST, Duxbury, LE. & Higgs, CA. 2006. A comparison of the value and commitment
of private sector, public sector, and para-public sector employees. Public Administration
Review, 669(4):605-620.
436
Mabelebele, J. 2006. Ideological objectives underpinning imbizos as a model of
communication and government. Communicare, 25(2):102-125.
Mackey, S. Rhetorical theory of public relations: opening the door to semiotic and
pragmatic approaches. 2005. Paper presented at the annual meeting of the Australian and
New Zealand Communication Association Christchurch, New Zealand.
Mainardes, E.W., Alves, H & Raposa, M. 2011. Stakeholder theory: issues to resolve.
Management
Decision,
49(2):226-252.
[Online]
Available
from:
www.emeraldinsight.com/0025-1747.htm [Downloaded: 2011-08-27].
Mathiasen, D.G. 1999. The New Public Management and its critics. International Public
Management Journal, 2(1):90-111.
Mersham, G., Skinner, C., & Rensburg, R. 2011. Approaches to African communication
management and public relations: A case for theory-building on the continent. Journal of
Public Affairs, 11(4):195-207.
Mertinelli, D.K. 2012. Strategic Communication Planning. In Lee, M. Neeley, G and
Stewart, K. 2012. The Practice of Government Public Relations. CRC Press.
McCombs, M, Shaw, D.L. & Weaver, D. 1997. Communication and democracy: Exploring
the Intellectual frontiers in agenda setting theory. London: London Erlbaum Associates,
Publishers.
McNair, B. 2011. An introduction to political communication. New York: Taylor & Francis.
Meintjes, C., & Niemann-Struweg, I. 2009. The role of a professional body in
professionalisation: The South African public relations case. PRism 6(2). [Online] Available
from: http://praxis.massey.ac.nz/prism_on-line_journ.html [Downloaded: 2011-07-17].
437
Melewar, T.C and Jenkins, E. 2002. Defining the corporate identity construct. Corporate
Reputation Review, 5(1):76-90.
Meier, K. And O’Toole, L,J. 2011. Comparing public and private management: theoretical
expectations. Journal of Public Administration Research and Theory, 21(3):283-299.
Metzler, M.S. 2001. The centrality of organisational legitimacy to public relations practice.
In: Heath (ed.) Handbook of Public Relations. London: Sage publications.
Mogalakwe, M. 2006. The use of documentary research methods in social research.
African Sociological Review, 10(1):221-230.
Moss, D & Warnaby, G. 1998. Communications strategy? Strategy communication?
Integrated different perspectives. Journal of Marketing Communication, 4(3):131-140.
Moss, D, Newman, A & DeSanto, B. 2005. What do communication managers do?
Defining the core elements of management in a public relations/corporate communication
context. Journalism and Mass Communication Quarterly, 82(4):879-890.
Mouton, J. How to succeed in your master’s and doctoral studies: a South African guide
and resource book. South Africa: Van Schaik.
Morgan, D.F & Cook, B.J. (eds). 2014. New public governance: A regime centered
perspective, USA: Routledge.
Msibi, F. & Penzhorn, C. 2010. Participatory communication for local government in South
Africa: a study of the Kungwini local municipality. Information Development, 26(3):255-236.
Neuman, W.L. 2000. Social research methods: Qualitative and quantitative approaches.
th
4 ed. Boston, MA: Pearson Education.
438
Netshitomboni, L.R. 2007. Managing participatory development communication: The case
for the Government Communication and Information System (GCIS). Unpublished doctoral
thesis. Pretoria: University of Pretoria.
Nzimakwe, T. 2010. Marketing as a tool to promote public service provision. Journal of
Public Administration, 45(1):58-70.
Osborne, D. & Gaebler, T. 1992. Reinventing government: How the entrepreneurial spirit is
transforming the public sector. Reading, MA: Addison-Wesley.
Page, S. 2005. What's new about the new public management? Administrative change in
the human services. Public Administration Review, 65(6): 713-727.
Palenchar, M.J. 2011. Concluding thoughts and challenges. Management Communication
Quarterly, 25(3):474-493.
Pandey, S.K, & Garnett, J.L. 2006. Exploring public sector communication performance:
testing a model and drawing implications. Public Administration Review, 66(1):37-51.
Paul, C. 2012. Challenges facing U.S government and department of defence efforts in
strategic communication. Public Relations Reviews, 38(2):188-194.
Pearson, M. & Patching, R. 2008. Government media relations: a spin through the
literature.
Humanities
ePublications@bond.
and
Social
Sciences
[Online]
Paper
228.
Bond
University
Available
from:
http://epublications.bond.edu.au/hss_pubs/228 [Downloaded: 2011-05-10].
Perloff, R.M. 2014. The dynamics of political communication, media and politics in a digital
age. New York: Routledge
Perry, J.L. & Rainey, H.G. 1988. The public-private distinction in organization theory: a
critique and research strategy. The Academy of Management Review, 13(2):182-201.
439
Peters, G.B & Pierre, J. 1998. Governance without Government? Rethinking Public
Administration, Journal of Public Administration Research and Theory.
Pierre, J. & Peters. B.G. 2005. Governing Complex Societies: Trajectories and Scenarios.
Palrave MacMillilian.
Plack, M.M. Human nature and research paradigms: theory meets physical therapy
practice. The Qualitative Report, 10(2):223-245.
Ponterotto, J.G. 2005. Qualitative research in counselling psychology: a primer on
research paradigms and philosophy of science. Journal of Counselling Psychology,
52(2):126-136.
Rainey, H.G., Backoff, R.W.
& Levine, G.H. 1976. Comparing public and private
organizations. Public Administration Review, 36(2):233-244.
Rainey, H.G and Bozeman, B. 2000. Comparing public and private organisations:
empirical research and the power of the a priori. Journal of Public Administration Research
and Theory, 10(2):447-469.
Rainey, H.G. 2003. Understanding and managing public organisations. 3rd ed. San
Francisco: Jossey-Bass.
Rasila, B.N. & Mudau, M.J. 2012. Effective communication as a strategic tool for rural
development: a model to take South African Government beyond mobilization and
consultation through public participation. Journal of Media and Communication Studies,
4(7):134-141.
Rensburg, R 2007, 'Communications management in the Africa context: implications for
theory, research, and practice', International Journal of Strategic Communication, 1(1):3751. [Online] Available from: [http://www.tandf.co.uk/journals/authors/hstcauth.asp].
440
Rensburg & Cant. 2003. Public relations: South African perspectives.
Cape Town:
Heinemann.
Highsaw R.B. &. Bowen.L.D. 1965. (eds) Communication in Public Administration.
Paragon Press (The University of Alabama).
Ring, P.S, & Perry, J.L. 1985. Strategic management in public and private organisations:
implications of distinctive contexts and constraints. The Academy of Management Review,
10(2):276-286.
Roper, J. 2005. Symmetrical communication: excellent public relations or strategy for
hegemony? Journal of Public Relation Research, 17(1):69-86.
Rose, A. 1999. The distinctiveness of public management. In: Rose & Lawton, A. (eds.)
Public Services Management. Great Britain: Person Education Limited.
Sadeghi, L. 2012. Web 2.0. In Lee, M. Neeley, G and Stewart, K. 2012. The practice of
government public relations. CRC Press.
Sanders, K., Canel, J.M., & Holtz-Bacha, C. 2011. Communicating governments: a threecountry comparison of how governments communicate with citizens. The International
Journal
of
Press/Politics,
xx(x):1-25.
[Online]
available
from:
http://hij.sagepub.com/content/early/2011/09/08/1940161211418225 [Downloaded: 14-032012].
th
Saunders, M., Lewis, P. & Thornhill, A. 2009. Research methods for business students. 5
ed. Harlow, Essex: Pearson.
Sayre, W.S. 1958. Premises of public administration: past and emerging. Public
Administration Review, 18(2):102-105.
441
Seidman, I. 2006. Interviewing as qualitative research: a guide for researchers in
education and social sciences. 3rd ed. New York: Teachers College Press.
Sumser, J. 2001. A guide to empirical research in communication: rules for looking. United
Kingdom: Sage publications.
Shelby, 1993. Organizational, business, management, and communication: an analysis of
boundaries and relationships. Journal of Business Communication, 30(3)241-267.
Seitel, P.F. 1984. The practice of public relations. 2nd ed. Columbus: Merrill Publishing
Company.
Spicer, 1997. Communication from an advocacy frame. Organizational public relations: a
political perspective. New Jersey: Lawrence Erlbaum publishers.
Sproule, J.M. 1988. The new managerial rhetoric and the old criticism. Quarterly Journal of
Speech, 74(4):468-486.
Steyn, B. & Green, M. 2001. Investigating strategic management roles of the corporate
communication function in the Department of Housing. Communicare, 20(2):1-35.
Steyn, B. 2004. From strategy to corporate communication strategy: a conceptualisation.
Journal of Communication Management, 8(2):68-183.
Steyn, B & Puth, G. 2000. Corporate communication strategy. Sandown, South Africa:
Heinemann Publishers.
Tench, R and Yeomas, L. 2009. Exploring Public Relations. 2nd ed. United Kingdom:
Prentice Hall.
442
Tindall, N.T.J. & Holtzhausen, D.R. 2011. Towards a role theory for strategic
communication:
the
case
of
South
Africa.
International
Journal
of
Strategic
Communication, 5(2):74-94.
Theaker, A. (ed.) 2004. Public sector public relations. The public relations handbook.
London and New York: Routledge.
Teer-Tomaselli, R. 2006. Political advertising in South Africa. The Sage Handbook of
Political Advertising, 429-442.
Valentini, C. 2013. Public relations in the public sector: the role of strategic communication
in the Italian public administration. Sinergie rivista di studi e ricerche. [Online] available
from: http://sinergiejournal.it/pdf/92/05.pdf [Downloaded: 04.02.2014].
Van Audenhove, L. 2003. Towards an integrated information society policy in South Africa:
an overview of political rhetoric and policy initiatives 1994-2000. Communicatio: South
African Journal for Communication Theory and Research, 29(2):129-147.
Van Bekkum, T., Cornelissen, J.P., & Van Ruler, B. 2008. Corporate communications and
corporate reputation: understanding how (best) practices make a difference. In: Melewar,
T.C. (ed.) Facets of Corporate Identity, Communication and Reputation. London and New
York: Routledge.
Van der Walt, G. 2014. Public Administration teaching and interdisciplinarity: Considering
the consequences, Teaching Public Administration, 32(2):169-193.
Van Riel, C.B.M. & Balmer, J.M.T. 1997. Corporate identity: the concept, its measurement
and management. European Journal of Marketing, 31(6):340-355.
Van Riel, C.B.M & Fombrun, C.J. 2007. Essentials of corporate communications. New
York: Routledge.
443
Van Ruler, B. 2004. The communication grid: an introduction of a model of four
communication strategies. Public Relations Review, 30:123-143.
Van Ruler, B. 2000. Communication management in the Netherlands. Public Relations
Review, 26(4):403-423.
Van Slyke Turk, J. & Franklin, B. (1987). Information subsidies: agenda-setting traditions.
Public Relations Review, 13:29-41.
Vos, M. 2006. Setting the research agenda for government communication. Journal of
Communication
Management,
10(3):250-258.
[Online]
Available
from:
www.emeraldinsight.com/1363-254X.htm. [Downloaded: 2011-03-12].
Vos, M. 2009. Communicating quality and added value: a measurement instrument for
municipalities. Journal of Communication Management, 13(4):362-377.
Vos, M & Westerhoudt, E. 2008. Trends in government communication in the Netherlands.
Journal of Communication Management, 12(1):18-29.
Vasu, ML., Stewart, DW & Garson. 1990. Organisational Behaviour and Public
Management (2nd ed). New York: CRC Press.
Walsh, K. 1994. Marketing and public sector management. European Journal of
Marketing, 28(3):63-71.
Wasserman, H. & de Beer, A.S. 2005. A fragile affair: The relationship between the
mainstream media and government in post-apartheid South Africa. Journal of Mass Media
Ethics, 20(3):192-208.
Watson, T & Noble, P. 2007. Evaluating structures and processes. Evaluating public
relations: a best practice guide to public relations planning, research and evaluation. (2nd
edition). London and Philadelphia: Kogan Page.
444
Waymer, D. 2013. Democracy and government public relations: expanding the scope of
“relationship” in public relations research. Public Relations Review, 39:320-331.
Whelan, S., Davies, G., Walsh, M. & Bourke, R. 2009. Public sector corporate branding
and customer orientation. Journal of Business research, 63:1164-1.
Wimmer, R.D & Dominick, J.R. 2012. 10th ed. Content analysis. Mass Media Research: an
Introduction. United States: Cengege Learning.
Wigston, D.J. 2009. Quantitative content analysis. In: Fourie, P.J. (ed.) Media studies:
media content and media audiences. South Africa: Juta publications.
Wood, E. 2004. Corporate identity. In: Theaker, A. (ed.) The Public Relations Handbook.
London and New York: Routledge.
Young, (ed.) 2007. Government communication in Australia. Australia: Cambridge
University Press.
445
APPENDIX A
- 1st draft of data collection instrument(-s) -
446
Questionnaire
INVESTIGATING COMMUNICATION MANAGEMENT BY GOVERNMENT BY
DEPARTMENTS IN THE KWAZULU NATAL PROVINCE IN SOUTH AFRICA
Dear respondent
Thank you for your willingness to complete this survey. The purpose of this survey is to
evaluate if government communication is as unique as predicted by extant literature.
Literature postulates that communication management in the public sector is different from
that of the private-corporate sector. The proposed study questions the practical existence
of a unique communication environment in the public sector and its likely impacts on
government communication practices within the KwaZulu Natal metropolitan.
The survey should not take more than 30 minutes to complete. This is an anonymous and
confidential survey. You cannot be identified and the answers you provide will be used for
research purposes only.
Please answer all questions were possible. There are no right or wrong answers. We are
only interested in understanding your opinions, perceptions and experiences as
government communicators.
Do you consider yourself a government communicator?
This term refers to government public relation practitioners who handle communication on the behalf of
government departments. The term is inclusive of all various positions and n names given to different
specialty functions of government communication.
YES
NO
If your answer is ‘NO’, please do not continue answering the questionnaire.
Do you handle communication for a government department in the KwaZulu Natal
metropolitan area?
YES
NO
If your answer is ‘NO’, please do not continue answering the questionnaire.
If you answered ‘No’ to either question 1 or question 2, please stop. Do not continue
answering the questionnaire. Thank you for your time. If you answered ‘Yes’ to both
questions, please continue.
Please write your employee’s Title (example: Media Liaison, communication officer
Corporate Communication manager, Chief Communication Officer):
..........................................................................................................................................
447
Please indicate your gender
*Please indicate your term of employment
Male
Permanent
Female
Please indicate your age
20-34
50-54
Contract
35-39
55-59
Please indicate your education qualification
BA
BA Hons
MA
BS
MS
LLB
40-44
60-65
45-49
0lder
MBA
PhD
Diploma
No tertiary
*Specify if other: ..................................................................................................................
How many years if any, have you been employed in government communication ?
1-2
3-5
6-8
8-9
10 & beyond
Some months
Question: how frequently do you engage in the following media relations’ activity?
On a scale of 1 to 5, where 1 = “never engage in activity” and 5= “engage in activity daily”.
How frequent do you perform the following media relations roles?
1
2
3
4
5
Responding to media inquiries
Contribute to/edit Website
Media release
Track media clips
Social Network fb, Twitter…
Brochures
Fliers
Pitch stories to media
Newsletters
Media interviews
Strategic plans
Fact sheet
Guides
Train leadership/experts for interviews
Crisis communication plans
Print advertising
Community meetings
Primary research
Radio or TV
News conference
Broadcast advertising
Blog
448
(Source: Liu et al., 2010)
In my department, government communication functions include (check all that applies
Advertising
Marketing of departments services
Corporate Identity Management
E-governance (websitea)
Reputation Management
Social Media
Corporate missions statements
Media Relations
Crisis management
Internal Communications
Issue management
Community engagement
Speech writing
Intergovernmental Relations
Communication advice to management
Other:
Other:
Table Scale (source: Liu et a.,l 2010)
Other:
Please rate the following as high or low
How would you rate the level of coverage?
-positive
Media coverage
-negative
evaluation
-neutral
-fair
HIGH
Politics
Rate the impact of politics on your job
Professional
Development
How satisfied are you with your employer’s support to your
professional development?..............................................
How satisfied are you with you’re the GCIS’s support to your
professional development?..........................................
Rate your satisfaction of promotion and advancement
opportunities within your organisation ?
Centralization
Rate the frequency in which you interact with the central
government department in Pretoria?
Rate the frequency in which you interact with the districts?
Relationships with
Primary Publics
Rate the level of information diffusion to publics?
Rate the level of interaction with publics?
Devaluation of
Communication by
Management
Rate the value of government communication as perceived
by management?
Rate the value of government communication as perceived
by the general public?
GCIS
Rate the level in which you consult the handbook?
Rate the level in which you interact with gcis?
Transparency
Rate your personal value to transparency.
Rate the level of transparency in your department.
Rate your support of the information bill
Rate politicians/management support of transparency.
LOW
449
Thank you
Interview questions
Section 1: government communication as a practice
Government Communication: Roles and Responsibility
 What is your employment title?
 What is the role of the communication cluster in this government department?
 What are your roles and responsibilities in the department?
 Are these roles and responsibilities in alignment with your job title and job
description?
 Do you feel that you are expected to perform a variety of responsibilities outside
your job description? If so, please describe additional roles.
 How long have you been working in government communication and in what
capacity?
 What levels of education are you qualified and for which discipline are you
qualified?
 What is your employment background, including those conducted in other sectors?
 If you have worked in communication at the private sector, (even if not) how do you
view the similarities and differences of communication management within the two
sectors?
 How many government communicators are currently employed by this government
department?
 How many employees if any do you manage?
 What do you think is the overall purpose of government communication?
 Do you think managers (politicians) understand the role of government
communication ?
 To what extent is government communication advocacy, information diffusion, or
boundary spanning?
Role of the GCIS in the province







Do you understand the role of the GCIS in the province?
How do you relate with the GCIS and when last have you been in contact with them
and for what matters?
How often do you attend GCIS briefings?
In terms of training and development, do you feel that you have enough support
from the GCIS?
How useful is the GCIS and its resources in conducting your everyday job?
How often do you consult the GCIS communication handbook and how useful has it
been?
For communication managers, how useful are the PCF meetings?
Strategic Government Communication
450










Do you have a communication strategy document in the department?
How closely aligned is this communication strategy from the GCIS provincial
communication strategy?
Who is responsible for the development of a communication strategy and how much
input does he have from the rest of the colleagues?
What is your understanding of strategic communication?
To what extent, if any, does the communication cluster have influence over policy
decisions in the government department?
Does the communication managers have a sit in the decision making table?
According to literature, strategic communication involves environmental scanning,
compilation of information from the environment and communicating this to
management. Management will henceforth consider arising information and make
decisions, policies and legislations in respond to identified public issues. It becomes
a circular process. How do you see this process working in your department?
In retrospect, what would you say are the major challenges in government
communication?
Is communication symmetrical (one way) or asymmetrical (interactive)?
What is done as part of internal communication?
Communication Structures






Please provide me with the organogram of the communication cluster?
Can you explain how the communication cluster fits in the overall departmental
organogram?
Does this structure have an impact on government communication?
Are there government communicators in districts?
How does this (communication) department relate to them, how often do you
communicate with them (districts)?
Are these trained government communicators and who regulates their activities?
Communication Evaluations




How do you collect data about the public’s needs?
How possible is it to conduct communication effectiveness evaluation?
What types of evaluations are conducted using which tools?
How often are communication evaluations conducted?
Outreach programmes and events management






How often do you initiate communication with citizens as your primary publics?
What are imbizos and how are they structured and handled?
What are outreach programmes and how do their work?
Who sets the agenda for these events, who decides on the area to visit?
Is there a criterion on deciding the locations for imbizos and outreach programmes?
What is project ‘sukuma’sakhe’? And how is it enacted in your department?
Corporate identity and branding
451



Do you think the public is aware of your branding (brand awareness)?
Can you explain the process of branding for events and outreach programmes?
What other identity communication initiatives are in place excluding the visual
branding?
Direct communication: Publications






What in-house journals do you have? Who are the target audiences?
What publications are directed at external stakeholders, particularly the general
public?
How often does this department contribute news to Simama?
How is Simana and other publications distributed to the public (circulation)?
What is the readership figure of your external publication (readership)?
It seems KZN government is moving towards direct communication through the
establishment of self-publications, what is driving that move?
Government Communication and Media Relations












Literature shows a high media scrutiny and negative coverage of government,
what’s your perception on this?
Do you feel that the media fully understands the issues of the department?
Whose role is it to educate the media about the intricacies of your departmental
issues?
What is done in this regard?
How important is building relationships with the media?
What strategies do you use to encourage more (positive) media coverage?
How often does the department initiate communication with the media?
Who sets the communication agenda?
Do you feel that management (politicians) understand media relations?
Which media do you most engage? Local, provisional, or national?
Which media type is predominately targeted by the department? Newspapers,
magazines, radio, television, the internet (our website)?
How does the GCIS assist in media relations?
Section 2: the uniqueness of government communication
Politics

Politics is a dynamic of every organisation, but literature assumes that politics is
fully encompassing in government, how does politics affect your job?
 Are you able to remain non-partisan in performing your job?
 What would you say marks a distinction between government communication and
political communication?
Legal constraints



Are there any laws or legal issues that stifle your ability to communicate?
How affected is government communication by the bureaucracies of government?
How do you think the proposed information bill will affect government
communication?
452
Devaluation of Communication
 Do you think the value of communication is recognised by management
(politicians)?
 Do you feel appreciated for your job?
 Does communication have enough budgets, and enough resources including
human resource?
Professional development:










Are you a member of any professional organisation like prisa or other?
How useful is the GCIS in professional development?
Is there any kind of training that you have received from GCIS?
Is there any training you would like to attend and have you made any request for it
and to whom?
In your opinion, how can GCIS improve its services to you as government
communicators?
How are new staffs inducted into government communication?
Do you think government communicators (particularly new ones) fully understand
the intricacies of government?
How satisfied are you with advancement and promotion opportunities within your
organisation ?
How satisfied are you with your ability to play a leadership role within your organisation ?
What is the most important skill a government communicator must possess? How
different is this from the skill required of corporate communicators? Comment.
Centralisation
 How often do you work with your central government department in Pretoria?
 How often do you work with local offices of your government department?
[Thank You]
Communication strategy documents consulted
1. Department of public works communication strategy (2010-2014) Final draft
December 2009 (not yet approved)
2. Draft Communication policy department of sport and recreation 2012 (not approved)
3. Provincial Communication strategy (2012/2013)
4. Department of Health corporate communication strategy 2011
5. Communication, marketing and media strategy – KZN Department of Co-operative
Governance and Traditional Affairs April 2012 – March 2013.
6. Department of education’s draft communication strategy (2012/13 – 2017/8)
7. Economic development and Tourism (KZN) draft DEDT Communication Policy
2012/2013
453
APPENDIX B
- Informed consent form -
454
Introduction Letter
GOVERNMENT COMMUNICATORS
INVESTIGATING COMMUNICATION MANAGEMENT BY GOVERNMENT DEPARTMENTS IN THE
KWAZULU NATAL PROVINCE IN SOUTH AFRICA
Greetings, my name is Rofhiwa Felicia Mukhudwana. I am a PhD candidate at the University of
Pretoria.
This letter is an invitation to an empirical study focusing on government communication and
government communicators. All government departments in KZN are targeted for this study. For
years, government communication has been seen as tantamount to corporate communication in the
private sector. Communication research examining the public sector rarely indicates differentiation
of communication practices as due to a differential communication environment of the government
sector.
It is claimed that government communication is unique and distinguished from the communication
management of the private sector. Government communication contains with it opportunities and
constraints that are assumed different. For instance, Theaker (2004:218) argues that working in the
public sector is challenging for public relations in that government often deals with various, neverending complex networks of stakeholders. This calls into question the uniqueness of government
communication.
The purpose of the study is to explore the extent to which the unique communication environment
of the public sector impacts upon the practice of communication management in government
departments within the KwaZulu Natal metropolitan. In addition, the study examines the role of the
Government Communication and Information Systems GCIS in standardising and professionalising
government communication at a provincial departmental level.
I will extremely appreciate your participation and input in this research, and hence would like an
opportunity to come and explain the study in further details (10 minutes). Participation in this
research will consist of a 20 minutes interview and a 15 minutes self-administered questionnaire.
The goal is to understand your experiences as a government communicator. I sincerely believe that
the department has a lot to contribute and learn from the project (together we can do more). The
study is conducted for academic purposes. The findings will be made available to the participants
and confidentiality is guaranteed. A consent form is attached for your perusal.
A response to this meeting request will be greatly appreciated. A courtesy phone call will be made
at your request for more details.
Kind Regards
Ms R.F Mukhudwana (ID: 840204 0803 082)
455
Faculty of Economic and
Management Sciences
Informed consent for participation in an academic
research study
Dept. of Communication Management
INVESTIGATING COMMUNICATION MANAGEMENT BY GOVERNMENT DEPARTMENTS IN
THE KWAZULU NATAL PROVINCE IN SOUTH AFRICA
Research conducted by:
Ms. R.F. Mukhudwana (11168049)
Cell: 076 7534 844
Dear Respondent
You are invited to participate in an academic research study conducted by Rofhiwa Felicia Mukhudwana, a
Doctoral student from the Department of Marketing and Communication Management at the University of
Pretoria.
The purpose of this study is to explore the extent to which the unique communication environment of the
public sector impacts upon the nature of communication management practiced in the South African
government sector (KZN) and the degree to which this uniqueness is perceived and experienced by
government communicators. In addition, the study aims to examine the role of the GCIS in standardising and
professionalizing government communication at a provincial departmental level.
Please note the following:

This study involves an anonymous survey. Your name will not appear on the questionnaire and the
answers you give will be treated as strictly confidential. You cannot be identified in person based on the
answers you give.

Your participation in this study is very important to us. You may, however, choose not to participate and
you may also stop participating at any time without any negative consequences.

Please answer the questions in the attached questionnaire as completely and honestly as possible. This
should not take more than 30 minutes of your time.

The results of the study will be used for academic purposes only and may be published in an academic
journal. We will provide you with a summary of our findings on request.

Please contact my supervisor, Professor Ronel Rensburg ([email protected]. 0122403395,
0836325332) if you have any questions or comments regarding the study.
Please sign the form to indicate that:

You have read and understand the information provided above.

You give your consent to participate in the study on a voluntary basis.
___________________________
Respondent’s signature
___________________
456
457